Standard Chinese

A modular Approach

Sponsored by Agencies of the United States and Canadian governments

Table of Contents
List of Tables

Colophon

This publication is to be used primarily in support of instructing military personnel as part of the Defense Language Program (resident and nonresident). Inquiries concerning the use of materials, including requests for copies, should be addressed to:

Defense Language Institute

Foreign Language Center

Nonresident Training Division

Presidio of Monterey, CA 93944-5006

Topics in the areas of politics, international relations, mores, etc., which may be considered as controversial from some points of view, are sometimes included in the language instruction for DLIFLC students since military personnel may find themselves in positions where a clear understanding of conversations or written materials of this nature will be essential to their mission. The presence of controversial statements—whether real or apparent—in DLIFLC materials should not be construed as representing the opinions of the writers, the DLIFLC, or the Department of Defense.

Actual brand names and businesses are sometimes cited in DLIFLC instructional materials to provide instruction in pronunciations and meanings. The selection of such proprietary terms and names is based solely on their value for instruction in the language. It does not constitute endorsement of any product or commercial enterprise, nor is it intended to invite a comparison with other brand names and businesses not mentioned.

In DLIFLC publications, the words he, him, and/or his denote both masculine and feminine genders. This statement does not apply to translations of foreign language texts.

The DLIFLC may not have full rights to the materials it produces. Purchase by the customer does net constitute authorization for reproduction, resale, or showing for profit. Generally, products distributed by the DLIFLC may be used in any not-for-profit setting without prior approval from the DLIFLC.

🛈︎
Note

This course was formatted by Eric Streit (eric@yojik.eu) using the docbook format from the pdf scanned documents found on:

https://fsi-language.yojik.eu

Ronald Grenier (Demi Puppet) is helping a lot with digitizing, proofreading)! Thanks a lot.

You can find the pdf, epub, odt versions on https://git.yojik.eu/ (whole book or separate lessons)

The document will be edited with traditional characters, and converted to simplified later. The transformation from traditional to simplified is far more accurate than the other way I intended to do.

The tones in the book sentences will match how the word would sound when spoken in a sentence, not how it sounds in the dictionary.

I intend to do a French version later ….

Preface

Standard Chinese: A Modular Approach originated in an inter-agency conference held at the Foreign Service Institute in August 1973 to address the need generally felt in the U.S. Government language training community for improving and updating Chinese materials, to reflect current usage in Beijing and Taipei.

The conference resolved to develop materials which were flexible enough in form and content to meet the requirements of a wide range of government agencies and academic institutions.

A Project Board was established consisting of representatives of the Central Intelligence Agency Language Learning Center, the Defense Language Institute, the State Department’s Foreign Service Institute, the Cryptologic School of the National Security Agency, and the U.S. Office of Education, later joined by the Canadian Forces Foreign Language School. The representatives have included Arthur T. McNeill, John Hopkins, and John Boag (CIA); Colonel John F. Elder III, Joseph C. Hutchinson, Ivy Gibian, and Major Bernard Muller-Thym (DLI); James R. Frith and John B. Ratliff III (FSI); Kazuo Shitama (NSA); Richard T. Thompson and Julia Petrov (OE); and Lieutenant Colonel George Kozoriz (CFFLS).

The Project Board set up the Chinese Core Curriculum Project in 1974 in space provided at the Foreign Service Institute. Each of the six U.S. and Canadian government agencies provided funds and other assistance.

Gerard P. Kok was appointed project coordinator, and a planning council was formed consisting of Mr. Kok, Frances Li of the Defense Language Institute, Patricia O’Connor of the University of Texas, Earl M. Rickerson of the Language Learning Center, and James Wrenn of Brown University. In the fall of 1977, Lucille A. Barale was appointed deputy project coordinator. David W. Dellinger of the Language Learning Center and Charles R. Sheehan of the Foreign Service Institute also served on the planning council and contributed material to the project. The planning council drew up the original overall design for the materials and met regularly to review their development.

Writers for the first half of the materials were John H. T. Harvey, Lucille A. Barale, and Roberta S. Barry, who worked in close cooperation with the planning council and with the Chinese staff of the Foreign Service Institute. Mr. Harvey developed the instructional formats of the comprehension and production self-study materials, and also designed the communications classroom activities and wrote the teacher’s guides. Lucille A. Barale and Roberta S. Barry wrote the tape scripts and the student text. By 1978 Thomas E. Madden and Susan C. Pola had joined the staff. Led by Ms. Barale, they have worked as a team to produce the materials subsequent to Module 6.

All Chinese language material was prepared or selected by Chuan 0. Chao, Ying-chi Chen, Hsiao-Jung Chi, Eva Diao, Jan Hu, Tsung-mi Li, and Yunhui C. Yang, assisted for part of the time by Chieh-fang Ou Lee, Ying-ming Chen, and Joseph Yu Hsu Wang. Anna Affholder, Mei-li Chen, and Henry Khuo helped in the preparation of a preliminary corpus of dialogues.

Administrative assistance was provided at various times by Vincent Basciano, Lisa A. Bowden, Jill W. Ellis, Donna Fong, Renee T. C. Liang, Thomas E. Madden, Susan C. Pola, and Kathleen Strype.

The production of tape recordings was directed by Jose M. Ramirez of the Foreign Service Institute Recording Studio. The Chinese script was voiced by Ms. Chao, Ms. Chen, Mr. Chen, Ms. Diao, Ms. Hu, Mr. Khuo, Mr. Li, and Ms. Yang. The English script was read by Ms. Barale, Ms. Barry, Mr. Basciano, Ms. Ellis, Ms. Pola, and Ms. Strype.

The graphics were produced by John McClelland of the Foreign Service Institute Audio-Visual staff, under the general supervision of Joseph A. Sadote, Chief of Audio-Visual.

Standard Chinese: A Modular Approach was field-tested with the cooperation of Brown University; the Defense Language Institute, Foreign Language Center; the Foreign Service Institute; the Language Learning Center; the United States Air Force Academy; the University of Illinois; and the University of Virginia.

Colonel Samuel L. Stapleton and Colonel Thomas G. Foster, Commandants of the Defense Language Institute, Foreign Language Center, authorized the DLIFLC support necessary for preparation of this edition of the course materials. This support included coordination, graphic arts, editing, typing, proofreading, printing, and materials necessary to carry out these tasks.

Introduction

About the course

This course is designed to give you a practical command of spoken Standard Chinese. You will learn both to understand and to speak it. Although Standard Chinese is one language, there are differences between the particular form it takes in Beijing and the form it takes in the rest of the country. There are also, of course, significant non-linguistic differences between regions of the country. Reflecting these regional differences, the settings for most conversations are Beijing and Taipei.

This course represents a new approach to the teaching of foreign languages. In many ways it redefines the roles of teacher and student, of classwork and homework, and of text and tape. Here is what you should expect:

  • The focus is on communicating in Chinese in practical situations—the obvious ones you will encounter upon arriving in China. You will be communicating in Chinese most of the time you are in class. You will not always be talking about real situations, but you will almost always be purposefully exchanging information in Chinese.

  • This focus on communicating means that the teacher is first of all your conversational partner. Anything that forces him1 back into the traditional roles of lecturer and drill-master limits your opportunity to interact with a speaker of the Chinese language and to experience the language in its full spontaneity, flexibility, and responsiveness.

  • Using class time for communicating, you will complete other course activities out of class whenever possible. This is what the tapes are for. They introduce the new material of each unit and give you as much additional practice as possible without a conversational partner.

  • The texts summarize and supplement the tapes, which take you through new material step by step and then give you intensive practice on what you have covered. In this course you will spend almost all your time listening to Chinese and saying things in Chinese, either with the tapes or in class.

How the Course Is Organized

The subtitle of this course, “A Modular Approach,” refers to overall organization of the materials into MODULES which focus on particular situations or language topics and which allow a certain amount of choice as to what is taught and in what order. To highlight equally significant features of the course, the subtitle could just as well have been “A Situational Approach,” “A Taped-Input Approach,” or “A Communicative Approach.”

Ten situational modules form the core of the course:

ORIENTATION (ORN) Talking about who you are and where you are from.
BIOGRAPHIC INFORMATION (BIO) Talking about your background, family, studies, and occupation and about your visit to China.
MONEY (MON) Making purchases and changing money.
DIRECTIONS (DIR) Asking directions in a city or in a building.
TRANSPORTATION (TRN) Taking buses, taxis, trains, and planes, including finding out schedule information, buying tickets, and making reservations.
ARRANGING A MEETING (MTG) Arranging a business meeting or a social get-together, changing the time of an appointment, and declining an invitation.
SOCIETY (SOC) Talking about families, relationships between people, cultural roles in traditional society, and cultural trends in modern society.
TRAVELING IN CHINA (TRL) Making travel arrangements and visiting a kindergarten, the Great Wall, the Ming Tombs, a commune, and a factory.
LIFE IH CHINA (LIC) Talking about daily life in Běijīng street committees, leisure activities, traffic and transportation, buying and rationing, housing.
TALKING ABOUT THE NEWS (TAN) Talking about government and party policy changes described in newspapers the educational system agricultural policy, international policy, ideological policy, and policy in the arts.

Each core module consists of tapes, a student textbook, and a workbook.

In addition to the ten CORE modules, there are also RESOURCE modules and OPTIONAL modules. Resource modules teach particular systems in the language, such as numbers and dates. As you proceed through a situational core module, you will occasionally take time out to study part of a resource module. (You will begin the first three of these while studying the Orientation Module.)

PRONUNCIATION AND ROMANIZATION (P&R) The sound system of Chinese and the Pinyin system of romanization.
NUMBERS (NUM) Numbers up to five digits.
CLASSROOM EXPRESSIONS (CE) Expressions basic to the classroom learning situation.
TIME AND DATES (T&D) Dates, days of the week, clock time, parts of the day.
GRAMMAR Aspect and verb types, word order, multisyllabic verbs and auxiliary verbs, complex sentences, adverbial expressions.

Each module consists of tapes and a student textbook.

The eight optional modules focus on particular situations:

  • RESTAURANT (RST)

  • HOTEL (HTL)

  • PERSONAL WELFARE (WLF)

  • POST OFFICE AND TELEPHONE (PST/TEL)

  • CAR (CAR)

  • CUSTOMS SURROUNDING MARRIAGE, BIRTH, MD DEATH (MBD)

  • NEW YEAR’S CELEBRATION (NYR)

  • INSTITUTIONS AND ORGANIZATIONS (I&O)

Each module consists of tapes and a student textbook. These optional modules may be used at any time after certain core modules,

The diagram on page here shows how the core modules, optional modules, and resource modules fit together in the course. Resource modules are shown where study should begin. Optional modules are shown where they may be introduced.

Inside a Core Module

Each core module has from four to eight units. A module also includes:

  • Objectives: The module objectives are listed at the beginning of the text for each module. Read these before starting work on the first unit to fix in your mind what you are trying to accomplish and what you will have to do to pass the test at the end of the module.

  • Target Lists: These follow the objectives in the text. They summarize the language content of each unit in the form of typical questions and answers on the topic of that unit. Each sentence is given both in romanized Chinese and in English. Turn to the appropriate Target List before, during, or after your work on a unit, whenever you need to pull together what is in the unit.

  • Review Tapes (R-l): The Target List sentences are given on these tapes. Except in the short Orientation Module, there are two R-l tapes for each module.

  • Criterion Test: After studying each module, you will take a Criterion Test to find out which module objectives you have met and which you need to work on before beginning to study another module.

Inside a Unit

Here is what you will be doing in each unit. First, you will work through two tapes:

  1. Comprehension Tape 1 (C-1): This tape introduces all the new words and structures in the unit and lets you hear them in the context of short conversational exchanges. It then works them into other short conversations and longer passages for listening practice, and finally reviews them in the Target List sentences. Your goal when using the tape is to understand all the Target List sentences for the unit.

  2. Production Tape 1 (P-1): This tape gives you practice in pronouncing the new words and in saying the sentences you learned to understand on the C-1 tape. Your goal when using the P-1 tape is to be able to produce any of the Target List sentences in Chinese when given the English equivalent.

    The C-1 and P-1 tapes, not accompanied by workbooks, are “portable,” in the sense that they do not tie you down to your desk. However, there are some written materials for each unit which you will need to work into your study routine. A text Reference List at the beginning of each unit contains the sentences from the C-1 and P-1 tapes. It includes both the Chinese sentences and their English equivalents. The text Reference Notes restate and expand the comments made on the C-1 and P-1 tapes concerning grammar, vocabulary, pronunciation, and culture. After you have worked with the C-1 and P-1 tapes, you go on to two class activities:

  3. Target List Review: In this first class activity of the unit, you find out how well you learned the C-1 and P-1 sentences. The teacher checks your understanding and production of the Target List sentences. He also presents any additional required vocabulary items, found at the end of the Target List, which were not on the C-1 and P-1 tapes.

  4. Structural Buildup: During this class activity, you work on your understanding and control of the new structures in the unit. You respond to questions from your teacher about situations illustrated on a chalkboard or explained in other ways.

    After these activities, your teacher may want you to spend some time working on the drills for the unit.

  5. Drill Tape: This tape takes you through various types of drills based on the Target List sentences and on the additional required vocabulary.

  6. Drills: The teacher may have you go over some or all of the drills in class, either to prepare for work with the tape, to review the tape, or to replace it.

    Next, you use two more tapes. These tapes will give you as much additional practice as possible outside of class.

  7. Comprehension Tape 2 (C-2): This tape provides advanced listening practice with exercises containing long, varied passages which fully exploit the possibilities of the material covered. In the C-2 Workbook you answer questions about the passages.

  8. Production Tape 2 (P-2): This tape resembles the Structural Buildup in that you practice using the new structures of the unit in various situations. The P-2 Workbook provides instructions and displays of information for each exercise.

    Following work on these two tapes, you take part in two class activities:

  9. Exercise Review: The teacher reviews the exercises of the C-2 tape by reading or playing passages from the tape and questioning you on them. He reviews the exercises of the P-2 tape by questioning you on information displays in the P-2 Workbook.

  10. Communication Activities: Here you use what you have learned in the unit for the purposeful exchange of information. Both fictitious situations (in Communication Games) and real-world situations involving you and your classmates (in "interviews") are used.

Materials and Activities for a Unit

TAPED MATERIALS WRITTEN MATERIALS CLASS ACTIVITIES
C-1, P-1 Tapes

Target List

Reference List

Reference Notes

Target List Review
——————- ——————- Structural Buildup
D-1 Tapes Drills Drills
C-2, P-2 Tapes

Reference Notes

C-2, P-2 Workbooks

Exercise Review
——————- ——————- Communication Activities

By Photo by CEphoto, Uwe Aranas or alternatively © CEphoto, Uwe Aranas, CC BY-SA 3.0, https://commons.wikimedia.org/w/index.php?curid=51438668

Figure 1.1 Wén wǔ Temple in central Taiwan (courtesy of Thomas Madden)

Background Notes: About Chinese

The Chinese Languages

We find it perfectly natural to talk about a language called “Chinese.” We say, for example, that the people of China speak different dialects of Chinese, and that Confucius wrote in an ancient form of Chinese. On the other hand, we would never think of saying that the people of Italy, France, Spain, and Portugal speak dialects of one language, and that Julius Caesar wrote in an ancient form of that language. But the facts are almost exactly parallel.

Therefore, in terms of what we think of as a language when closer to home, “Chinese” is not one language, but a family of languages. The language of Confucius is partway up the trunk of the family tree. Like Latin, it lived on as a literary language long after its death as a spoken language in popular use. The seven modern languages of China, traditionally known as the “dialects,” are the branches of the tree. They share as strong a family resemblance as do Italian, French, Spanish, and Portuguese, and are about as different from one another.

The predominant language of China is now known as Pǔtōnghuà, or “Standard Chinese” (literally “the common speech”). The more traditional term, still used in Taiwan, is Guóyǔ, or “Mandarin” (literally “the national language”). Standard Chinese is spoken natively by almost two-thirds of the population of China and throughout the greater part of the country.

The term “Standard Chinese” is often used more narrowly to refer to the true national language which is emerging. This language, which is already the language of all national broadcasting, is based primarily on the Peking dialect, but takes in elements from other dialects of Standard Chinese and even from other Chinese languages. Like many national languages, it is more widely understood than spoken, and is often spoken with some concessions to local speech, particularly in pronunciation.

The Chinese languages and their dialects differ far more in pronunciation than in grammar and vocabulary. What distinguishes Standard Chinese most from the other Chinese languages, for example, is that it has the fewest tones and the fewest final consonants.

The remaining six Chinese languages, spoken by approximately a quarter of the population of China, are tightly grouped in the southeast, below the Yangtze River. The six are: the Wu group (), which includes the “Shanghai dialect”; Hunanese (Xiāng); the “Kiangsi dialect” (Gàn); Cantonese (Yuè), the language of Guǎngdōng, widely spoken in Chinese communities in the United States; Fukienese (Mǐn), a variant of which is spoken by a majority on Taiwan and hence called Taiwanese; and Hakka (Kèjiā), spoken in a belt above the Cantonese area, as well as by a minority on Taiwan. Cantonese, Fukienese, and Hakka are also widely spoken throughout Southeast Asia.

There are minority ethnic groups in China who speak non-Chinese languages. Some of these, such as Tibetan, are distantly related to the Chinese languages. Others, such as Mongolian, are entirely unrelated.

Some Characteristics of Chinese

To us, perhaps the roost striking feature of spoken Chinese is the use of variation in tone (“tones” to distinguish the different meanings of syllables which would otherwise sound alike. All languages, and Chinese is no exception, make use of sentence intonation to indicate how whole sentences are to be understood. In English, for example, the rising pattern in “He’s gone?” tells us that the sentence is meant as a question. The Chinese tones, however, are quite a different matter. They belong to individual syllables, not to the sentence as a whole. An inherent part of each Standard Chinese syllable is one of four distinctive tones. The tone does just as much to distinguish the syllable as do the consonants and vowels. For example, the only difference between the verb “to buy,” mǎi and the verb “to sell,” mài, is the Low tone (ˇ̆) and the Falling tone (`). And yet these words are Just as distinguishable as our words “buy” and “guy,” or “buy” and “boy.” Apart from the tones, the sound system of Standard Chinese is no more different from English than French is.

Word formation in Standard Chinese is relatively simple. For one thing, there are no conjugations such as are found in many European languages. Chinese verbs have fewer forms than English verbs, and nowhere near as many irregularities. Chinese grammar relies heavily on word order, and often the word order is the same as in English. For these reasons Chinese is not as difficult for Americans to learn to speak as one might think.

It is often said that Chinese is a monosyllabic language. This notion contains a good deal of truth. It has been found that, on the average, every other word in ordinary conversation is a single-syllable word. Moreover, although most words in the dictionary have two syllables, and some have more, these words can almost always be broken down into single-syllable units of meaning, many of which can stand alone as words.

Written Chinese

Most languages with which we are familiar are written with an alphabet. The letters may be different from ours, as in the Greek alphabet, but the principle is the same: one letter for each consonant or vowel sound, more or less. Chinese, however, is written with “characters” which stand for whole syllables—in fact, for whole syllables with particular meanings. Although there are only about thirteen hundred phonetically distinct syllables in standard Chinese, there are several thousand Chinese characters in everyday use, essentially one for each single-syllable unit of meaning. This means that many words have the same pronunciation but are written with different characters, as tiān, “sky,” , and tiān, “to add,” “to increase,” . Chinese characters are often referred to as “ideographs” which suggests that they stand directly for ideas. But this is misleading. It is better to think of them as standing for the meaningful syllables of the spoken language.

Minimal literacy in Chinese calls for knowing about a thousand characters. These thousand characters, in combination, give a reading vocabulary of several thousand words. Full literacy calls for knowing some three thousand characters. In order to reduce the amount of time needed to learn characters, there has been a vast extension in the People’s Republic of China (PRC) of the principle of character simplification, which has reduced the average number of strokes per character by half.

During the past century, various systems have been proposed for representing the sounds of Chinese with letters of the Roman alphabet. One of these romanizations, Hànyǔ Pīnyīn (literally “Chinese Language Spelling,” generally called “Pinyin” in English), has been adopted officially in the PRC, with the short-term goal of teaching all students the Standard Chinese pronunciation of characters. A long-range goal is the use of Pinyin for written communication throughout the country. This is not possible, of course, until speakers across the nation have uniform pronunciations of Standard Chinese. For the time being, characters, which represent meaning, not pronunciation, are still the most widely accepted way of communicating in writing.

Pinyin uses all of the letters in our alphabet except “v,” and adds the letter “ü.” The spellings of some of the consonant sounds are rather arbitrary from our point of view, but for every consonant sound there is only one letter or one combination of letters, and vice versa. You will find that each vowel letter can stand for different vowel sounds, depending on what letters precede or follow it in the syllable. The four tones are indicated by accent marks over the vowels, and the Neutral tone by the absence of an accent mark:

High:

Falling:

Rising:

Neutral: ma

Low:

One reason often given for the retention of characters is that they can be read, with the local pronunciation, by speakers of all the Chinese languages. Probably a stronger reason for retaining them is that the characters help keep alive distinctions of meaning between words, and connections of meaning between words, which are fading in the spoken language. On the other hand, a Cantonese could learn to speak Standard Chinese, and read it alphabetically, at least as easily as he can learn several thousand characters.

Pinyin is used throughout this course to provide a simple written representation of pronunciation. The characters, which are chiefly responsible for the reputation of Chinese as a difficult language, are taught separately.

BACKGROUND NOTES: ABOUT CHINESE CHARACTERS

Each Chinese character is written as a fixed sequence of strokes. There are very few basic types of strokes, each with its own prescribed direction, length, and contour. The dynamics of these strokes as written with a brush, the classical writing instrument, show up clearly even in printed characters. You can tell from the varying thickness of the stroke how the brush met the paper, how it swooped, and how it lifted; these effects are largely lost in characters written with a ball-point pen.

The sequence of strokes is of particular importance. Let’s take the character for “mouth,” pronounced kǒu. Here it is as normally written, with the order and directions of the strokes indicated.

Figure 2.1 Strokes order

If the character is written rapidly, in “running-style writing,” one stroke glides into the next, like this.

Figure 2.2 Running style writing

If the strokes were written in any but the proper order, quite different distortions would take place as each stroke reflected the last and anticipated the next, and the character would be illegible.

The earliest surviving Chinese characters, inscribed on the Shang Dynasty “oracle bones” of about 1500 B.C. , already included characters that vent beyond simple pictorial representation. There are some characters in use today which are pictorial, like the character for “mouth.” There are also some which are directly symbolic, like our Roman numerals I, II, and III. (The characters for these numbers—the first numbers you learn in this course—are like the Roman numerals turned on their sides.) There are some which are indirectly symbolic, like our Arabic numerals 1, 2, and 3. But the most common type of character is complex, consisting of two parts: a “phonetic,” which suggests the pronunciation, and a “radical,” which broadly characterizes the meaning. Let’s take the following character as an example.

Figure 2.3 Running style writing

This character means “ocean” and is pronounced yáng. The left side of the character, the three short strokes, is an abbreviation of a character which means “water” and is pronounced shuǐ. This is the “radical.” It has been borrowed only for its meaning, "water.” The right side of the character above is a character which means "sheep” and is pronounced yáng. This is the “phonetic.” It has been borrowed only for its sound value, yáng. A speaker of Chinese encountering the above character for the first time could probably figure out that the only Chinese word that sounds like yáng and means something like “water,” is the word yáng meaning “ocean,” We, as speakers of English, might not be able to figure it out. Moreover, phonetics and radicals seldom work as neatly as in this example. But we can still learn to make good use of these hints at sound and sense.

Many dictionaries classify characters in terms of the radicals. According to one of the two dictionary systems used, there are 176 radicals; in the other system, there are 214. There are over a thousand phonetics.

Chinese has traditionally been written vertically, from top to bottom of the page, starting on the right-hand side, with the pages bound so that the first page is where we would expect the last page to be. Nowadays, however, many Chinese publications paginate like Western publications, and the characters are written horizontally, from left to right.

BACKGROUND NOTES: ABOUT CHINESE PERSONAL NAMES AND TITLES

A Chinese personal name consists of two parts: a surname and a given name. There is no middle name. The order is the reverse of ours: surname first, given name last.

The most common pattern for Chinese names is a single-syllable surname followed by a two-syllable given name:2

Máo Zédōng (Mao Tse-tung)

Zhōu Ēnlái (Chou En-lai)

Jiǎng Jièshí (Chiang Kai-shek)

Sòng Qìnglíng (Soong Chʽing-ling—Mme Sun Yat-sen)

Sòng Měilíng (Soong Mei-ling—Mme Chiang Kai-shek)

It is not uncommon, however, for the given name to consist of a single syllable:

Zhū Dé (Chu De) : Marshal Zhu De, the communist general 朱德

Lín Biāo (Lin Piao)

Hú Shì (Hu Shih)

Jiāng Qīng (Chiang Chʽing—Mme Mao Tse-tung)

There are a few two-syllable surnames.

These are usually followed by single-syllable given names:

Sīmǎ Guāng (Ssu-ma Kuang)

Ōuyáng Xiū (Ou-yang Hsiu)

Zhūgě Liàng (Chu-ke Liang)

But two-syllable surnames may also be followed by two-syllable given names:

Sīmǎ Xiāngrú (Ssu-ma Hsiang-ju)

An exhaustive list of Chinese surnames includes several hundred written with a single character and several dozen written with two characters. Some single-syllable surnames sound exactly alike although written with different characters, and to distinguish them, the Chinese nay occasionally have to describe the character or “write” it with a finger on the palm of a hand. But the surnames that you are likely to encounter are fever than a hundred, and a handful of these are so common that they account for a good majority of China’s population.

Given names, as opposed to surnames, are not restricted to a limited list of characters, Men’s names are often but not always distinguishable from women’s; the difference, however, usually lies in the meaning of the characters and so is not readily apparent to the beginning student with a limited knowledge of characters.

Outside the People’s Republic the traditional system of titles is still in use. These titles closely parallel our own “Mr.,” “Mrs.,” and “Miss.” Notice, however, that all Chinese titles follow the name—either the full name or the surname alone—rather than preceding it.

The title “Mr.” is Xiānsheng.

Mǎ Xiānsheng

Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng

The title “Mrs.” is Tàitai. It follows the husband’s full name or surname alone.

Mǎ Tàitai

Mǎ Mínglǐ Tàitai

The title “Miss” is Xiǎojiě. The Ma family’s grown daughter, Défēn, would be

Mǎ Xiǎojiě

Mǎ Défēn Xiǎojiě

Even traditionally, outside the People’s Republic, a married woman does not take her husband’s name in the same sense as in our culture. If Miss Fang Bǎolán marries Mr. Ma Mínglǐ, she becomes Mrs, Mǎ Mínglǐ, but at the same time she remains Fāng Bǎolán, She does not become Mǎ Bǎolán; there is no equivalent of “Mrs. Mary Smith.” She may, however, add her husband’s surname to her own full name and refer to herself as Mǎ Fāng Bǎolán. At work she is quite likely to continue as Miss Fāng.

These customs regarding names are still observed by many Chinese today in various parts of the world. The titles carry certain connotations, however, when used in the PRC today: Tàitai should not be used because it designates that woman as a member of the leisure class. Xiǎojiě should not be used because it carries the connotation of being from a rich family.

In the People’s Republic, the title “Comrade,” Tóngzhì is used in place of the titles Xiānsheng, Tàitai, and Xiǎojiě. Mǎ Mínglǐ would be:

Mǎ Tóngzhì

Mǎ Mínglǐ Tóngzhì

The title “Comrade” is applied to all, regardless of sex or marital status. A married woman does not take her husband’s name in any sense. Mǎ Mínglǐ’s wife would be:

Fāng Tóngzhì

Fāng Bǎolán Tóngzhì

Children may be given either the mother’s or the father’s surname at birth. In some families one child has the father’s surname, and another child has the mother’s surname. Mǎ Mínglǐ’s and Fāng Bǎolán’s grown daughter could be

Mǎ Tŏngzhì

Mǎ Děfēn Tóngzhì

Their grown son could be

Fāng Tóngzhì

Fāng Zìqiáng Tóngzhì

Both in the PRC and elsewhere, of course, there are official titles and titles of respect in addition to the common titles we have discussed here. Several of these will be introduced later in the course.

The question of adapting foreign names to Chinese calls for special consideration. In the People’s Republic the policy is to assign Chinese phonetic equivalents to foreign names. These approximations are often not as close phonetically as they might be, since the choice of appropriate written characters may bring in non-phonetic considerations. (An attempt is usually made when transliterating to use characters with attractive meanings.) For the most part, the resulting names do not at all resemble Chinese names. For example, the official version of “David Anderson” is Dàiwěi Āndésēn.

An older approach, still in use outside the PRC, is to construct a valid Chinese name that suggests the foreign name phonetically. For example, “David Anderson” might be An Dàwèi.

Sometimes, when a foreign surname has the same meaning as a Chinese surname, semantic suggestiveness is chosen over phonetic suggestiveness. For example, Wáng, a common Chinese surname, means “king,” so “Daniel King” might be rendered Wáng Dànián.

Students in this course will be given both the official PRC phonetic equivalents of their names and Chinese-style names.

Chapter 1. Module 1: Orientation

The Orientation Module and associated resource modules provide the linguistic tools needed to begin the study of Chinese. The materials also introduce the teaching procedures used in this course.

The Orientation Module is not a typical course module in several respects. First, it does not have a situational topic of its own, but rather leads into the situational topic of the following module—Biographic Information. Second, it teaches only a little Chinese grammar and vocabulary. Third, two of the associated resource modules (Pronunciation and Romanization, Numbers) are not optional; together with the Orientation Module, they are prerequisite to the rest of the course.

1 Objectives

Upon successful completion of this module and the two associated resource modules, the student should:

  1. Distinguish the sounds and tones of Chinese well enough to he able to write the Hànyǔ Pīnyīn romanization for a syllable after hearing the syllable.

  2. Be able to pronounce any combination of sounds found in the words of the Target Lists when given a romanized syllable to read. (Although the entire sound system of Chinese is introduced in the module, the student is responsible for producing only sounds used in the Target Sentences for ORN. Producing the remaining sounds is included in the Objectives for Biographic Information,)

  3. Know the names and locations of five cities and five provinces of China well enough to point out their locations on a map, and pronounce the names well enough to be understood by a Chinese.

  4. Comprehend the numbers 1 through 99 well enough to write them down when dictated, and be able to say them in Chinese when given English equivalents.

  5. Understand the Chinese system of using personal names, including the use of titles equivalent to “Mr.,” "Mrs.,” “Miss,” and “Comrade.”

  6. Be able to ask and understand questions about where someone is from.

  7. Be able to ask and understand questions about where someone is.

  8. Be able to give the English equivalents for all the Chinese expressions in the Target Lists.

  9. Be able to say all the Chinese expressions in the Target Lists when cued with English equivalents.

  10. Be able to take part in short Chinese conversations, based on the Target Lists, about how he is, who he is, and where he is from.

2 Tapes for ORN and associated resource modules

Orientation (ORN)
Unit 1 1 C-1 1 P-1 1&2 D-1
Unit 2 2 C-1 2 P-1
Unit 3 3 C-1 3 P-1 3 D-1 3 C-2 3 P-2
Unit 4 4 C-1 4 P-1 4 D-1 4 C-2 4 P-2
Pronunciation and Romanization (P&R)
P&R 1 P&R 2 P&R 3 P&R 4 P&R 5 P&R 6
Numbers
NUM 1 NUM 2 NUM 3 NUM 4
Classroom Expressions (CE)
CE 1

3 Unit 1 Target List

1. A: Nǐ shi shéi? 你是誰? Who are you?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I am Wáng Dànián (Daniel King).
A: Wǒ shi Hú Měilíng. 我是胡美玲。 I am Hú Měilíng.
2. A: Nǐ xìng shénme? 你姓什麼? What is your surname?
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng (King).
A: Wǒ xìng Hú. 我姓胡。 My surname is .
3. A: Tā shi shéi? 他/她是誰? Who is He/she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ. 他是馬明理。 He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.
A: Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng. 他是馬先生。 He is Mr. .
B: Tā shi Mǎ Tàitai. 她是馬太太。 She is Mrs. .
A: Tā shi Mǎ Xiǎojiě? 她是馬小姐。 She is Miss .
B: Tā shi Mǎ Tóngzhì 他/她是馬同志。 He/she is Comrade .
4. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,他是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng. 他是馬明理先 生。 He is Mr. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
5. A: Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 先生,她是誰? Sir, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Tàitai. 她是馬明理太 太。 She is Mrs. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
6. A: Tóngzhì, tā shi shéi? 同志,她是誰? Comrade, who is she?
B: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolán Tóngzhì. 她是方寶蘭同志。 She is Comrade Fāng Bǎolán.

4 Unit 2 Target List

1. A: Nǐ shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma? 你是王先生嗎? Are you Mr. Wáng?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I am Wáng Dànián.
A: Wǒ bú shi Wáng Xiānsheng. 我不是王先生。 I’m not Mr. Wáng.
2. A: Nǐ xìng Wáng ma? 你姓王嗎? Is your surname Wáng?
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
A: Wǒ bú xìng Wáng. 我不姓王。 My surname isn’t Wáng.
3. A: Nín guìxìng? 您貴姓? Your surname? (POLITE)
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
4. A: Nǐ jiào shénme? 你叫什麼? What is your given name?
B: Wǒ jiào Dànián. 我叫大年。 My given name is Dànián (Daniel).
5. A: Nǐ hǎo ma? 你好嗎? How are you?
B: Wǒ hǎo. Nǐ ne? 我好。你呢? I’m fine. And you?
A: Hǎo. Xièxie. 好。謝謝。 Fine, thank you.
Additional required vocabulary (not presented on P-1 and P-1 tapes)
6. míngzi 名字 given name

5 Unit 3 Target List

1. A: Nǐ shi Měiguo rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you an American?
B: Shì. 是。 Yes (I am).
B: Bú shi. 不是。 No (I’m not).
2. A: Nǐ shi Zhōngguo rén ma? 你是中國人嗎? Are you Chinese?
B: Shì, wǒ shi Zhōngguo rén. 是,我是中國人。 Yes, I’m Chinese.
B: Bú shi, wǒ bú shi Zhōngguo rén. 不是,我不是中國人。 No, I’m not Chinese.
3. A: Nǐ shi neǐguó rén? 你是哪國人? What is your nationality?
B: Wǒ shi Měiguo rén. 我是美國人。 I’m an American.
B: Wǒ shi Zhōngguo rén. 我是中國人。 I’m Chinese.
B: Wǒ shi Yīngguó rén. 我是英國人。 I’m English.
4. A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 你是哪兒的人? Where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Jiāzhōu rén. 我是加州人。 I’m a Californian.
B: Wǒ shi Shànghǎi rén. 我是上海人。 I’m from Shanghai.
Additional required vocabulary (not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)
5: Déguó 德國 Germany
6:

🛈︎
Pronunciation tip

Éguó: Mainland, Èguó: Taiwan

Èguó (Éguó)

俄國 Russia
7: Fàguó (Fǎguó) 法國 France
8: Rìběn 日本 Japan

6 Unit 4 Target List

1. A: Āndésēn Xiānsheng, nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 安德森先生,你是哪兒的人? Where are you from, Mr. Anderson?
B: Wǒ shi Dézhōu rén. 我是德州人。 I’m from Texas.
A: Āndésēn Fūren ne? 安德森夫人呢? And Mrs. Anderson?
B: Tā yě shi Dézhōu rén. 她也是德州人。 She is from Texas too.
2: A: Tā shi Yīngguo rén ma? 他是英國人嗎? Is he English?
B: Bú shi, tā bú shi Yīngguo rén. 不是,他不是英國人。 No, he is not English.
A: Tā àiren ne? 他愛人呢? And his wife?
B: Tā yě bú shi Yīngguo rén. 她也不是英國人。 She isn’t English either.
3. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ lǎojiā zài nǎr? 請問,你老家在哪兒? May I ask, where is your family from?
B: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Shāndōng. 我老家在山東。 My family is from Shāndōng
4. A: Qīngdǎo zài zhèr ma? 青島在這兒嗎? Is Qīngdǎo here? (pointing to a map)
B: Qīngdǎo bú zài nàr, zài zhèr. 青島不在那兒,在這兒。 Qīngdǎo isn’t there; it’s here. (pointing to a map)
5. A: Nǐ àiren xiànzài zài nǎr? 你愛人現在在哪兒? Where is your spouse now?
B: Tā xiànzài zài Jiānádà. 她現在在見那大。 He/she is in Canada now.
Additional required vocabulary (not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)
6. Learn the pronunciation and location of any five cities and five provinces of China found on the maps on pages 80-8l.
Figure 6.1 On a Běijīng street (courtesy of Pat Fox)

7 Unit 1

7.1 Introduction

7.1.1 Topics Covered in this Unit

  1. Questions and answers about full names and surnames.

  2. Titles and terms of address ("Mr.,” “Mrs.,” etc.).

7.1.2 Prerequisites to the Unit

(Be sure to complete these before starting the unit.)

  1. Background Notes

  2. P&R 1 (Tape 1 of the resource module on Pronunciation and Romanization), the tones.

  3. P&R 2 (Tape 2 of the resource module on Pronunciation and Romanization), the tones.

7.1.3 Materials You Will Need

  1. The C-1 and P-1 tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The drill tape (1D-1)

7.1.4 About the C-1 and P-1 Tapes

The C-1 and P-1 tapes are your introduction to the Chinese words and structures presented in each unit. The tapes give you explanations and practice on the new material. By the time you have worked through these two tapes, you will be competent in understanding and producing the expressions introduced in the unit.

With the C-1 tape, you learn to understand the new words and structures. The material is presented in short conversational exchanges, first with English translations and later with pauses which allow you to translate. Try to give a complete English translation for each Chinese expression. Your goal when using the C-1 tape is to learn the meanings of all the words and structures as they are used in the sentences.

With the P-1 tape, you learn to put together these sentences. You learn to pronounce each new word and use each new structure. When the recorded instructions direct you to pronounce a word or say a sentence, do so out loud. It is important for you to hear yourself speaking Chinese, so that you will know whether you are pronouncing the words correctly. Making the effort to say the expression is a big part of learning it. It is one thing to think about how a sentence should be put together or how it should sound. It is another thing to put it together that way or make it sound that way. Your goal when using the P-1 tape is to produce the Target List expressions in Chinese when given English equivalents. At the end of each P-1 tape is a review of the Target List which you can go over until you have mastered the expressions.

At times, you may feel that the material on a tape is being presented too fast. You may find that there is not enough time allowed for working out the meaning of a sentence or saying a sentence the way you want to. When this happens, stop the tape. If you want to, rewind; Use the control buttons on your machine to make the tape manageable for you most and to get the most out of it.

7.1.5 About the Reference List and the Reference Notes

The Reference List and the Reference Notes are designed to be used before, during, or directly after work with the C-1 and P-1 tapes.

The Reference List is a summary of the C-1 and P-1 tapes. It contains all sentences which introduce new material, shoving you both the Chinese sentences written in romanization and their English equivalents. You will find that the list is printed so that either the Chinese or the English can be covered to allow you to test yourself on comprehension, production, or romanization of the sentences.

The Reference Notes give you information about grammar, pronunciation, and cultural usage. Some of these explanations duplicate what you hear on the C-1 and P-1 tapes. Other explanations contain new information.

You may use the Reference List and Reference Notes in various ways. For example, you may follow the Reference Notes as you listen to a tape, glancing at an exchange or stopping to read a comment whenever you want to. Or you may look through the Reference Notes before listening to a tape, and then use the Reference List while you listen, to help you keep track of where you are. Whichever way you decide to use these parts of a unit, remember that they are reference materials. Don’t rely on the translations and romanizations as subtitles for the C-1 tape or as cue cards for the P-1 tape, for this would rob you of your chance to develop listening and responding skills.

7.1.6 About the Drills

The drills help you develop fluency, ease of response, and confidence. You can go through the drills on your own, with the drill tapes, and the teacher may take you through them in class as well.

Allow more than half an hour for a half-hour drill tape, since you will usually need to go over all or parts of the tape more than once to get full benefit from it.

The drills include many personal names, providing you with valuable pronunciation practice. However, if you find the names more than you can handle the first time through the tape, replace them with the pronoun whenever possible. Similar substitutions are often possible with place names.

Some of the drills involve sentences which you may find too long to understand or produce on your first try, and you will need to rewind for another try. Often, particularly the first time through a tape, you will find the pauses too short, and you will need to stop the tape to give yourself more time. The performance you should aim for with these tapes, however, is full comprehension and full, fluent, and accurate production while the tape rolls.

The five basic types of drills are described below.

  1. Substitution Drills: The teacher (T) gives a pattern sentence which the student (S) repeats. Then the teacher gives a word or phrase (a cue) which the student substitutes appropriately in the original sentence. The teacher follows immediately with a new cue.

    • T: Are you an American?

    • S: Are you an American?

    • T: (cue) English

    • S: Are you English?

    • T: (cue) French

    • S: Are you French?

    Example 1.1 Here is an English example of a substitution drill:

  2. Transformation Drills: On the basis of a model provided at the beginning of the drill, the student makes a certain change in each sentence the teacher says.

    • T: I’m going to the bank.

    • S: I’m not going to the bank.

    • T: I’m going to the store.

    • S: I’m not going to the store.

    Example 2.1 Here is an English example of a transformation drill, in which the student is changing affirmative sentences into negative ones:
  3. Response Drills: On the basis of a model given at the beginning of the drill, the student responds to questions or remarks by the teacher as cued by the teacher.

    • T: What is his name? (cue) Harris

    • S: His name is Harris.

    • T: What is her name? (cue) Noss

    • S: Her name is Noss.

    Example 3.1 Here is an English example of a response drill:
  4. Expansion Drills: The student adds something to a pattern sentence as cued by the teacher.

    • T: He isn’t Chinese, (cue) Japanese.

    • S: He isn’t Chinese. He’s Japanese.

    • T: She isn’t German. (cue) French.

    • S: She isn’t German. She’s French.

    Example 4.1 Here is an English example of an expansion drill:
  5. Combination Drills: On the basis of a model given at the beginning of the drill, the student combines two phrases or sentences given by the teacher into a single utterance.

    • T: I am reading a book. John gave me the book.

    • S: I am reading a book which John gave me.

    • T: Mary bought a picture. I like the picture.

    • S: Mary bought a picture which I like.

    Example 5.1 Here is an English example of a combination drill:

7.2 References

7.2.1 Reference list

1. A: Nǐ shi shéi? 你是誰? Who are you?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.
2. A: Nǐ shi shéi? 你是誰? Who are you?
B: Wǒ shi Hú Měilíng. 我是胡美玲。 I’m Hú Měilíng.
3. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ 他是馬明理。 He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.
4. A: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ. 他是馬明理。 He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.
B: Tā shi Hú Měilíng. 她是胡美玲。 She is Hú Měilíng.
5. A: Nǐ xìng shénme? 你姓什麼? What is your surname?
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
6. A: Tā xìng shénme? 他姓什麼? What is his surname?
B: Tā xìng Mǎ. 他姓馬。 His surname is .
7. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng. 他是馬先生。 He is Mr. .
8. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng. 他是馬明理先生。 He is Mr. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
9. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,他是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng. 他是馬明理先生。 He is Mr. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
10. A: Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 先生,他是誰? Sir, who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng 他是馬先生。 He is Mr. .
11. A: Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 先生,她是誰? Sir, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Tàitai. 她是馬太太。 She is Mrs. .
12. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,她是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Tàitai. 她是馬明理太太。 She is Mrs. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
13. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,她是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiǎojiě. 她是馬小姐。 She is miss .
14. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Tóngzhì. 他是馬明理同志。 He is comrade Mínglǐ.
15. A: Tóngzhì, tā shi shéi? 同志,她是誰? Comrade, who is she?
B: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolán. 她是方寶蘭。 She is Fāng Bǎolán.
16. A: Tóngzhì, tā shi shéi? 同志,她是誰? Comrade, who is she?
B: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolán Tóngzhì. 她是方寶蘭同志。 She is comrade Fāng Bǎolán.

7.2.2 Vocabulary

you
shéi who
shénme 什麼 what
shì to be
他,她,它 he, she, it
tàitai 太太 Mrs. , wife, married woman, lady
tóngzhì 同志 comrade
I
xiānsheng 先生 Mr. , sir, husband, teacher
xiǎojiě (xiǎojie) 小姐 Miss, lady, daughter (polite)
xìng to be surnamed

7.2.3 Reference Notes

7.2.3.1 Notes on № 1-4
1. A: Nǐ shi shéi? 你是誰? Who are you?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.
2. A: Nǐ shi shéi? 你是誰? Who are you?
B: Wǒ shi Hú Měilíng. 我是胡美玲。 I’m Hú Měilíng.
3. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ 他是馬明理。 He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.
4. A: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ. 他是馬明理。 He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.
B: Tā shi Hú Měilíng. 她是胡美玲。 She is Hú Měilíng.

The verb shì means “to be” in the sense of “to be someone or something,” as in “I am Daniel King.” It expresses identity. (In Unit 4 you will learn a verb which means “to be” in another sense, “to be somewhere,” as in “I am in Běijīng.” That verb expresses location.) The verb shì is in the Neutral tone (with no accent mark) except when emphasized.

Unlike verbs in European languages, Chinese verbs do not distinguish first, second, and third persons. A single form serves for all three persons.

shi Wáng Dànián. I am Wáng Dànián.
shi Hú Měilíng. You are Hú Měilíng.
shi Mǎ Mínglǐ. He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.

Later you will find that Chinese verbs do not distinguish singular and plural, either, and that they do not distinguish past, present, and future as such. You need to learn only one form for each verb.

The pronoun is equivalent to both “he” and “she.” (and it), but the writing is different: he ↠ , she ↠ , it ↠ .

The question Nǐ shi shéi? is actually too direct for most situations, although it is all right from teacher to student or from student to student. (A more polite question is introduced in Unit 2.)

Unlike English, Chinese uses the same word order in questions as in statements.

shi shéi? Who is he?
shi Mǎ Mínglǐ? He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.

When you answer a question containing a question word like shéi. “who,” simply replace the question word with the information it asks for.

7.2.3.2 Notes on № 5-6
5. A: Nǐ xìng shénme? 你姓什麼? What is your surname?
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
6. A: Tā xìng shénme? 他姓什麼? What is his surname?
B: Tā xìng Mǎ. 他姓馬。 His surname is .

Xìng is a verb, “to be surnamed.” It is in the same position in the sentence as shì, “to be.”

shi Wáng Dànián.
I am Wáng Dànián.
xìng Wáng.
I am surnamed Wáng.

Notice that the question word shénme. “What,” takes the same position as the question word shéi “who.”

shi shéi?
You are who?
xìng shénme?
You are surnamed what?

Shénme is the official spelling. However, the word is pronounced as if it were spelled shémma, or even shéma (often with a single rise in pitch extending over both syllables.) Before another word which begins with a consonant sound, it is usually pronounced as if it were spelled shém.

7.2.3.3 Notes on № 7-8
7. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng. 他是馬先生。 He is Mr. .
8. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng. 他是馬明理先生。 He is Mr. Mǎ Mínglǐ.

After the verb shì you may have the full name alone, the surname plus title, or the full name plus title.

shi Mínglǐ
shi Xiānsheng.
shi Mínglǐ Xiānsheng.

Xiānsheng, literally “first-born,” has more of a connotation of respectfulness than “Mr.” Xiānsheng is usually applied only to people other than oneself. Do not use the title Xiānsheng (or any other respectful title, such as Jiàoshòu, “Professor” when giving your own name. If you want to say “I am Mr. Jones,” you may say Wǒ xìng Jones.

When a name and title name are said together, logically enough it is the name which gets the heavy stress: WÁNG Xiānsheng, You will often hear the title pronounced with no full tones: WÁNG Xiansheng.

7.2.3.4 Notes on № 9-12
9. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,他是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Xiānsheng. 他是馬明理先生。 He is Mr. Mǎ Mínglǐ.
10. A: Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 先生,他是誰? Sir, who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng 他是馬先生。 He is Mr. .
11. A: Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 先生,她是誰? Sir, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Tàitai. 她是馬太太。 She is Mrs. .
12. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,她是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Tàitai. 她是馬明理太太。 She is Mrs. Mǎ Mínglǐ.

When you address someone directly, use either the name plus the title or the title alone. Xiānsheng must be translated as “Sir” when it is used alone, since “Mr.” would not capture its respectful tone. (Tàitai, however, is less respectful when used alone. You should address Mrs. as Mǎ Tàitai.)

7.2.3.5 Notes on № 13-16
13. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, tā shi shéi? 王先生,她是誰? Mr. Wáng, who is she?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Xiǎojiě. 她是馬小姐。 She is miss .
14. A: Tā shi shéi? 他是誰? Who is he?
B: Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ Tóngzhì. 他是馬明理同志。 He is comrade Mínglǐ.
15. A: Tóngzhì, tā shi shéi? 同志,她是誰? Comrade, who is she?
B: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolán. 她是方寶蘭。 She is Fāng Bǎolán.
16. A: Tóngzhì, tā shi shéi? 同志,她是誰? Comrade, who is she?
B: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolán tóngzhì. 她是方寶蘭同志。 She is comrade Fāng Bǎolán.

See the Background Notes on Chinese Personal Names and Titles for Tóngzhì. “Comrade,” and the use of maiden names.

7.3 Drills

7.3.1 Substitution drill.

Cue Answer

1.

Mǎ Mínglǐ

馬明理

Tā shi Mǎ Mínglǐ

他是馬明理。

He is Mǎ Mínglǐ.

2.

Hú Měilíng

胡美玲

Tā shi Hú Měilíng

她是胡美玲。

She is Hú Měilíng.

3.

Wáng Dànián

王大年

Tā shi Wáng Dànián

他是王大年。

He is Wáng Dànián.

4.

Lǐ Shìmín

李世民

Tā shi Lǐ Shìmín

他是李世民。

He is Lǐ Shìmín.

5.

Liú Lìróng

劉麗容

Tā shi Liú Lìróng

她是劉麗容。

She is Liú Lìróng.

6.

Zhāng Bǎolán

張寶蘭

Tā shi Zhāng Bǎolán.

她是張寶蘭。

She is Zhāng Bǎolán.

7.3.2 Response Drill

When the cue is given by a male speaker, male students should respond. When the cue is given by a female speaker, female students should respond.

Question Cue Answer

1.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Wáng Dànián

王大年

Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián

我是王大年。

I am Wáng Dànián.

2.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Hú Měilíng

胡美玲

Wǒ shi Hú Měilíng.

我是胡美玲。

I am Hú Měilíng.

3.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Liú Shìmín

李世民

Wǒ shi Liú Shìmín.

我是李世民。

I am Liú Shìmín.

4.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Chén Huìrán

陳蕙然

Wǒ shi Chén Huìrán.

我是陳蕙然。

I am Chén Huìrán.

5.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Huáng Déxián

黃德賢

Wǒ shi Huáng Déxián.

我是黃德賢。

I am Huáng Déxián.

6.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Zhào Wǎnrú

趙婉如

Wǒ shi Zhào Wǎnrú.

我是趙婉如。

I am Zhào Wǎnrú.

7.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Jiǎng Bīngyíng

蔣冰瑩

Wǒ shi Jiǎng Bīngyíng.

我是蔣冰瑩。

I am Jiǎng Bīngyíng.

8.

Nǐ shi shéi?

你是誰?

Who are you?

Gāo Yǒngpíng

局永平

Wǒ shi Gāo Yǒngpíng.

我是高永平。

I am Gāo Yǒngpíng.

7.3.3 Response drill.

Question Cue Answer

1.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

Mǎ Xiānsheng

馬先生

Mr.

Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng.

他是馬先生。

He is Mr. .

2.

Tā shi shéi?

她是誰?

Who is she?

Hú Tàitai

胡太太

Mrs.

Tā shi Hú Tàitai.

她是胡太太。

She is Mrs. .

3.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

Máo xiānsheng

毛先生

Mr. Máo

Tā shi Máo Xiānsheng.

他是毛先生。

He is Mr. Máo.

4.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

Zhāng Tóngzhì

張同志

Comrade Zhāng

Tā shi Zhāng Tóngzhì.

他是張同志。

He is Comrade Zhāng.

5.

Tā shi shéi?

她是誰?

Who is she?

Liú Xiǎojiě

劉小姐

Miss Liú

Tā shi Liú Xiǎojiě.

她是劉小姐。

She is Miss Liú.

6.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

Mǎ Xiānsheng

馬先生

Mr.

Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng.

他是馬先生

He is Mr. .

7.

Tā shi shéi?

她是誰?

Who is she?

Zhào Tàitai

趙太太

Mrs. Zhào

Tā shi Zhào Tàitai.

她是趙太太。

She is Mrs. Zhào.

8 Unit 2

8.1 Introduction

8.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Questions and answers about given names.

  2. Yes/no questions.

  3. Negative statement.

  4. Greetings.

8.1.2 Prerequisites to the Unit

  1. P&R 3 and P&R 4 (Tapes 3 and 4 of the resource module on Pronunciation and Romanization).

8.1.3 Materials You Will Need

  1. The C-1 and P-1 tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The 2D-1 tape.

8.2 References

8.2.1 Reference list

1. A: Tā shi Wáng Tàitai ma? 她是王太太,嗎? Is she Mrs. Wáng?
B: Tā shi Wáng Tàitai. 她是王太太。 she is Mrs. Wáng.
2. A: Nǐ shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma? 你是王先生嗎? Are you Mr. Wáng?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.
3. A: Nǐ shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma? 你是馬先生嗎? Are you Mr. .
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.
4. A: Nǐ shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma? 你是馬先生嗎? Are you Mr. ?
B: Wǒ bú shi Mǎ Xiānsheng. 我不是馬先生。 I’m not Mr. .
5. A: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I am Wáng Dànián.
B: Wǒ bú shi Wáng Dànián. 我不是王大年。 I am not Wáng Dànián.
6. A: Nǐ xìng Fāng ma? 你姓方嗎? Is your surname Fāng?
B: Wǒ bú xìng Fāng 我不姓方。 My surname isn’t Fāng.
7. A: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
B: Wǒ bú shi Wáng. 我不姓王。 My surname isn’t Wáng.
8. A: Nǐ xìng Mǎ ma? 你姓馬嗎? Is your surname ?
B: Bú xìng Mǎ. Xìng Wáng. 不姓馬。 (我)姓王。 My surname isn’t . My surname is Wáng.
9. A: Nín guìxìng? 您貴姓? Your surname? (polite)
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
10. A: Nǐ jiào shénme? 你叫什麼? What is your given name?
B: Wǒ jiào Dànián. 我叫大年。 My given name is Dànián.
11. A: Nǐ hǎo a? 你好阿? How are you?
B: Wǒ hǎo. 我好。 I’m fine.
12. A: Nǐ hǎo a? 你好阿? How are you?
B: Wǒ hǎo. Nǐ ne? 我好,你呢? I’m fine. And you?
A: Hǎo, xièxie. 好, 謝謝。 Fine, thanks.

8.2.2 Vocabulary

a suffix added to the end of any sentence
bù/bú not
bú shi  不是 not to be
guìxìng 貴姓 honorable name
hǎo to be fine, to be well, ok, good
jiào to be called, named
ma question marker at the end of the sentence
míngzi 名字 given name, full name
ne question marker
xièxie 謝謝 thank you

8.2.3 Reference Notes

8.2.3.1 Notes on № 1-3
1. A: Tā shi Wáng Tàitai ma? 她是王太太,嗎? Is she Mrs. Wáng?
B: Tā shi Wáng Tàitai. 她是王太太。 She is Mrs. Wáng.
2. A: Nǐ shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma? 你是王先生嗎? Are you Mr. Wáng?
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.
3. A: Nǐ shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma? 你是馬先生嗎? Are you Mr. .
B: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I’m Wáng Dànián.

The marker ma may be added to any statement to turn it into a question which may be answered “yes” or “no,”

shi Wáng Tàitai She is Mrs. Wáng
shi Wáng Tàitai ma? Is she Mrs. Wáng.

The reply to a yes/no question is commonly a complete affirmative or negative statement, although, as you will see later, the statement may be stripped down considerably.

8.2.3.2 Notes on № 4-5
4. A: Nǐ shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma? 你是馬先生嗎? Are you Mr. ?
B: Wǒ bú shi Mǎ Xiānsheng. 我不是馬先生。 I’m not Mr. .
5. A: Wǒ shi Wáng Dànián. 我是王大年。 I am Wáng Dànián.
B: Wǒ bú shi Wáng Dànián. 我不是王大年。 I am not Wáng Dànián.

The negative of the verb shì, “to be,” is bú shi, “not to be.” The equivalent of “not” is the syllable . The tone for the syllable depends on the tone of the following syllable. When followed by a syllable with a High, Rising, or Low tone, a Falling tone is used (). When followed by a syllable with a Falling or Neutral tone, a Rising tone is used ().

bù fēi (not to fly)

bù féi (not to be fat)

bù fěi (not to slander)

bú fèi (not to waste)

Example 1.1 Examples

Almost all of the first few verbs you learn happen to be in the Falling tone, and so take . But remember that is the basic form. That is the form the syllable takes when it stands alone as a short “no” answer——and when it is discussed, as in “ means ‘not’.”

Notice that even though shì, “to be,” is usually pronounced in the Neutral tone in the phrase bú shi , the original Falling tone of shì still causes to “be pronounced with a Rising tone: .

shi Wáng Dànián.
I am Wáng Dànián.
shi Mǎ Xiānsheng.
I am not Mǎ Xiānsheng.

8.2.3.3 Notes on № 6-8
6. A: Nǐ xìng Fāng ma? 你姓方嗎? Is your surname Fāng?
B: Wǒ bú xìng Fāng 我不姓方。 My surname isn’t Fāng.
7. A: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.
B: Wǒ bú shi Wáng. 我不姓王。 My surname isn’t Wáng.
8. A: Nǐ xìng Mǎ ma? 你姓馬嗎? Is your surname ?
B: Bú xìng Mǎ. Xìng Wáng. 不姓馬。 (我)姓王。 My surname isn’t . My surname is Wáng.

It is quite common in Chinese—much commoner than in English—to omit the subject of a sentence when it is clear from the context.

8.2.3.4 Notes on № 9
9. A: Nín guìxìng? 您貴姓? Your surname? (polite)
B: Wǒ xìng Wáng. 我姓王。 My surname is Wáng.

Nín is the polite equivalent of , “you.”

Guìxìng is a polite noun, “surname.” Guì means “honorable.” Xìng which you have learned as the verb “to be surnamed” is in this case a noun, “surname.”

Literally, Nín guìxìng? is “Your surname?” The implied question is understood, and the “sentence” consists of the subject alone.

8.2.3.5 Notes on № 10
10. A: Nǐ jiào shénme? 你叫什麼? What is your given name?
B: Wǒ jiào Dànián. 我叫大年。 My given name is Dànián.

Jiào is a verb meaning “to be called.” In a discussion of personal names, we can say that it means “to be given-named.”

8.2.3.6 Notes on № 11
11. A: Nǐ hǎo a? 你好阿? How are you?
B: Wǒ hǎo. 我好 I’m fine.

Notice that the Low tones of and change to Rising tones before the Low tone of hǎo: Ní hǎo a? Wó hǎo.

Hǎo is a verb: “to be good” “to be well” “to be fine." Since it functions like the verb “to be” plus an adjective in English, we will call it an adjectival verb.

hǎo
I am fine
hǎo a?
You are fine ?

8.2.3.7 Notes on № 12
12. A: Nǐ hǎo a? 你好阿? How are you?
B: Wǒ hǎo. Nǐ ne? 我好,你呢? I’m fine. And you?
A: Hǎo, xièxie. 好, 謝謝。 Fine, thanks.

The marker ne makes a question out of the single work , “you”: “And you?” or “How about you?”

Xiè is the verb “to thank.” “I thank you” would be Wǒ xièxie ni. Xièxie is often repeated: Xièxie, xièxie.

8.2.3.8 Notes on № 13

One way to ask what someone’s given name is: Nǐ jiào shénme míngzi?

8.3 Drills

8.3.1 Transformations drill

Table 8.3.1.1 Create a question from the statement
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

他是王先生。

He is Mr. Wáng .

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

2.

Tā shi Hú Tàitai.

她是胡太太。

She is Mrs.

Tā shi Hú Tàitai ma?

她是胡太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. ?

3.

Tā shi Liú Tóngzhì.

他是劉同志

He is comrade Liú.

Tā shi Liú Tóngzhì ma?

他是劉同志嗎?

Is he comrade Liú?

4.

Tā shi Zhāng Xiǎojiě.

她是張小姐

She is Miss Zhāng.

Tā shi Zhāng Xiǎojiě ma?

她是張小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Zhāng?

5.

Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng.

他是馬先生。

He is Mr. .

Tā Shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma?

他是馬先生嗎?

Is he Mr. ?

6.

Tā shi Fāng Xiǎojiě.

她是方小姐。

She is Miss Fāng.

Tā shi Fāng Xiǎojiě ma?

她是方小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Fāng?

7.

Tā shi Lín Tóngzhì.

他是林同志。

He is comrade Lín.

Tā shi Lín Tóngzhì ma?

他是林同志嗎?

Is he comrade Lín?

8.3.2 Response drill

Table 8.3.2.1 Respond by affirmative.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

Shi. Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

是。他是王先生。

Yes. He is Mr. Wáng.

2.

Tā shi Zhào Tàitai ma?

她是趙太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Zhào?

Shi. Tā shi Zhào Tàitai.

是。她是趙太太。

Yes. She is Mrs. Zhào.

3.

Tā shi Chén Tóngzhì ma?

她是陳同志嗎?

Is she comrade Chén?

Shi. Ta shi Chén Tóngzhì.

是。她是陳同志。

Yes. She is comrade Chén.

4.

Tā shi Liú Xiǎojiě ma?

她是劉小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Liú?

Shi. Tā shi Liú Xiǎojiě.

是。她是劉小姐。

Yes. She is Miss Liú.

5.

Tā shi Sòng Xiānsheng ma?

他是宋先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Sòng?

Shi. Tā shi Sòng Xiānsheng.

是。他是宋先生。

Yes. He is Mr. Sòng.

6.

Tā shi Sūn Tàitai ma?

她是孫太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Sūn?

Shi. Tā shi Sūn Tàitai.

是。她是孫太太。

Yes. She is Mrs. Sūn.

7.

Tā shi Zhāng Xiānsheng ma?

他是張先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Zhāng?

Shi. Tā shi Zhāng Xiānsheng.

是。他是張先生。

Yes. He is Mr. Zhāng.

8.3.3 Response drill

Table 8.3.3.1 All your answers will be negative. Give the correct name according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

Liú

Bú shi. Tā shi Liú Xiānsheng.

不是。他是劉先生。

No. He is Mr. Liú .

2.

Tā shi Gāo Xiǎojiě ma?

她是高小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Gāo?

Zhào

Bú shi. Tā shi Zhào Xiǎojiě.

不是。她是趙小姐。

No. She is Miss Zhào.

3.

Tā shi Huáng Tóngzhì ma?

她是黃同志嗎?

Is she comrade Huáng?

Wáng

Bú shi. Tā shi Wáng Tóngzhì.

不是。她是王同志。

No. She is comrade Wáng.

4.

Tā shi Yáng Tàitai ma?

她是楊太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Yáng?

Jiǎng

Bú shi. Tā shi Jiǎng Tàitai.

不是。她是蔣太太。

No. She is Mrs. Jiǎng.

5.

Tā shi Mǎ Xiānsheng ma?

他是馬先生嗎?

Is he Mr. ?

Máo

Bú shi. Tā shi Máo Xiānsheng.

不是。他是毛先生。

No. He is Mr. Máo.

6.

Tā shi Zhōu Xiǎojiě ma?

她是周小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Zhōu?

Zhào

Bú shi.Tā shi Zhào Xiǎojiě.

不是。她是趙小姐。

No. She is Miss Zhào.

7.

Tā shi Jiāng Xiānsheng ma?

他是江先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Jiāng?

Jiǎng

Bú shi. Tā shi Jiǎng Xiānsheng.

不是。他是蔣先生。

No. He is Mr. Jiǎng .

8.3.4 Response drill

Table 8.3.4.1 This drill is a combination of the two previous drills. Give an affirmative or a negative answer according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi Liú Tàitai ma?

她是劉太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Liú?

Liú

Shì. Tā shi Liú Tàitai.

是。她是劉太太。

Yes. She is Mrs. Liú.

2.

Tā shi Liú Tàitai ma?

她是劉太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Liú?

Huáng

Bú shi. Tā shi Huáng Tàitai.

不是。她是黃太太。

No. She is Mrs. Huáng.

3.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

Wáng

Shì. Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

是。他是王先生。

Yes He is Mr. Wáng.

4.

Tā shi Gāo Tàitai ma?

她是高太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Gāo?

Zhào

Bú shi. Tā shi Zhào Tàitai.

不是。她是趙太太。

No. She is Mrs. Zhào.

5.

Tā shi Táng Xiǎojiě ma?

她是唐小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Táng?

Táng

Shì. Tā shi Táng Xiǎojiě.

是。她是唐小姐。

Yes. She is Miss Táng.

6.

Tā shi Huáng Xiānsheng ma?

她是黃先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Huáng?

Wáng

Bú shi. Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

不是。他不是王先生。

No. He is Mr. Wáng.

7.

Tā shi Zhāng Tàitai ma?

她是張太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Zhāng?

Jiāng

Bú shi. Tā shi Jiāng Tàitai.

不是。她是江太太。

No. She is Mrs. Jiāng.

8.3.5 Transformation drill

Table 8.3.5.1 Transform the sentence using xìng.
Statement Answer
1.

Nǐ shi Zhāng Xiānsheng ma?

你是張先生嗎?

Are you Mr. Zhāng ?

Nǐ xìng Zhāng ma?

你姓張嗎?

Is your surname Zhāng?

2.

Nǐ shi Zhào Tàitai ma?

你是趙太太嗎?

Are you Mrs. Zhào?

Nǐ xìng Zhào ma?

你姓趙嗎?

Is your surname Zhào?

3.

Nǐ shi Jiǎng Xiǎojiě m?

你是蔣小姐嗎?

Are you Miss Jiǎng?

Nǐ xìng Jiǎng ma?

你姓蔣嗎?

Is your surname Jiǎng?

4.

Nǐ shi Liú Tóngzhì ma?

你是劉同志嗎?

Are you Comrade Liú?

Nǐ xìng Liú ma?

你姓劉嗎?

Is your surname Liú?

5.

Nǐ shi Sòng Tàitai ma?

你是宋太太嗎?

Are you Mrs. Sòng?

Nǐ xìng Sòng ma?

你姓宋嗎?

Is your surname Sòng?

6.

Nǐ shi Lǐ Xiānsheng ma?

你是李先生嗎?

Are you Mr. ?

Nǐ xìng Lǐ ma?

你姓李嗎?

Is your surname ?

7.

Nǐ shi Sūn Tóngzhì ma?

你是孫同志嗎?

Are you Comrade Sūn?

Nǐ xìng Sūn ma?

你姓孫嗎?

Is your surname Sūn?

8.3.6 Transformation drill

Table 8.3.6.1 Transform the sentence in a negative one.
Statement Answer
1.

Wǒ xìng Zhāng.

我姓張。

My surname is Zhāng.

Wǒ bú xìng Zhāng.

我不姓張。

My surname is not Zhāng.

2.

Wǒ xìng Chén.

我姓陳。

My surname is Chén.

Wǒ bú xìng Chén.

我不姓陳。

My surname is not Chén.

3.

Wǒ xìng Huáng.

我姓黃。

My surname is Huáng.

Wǒ bú xìng Huáng.

我不姓黃。

My surname is not Huáng.

4.

Wǒ xìng Gāo.

我姓高。

My surname is Gāo.

Wǒ bú xìng Gāo.

我不姓高。

My surname is not Gāo.

5.

Wǒ xìng Sūn.

我姓孫。

My surname is Sūn.

Wǒ bú xìng Sūn.

我不姓孫。

My surname is not Sūn.

6.

Wǒ xìng Zhāng.

我姓張。

My surname is Zhāng.

Wǒ bú xìng Zhāng.

我不姓張。

My surname is not Zhāng.

7.

Wǒ xìng Zhōu.

我姓周。

My surname is Zhōu.

Wǒ bú xìng Zhōu.

我不姓周。

My surname is not Zhōu.

8.3.7 Transformation drill

Table 8.3.7.1 Transform the sentence using bú xìng.
Statement Answer
1.

Wǒ bú shi Lǐ Xiānsheng.

我不是李先生。

I’m not Mr. .

Wǒ bú xìng Lǐ.

我不姓李。

My surname is not .

2.

Wǒ bú shi Wáng Tàitai.

我不是王太太。

I’m not Mrs. Wáng.

Wǒ bú xìng Wáng.

我不姓王。

My surname is not Wáng.

3.

Wǒ bú shi Chén Xiānsheng.

我不是陳先生。

I’m not Mr. Chén.

Wǒ bú xìng Chén.

我不姓陳。

My surname is not Chén.

4.

Wǒ bú shi Lín Tóngzhì.

我不是林同志。

I’m not Comrade Lín.

Wǒ bú xìng Lín.

我不姓林。

My surname is not Lín.

5.

Wǒ bú shi Zhōu Xiǎojiě.

我不是周小姐。

I’m not Miss Zhōu.

Wǒ bú xìng Zhōu.

我不姓周。

My surname is not Zhōu.

6.

Wǒ bú shi Jiǎng Xiānsheng.

我不是蔣先生。

I’m not Mr. Jiǎng.

Wǒ bú xìng Jiǎng.

我不姓蔣。

My surname is not Jiǎng.

7.

Wǒ bú shi Sòng Tàitai.

我不是宋太太。

I’m not Mrs. Sòng.

Wǒ bú xìng Sòng.

我不姓宋。

My surname is not Sòng.

8.3.8 Expansion drill

Table 8.3.8.1 Transfomr the sentence according to the model.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā bú shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

他不是王先生。

He is not Mr. Wáng.

Huáng

Tā bú shi Wáng Xiānsheng, tā xìng Huáng.

他不是王先生,他姓黃。

He is not Mr. Wáng, his surname is Huáng.

2.

Tā bú shi Jiǎng Tàitai.

她不是蔣太太。

She is not Mrs. Jiǎng.

Jiāng

Tā bú shi Jiǎng Tàitai, tā xìng Jiāng.

她不是蔣太太,她姓江。

She is not Mrs. Jiǎng, her surname is Jiāng.

3.

Tā bú shi Liú Tóngzhì.

他不是劉同志。

He is not comrade Liú.

Lín

Tā bú shi Liú Tóngzhì, tā xìng Lín.

他不是劉同志,他姓林。

He is not comrade Liú, his surname is Lín.

4.

Tā bú shi Sòng Xiǎojiě.

她不是宋小姐。

She is not Miss Sòng.

Sūn

Tā bú shi Sòng Xiǎojiě, tā xìng Sūn.

她不是宋小姐,她姓孫。

She is not Miss Sòng, her surname is Sūn.

5.

Tā bú shi Zhào Xiānsheng.

他不是趙先生。

He is not Mr. Zhào.

Zhōu

Tā bú shi Zhào Xiānsheng, tā xìng Zhōu.

他不是趙先生,他姓周。

He is not Mr. Zhào, his surname is Zhōu .

6.

Tā bú shi Jiāng Tóngzhì.

他不是江同志。

He is not Comrade Jiāng.

Zhāng

Tā bú shi Jiāng Tóngzhì, tā xìng Zhāng.

他不是江同志,他姓張。

He is not Comrade Jiāng, his surname is Zhāng.

7.

Tā bú shi Sūn Tàitai.

她不是孫太太。

She is not Mrs. Sūn.

Sòng

Tā bú shi Sūn Tàitai, tā xìng Sòng.

她不是孫太太,她姓宋。

She is not Mrs. Sūn, her surname is Sòng.

8.3.9 Expansion drill

Table 8.3.9.1 Expand the sentence using the model.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Wǒ bú xìng Fāng.

我不姓方。

My surname is not Fāng.

Wǒ bú xìng Fāng, xìng Hú.

我不姓方。姓胡。

My surname is not Fāng, it’s .

2.

Wǒ bú xìng Sūn.

我不姓孫。

My surname is not Sūn.

Sòng

Wǒ bú xìng Sūn, xìng Sòng.

我不姓孫,姓宋。

My surname is not Sūn, it’s Sóng.

3.

Wǒ bú xìng Yáng.

我不姓楊。

My surname is not Yáng.

Táng

Wǒ bú xìng Yáng, xìng Táng.

我不姓楊,姓唐。

My surname is not Yáng, it’s Táng.

4.

Wǒ bú xìng Jiǎng.

我不姓蔣。

My surname is not Jiǎng.

Zhāng

Wǒ bú xìng Jiǎng, xìng Zhāng.

我不姓蔣,姓張。

My surname is not Jiǎng, it’s Zhāng.

5.

Wǒ bú xìng Zhōu.

我不姓周。

My surname is not Zhōu.

Zhào

Wǒ bú xìng Zhōu, xìng Zhào.

我不姓周,姓趙。

My surname is not Zhōu, it’s Zhào.

6.

Wǒ bú xìng Wáng.

我不姓王。

My surname is not Wáng.

Huáng

Wǒ bú xìng Wáng, xìng Huáng.

我不姓王,姓黃。

My surname is not Wáng, it’s Huáng.

7.

Wǒ bú xìng Jiāng.

我不姓江。

My surname is not Jiāng.

Jiǎng

Wǒ bú xìng Jiāng, xìng Jiǎng.

我不姓江,姓蔣。

My surname is not Jiāng, it’s Jiǎng.

8.3.10 Response drill

Table 8.3.10.1 Respond according to the cue and the model.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

Wáng

Shì. Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng.

是。他是王先生。

Yes. He is Mr. Wáng

2.

Tā shi Wáng Xiānsheng ma?

他是王先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Wáng?

Huáng

Tā bú shi Wáng Xiānsheng, tā xìng Huáng.

他不是王先生, 他姓黃。

His is not Mr. Wáng. His surname is Huáng.

3.

Tā shi Liú Tàitai ma?

她是劉太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Liú?

Lín

Tā bú shi Liú Tàitai. Tā xìng Lín.

她不是劉太太。她姓林。

She is not Mrs. Liú. Her surname is Lín.

4.

Tā shi Chén Xiǎojiě ma?

她是陳小姐嗎?

Is she Miss Chén?

Chén

Shì. Tā shi Chén Xiǎojiě.

是。她是陳小姐。

Yes. She is Miss Chén.

5.

Tā shi Máo Xiānsheng ma?

他是毛先生嗎?

Is he Mr. Máo?

Máo

Shì. Tā shi Máo Xiānsheng.

是。他是毛先生。

Yes. He is Mr. Máo.

6.

Tā shi Jiāng Tóngzhì ma?

他是江同志嗎?

Is He/she Comrade Jiāng?

Zhāng

Tā bú shi Jiāng Tóngzhì. Tā xìng Zhāng.

他不是江同志。 他姓張。

He/she isn’t Comrade Jiāng. His/her surname is Zhāng.

7.

Tā shi Sòng Tàitai ma?

她是宋太太嗎?

Is she Mrs. Sòng?

Sòng

Shì. Tā shi Sòng Tàitai.

是。她是宋太太。

Yes. She is Mrs. Sòng.

8.

Tā shi Lǐ Xiānsheng ma?

Is he Mr. ?

他是李先生嗎?

Wáng

Tā bú shi Lǐ Xiānsheng. Tā xìng Wáng.

他不是李先生。他姓王。

He isn’t Mr. . His surname is Wáng.

8.3.11 Transformation drill

Table 8.3.11.1 Respond according to the model.
Statement Answer part1 Answer part 2
1.

Wǒ xìng Wáng.

我姓王。

My surname is Wáng.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Wáng.

他姓王。

His surname is Wáng.

2.

Wǒ xìng Chén.

我姓陳。

My surname is Chén.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Chén.

他姓陳。

His surname is Chén.

3.

Wǒ xìng Liú.

我姓劉。

My surname is Liú.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Liú.

他姓劉。

His surname is Liú.

4.

Wǒ xìng Huáng.

我姓黃。

My surname is Huáng.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Huáng.

他姓黃。

His surname is Huáng.

5.

Wǒ xìng Sòng.

我姓宋。

My surname is Sòng.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Sòng.

他姓宋。

His surname is Sòng.

6.

Wǒ xing Lǐ.

我姓李。

My surname is .

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Lǐ.

他姓李。

His surname is .

7.

Wǒ xìng Wáng.

我姓王。

My surname is Wáng.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼?

What is his surname?

Tā xìng Wáng.

他姓王。

His surname is Wáng.

8.3.12 Transformation drill

Table 8.3.12.1 Transform the statement according to the model.
Statement Answer part 1 Answer part 2
1.

Wǒ xìng Wáng jiào Dànián.

我姓王叫大年。

My surname is Wáng, and my given name is Dànián.

Nǐ xìng Wáng jiào shénme?

你姓王叫什麼?

Your surname is Wáng, and what is your given name?

Dànián.

大年。

2.

Wǒ xìng Hú jiào Měilíng.

我姓胡叫美玲。

My surname is , and my given name is Měilíng.

Nǐ xìng Hú jiào shénme?

你姓胡叫什麼?

Your surname is , and what is your given name?

Měilíng.

美玲。

3.

Wǒ xìng Lǐ jiào Shìyīng.

我姓李叫世英。

My surname is , and my given name is Shìyīng.

Nǐ xìng Lǐ jiào shénme?

你姓李叫什麼?

Your surname is , and what is your given name?

Shìyīng.

世英。

4.

Wǒ xìng Fāng jiào Bǎolán.

我姓方叫寶蘭。

My surname is Fāng, and my given name is Bǎolán.

Nǐ xìng Fāng jiào shénme?

你姓方叫什麼?

Your surname is Fāng, and what is your given name?

Bǎolán.

寶蘭。

5.

Wǒ xìng Sūn jiào Déxián.

我姓孫叫德賢。

My surname is Sūn, and my given name is Déxián.

Nǐ xìng Sūn jiào shénme?

你姓孫叫什麼?

Your surname is Sūn, and what is your given name?

Déxián.

德賢。

6.

Wǒ xìng Chén jiào Huìrán.

我姓陳叫蕙然。

My surname is Chén, and my given name is Huìrán.

Nǐ xìng Chén jiào shénme?

你姓陳叫什麼?

Your surname is Chén, and what is your given name?

Huìrán.

蕙然。

7.

Wǒ xìng Zhāng jiào Zhènhàn.

我姓張叫振漢。

My surname is Zhāng, and my given name is Zhènhàn.

Nǐ xìng Zhāng jiào shénme?

你姓張叫什麼?

Your surname is Zhāng, and what is your given name?

Zhènhàn.

振漢。

8.3.13 Combination drill

Table 8.3.13.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā xìng Chén. Tā jiào Bǎolán.

他姓陳。他叫寶蘭。

Her surname is Chén. Her given name is Bǎolán.

Tā xìng Chén, jiào Bǎolán.

他姓陳,叫寶蘭。

Her surname is Chén, given name Bǎolán.

2.

Tā xìng Lǐ. Tā jiào Mínglǐ.

他姓李。他叫明理。

Her surname is . Her given name is Mínglǐ.

Tā xìng Lǐ, jiào Mínglǐ.

他姓李,叫明理。

Her surname is , given name Mínglǐ.

3.

Tā xìng Hú. Tā jiào Bǎolán.

他姓胡。他叫寶蘭。

Her surname is . Her given name is Bǎolán.

Tā xìng Hú, jiào Bǎolán.

他姓胡,叫寶蘭。

Her surname is , given name Bǎolán.

4.

Tā xìng Jiāng. Tā jiào Déxián.

他姓江。他叫德賢。

Her surname is Jiāng. Her given name is Déxián.

Tā xìng Jiāng, jiào Déxián.

他姓江,叫德賢。

Her surname is Jiāng, given name Déxián.

5.

Tā xìng Zhōu. Tā jiào Zǐyàn.

他姓周。他叫紫燕。

Her surname is Zhōu. Her given name is Zǐyàn.

Tā xìng Zhōu, jiào Zǐyàn.

他姓周,叫紫燕。

Her surname is Zhōu, given name Zǐyàn.

6.

Tā xìng Zhāng. Tā jiào Tíngfēng.

他姓張。他叫廷峯。

Her surname Zhāng. Her given name is Tíngfēng.

Tā xìng Zhāng, jiào Tíngfēng.

他姓張,叫廷峯。

Her surname is Zhāng, given name Tíngfēng.

7.

Tā xìng Chén. Tā jiào Huìrán.

他姓陳。他叫蕙然。

Her surname is Chén. Her given name is Huìrán.

Tā xìng Chén, jiào Huìrán.

他姓陳,叫蕙然。

Her surname is Zhāng, given name Huìrán.

9 Unit 3

9.1 Introduction

9.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Nationality.

  2. Home state, province, and city.

9.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

  1. P&R 5 and P&R 6 (Tapes 5 and 8 of the resource module on Pronunciation and Romanization.)

  2. NUM 1 and NUM 2 (Tapes 1 and 3 of the resource module on Numbers), the numbers from 1 to 10.

9.1.3 Material you will need

  1. The C-1 and P-1 tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the workbook.

  3. The 3D-1 tape.

9.2 References

9.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you American?
B: Wǒ shi Měiguó rén. 我是美國人。 I’m American.
2. A: Nǐ shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 你是中國人嗎? Are you Chinese?
B: Wǒ shi Zhōngguó rén. 我是中國人。 I’m Chinese.
3. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, nǐ shi Yīngguó rén ma? 王先生,你是英國人嗎 ? Mr. Wáng, are you English?
B: Wǒ bú shi Yīngguó rén. 我不是英國人。 I’m not English.
4. A: Nǐ shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 你是中國人嗎? Are you Chinese?
B: Bú shi. 不是。 No.
A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you American?
B: Shì. 是。 Yes, I’m.
5. A: Mǎ Xiǎojiě shi Měiguo rén ma? 馬小姐是美國人嗎? Is Miss an American?
B: Bú shi, tā bú shi Měiguó rén. 不是,他不是美國人。 No, she is not an American.
A: Tá shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 他是中國人嗎? Is she Chinese?
B: Shì, tā shi Zhōngguó rén. 是, 他是中國人。 Yes, she is Chinese.
6. A: Nǐ shi něiguó rén? 你是哪國人? What is your nationality?
B: Wǒ shi Měiguó rén. 我是美國人。 I’m American.
7. A: Tā shi něiguó rén? 他是哪國人? What is his nationality?
B: Tā shi Yīngguó rén. 他是英國人。 He is English.
8. A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 他是哪兒的人? Where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Shànghǎi rén. 我是上海人。 I’m from Shànghǎi.
9. A: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolánde Xiānsheng. 他是方寶蘭的先生。 He is Fāng Bǎolán’s husband.
10. A: Tā shi nǎrde rén? 他是哪兒的人? Where is he from?
B: Tā shi Shāndōng rén. 他是山東人。 He’s from Shāndōng.
11. A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 你是哪兒的人? Where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Jiāzhōu rén. 我是加州人。 I’m Californian.
12. A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you an American?
B: Nǐ shi něiguó rén? 你是哪國人? What’s your nationality?
A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 你是哪兒的人? Where are you from?

9.2.2 Vocabulary

-de possessive marker
Déguó 德國 Germany
Èguó Éguó 俄國 Russia
Fàguó Fǎguó 法國 France
-guó country
Jiāzhōu 加州 California
Měiguó 美國 America, United States
nǎr 哪兒 where?
něi- which?
něiguó 哪國 which country?
rén person
Rìběn 日本 Japan
Shāndōng 山東 a province name
Shànghǎi 上海 a city name
Yīngguó 英國 England
Zhōngguó 中國 China
Figure 9.2.2.1 0021-FSI-StandardChinese-Module01ORN-StudentText-7.png

9.2.3 Reference Notes

9.2.3.1 Notes on № 1-3
1. A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you American?
B: Wǒ shi Měiguó rén. 我是美國人。 I’m American.
2. A: Nǐ shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 你是中國人嗎? Are you Chinese?
B: Wǒ shi Zhōngguó rén. 我是中國人。 I’m Chinese.
3. A: Wáng Xiānsheng, nǐ shi Yīngguó rén ma? 王先生,你是英國人嗎 ? Mr. Wáng, are you English?
B: Wǒ bú shi Yīngguó rén. 我不是英國人。 I’m not English.

Rén is a noun, “person” or “persons”; so Měiguó rén is a noun phrase, literally “American person." Sometimes, however, it is preferable or necessary to translate expressions of this sort as adjectives or prepositional phrases.

Tā shi Meǐguó rén . 他是美國人。 He is an American (noun phrase)
Tā shi Zhōngguó rén. 他是中國人。 He is Chinese (adjective)
Tā shi Shāndōng rén. 他是山東人。 Hi is from Shāndōng. (prepositional phrase)

Although Měiguó rén is translated here as “an American,” in other contexts it may be translated as “the American,” “American,” or “the Americans.” Later you will learn the various ways to indicate in Chinese whether a noun is definite or indefinite, singular or plural.

The syllable -guó usually loses its tone in expressions like Měiguó rén. (some speakers drop the tone when the word stands alone: Měiguo.)

9.2.3.2 Notes on № 4-5
4. A: Nǐ shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 你是中國人嗎? Are you Chinese?
B: Bú shi. 不是。 No.
A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you American?
B: Shì. 是。 Yes, I’m.
5. A: Mǎ Xiǎojiě shi Měiguo rén ma? 馬小姐是美國人嗎? Is Miss an American?
B: Bú shi, tā bú shi Měiguó rén. 不是,他不是美國人。 No, she is not an American.
A: Tá shi Zhōngguó rén ma? 他是中國人嗎? Is she Chinese?
B: Shì, tā shi Zhōngguó rén. 是, 他是中國人。 Yes, she is Chinese.

The short “yes” answer shì is really the verb “am” of the longer, more complete answer. The short “no” answer bú shi is really the “am not” of the longer answer.

It is possible to reduce a “no” answer to (note the Falling tone), but polite usage requires that you follow it up with a more complete answer. Both the short answers shì and bú shi are commonly followed by complete answers.

9.2.3.3 Notes on № 6-7
6. A: Nǐ shi něiguó rén? 你是哪國人? What is your nationality?
B: Wǒ shi Měiguó rén. 我是美國人。 I’m American.
7. A: Tā shi něiguó rén? 他是哪國人? What is his nationality?
B: Tā shi Yīngguó rén. 他是英國人。 He is English.

Něi- is the question word “which.” It is a bound word—a word which cannot stand alone—not a free word.

něi- guo rén
which country person

Notice that the syllable -guó, “country," in the phrase něiguó rén may lose its rising tone.

9.2.3.4 Notes on № 8-11
8. A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 他是哪兒的人? Where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Shànghǎi rén. 我是上海人。 I’m from Shànghǎi.
9. A: Tā shi Fāng Bǎolánde xiānsheng. 他是方寶蘭的先生? He is Fāng Bǎolán’s husband.
10. A: Tā shi nǎrde rén? 他是哪兒的人? Where is he from?
B: Tā shi Shāndōng rén. 他是山東人。 He’s from Shāndōng.
11. A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 你是哪兒的人? Where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Jiāzhōu rén. 我是加州人。 I’m Californian.

nǎr is the question word “where." The syllable de is the possessive marker; it functions like the English possessive ending -’s.

nǎr -de rén
where ’s person

By reversing the word order, a slightly more idiomatic translation is possible: “a person of where." The closest English equivalent is “a person from where." To clarify the role of -de in this expression, the tape gives the following example of -de functioning like the English possessive ending -’s:

Fāng Bǎolán -de xiānsheng
Fāng Bǎolán ’s husband
9.2.3.5 Notes on № 12
12. A: Nǐ shi Měiguó rén ma? 你是美國人嗎? Are you an American?
B: Nǐ shi něiguó rén? 你是哪國人? What’s your nationality?
A: Nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 你是哪兒的人? Where are you from?

9.3 Drills

9.3.1 Response Drill

Table 9.3.1.1 All responses will be affirmative.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén ma?

他是中國人嗎?

Is he Chinese?

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén.

他是中國人。

He is Chinese.

2.

Tā shi Rìběn rén ma?

他是日本人嗎?

Is he Japanese?

Tā shi Rìběn rén.

他是日本人。

He is Japanese.

3.

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén ma?

他是中國人嗎?

Is he Chinese?

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén.

他是中國人。

He is Chinese.

4.

Tā shi Měiguó rén ma?

他是美國人嗎?

Is he American?

Tā shi Měiguó rén.

他是美國人。

He is American.

5.

Tā shi Déguo rén ma?

他是德國人嗎?

Is he German.

Tā shi Déguo rén.

他是德國人。

He is German.

6.

Tā shi Jiānádà rén ma?

T阿斯加拿大人嗎?

Is he Canadian?

Tā shi Jiānádà rén.

他是加拿大人。

He is Canadian.

7.

Tā shi Fàguo rén ma?

他是法國人嗎?

Is he French.

Tā shi Fàguo rén.

他是法國人。

He is French.

9.3.2 Response Drill

Table 9.3.2.1 Answer according to the model.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi Jiānádà rén ma?

他是加拿大人嗎?

Is he Canadian?

Yīngguó

England

英國

Tā bú shi Jiānádà rén. Shì Yīngguó rén.

他不是加拿大人。是英國人。

He not Canadian. (He) is English.

2.

Tā shi Rìběn rén ma?

他是日本人嗎?

Is he Japanese?

Zhōngguó

China

中國

Tā bú shi Rìběn rén. Shì Zhōngguó rén.

他不是日本人。是中國人。

He is not Japanese. (He) is Chinese.

3.

Tā shi Yīngguó rén ma?

他是英國人嗎?

Is he English?

Měiguó

America

美國

Tā bú shi Yīngguó rén. Shì Měiguó ren.

他不是英國人。是美國人。

He is not English. (He) is American.

4.

Tā shi Měiguó rén ma?

他是美國人嗎?

Is he American?

Jiānádà

Canada

加拿大

Tā bú shi Měiguó rén, Shì Jiānádà rén.

他不是美國人。是加拿大人。

He is not American. (He) is Canadian.

5.

Tā shi Èguó rén ma?

他是俄國人嗎?

Is he Russian?

Déguó

Germany

德國

Tā bú shi èguó rén. Shì Déguó rén.

他不是俄國人。是德國人。

He is not Russian. (He) is German .

6.

Tā shi Yuènán rén ma?

他是越南人嗎?

Is he Vietnamese?

Zhōngguó

China

中國

Tā bú shi Yuènán rén. Shì Zhōngguó rén.

他不是越南人。是中國人。

He is not Vietnamese. (He) is Chinese.

7.

Tā shi Fàguó rén ma?

他是法國人嗎?

Is he French?

Yīngguó

England

英國

Tā bú shi Fàguó rén. Shì Yīngguó ren.

他不是法國人。是英國人。

He is not French. (He) is English.

9.3.3 Response Drill

Table 9.3.3.1 Answer according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Fàguó

France

法國

Tā shi Fàguó rén.

他是法國人。

He is French.

2.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Zhōngguó

China

中國

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén.

他是中國人。

He is Chinese.

3.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Měiguó

America

美國

Tā shi Měiguó rén.

他是美國人。

He is American.

4.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Jiānádà

Canada

加拿大

Tā shi Jiānádà rén.

他是加拿大人。

He is Canadian.

5.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Rìběn

Japan

日本

Tā shi Rìběn rén.

他是日本人。

He is Japanese.

6.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Èguó

Russian

俄國

Tā shi Èguó rén.

他是俄國人。

He is Russian.

7.

Tā shi něiguo rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

Déguó

German

德國

Tā shi Déguó rén.

他是德國人。

He is German.

9.3.4 Response Drill

Table 9.3.4.1 Respond according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Běijīng

北京

Tā shi Běijīng rén.

他是北京人。

He is from Běijīng.

2.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Shànghǎi

上海

Tā shi Shànghǎi rén.

他是上海人。

He is from Shànghǎi.

3.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Chángshā

長沙

Tā shi Chángshā rén.

他是長沙人。

He is from Chángshā.

4.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Táizhōng

臺中

Tā shi Táizhōng rén.

他是臺中人。

He is from Táizhōng.

5.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Táiběi

臺北

Tā shi Táiběi rén.

他是臺北人。

He is from Táiběi.

6.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Tiānjīn

天津

Tā shi Tiānjīn rén.

他是天津人。

He is from Tiānjīn.

7.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

Běijīng

北京

Tā shi Běijīng rén.

他是北京人。

He is from Běijīng.

9.3.5 Transformation Drill

Table 9.3.5.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Běijīng rén.

他是北京人。

He is from Běijīng.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

2.

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén.

他是中國人。

He is from China.

Tā shi něiguó rén?

他是哪國人?

Where is he from?

3.

Tā shi Jiānádà ren.

他是加拿大人。

He is from Canada.

Tā shi něiguó rén?

他是哪國人?

Where is he from?

4.

Tā shi Táiběi rén.

他是臺北人。

He is from Táiběi.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

5.

Tā shi Shànghǎi rén.

他是上海人。

He is from Shànghǎi.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

6.

Tā shi Yīngguó rén.

他是英國人。

He is from England.

Tā shi něiguó rén?

他是哪國人?

Where is he from?

7.

Tā shi Měiguó rén.

他是美國人。

He is from America.

Tā shi něiguó rén?

他是哪國人?

Where is he from?

8.

Tā shi Táizhōng rén.

他是臺中人。

He is from Táizhōng.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

9.3.6 Transformation Drill

Table 9.3.6.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
1.

Tā shi Lǐ Tàitai.

她是李太太。

She is Mrs. .

Tā bú shi Lǐ Tàitai.

她不是李太太。

She is not Mrs. .

2.

Tā xìng Gāo.

他姓高。

Her surname is Gāo.

Tā bú xìng Gāo.

他不姓高。

Her surname is not Gāo.

3.

Tā shi Táiběi rén.

她是臺北人。

Hi is from Táiběi.

Tā bú shi Táiběi rén.

她不是臺北人。

Hi is not from Táiběi.

4.

Tā xìng Liú.

他姓劉。

Her surname is Liú.

Tā bú xìng Liú.

他不姓劉。

Her surname is not Liú.

5.

Tā shi Měiguó rén.

她是美國人。

She is American.

Tā bú shi Měiguó rén.

她不是美國人。

She is not American.

6.

Tā shi Jiānádà rén.

她是加拿大人。

She is Canadian.

Tā bú shi Jiānádà rén.

她不是加拿大人。

She is not Canadian.

9.3.7 Transformation Drill

Table 9.3.7.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā xìng Hú.

他姓胡。

His surname is .

Tā xìng Hú ma?

他姓胡嗎?

Is his surname ?

2.

Tā shi Běijīng rén.

他是北京人。

He is from Běijīng.

Tā shi Běijīng rén ma?

他是北京人嗎?

Is he from Běijīng?

3.

Tā shi Wáng Dànián.

他是王大年。

He is Wáng Dànián.

Tā shi Wáng Dànián ma?

他是王大年嗎?

Is he Wáng Dànián?

4.

Tā xìng Lín.

她姓林。

Her surname is Lín.

Tā xìng Lín ma?

她姓林嗎?

Is her surname Lín?

5.

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén.

她是中國人。

She is Chinese.

Tā shi Zhōngguó rén ma?

她是中國人嗎? 

Is she Chinese?

9.3.8 Transformation Drill

Table 9.3.8.1 Ask the question corresponding to the statement.
1.

Tā xìng Zhāng.

他姓張。

His surname is Zhāng.

Tā xìng shénme?

他姓什麼? 

What’s his surname?

2.

Tā shi Běijīng rén.

他是北京人。

He is from Běijīng.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

3.

Tā shi Wáng Dànián.

他是王大年。

He is Wáng Dànián.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

4.

Tā shi Rìběn rén.

他是日本人。

He is Japanese.

Tā shi něiguó rén?

他是哪國人?

What is his nationality?

5.

Tā shi Shāndōng rén.

他是山東人。

He is from Shāndōng.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他是哪兒的人?

Where is he from?

6.

Tā shi Chén Tóngzhì.

他是陳同志。

He is comrade Chén.

Tā shi shéi?

他是誰?

Who is he?

10 Unit 4

10.1 Introduction

10.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Location of people and places.

  2. Where people’s families are from.

10.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

  1. NUM 3 and NUM 4 (Tapes 3 and 4 of the resource module on Numbers.)

  2. CE 1, on Classroom Expressions.

10.1.3 Material you will need

  1. The C-1 and P-1 tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes , the workbook.

  3. The 4D-1 tape.

10.2 References

10.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 請問, 你是哪兒的人? May I ask, where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Dézhōu rén. 我是德州人。 I’m from Texas.
2. A: Qǐngwèn, Āndésen Fūren shi nǎrde rén? 請問,安德森夫人是哪兒的人? May I ask, where is Mrs. Andersen from?
B: Tā yě shi Dézhōu rén. 她也是德州人。 She is from Texas too.
3. A: Tā shi Yīngguó rén ma? 她是英國人嗎? Is he English?
B: Bú shi, tā bú shi Yīngguó rén. 不是,他不是英國人。 No, he is not English.
A: Tā àiren ne? 他愛人呢? And his wife?
B: Tā yě bú shi Yīngguó rén. 她也不是英國人。 She isn’t English either.
4. A: Qǐngwèn, Qīngdǎo zài nǎr? 請問,青島在哪兒? May I ask, where is Qīngdǎo?
B: Qīngdǎo zài Shāndōng. 青島在山東。 Qīngdǎo is in Shāndōng.
5. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ lǎojiā zài nǎr? 請問, 你老家在哪兒? May I ask, where is your family from?
B: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Āndàlüè. 我老家在安大略。 My family is from Ontario.
B: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Shāndōng. 我老家在山東。 My family is from Shāndōng.
6. A: Chén Shìmín Tóngzhì zài nǎr? 陳世民同志在哪兒? Where is comrade Chén Shìmín?
B: Tā zài nàr. 他在那兒。 He’s there.
7. A: Qīngdǎo zài nǎr? 青島在哪兒? Where is Qīngdǎo?
B: Zài zhèr. 在這兒。 It’s here.
8. A: Nǐ àiren xiànzài zài nǎr? 你愛人現在在哪兒? Where is your wife now?
B: Wǒ àiren xiànzài zài Jiānádà. 我愛人現在在加拿大。 My wife is in Canada now.

10.2.2 Vocabulary

àiren 愛人 spouse
Āndàlüè 安大略 Ontario
Dézhōu 德州 Texas
fūren 夫人 Lady, Madame, Mrs. , wife (of a high ranking person)
Jiānádà 加拿大 Canada
lǎojiā 老家 “original home”
nàr (nèr) 那兒 there
Qīngdǎo 青島 a city name
Qǐngwèn 請問 May I ask?
xiànzài 現在 now
also, too, either
zài to be in/at/one
zhèr 這兒 here

Additional required vocabulary not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes.

Learn the pronunciation and location of any five cities and five provinces of China on the maps on page 80-81.

Figure 10.2.2.1 0021-FSI-StandardChinese-Module01ORN-StudentText-8.png

10.2.3 Reference Notes

10.2.3.1 Notes on № 1
1. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ shi nǎrde rén? 請問,你是哪兒的人? May I ask, where are you from?
B: Wǒ shi Dézhōu rén. 我是德州人。 I’m from Texas.

Qǐngwèn: Literally, qǐng means “request,” and wèn means “ask (for information).” Qǐngwèn is used as English speakers use “excuse me,” to get someone’s attention in order to ask him a question.

🛈︎
Note

Qǐngwèn is NOT the word used for saying “excuse me” when you step on some­one’s foot. For that, you say duìbuqǐ .

10.2.3.2 Notes on № 2
2. A: Qǐngwèn, Āndésen Fūren shi nǎrde rén? 請問,安德森夫人是哪兒的人? May I ask, where is Mrs. Andersen from?
B: Tā yě shi Dézhōu rén. 他也是德州人。 She is from Texas too.

Names: In the People’s Republic, a foreigner is known by the standard phonetic equivalent of his full name. His given name is followed by his surname, which is followed by the appropriate title, Mr. David Anderson will be called Dàiwéi Āndésèn Xiānsheng . In Taiwan, there is no set way of giving names to foreigners. Sometimes, as in the PRC, a phonetic equivalent of the full name is used (though there are no standard versions). Sometimes, the equivalent is based entirely on the surname. Mr. Anderson, for instance, might be Ān Désēn Xiānsheng. The surname may also be translated, as when “King” is translated into Wáng. It is also common to base the Chinese surname on the first syllable of the original surname, and the Chinese given name on something else (often the original given name). In Taiwan, Dàwèi is a common phonetic equivalent for “David.” “Mr. David Anderson,” therefore, might be Ān Dàwèi Xiānsheng .

Here is a chart of SOME of the Chinese names that might be given to Mr. David Anderson.

Table 2.1 PRC
Dàwéi Āndésēn Xiānsheng
Table 2.2 TAIWAN
Ān Désēn Xiānsheng
Ān Dàwèi Xiānsheng

Titles: In the PRC, a foreign man is addressed as Xiānsheng, and a married woman as either Fūren or Taìtai, depending on her status. The term Fūren is an especially respectful term used to address the wife of a high-ranking official or businessman. Fūren is also used this way on Taiwan.

An unmarried foreign woman in the PRC may be addressed as xXiǎojiě “Miss.” Married or unmarried women may be addressed as Nǚshì. or “Ma’am.” Nǚshì will be introduced in BIO, Unit 1.

The term Tóngzhì, “Comrade,” was originally used only by members of the Communist Party to address other members. It is now the general term of address used by all Chinese adults in the PRC. It should be remembered, though, that Tóngzhì does carry a distinct political implication. Visitors in the People’s Republic, who are not citizens and who do not take part in efforts to realize Communist ideals, will not be addressed as Tóngzhì and should not feel obliged to address anyone else as such.

is an adverb meaning “also,” or “too.” It always comes before the verb.

10.2.3.3 Notes on № 3
3. A: Tā shi Yīngguó rén ma? 他是英國人嗎? Is she English?
B: Bú shi, tā bú shi Yīngguó rén. 不是,他不是英國人。 No, he is not English.
A: Tā àiren ne? 他愛人呢? And his wife?
B: Tā yě bú shi Yīngguó rén. 她也不是英國人。 She isn’t English either.

Àiren, which originally meant “loved one,” “sweetheart” or “lover,” is used in the PRC for either “husband” or “wife,” i.e., for “spouse.”

The possessive phrase Tā Àiren, “his wife” (or, “her husband”), is formed by putting the words for “he” (or “she”) and “spouse” together.

The marker -de (which you have seen in nǎrde rén) is not needed when the possessive relationship is felt to be very close. (See also the notes on No. 5.)

in a negative sentence is usually translated as “either.” In this case, comes between and the verb. Possible English translations for , in both affirmative and negative sentences, are:

Tā yě shi Yǐngguo rén. 她也是英國人。

She is English too.

She is also English.

Tā yě bú shi Yīnggguo rén. 她也不是英國人。

She is not English either.

She is also not English.

10.2.3.4 Notes on № 4
4. A: Qǐngwèn, Qīngdǎo zài nǎr? 請問,青島在哪兒? May I ask, where is Qīngdǎo?
B: Qīngdǎo zài Shāndōng. 青島在山東。 Qīngdǎo is in Shāndōng.

Zài is the verb “to be in/at/on,” that is, “to be somewhere.” Zài involves location, while shì involves identity, “to be someone/something.”

10.2.3.5 Notes on № 5
5. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ lǎojiā zài nǎr? 請問,你老家在哪兒? May I ask, where is your family from?
B: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Āndàlüè. 我老家在安大略。 My family is from Ontario.
B: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Shāndōng. 我老家在山東。 My family is from Shāndōng.

Literally, lǎojiā is “old home” (“original home,” “ancestral home,” “native place”), that is, the place you and your family are from. When a Chinese asks you about your lǎojiā, he probably wants to know about your hometown, the place where you grew up.

When you ask a Chinese about his lǎojiā however, he will tell you where his family came from originally. A Chinese whose grandparents came from the province of Guǎngdōng will give that as his lǎojiā, even if he and his parents have spent all of their lives in Sìchuān.

Nǐ lǎojiā zài nǎr? (literally “Where is your original home?") asks for the LOCATION of the town you come from.

The question is answered with zài plus the name of the province (or state) that the town is located in: Wǒ lǎojiā zài Dèzhōu (Āndàlüè, Shāndōng). Nǐ lǎojiā shi nǎr? (translated into English as “What is your original home?” asks about the IDENTITY of the town you come from. That question is answered with shi plus the name of the town (or city): Wǒ lǎojiā shi Jiùjīnshān (Qǐngdǎo, Shànghǎi).

Compare:

Wó lǎojiā zài Guǎngdōng. 我老家在廣東。 My original home is in Guǎngdōng.
Wǒ lǎojiā shi Guǎngzhōu. 我老家是廣州。 My original home is Guǎngzhōu.

The possessive nǐ lǎojiā, like tā àiren, does not require a possessive marker. However, if more than one word must be used to indicate the possessor, -de is often inserted after the last word: nǐ àirende lǎojiā, “your spouse’s original home” or “where your spouse’s family comes from.”

10.2.3.6 Notes on № 6-8
6. A: Chén Shìmín Tóngzhì zài nǎr? 陳世民同志在哪兒? Where is comrade Chén Shìmín?
B: Tā zài nàr. 他在那兒。 He’s there.
7. A: Qīngdǎo zài nǎr? 青島在哪兒? Where is Qīngdǎo?
B: Zài zhèr. 在這兒。 It’s here.
8. A: Nǐ àiren xiànzài zài nǎr? 你愛人現在在哪兒? Where is your wife now?
B: Wǒ àiren xiànzài zài Jiānádà. 我愛人現在在加拿大。 My wife is in Canada now.

You have learned three words for asking and telling about locations.

nǎr 哪兒 where
nàr (nèr) 那兒 there
zhèr 這兒 here

Notice that the question word nǎr is in the Low tone, while the answer words nàr and zhèr are both in the Falling tone. Also notice that the vowel sound in zhèr is different from that in nǎr and nàr. (Some speakers prefer nèr to nàr.) When you are talking about movable things and people that you presume are not nearby (“nearby,” being approximately within pointing range), you usually ask where they are NOW. The “present time” word may be omitted if the time has been established earlier in the conversation.

Nǐ àiren xiànzài zài nǎr? 你愛人現在在哪兒? Where is your wife now?
Tā zài Běijīng. 她在北京。 She’s in Běijīng (now).
If you ask about someone or something you presume to be nearby (a pair of scissors in a drawer, for instance, or a person in a group across the room), you do not use xiànzài.

In English, the words “here” and “there” are used to refer to locations of any size. In Chinese, however, zhèr and nàr are usually not used for cities, provinces, and countries (with the exception that you may use zhèr to refer to the city you are in). Instead, you repeat the name of the place.

Compare these two exchanges in Beìjǐng:

Country:

Mǎdīng Xiānsheng xiànzài zài Zhōngguó ma?

Tā xiànzài zài Zhōngguó.

He is here now.

City:

Mǎdīng Xiānsheng xiànzài zài Shànghǎi ma?

Tā bú zài Shànghǎi; tā zài zhèr.

He is not there; he is here.

Jiānádà “Canada”: Although the middle syllable of this word is marked with the Rising tone, at a normal rate of speech you will probably hear Jiānādà.

10.3 Drills

10.3.1 Response Drill

Table 10.3.1.1 Respond to the question “Where is He/she from?” according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Húnán

湖南

Tā shi Húnán rén.

他/她是湖南人。

He/she is from Húnán.

2.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Shāndōng

山東

Tā shi Shāndōng rén.

他/她是山東人。

He/she is from Shāndōng.

3.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Héběi

河北

Tā shi Héběi rén.

他/她是河北人。

He/she is from Héběi.

4.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Jiāngsū

江蘇

Tā shi Jiāngsū rén.

他/她是江蘇人。

He/she is from Jiāngsū.

5.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Guāngdōng

廣東

Tā shi Guāngdōng rén.

他/她是廣東人。

He/she is from Guāngdōng.

6.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Húběi

湖北

Tā shi Húběi rén.

他/她是湖北人。

He/she is from Húběi.

7.

Tā shi nǎrde rén?

他/她是哪兒的人?

Where is He/she from?

Sìchuān

四川

Tā shi Sìchuān rén.

他/她是四川人。

He/she is from Sìchuān.

10.3.2 Transformation Drill

Table 10.3.2.1 Ask the appropriate “where" question, as in the example.
Statement Answer
1.

Zhāng Tóngzhì Fūren shi Běijīng rén.

張同志夫人是北京人。

Comrade Zhāng’s wife is from Běijīng.

Qǐngwèn, Zhāng fūren shi nǎrde rén?

請問張夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Zhāng from?

2.

Huáng Tóngzhì fūren shi Shànghǎi ren.

黃同志夫人是上海人。

Comrade Huáng’s wife is from Shànghǎi.

Qǐngwèn, Huáng fūren shi nǎrde rén?

請問黃夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Huáng from?

3.

Wáng Tóngzhì fūren shi Nánjīng rén.

王同志夫人是南京人。

Comrade Wáng’s wife is from Nánjīng.

Qǐngwèn, Wáng fūren shi nǎrde ren?

請問黃夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Wáng from?

4.

Lǐ Tóngzhì fūren shi Guǎngzhōu rén.

李同志夫人是廣州人。

Comrade ’s wife is from Guǎngzhōu.

Qǐngwèn, Lǐ fūren shi nǎrde rén?

請問李夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. from?

5.

Zhào tōngzhì fūren shi Xiānggǎng ren.

趙同志夫人是香港。

Comrade Zhào’s wife is from Xiānggǎng.

Qǐngwèn, Zhào fūren shi nǎrde ren?

請問趙夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Zhào from?

6.

Máo Tóngzhì fūren shi Qīngdǎo ren.

毛同志夫人是青島人。

Comrade Máo’s wife is from Qīngdǎo.

Qǐngwèn, Máo fūren shi nǎrde rén?

請問毛夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Máo from?

7.

Chén Tóngzhì fūren shi Běijīng rén.

陳同志夫人是北京人。

Comrade Chén’s wife is from Xiānggǎng.

Qǐngwèn, Chén fūren shi nǎrde rén?

請問陳夫人是哪兒的人?

May I ask, where is Mrs. Chén from?

10.3.3 Transformation Drill

Table 10.3.3.1 Change affirmative statements to negative statements.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Héběi rén.

他/她是河北人。

He/she is from Héběi.

Tā bú shi Héběi ren.

他/她不是河北人。

He/she is not from Héběi.

2.

Tā shi Shāndōng rén.

他/她是山東人。

He/she is from Shāndōng.

Tā bú shi Shāndōng rén.

他/她不是山東人。

He/she is not from Shāndōng.

3.

Tā shi Jiāngsū ren.

他/她是江蘇人。

He/she is from Jiāngsū.

Tā bú shi Jiāngsū rén.

他/她不是江蘇人。

He/she is not from Jiāngsū.

4.

Tā shi Fújiàn rén.

他/她是福建人。

He/she is from Fújiàn.

Tā bú shi Fújiàn rén.

他/她不是福建人。

He/she is not from Fújiàn.

5.

Tā shi Zhèjiāng rén.

他/她是浙江人。

He/she is from Zhèjiāng.

Tā bú shi Zhèjiāng rén.

他/她不是浙江人。

He/she is not from Zhèjiāng.

6.

Tā shi Húnán ren.

他/她是湖南人。

He/she is from Húnán.

Tā bú shi Húnán ren.

他/她不是湖南人。

He/she is not from Húnán.

7.

Tā shi Sìchuān rén.

他/她是四川人。

He/she is from Sìchuān.

Tā bú shi Sìchuān rén.

他/她不是四川人。

He/she is not from Sìchuān.

10.3.4 Transformation Drill

Table 10.3.4.1 Add to the statement.
Statement Answer
1.

Tā shi Héběi ren.

他/她是河北人。

He/she is from Héběi

Tā yě shi Héběi rén.

他/她也是河北人。

He/she is from Héběi too.

2.

Tā shi Zhèjiāng ren.

他/她是浙江人。

He/she is from Zhèjiāng

Tā yě shi Zhèjiāng rén.

他/她也是浙江人。

He/she is from Zhèjiāng too.

3.

Tā shi Fújiàn ren.

他/她是福建人。

He/she is from Fújiàn

Tā yě shi Fújiàn rén.

他/她也是福建人。

He/she is from Fújiàn too.

4.

Tā shi Húnán ren.

他/她是湖南人。

He/she is from Húnán

Tā yě shi Húnán rén.

他/她也是湖南人。

He/she is from Húnán too.

5.

Tā shi Jiāngsū ren.

他/她是江蘇人。

He/she is from Jiāngsū

Tā yě shi Jiāngsū rén.

他/她也是江蘇人。

He/she is from Jiāngsū too.

6.

Tā shi Shāndōng rén.

他/她是山東人。

He/she is from Shāndōng

Tā yě shi Shāndōng rén.

他/她也是山東人。

He/she is from Shāndōng too.

7.

Tā shi Hénán rén.

他/她是河南人。

He/she is from Hénán

Tā yě shi Hénán rén.

他/她也是河南人。

He/she is from Hénán too.

10.3.5 Transformation Drill

Table 10.3.5.1 Add to the statement.
Statement Answer
1.

Zhào Xiānsheng bú shi Táiwān rén.

趙先生不是臺灣人。

Mr. Zhào isn’t from Táiwān.

Zhào Xiānsheng yě bú shi Táiwān rén.

趙先生也不是臺灣人。

Mr. Zhào isn’t from Táiwān either.

2.

Lǐ Xiānsheng bú shi Táiběi ren.

李先生不是臺北人。

Mr. isn’t from Táiběi.

Lǐ Xiānsheng yě bú shi Táiběi ren.

李先生也不是臺北人。

Mr. isn’t from Táiběi either.

3.

Wáng Xiānsheng bú shi Táizhōng ren.

王先生不是臺中人。

Mr. Wáng isn’t from Táizhōng.

Wáng Xiānsheng yě bú shi Táizhōng ren.

王先生也不是臺中人。

Mr. Wáng isn’t from Táizhōng either.

4.

Huáng Xiānsheng bú shi Táinán rén.

黃先生不是臺南人。

Mr. Huáng isn’t from Táinán.

Huáng Xiānsheng yě bú shi Táinán rén.

黃先生也不是臺南人。

Mr. Huáng isn’t from Táinán either.

5.

Liú Xiānsheng bú shi Táidōng rén.

劉先生不是臺東人。

Mr. Liú isn’t from Táidōng.

Liú Xiānsheng yě bú shi Táidōng rén.

劉先生也不是臺東人。

Mr. Liú isn’t from Táidōng either.

6.

Hú Xiānsheng bú shi Jīlóng rén.

胡先生不是基隆市人。

Mr. isn’t from Jīlóng.

Hú Xiānsheng yě bú shi Jīlóng rén.

胡先生也不是基隆市人。

Mr. isn’t from Jīlóng either.

7.

Chén Xiānsheng bú shi Gāoxióng rén.

陳先生不是高雄人。

Mr. Chén isn’t from Gāoxióng.

Chén Xiānsheng yě bú shi Gāoxióng rén.

陳先生也不是高雄人。

Mr. Chén isn’t from Gāoxióng either.

10.3.6 Response drill

Table 10.3.6.1 Give a negative answer to the statements..
Question Answer
1.

Mǎ Tóngzhì shi Běijīng rén ma?

馬同志是北京人嗎?

Is comrade from Běijīng?

Tā bú shi Běijīng rén.

他/她不是北京人。

He/she isn’t from Běijīng.

2.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā àiren yě bú shi Běijīng rén.

他/她愛人也不是北京人。

He/she isn’t from Běijīng either.

3.

Zhāng Tóngzhì shi Shànghǎi rén ma?

張同志是上海人嗎?

Is comrade Zhāng from Shànghǎi?

Tā bú shi Shànghǎi rén.

他/她不是上海人。

He/she isn’t from Shànghǎi.

4.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Shànghǎi rén.

他/她也不是上海人。

He/she isn’t from Shànghǎi either.

5.

Jiāng Tóngzhì shi Nánjīng rén ma?

蔣同志是南京人嗎?

Is comrade Jiāng from Nánjīng?

Tā bú shi Nánjīng rén.

他/她不是南京.

He/she isn’t from Nánjīng.

6.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Nánjīng rén.

他/她也不是南京人。

He/she isn’t from Nánjīng either.

7.

Chén Tóngzhì shi Guǎngzhōu rén ma?

陳同志是廣州人嗎?

Is comrade Chén from Guǎngzhōu?

Tā bú shi Guǎngzhōu rén.

他/她不是廣州人。

He/she isn’t from Guǎngzhōu.

8.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Guǎngzhōu rén.

他/她也不是廣州人。

He/she isn’t from Guǎngzhōu either.

9.

Sūn Tóngzhì shi Chéngdū rén ma?

孫同志是成都人嗎?

Is comrade Sūn from Chéngdū?

Tā bū shi Chéngdū rén.

他/她不是成都人。

He/she isn’t from Chéngdū.

10.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Chéngdū rén.

他/她也不是成都人。

He/she isn’t from Chéngdū either.

11.

Máo Tóngzhì shi Qīngdǎo rén ma?

毛同志是青島人嗎?

Is comrade Máo from Qīngdǎo?

Tā bú shi Qīngdǎo rén.

他/她不是青島人。

He/she isn’t from Qīngdǎo.

12.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Qīngdǎo rén.

他/她也不是青島人。

He/she isn’t from Qīngdǎo either.

13.

Yáng Tóngzhì shi Běijīng rén ma?

楊同志是北京人嗎?

Is comrade Yáng from Běijīng?

Tā bú shi Běijīng rén.

他/她不是北京人。

He/she isn’t from Běijīng.

14.

Tā àiren ne?

他/她愛人呢?

And his/her spouse?

Tā yě bú shi Běijīng rén.

他/她也不是北京人。

He/she isn’t from Běijīng either.

10.3.7 Response Drill

Table 10.3.7.1 Respond according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Qǐngwèn, Qīngdǎo zài nǎr?

請問青島在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Qīngdǎo?

Shāndōng

山東

Qīngdǎo zài Shāndōng.

青島在山東。

Qīngdǎo is in Shāndōng.

2.

Qǐngwèn, Nánjīng zài nǎr?

請問南京在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Nánjīng?

Jiāngsū

江蘇

Nánjīng zài Jiāngsū.

南京在江蘇。

Nánjīng is in Jiāngsū.

3.

Qǐngwèn, Guǎngzhōu zài nǎr?

請問廣州在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Guǎngzhōu?

Guǎngdōng

廣東

Guǎngzhōu zài Guǎngdōng.

廣州在廣東。

Guǎngzhōu is in Guǎngdōng.

4.

Qǐngwèn, Shànghǎi zài nǎr?

請問上海在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Shànghǎi?

Jiāngsū

江蘇

Shànghǎi zài Jiāngsū.

上海在江蘇。

Shànghǎi is in Jiāngsū.

5.

Qǐngwèn, Běijīng zài nǎr?

請問北京在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Běijīng?

Héběi

河北

Běijīng zài Héběi.

北京在河北。

Běijīng is in Héběi.

6.

Qǐngwèn, Qīngdǎo zài nǎr?

請問青島在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Qīngdǎo?

Shāndōng

山東

Qīngdǎo zài Shāndōng.

青島在山東。

Qīngdǎo is in Shāndōng.

7.

Qǐngwèn, Shànghǎi zài nǎr?

請問上海在哪兒?

May I ask, where is Shànghǎi.

Jiāngsū

江蘇

Shànghǎi zài Jiāngsū.

上海在江蘇。

Shànghǎi is in Jiāngsū.

10.3.8 Transformation Drill

Table 10.3.8.1 Transform the statement according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

Lín Tóngzhì shi Húběi rén.

林同志是河北。

Comrade Lín is from Húběi.

Lín Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Húběi.

林同志的老家在河北。

Comrade Lín’s family is from Húběi.

2.

Wáng Tóngzhì shi Shānxī rén.

王同志哦是山西。

Comrade Wáng is from Shānxī.

Wáng Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Shānxī.

王同志的老家在山西。

Comrade Wáng’s family is from Shānxī.

3.

Huáng Tóngzhì shi Shānxī rén.

黃同志哦是山西。

Comrade Huáng is from Shānxī.

Huáng Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Shānxī.

黃同志的老家在山西。

Comrade Huáng’s family is from Shānxī.

4.

Gāo Tóngzhì shi Fújiàn rén.

高同志哦是福建。

Comrade Gāo is from Fújiàn.

Gāo Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Fújiàn.

高同志的老家在福建。

Comrade Gāo’s family is from Fújiàn.

5.

Lǐ tóngzhǐ shi Sǐchuān rén.

李同志是四川。

Comrade is from Sǐchuān.

Lǐ Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Sìchuān.

李同志的老家在四川。

Comrade ’s family is from Sǐchuān.

6.

Zhōu Tóngzhì shi Zhèjiāng rén.

周同志是浙江。

Comrade Zhōu is from Zhèjiāng.

Zhōu Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Zhèjiāng.

周同志的老家在浙江。

Comrade Zhōu’s family is from Zhèjiāng.

7.

Máo Tóngzhì shi Húnán rén.

毛同志是湖南。

Comrade Máo is from Húnán.

Máo Tóngzhìde lǎojiā zài Húnán.

毛同志的老家在湖南。

Comrade Máo’s family is from Húnán.

10.3.9 Response Drill

Table 10.3.9.1 Respond according to the cue.
Statement Cue Answer
1.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Měiguó

美國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Měiguó.

他/她愛人現在在美國。

His/Her spouse is in America now.

2.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Jiānádà

加拿大

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Jiānádà.

他/她愛人現在在加拿大。

His/Her spouse is in Canada now.

3.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Yīngguó

英國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Yīngguó.

他/她愛人現在在英國。

His/Her spouse is in England now.

4.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Déguó

德國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Déguó.

他/她愛人現在在德國。

His/Her spouse is in Germany now.

5.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Měiguó

美國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Měiguó.

他/她愛人現在在美國。

His/Her spouse is in America now.

6.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Fàguó

法國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Fàguó.

他/她愛人現在在法國。

His/Her spouse is in France now.

7.

Tā àiren zài nǎr?

他/她愛人在哪兒?

Where is his/her spouse?

Èguó

俄國

Tā àiren xiànzài zài Èguó.

他/她愛人現在在俄國。

His/Her spouse is in Russia now.

11 Criterion Test

The purpose of the Criterion Test at the end of each module is to show you not only how much of the material you have learned, but also what points you need to work on before beginning to study another module.

Since the primary goal of ORN is to introduce the sound system of Standard Chinese, this test focuses on your ability to discriminate and produce tones, vowels, and consonants. Additionally, there are sections which test your ability to comprehend and produce numbers from 1 through 99 and the material in the ORN Target Lists.

Your knowledge of personal names and titles and the romanization system is also tested. Read the Objectives at the beginning of the module for a description of exactly what the test covers.

Note: Although the entire sound system is introduced in the Pronunciation and Romanization Module, you will be tested here only on those sounds which occur in the Target Sentences. Other sounds will be included in Criterion Tests for later modules.

Following is a sample of the Criterion Test for this module. Each section of the test, with directions and a sample question, is represented here so that you may know exactly what is expected of you after studying the ORN Module.

Minimum scores are suggested for each section of the test. Achieving these scores means that you are adequately prepared for the next module. If you fall below the minimum criterion on any section, you should review relevant study materials.

You will use a tape to complete Part I of the test. Part II is written, and you will complete Part III with your instructor. Part IV of the test (Diagnostics) indicates the passing score for each section and review materials for each section.

11.1 Part I

  1. This section tests your ability to distinguish the four tones. In your test booklet you will see two syllables after each letter. The speaker will pronounce both syllables, and then say one of them again. You are to decide which syllable was repeated, and circle the appropriate one to indicate your choice. The syllables may occur in any of the four tones, regardless of which tone was used previously in the module. The same syllable may occur more than once in this section.

    For example, the speaker might say: fēi … fěi and then repeat fēi

    1. fēi fěi

  2. This section tests your ability to recognize the four tones in isolated syllables. The speaker will pronounce a syllable twice; you add to the written syllable the tone that you hear. Again, the syllables may occur in any of the four tones, regardless of which tone was used previously in the module.

    For example, the speaker might say: fěi...fěi

    1. feifěi

  3. This section tests your ability to recognize the four tones in two-syllables combinations. The speaker pronounces each two-syllable item twice and then pauses a moment for you to mark tones on the written syllables. For the first ten items, one of the two tones is already marked. For the last ten items, you must fill in both tones.

    For example: the speaker might say: cháběi...cháběi

    1. chabei → cháběi

  4. In this section, you are tested on syllables which differ minimally in sound. The speaker will pronounce each syllable in an item once; then he will pronounce one of the syllables again. Decide which of the syllables was repeated, and indicate your choice by circling that written syllable in your test booklet. The syllables in this test do not necessarily correspond in every way to syllables in the Target Lists They may vary in tone, for example.

    For example, the speaker might say: fàn...fàng and then repeat fàng.

    1. fàn fàng

  5. In this section, you complete the romanization for the syllables that you hear. As the speaker says a syllable, write the appropriate vowel or consonant letter(s) in the blank. This tests your ability to recognize the sounds of a syllable and to use the romanization system correctly. The speaker will say each syllable twice.

    For example, the speaker might say: pàng...pàng then you would write:

    1. pàng

  6. This section tests your ability to understand the numbers 1 through 99 in Chinese. For each item, the speaker will say a number, and you write down the numerals for that number.

    For example, you might hear: shí-sān

    1. 13

  7. This section tests your ability to understand questions and answers about where someone is from and where he is now. Listen to a conversation between Mr. Johnson and Comrade Zhào, who have just met. You will hear the conversation three times. The third time you hear it, a pause will follow each line. You may use these pauses to fill in the boxes in your booklet with appropriate information. (You do not have to wait for the second repetition of the conversation to fill in the answers, of course.)

    For example: [You will hear a conversation similar to conversations you heard on the C-2 tapes in this module.]

    Home State or Province Present Location
    Comrade Zhào
    Mr. Johnson (Yuēhànsūn)
    Comrade Zhào’s husband
    Mrs. Johnson
  8. This section tests your ability to comprehend Chinese utterances by asking you for the English equivalents. For each item, the speaker will say a sentence from the Target List twice. You indicate your understanding of the sentence by circling the letter of the English sentence which most closely matches the meaning of the Chinese sentence.

    For example, you might hear: nǐ shi shéi?...nǐ shi shéi?

    1. Who is she?

    2. Who is he?

    3. Who are you?

11.2 Part II

  1. This section tests your general understanding of the Chinese system of personal names and titles. Read the family histories in your test booklet, and answer the questions.

    For example,

    Yáng Tíngfēng is the Chinese name used lay an American, Timothy Young, now that he is living in Taipei. His Chinese surname is:

    1. Yáng

    2. Tíngféng

    3. Yáng Tíngféng

11.3 Part III

  1. This section tests your ability to pronounce the four tones. Simple sound combinations have been chosen so that special attention may be given to tone production. For each item, choose one syllable and read it aloud. As you do so, put a circle around the one you choose. The instructor will note the syllable he hears. Be sure to choose a fair sampling of all four tones, and select them in random order.

    For example, you might say:

    1. mǎ mà

  2. This section tests your ability to pronounce Chinese sounds from the Target Lists, as well as your ability to read romanization. For each item, choose one syllable and read it aloud. As you do so, put a circle around the one you choose. The instructor will note the syllable he hears. Be sure to choose syllables from each column as you go through this section of the test.

    For example, you might say: nín

    1. nín...níng

  3. This section tests your ability to locate and name main cities and provinces in China. Using the map in your booklet, point out to your instructor five cities and five provinces and name them. Pronunciation is of secondary importance here.

  4. This section tests your ability to produce sentences in Chinese. Your instructor will say an English sentence from the Target Lists, and you translate it into Chinese. Your Chinese sentence must “be correct,” both in grammar and in content.

  5. This section tests your ability to make conversational use of the material covered in this module. Although limited in scope, this conversation between you and your instructor represents a situation which you are likely to encounter in the real world. As in any conversation, you are free to ask for a repetition or rephrasing of a sentence, or you may volunteer information on the subject. It is not so much the correctness of your pronunciation and grammar that is being tested as it is your ability to communicate effectively.

12 Appendices

12.1 Appendix 1: Map of China

12.2 Appendix 2: Map of Taiwan

12.3 Appendix 3: Countries and Regions

12.4 Appendix 4: American States

Alabama 阿拉巴馬 Ālābāmǎ
Alaska 阿拉斯加 Ālāsǐjiā
Arizona 亞利桑那 Yàlìsāngnà
Arkansas 阿肯色 Ākěnsè, Akānsàsī
California 加州, 加利福尼亞 Jiāzhōu, Jiālìfóníyà
Colorado 科羅拉多 Kēluólāduō
Connecticut 康涅狄格, 康乃狄克 Kāngnièdígé, Kāngnǎidígé
Delaware 特拉華 Tèlāhuá, Délāwēi (ěr)
Florida 弗羅裏達 Fóluólǐdá
Georgia 喬治亞, 佐治亞 Qiáozhìyà, Zuǒzhìyà
Hawaii 夏威夷 Xiàwēiyí
Idaho 愛達荷 Àidáhé
Illinois 伊利諾 Yīlìnuò (sī)
Indiana 印第安納 Yìndiànnà
Iowa 愛奧華 Yīāhuá, Àiāhuá
Kansas 堪薩斯 Kānsàsī
Kentucky 肯塔基 Kěntǎjī
Louisiana 路易斯安那 Lùyìsīānnà
Maine 緬因 Miǎnyīn
Maryland 馬里蘭 Mǎlǐlán
Massachusetts 馬薩諸塞 Mǎsāzhūsài, Mǎshěng
Michigan 密歇根, Mìxīgēn, Mìzhíān
Minnesota 明尼蘇達 Míngnísūdá
Mississippi 密西西比 Mìxīxībǐ
Missouri 密蘇里 Mìsūlǐ
Montana 蒙大納 Méngdànà
Nebraska 內布拉斯加 Nèibùlāsījiā
Nevada 內華達 Nèihuádá
New Hampshire 新罕布什爾 Xīn Hānbùshíěr, Xīn Hǎnbùxià
New Jersey 新澤西 Xīn Zéxī
New Mexico 新墨西哥 Xīn Mòxīgē
New York 紐約 Niǔyuē
North Carolina 北卡羅來納 Běi Kǎluóláinà, Běi Kǎluólínnà
North Dakota 北達科他 Běi Dákētā, Běi Dákēdá
Ohio 俄亥俄 Éhàié
Oklahoma 俄克拉荷馬 Ékèlāhémǎ, Ākèlāhémǎ
Oregon 俄勒岡 Élègāng
Pennsylvania 賓州, 賓夕法尼亞, 賓西法尼亞 Bīnxhōu, Bīnxīfǎníyà, Bīnxīfánníyà
Rhode Island 羅得島 Luódé Dǎo, Luódéàilán
South Carolina 南卡羅來納 Nán Kǎluóláinà, Nán Kǎluólínnà
South Dakota 南達科他 Nán Dákētā
Tennessee 田納西 Tiánnàxī
Texas 得克薩斯 Dézhōu, Dékèsàsī
Utah 猶他 Yóutā, Yōuta
Vermont 佛蒙特 Wēiméngtè, Fóméngtè
Virginia 維吉尼亞, 弗吉尼亞 Wēijíníyà, Fójíníyà
Washington 華盛頓 Huáshèngdùn
West Virginia 西弗吉尼亞 Xī Fójíníyà
Wisconsin 威斯康星 Wēisīkāngxīn(g)
Wyoming 懷俄明 Huáiémíng

12.5 Appendix 5: Canadian Provinces

Alberta 阿爾伯塔, 艾伯塔 (Yǎbódá) Ā​'ěr​bó​tǎ, Ài​bó​tǎ
British Columbia 英屬哥倫比亞 Yīngshǔ Gēlúnbǐyà
Manitoba 馬尼托巴 Mànnítuōbā
New Brunswick 新不倫瑞克 Xīn Bùlúnzīwéikè
Newfoundland 紐芬蘭與拉布拉多 Niǔfēnlándǎo
Northwest Territories 西北領地 Xīběilíngdì
Nova Scotia 新斯科舍 Xīn Sīkèshè
Ontario 安大略省 Āndàlüè
Prince Eduard Island 愛德華島 Àidéhuádǎo
Quebec 魁北克 Kuíběkè
Saskatchewan 薩克其萬, 萨斯喀彻温 Sàkèqíwàn, Sàsīkāchèwēn
Yukon 育空 Yùkōng

12.6 Appendix 6: Common Chinese Names

🛈︎
Note

Wikipedia has a nice page about Chinese names, more complete than this short list. Take a look here: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/List_of_common_Chinese_surnames#Mainland_China,_Hong_Kong,_Macau,_and_Taiwan

Table 12.6.1 Surnames
Huáng Zhōu Liú
Wáng Jiāng Chén
Zhāng Jiǎng Yáng
Gaō Sīmǎ 司馬
Zhào Lín Oūyáng 歐陽
Máo Sūn
Táng Sòng
Fāng Liáng
Qián Zēng
Table 12.6.2 Given names (male)
Dálǐ 達禮 Yǒngpíng 永平 Shàowén 紹文
Mínglǐ 明理 Zìqiáng 自強 Shìyīng 世英
Dànián 大年 Jié Tíngfēng 廷峯
Shìmín 世民 Zhīyuǎn 知遠 Chéng
Huá Guóquán 國權 Zhènhàn 振漢
Déxián 德賢
Table 12.6.3 Given names (female)
Juān Huìwén 蕙文 Mínzhēn 敏貞
Lìróng 麗容 Défēn 德芬 Huìrán 蕙然
Wǎnrú 婉如 Bīngyíng 冰瑩
Xiùfèng 秀風 Yùzhēn 玉珍 Zǐyàn 紫燕
Qiǎoyún 巧雲 Měilì 美麗

12.7 Appendix 7: Chinese Provinces

Pinyin spelling Chinese spelling Map spelling
Ānhui 安徽 Anhwei
Fújiàn 福建 Fukien
Gānsù 甘肅 Kansu
Guǎngdōng 廣東 Kvangtung
Guànzhōu 官洲島 Kvangsi
Guǐzhōu 貴州 Kveìchou
Hébuǐ/Héběi 河北 Hopeh
Hēilóngjiāng 黑龍江 Heilungkiang
Hénán 河南 Honan
Húběi 湖北 Hupeh
Húnán 湖南 Hunan
Jiāngsū 江蘇 Kiangsu
Jiāngxī 江西 Kiangsi
Jílín 吉林 Kirin
Liáoníng 遼寧 Liaoning
Nèiměnggǔ 內蒙古 Inner Mongolia
Níngxià 寧夏 Ninghai
Qīnghǎi 青海 Tsinghai
Shāndōng 山東 Shantung
Shānxī 山西 Shansi
Shǎnxī 陝西 Shensi
Sìchuān 四川 Szechuan
Táiwān 臺灣 Taiwan
Xīnjiāng 新疆 Xinjiang
Xīzàng 西藏 Tibet
Yúnnán 雲南 Yunnan
Zhèjiāng 浙江 Chekiang

12.8 Appendix 8: Chinese Cities

Pinyin spelling Chinese spelling Map spelling
Běijīng 北京 Peking
Chángshā 長沙 Chʽang-sha
Chéngdū 成都 Chʽeng-tu
Dàtóng 大同 Ta-tʽung
Gāoxióng 高雄 Kao-hsiung
Guǎngzhōu 廣州 Canton
Hángzhōu 杭州 Hang-chou
Hánkǒu 漢口 Han-kʽou
Hǎinán 海南 Huai-nan
Jīlóng 基隆 Chi-lung
Kāifēng 開封 Kʽai-feng
Nánchāng 南昌 Nan-chʽang
Nánjīng 南京 Nanking
Qīngdǎo 青島 Tsingtao
Shànghǎi 上海 Shanghai
Táiběi 臺北 Taipei
Táidōng 臺東 Tʽai-tung
Táinán 臺南 Tʽai-nan
Táizhōng 臺中 Tʽai-chung
Tiānjīn 天津 Tientsin
Wúchāng 武昌 Wu-chʽang
Wǔhàn 武漢 Wu-han
Xiān 西安 Sian

Chapter 2. Module 2: Biographic Information

The Biographic Information Module provides you with linguistic and cultural skills needed for a simple conversation typical of a first-meeting situation in China. These skills include those needed at the beginning of a conversation (greetings, introductions, and forms of address), in the middle of a conversation (understanding and answering questions about your­self and your immediate family), and at the end of a conversation (leave-taking).

Before starting this module, you must take and pass the ORN Criterion Test. The resource modules Pronunciation and Romanization and Numbers (tapes 1-4) are also prerequisites to the BIO Module.

The Criterion Test will focus largely on this module, but material from Module 1 and associated resource modules may also be included.

1 Objectives

Upon successful completion of the module, the student should be able to:

  1. Pronounce correctly any word from the Target Lists of ORN or BIO, properly distinguishing sounds and tones, using the proper stress and neutral tones, and making the necessary tone changes.

  2. Pronounce correctly any sentence from the BIO Target Lists, with proper pauses and intonation, that is, without obscuring the tones with English intonation.

  3. Use polite formulas in asking and answering questions about identity (name), health, age, and other basic information.

  4. Reply to questions with the Chinese equivalents of "yes" and "no"

  5. Ask and answer questions about families, including who the members are, how old they are, and where they are.

  6. Ask and answer questions about a stay in China, including the date of arrival, location-purpose-duration of stay, previous visits, traveling companions, and date of departure.

  7. Ask and answer questions about work or study, identification of occupation, the location, and the duration.

  8. Give the English equivalent for any Chinese sentence in the BIO Target Lists.

  9. Be able to say any Chinese sentence in the BIO Target Lists when cued with its English equivalent.

  10. Take part in a short Chinese conversation, using expressions included in the BIO Target List sentences.

2 Tapes for BIO and associated modules

Biographic information (BIO)

Unit 1: 1 C-l 1 P-l 1&2 D-l 1 C-2 1 P-2
Unit 2: 2 C-l 2 P-l 2 C-2 2 P-2
Unit 3: 3 C-l 3 P-l 3&4 D-l 3 C-2 3 P-2
Unit 4: 4 C-l 4 P-l 4 C-2 4 P-2
Unit 5: 5 C-l 5 P-l 5&6 D-l 5 C-2 5 P-2
Unit 6: 6 C-l 6 P-l 6 C-2 6 P-2
Unit 7: 7 C-l 7 P-l 7&8 D-l 7C-2 7 P-2
Unit 8: 8 C-l 8 P-l 8 C-2 8 P-2

Units 1-4 R-1

Units 5-8 R-1

Classroom Expressions (CE)

CE 2

Time and Dates (T&D)

T&D 1 T&D 2

3 Unit 1 Target List

1. Qīnwèn, nǐ zhù zai nǎr? 请问,你住在那儿? May I ask, where are you staying?
Wǒ zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn. 我住在北京饭店 I'm staying at the Běijīng Hotel.
2. Nǐ zhù zai něige fàndiàn? 你住在哪个饭店? Which hotel are you staying at?
Wǒ zhù zai nèige fàndiàn. 我住在那个饭店。 I'm staying at that hotel.
3. Nǐ zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn ma? 你住在这个饭店吗? Are you staying at this hotel?
Bù, wǒ bú zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn. 不,我不住在这个饭店。 No, I'm not staying at this hotel.
4. Nǐ zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn? 你住在民族饭店? Are you staying at the Nationalities Hotel?
Bù, wǒ bú zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn. 不,我不住在民族饭店。 No, I'm not staying at the Nationalities Hotel.
5. Něiwèi shi Gāo Tóngzhì? 哪位是高同志? Which one is Comrade Gāo
Nèiwèi shi Gāo Tóngzhì. 那位是高同志 That one is Comrade Gāo.
6. Zǎo. Nuòwǎkè nǚshì! Nín hǎo. 早。 诺瓦克女士!您好 Good morning. Miss Nowak! How are you?
Wǒ hěn hǎo. 我很好 I'm very well.
7. Qīnwèn, nǐ shi Měiguó nǎrde rén? 请问,你是美国哪儿个人 Where are you from in America?
Wǒ shi Jiāzhōu Jiǔjīnshān rén. 我是加州旧金山人 I'm from San Francisco, California.

4 Unit 2 Target List

1. Nǐ péngyou jiā zài náli? 你朋友家在哪里? Where is your friend's house?
Tā jiā zài Dàlǐ Jiē. 他家在大理街。 His house is on Dàlǐ street.
2. Nǐ péngyoude dìzhǐ shi ...? 你朋友的地址是……? What is your friend's address?
Tāde dìzhǐ shi Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièr hào. 他的地址是大理街四十二号。 His address is No. 42 Dàlǐ Street.
3. Nǐ shi Wèi Shàoxiào ba? 你是魏少校把? You are Major Weiss, aren't you?
Shìde. 是的。 Yes.
4. Nà shi Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ba? 那是国宾大饭店吧? That is Ambassador Hotel, isn't it?
Shìde, nà shi Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn. 是的,那是国宾大饭店。 Yes, that's the Ambassador Hotel.
Nǐ zhù zai nàli ma? 你住在那里吗? Are you staying there?
Bù, wǒ zhù zai zhèli. 不,我住在这里 No, I'm staying here.
5. Nǐ péngyou zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma? 你朋友在台北工作吗? Does your friend work in Taipei?
Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò; tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò. 他不在台北工作;他在台中工作。 He doesn't work in Taipei; he works in Taichung.
6. Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? 你在哪里工作? Where do you work?
Wǒ zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò. 我在武官处工作。 I work at the defense attache's office.
Wǒ zài yínháng gōngzuò. 我在银行工作。 I work at a bank.

5 Unit 3 Target List

1. Nǐmen yǒu háizi ma? 你们有孩子 Do you have children?
Yǒu, wǒmen yǒu. 有,我们有。 Yes, we have.
2. Liú Xiānsheng méiyou Měiguó péngyou. 刘先生没有美国朋友。 Mr. Liú doesn't have any American friends.
3. Nǐmen yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi? 你们有几个男孩子,几个女孩子? How many boys and how many girls do you have?
Wómen yǒu liǎnge nánhaizi, yíge nǚháizi. 我们有两个男孩子,一个女孩子。 We have two boys and one girl.
4. Hú Xiānsheng, Hú tàitai yǒu jǐge háizi? 胡先生,胡太太有几个孩子? How many children do Mr. and Mrs. have?
Tāmen yǒu liǎngge háizi. 他们有两个孩子。 They have two children.
Shi nánháizi, shi nǚháizi? 是男孩子,是女孩子? Are they boys or girls?
Dōu shi nǚháizi. 都是女孩子。 Both of them are girls.
5. Nǐmen háizi dōu zài zhèli ma? 你们孩子都在这里吗? Are all your children here?
Bù. Liǎngge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Měiguó. 不,两个在这里,一个还在美国。 No. Two are here, and one is still in America.
6. Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are in your family?
Yǒu wǒ tàitai gēn sānge háizi. 有我太太跟三个孩子。 There's my wife and two children.
7. Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are in your family?
Jiù yǒu wǒ fùqin, mǔqin. 就有我父亲,母亲。 Just my father and mother.

6 Unit 4 Target List

1. Tā míngtiān lái ma? 他明天来吗? Is he coming tomorrow?
Tā yǐjīng lái le. 他已经来了。 He has already come.
2. Nǐ péngyou lái le ma? 你朋友来了吗? Has your friend come?
Tā hái méi(you) lái. 她还没来。 She hasn't come yet.
3. Tā shi shénme shíhou dàode? 他是什么时候到的? When did he arrive?
Tā shi zuótiān dàode. 他是昨天到的。 He arrived yesterday.
4. Nǐ shi yíge rén láide ma? 你是一个人来的吗? Did you come alone?
Bú shi, wǒ bú shi yíge rén láide. 不是,我不是一个人来的。 No, I didn't come alone.
5. Nǐ něitiān zǒu? 你哪天走? What day are you leaving?
Wǒ jīntian zǒu. 我今天走。 I'm leaving today.

7 Unit 5 Target List

1. Nǐ shi zài nǎr shēngde? 你是在哪儿生的? Where were you born?
Wǒ shi zài Dézhōu shēngde. 我是在得州生的。 I was born in Texas.
2. Nǐmen xīngqījǐ zǒu? 你们星期几走? What day of the week are you leaving?
Wǒmen Xīngqītiān zǒu. 我们星期天走。 We are leaving on Sunday.
3. Ní shi něinián shēngde? 你是哪年生的? What year were you born?
Wǒ shi yī jiǔ sān jiǔ nián shēngde. 我是一九三九年生的。 I was born in 1939.
4. Nǐ shi jǐyüè jíhào shēngde? 你是几月几号生的? What is your month and day of birth?
Wó shi qīyüè sìhào shēngde. 我是七月四号生的。 I was born on July 4.
5. Nǐ duō dà le? 你多大了? How old are you?
Wǒ sān shí wǔ le. 我三十五了。 I'm 35.
6. Níměn nánháizi dōu jǐsuì le? 你们男孩子都几岁了? How old are your boys?
Yíge jiǔsuì le, yíge liùsuì le. 一个九岁了,一个六岁了。 One is nine and one is six.

8 Unit 6 Target List

1. Nǐ zhù duō jiǔ? 你住多久? How long are you staying?
Wǒ zhù yìnián. 我住一年。 I'm staying one year.
2. Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhù duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住多久? How long is your wife staying in Hong Kong?
Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liǎngtiān. 我想她住两天。 I think she is staying two days.
3. Nǐ xiǎng zài Táiwān zhù duō jiǔ? 你想在台湾住多久? How long are you thinking of staying in Taiwan?
Wǒ xiǎng zhù liùge yuè. 我想住六个月。 I'm thinking of staying six months.
4. Nǐ láile duō jiǔ le? 你来了多久了? How long have you been here?
Wǒ láile liǎngge xīnqī le. 我来了两个星期。 I have been here two weeks.
5. Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhùle duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住了多久? How long did your wife stay in Hong Kong?
Tā zhùle liǎngtiān. 她住了两天。 She stayed two days.
6. Lǐ Tàitai méi lái. 李太太没来。 Mrs. didn't come.
7. Wǒ cóngqián méi láiguo. Wǒ tàitai láiguo. 我从前没来过。我太太来过。 I have never been here before. My wife has been here.

9 Unit 7 Target List

1. A: Nín zài náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài Měiguó Guówùyuàn gōngzuò. 我在美国国务院工作。 I work with the State Department.
2. A: Ní zai náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ shi xuésheng. 我是学生。 I'm student.
3. A: Nǐ lái zuò shénme? 您来做什么? What did you come here to do?
B: Wǒ lái niàn shū. 我来念书。 I came here to study.
4. A: Nǐ niàn shénme? 你念什么? What are you studying?
B: Wǒ xüé Zhōngwén. 我学中文。 I'm studying Chinese.
5. A: Nǐ zài dàxüé niànguo lìshǐ ma? 你在大学念过历史吗? Did you study history in college?
B: Niànguo. 念过。 Yes.
6. A: Nǐmen huì shuō Zhōngwén ma? 你们会说中文吗? Can you speak Chinese?
B: Wǒ tàitai bú huǐ shuō, wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn. 我太太不会说,我会说一点。 My wife can't speak it; I can speak it a little.
7. A: Nǐde Zhōngguo huà hěn hǎo. 你的中国话很好。 Your Chinese is very good.
B: Náli, náli. Wǒ jiù huì shuō yìdiǎn. 哪里,哪里。我就说一点。 Not at all. I can speak only a little.
8. A: Nǐ shi zài náli xüéde Zhōngzén? 你是在哪里学的中文? Where did you study Chinese?
B: Wó shi zài Huáshèngdùn xüéde. 我是在华盛顿学的。 I studied it in Washington.

10 Unit 8 Target List

1. A: Nǐ jīntiān hái yǒu kè ma? 你今天还有课吗? Do you have any more classes today?
B: Méi you kè le. 没有课了。 I don't have any more classes.
2. A: Nǐ cóngqián niàn Yīngwén niànle duō jiǔ? 你从前念英文念了多久? How long did you study English?
B: Wǒ niàn Yīngwén niànle liùniàn. 我念英文念了六年。 I studied English for six years.
3. A: Nǐ niàn Fàwén niànle duō jiǔ le? 你念法文念了多久了? How long have you been studying French?
B: Wǒ niànle yìnián le. 我念了一年了。 I've been studying it for one year.
4. A: Qùnián wǒ hái bú huì xiě Zhōnggui zì. 去年我还不会写中国字。 Last year, I couldn't write Chinese characters.
B: Xiànzài wǒ huì xiě yìdiǎn le. 现在我会写一点了。 Now, I can write a little.
5. A: Nǐ fùqin shi jǖnrén ma? 你父亲是军人吗? Is your father a military man?
B: Shì, tā shi hǎijǖn jǖnguān. 是,他是海军陆军。 Yes, he's a naval officer.
6. A: Wǒ jīntiān bù lái le. 我今天不来了。 I'm not coming today.
B: Wǒ bìng le. 我病了。 I'm sick.
7. A: Jīntiān hǎo le méi you? 今天好了没有? Are you better today?
B: Jīntiān hǎo le. 今天好了。 Today, I'm better.

11 Unit 1

11.1 Introduction

11.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Where people are staying (hotels),

  2. Short answers.

  3. The question word něige, "which."

11.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The drill tape (1D-1).

11.2 References

11.2.1 Reference List

(in Běijīng)

1. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ zhù zai nǎr? 请问,你朱在哪儿? May I ask, where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn. 握住在北京饭店。 I'm staying at the Beijing Hotel.
2. A: Nǐ zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn ma? 你住在民族饭店吗? Are you staying at the Nationalities Hotel?
B: Shì, wǒ zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn. 是,我住在民族饭店吗。 Yes, I'm staying at the Nationalities Hotel.
3. A: Nǐ zhù zai něige fàndiàn? 你住在呢个饭店? Which hotel are you staying at?
B: Wǒ zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn. 我住在北京饭店。 I'm staying ate the Beijing Hotel.
4. A: Něiwèi shì Zhāng tóngzhì? 哪位是张同志? Which one is comrade Zhāng?
B: Tā shì Zhāng tóngzhì. 他是张同志。 She is comrade Zhāng.
5. A: Něige rén shì Méi tóngzhì? 哪个人是梅同志? Which person is comrade Méi?
B: Nèige rén shì Méi tóngzhì. 那个人是梅同志。 That person is comrade Méi.
6. A: Něiwei shì Gāo tóngzhì? 哪位是高同志。 Which one is comrade Gāo?
B: Nèiwèi shì Gāo tóngzhì. 那位是高同志。 That one is comrade Gāo.

7.a

A: Nǐ zhù zai zheìge fàndiàn ma? 你住在这个饭店吗? Are you staying at this hotel?
B: Bù, wǒ bú zhù zai zheìge fàndiàn. 不,我不住在这个饭店。 No, I"m staying at this hotel.
8. A: Jiāng tóngzhì! nín zǎo. 江同志!您早。 Comrade Jiāng! Good morning.
B: Zǎo. Nuòwǎkè Nǔshì! nín hǎo. 早。Nuòwǎkè 女士!您好。 Good morning, Miss Novak! How are you?
A:

Wǒ hěn hǎo.

🛈︎
Tone sandhi

There is a one sandhi shift here for 2 3rd tones in a row to hén hǎo.

我很好 I'm very well.
9. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ shì Měiguo nǎrde rén? 请问,你是美国哪儿人? May I ask, where are you from in America?
B: Wǒ shì Jiāzhōu Jiùjīnshān rén. 我是加州旧金山人。 I'm from San Francisco, California.
a

This exchange occurs on the C-l tape only.

11.2.2 Vocabulary

fàndiàn 饭店 hotel
-ge general counter
hěn very
Jiùjīnshān 旧金山 San Francisco
Mínzú Fàndiàn 民族饭店 Nationalities Hotel
něi- 哪-? which
něige? 哪个 which?
nèige 那个 that
něiwei 哪位 which one (person)
nèiwèi 那位 that one (person)
nǚshì 女士 polite title for a married or unmarried woman) Mrs. ; Lady
shì yes, that's so.
-wèi polite counter for people
zǎo good morning
zhèi- 这- this
zheìge 这个 this
zhèiwèi 这位 this one (person)
zhù to stay, to live

11.2.3 Reference Notes

11.2.3.1 Notes on № 1
1. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ zhù zai nǎr? 请问,你朱在哪儿? May I ask, where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn. 我住在北京饭店。 I'm staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

The verb zhù, "to live," or "to reside," may be used to mean "to stay at" (temporary residence) or "to live in" (permanent residence).

Zhù zài nǎr literally means "live at where." The verb zài, "to be in/at/on," is used here as a preposition "at." It loses its tone in this position in a sentence. (The use of zài as a preposition is treated more fully in Unit 2.)

Fàndiàn has two meanings "restaurant" and "Hotel" (a relatively large hotel with modern facilities).3 Literally, fànguǎnzi means "rice shop."

11.2.3.2 Notes on № 2
2. A: Nǐ zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn ma? 你住在民族饭店吗? Are you staying at the Nationalities Hotel?
B: Shì, wǒ zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn. 是,我住在民族饭店。 Yes, I'm staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

Shì: The usual way to give a short affirmative answer is to repeat the verb used in the question. Some verbs, however, may not be repeated as short answers. Zhù is one such verb. Others not to be used are xìng, "to be surnamed," and jiào, "to be given-named." Many speakers do not repeat the verb zài as a short answer. To give a short "yes" answer to questions containing these verbs, you use shì.

11.2.3.3 Notes on № 3-7
3. A: Nǐ zhù zai něige fàndiàn? 你住在哪个饭店? Which hotel are you staying at?
B: Wǒ zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn. 我住在北京饭店。 I'm staying ate the Beijing Hotel.
4. A: Něiwèi shì Zhāng tóngzhì? 哪位是张同志? Which one is comrade Zhāng?
B: Tā shì Zhāng tóngzhì. 他是张同志。 She is comrade Zhāng.
5. A: Něige rén shì Méi tóngzhì? 哪个人是梅同志? Which person is comrade Méi?
B: Nèige rén shì Méi tóngzhì. 那个人是梅同志。 That person is comrade Méi.
6. A: Něiwei shì Gāo tóngzhì? 哪位是高同志。 Which one is comrade Gāo?
B: Nèiwèi shì Gāo tóngzhì. 那位是高同志。 That one is comrade Gāo.
7. A: Nǐ zhù zai zheìge fàndiàn ma? 你住在这个饭店吗? Are you staying at this hotel?
B: Bù, wǒ bú zhù zai zheìge fàndiàn. 不,我不住在这个饭店。 No, I"m staying at this hotel.

Něige is the question word "which." In the compound něiguó, you found the bound word něi-, which was attached to the noun guó. In the phrase něiguó rén, "which person," the bound word něi- is attached to the general counter -ge. (You will learn more about counters in Unit 3. For now, you nay think of -ge as an ending which turns the bound word něi- into the full word něige.)

Něige rén/něiwèi: To be polite when referring to an adult, you say něiwèi or nèiwèi, using the polite counter for people -wèi rather than the general counter -ge, though -ge is used in many informal situations.

Notice that the noun rén is not used directly after -wèi:

Nèiwèi Měiguó rén shì shéi?
Něiwèi zhù zài Mínzú Fàndiàn.

Compare the specifying words "which?" "that," and "this" with the location words you learned in Unit U of ORN:

Specifying words Location words
něige? (nǎge?) which nǎr where
nèige (nàge) that nàr (nèr) there
zhèige (zhège) this zhèr (zhàr) here

Both question words are in the Low tone, while the other four words are in the Falling tone.

Many people pronounce the words for "which?" "that," and "this" with the usual vowels for "where?" "there," and "here": nǎge? nàge, and zhège.

: A short negative answer is usually formed by plus a repetition of the verb used in the question. When a verb, like zhù (zài), cannot be repeated, is used as a short answer and is followed by a complete answer. Notice that when used by itself is in the Falling ton, but when followed by a Falling tone syllable is in the Rising tone.

Bù, tā xiānzài bú zài zhèr. No, he's not here now.

11.2.3.4 Notes on № 8
8. A: Jiāng tóngzhì! nín zǎo. 江同志!您早。 Comrade Jiang! Good morning.
B: Zǎo. Nuòwǎkè Nǔshì! nín hǎo. 早。Nuòwǎkè 女士!您好。 Good morning, Miss Novak! How are you?

Name as greeting: A greeting may consist simply of a person's name: Wáng tóngzhì! "Comrade Wáng!" The name may also be used with a greeting phrase: Wáng tóngzhì! Nín zǎo. "Comrade Wáng! Good morning." —or, in reverse order, Nín zǎo. Wáng tóngzhì! "Good morning. Comrade Wáng!" The name is pronounced as an independent exclamation acknowledging that person's presence and status. It is not de-emphasized like "Comrade Wáng," in the English sentence 11 Good morning, Comrade Wáng."

Nín zǎo means "good morning" —literally, "you are early." You may also say either nǐ zǎo or simply zǎo.

Nǚshì, "Ms.," is a formal, respectful title for a married or unmarried woman. It is used after a woman's own surname, not her husband's. Traditionally, this title was used for older, educated, and accomplished women.

In the PRC, where people use tóngzhì, "Comrade," in general only foreign women are referred to and addressed as (so-and-so) nǚshì. On Taiwan, however, any woman may be called (so-and-so) nǚshì in a formal context, such as a speech or an invitation.

Nín hǎo: This greeting may be said either with or without a question marker, just as in English we say "How are you?" as a question or "How are you?" as a simple greeting.

Nǐ hǎo ma? How are you?

Nǐ hǎo. How are you.

Also Just as in English, you may respond to the greeting by repeating it rather than giving an answer.

Lǐ tóngzhì! Nín hǎo. Comrade ! How are you.

Nín hǎo. Gāo tóngzhì! How are you. Comrade Gāo!

Literally, hěn means "very." The word often accompanies adjectival verbs (like hǎo, "to be good"), adding little to their meaning. (See also Module 3, Unit 3.)

How to identify yourself: You have now learned several ways to introduce yourself. One simple, direct way is to extend your hand and state your name in Chinese –- for instance, Mǎ Mínglǐ. Here are some other ways:

Wǒ shì Mǎ Mínglǐ. I'm Mǎ Mínglǐ.
Wǒ xìng Mǎ. My surname is .
Wǒ xìng Mǎ, jiào Mǎ Mínglǐ.

My surname is ; I'm called Mǎ Mínglǐ.

Wǒde Zhōngguó míngzi jiào Mǎ Mínglǐ. My Chinese name is Mǎ Mínglǐ.

11.2.3.5 Notes on № 9
9. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ shì Měiguo nǎrde rén? 请问,你是美国哪儿的人? May I ask, where are you from in America?
B: Wǒ shì Jiāzhōu Jiùjīnshān rén. 我是加州旧金山人。 I'm from San Francisco, California.

Order of place names: Notice that Jiāzhōu Jiùjīnshān is literally "California, San Francisco." In Chinese, the larger unit cones before the smaller. Similarly, in the question Nǐ shì Měiguó nǎrde rén? the name of the country comes before the question word nǎr, which is asking for a more detailed location. The larger unit is usually repeated in the answer:

Nǐ shì Shāndōng nǎr -de rén?
Wǒ shì Shāndōng Qīngdǎo rén.

Literally, Jiùjīnshān means "Old Gold Mountain." The Chinese gave this name to San Francisco during the Gold Rush days.

11.3 Drills

11.3.1 Response drill

Respond according to the cue

Table 11.3.1.1 Respond according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她住在哪儿?

Tā zhù zai nǎr?

Where is he/she staying?

北京饭店

Běijīng Fàndiàn

the Běijīng Hotel

他/她住在北京饭店。

Tā zhù zai Běijìng Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

2.

你爱人住在哪儿?

Nǐ àiren zhù zai nǎr?

Where is your spouse staying?

民族饭店

Mínzú Fàndiàn

the Nationalities Hotel

他/她住在民族饭店。

Tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

3.

李同志住在哪儿?

Lǐ Tóngzhì zhù zai nǎr?

Where is comrade staying?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

4.

方同志住在哪儿?

Fāng Tóngzhì zhù zai nǎr?

Where is comrade Fāng staying?

那个饭店

nèige fàndiàn

that hotel

他/她住在那个饭店。

Tā zhù zai nèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at that hotel.

5.

陈同志住在哪儿?

Chén Tóngzhì zhù zai nǎr?

Where is comrade Chén staying?

北京饭店

Běijīng Fàndiàn

the Běijīng Hotel

他/她住在北京饭店。

Ta zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

6.

林同志住在哪儿?

Lín Tóngzhì zhù zai nǎr?

Where is comrade Lín staying?

民族饭店

Mínzú Fàndiàn

the Nationalities Hotel

他/她住在民族饭店。

Tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

7.

黄同志住在哪儿?

Huáng Tóngzhì zhù zai nǎr?

Where is comrade Huáng staying?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

11.3.2 Response drill

Table 11.3.2.1 Give affirmative response to all questions.
Question Answer
1.

高女士住在民族饭店吗?

Gāo Nǚshì zhù zai Mínzú fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Gāo staying at the Nationalities Hotel?

是,她住在民族饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn,

>Yes, she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

2.

张女士住在北京饭店吗?

Zhāng Nǚshì zhù zai Běijìng Fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Zhāng staying at the Beǐjīng Hotel?

是,她住在北京饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn.

Yes, she is staying at the Beǐjīng Hotel.

3.

江女士住在这个饭店吗?

Jiāng Nǚshì zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Jiāng staying at this hotel?

是,她住在这个饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

Yes, she is staying at this hotel.

4.

黄女士住在那个饭店吗?

Huāng Nǚshì zhù zai nèige fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Huāng staying at that hotel?

是,她住在那个饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai nèige fàndiàn.

>Yes, she is staying at that hotel.

5.

王女士住在北京饭店吗?

Wáng Nǚshì zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Wáng staying at the Beǐjīng Hotel?

是,她住在北京饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai Beǐjīng fàndiàn.

Yes, she is staying at the Beǐjīng Hotel.

6.

林女士住在民族饭店吗?

Lín Nǚshì zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Lín staying at the Nationalities Hotel?

是,她住在民族饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn,

Yes, she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

7.

毛女士住在这个饭店吗?

Máo Nǚshì zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn ma?

Is Mrs. Máo staying at this hotel?

是,她住在这个饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

Yes, she is staying at this hotel.

11.3.3 Response drill

Table 11.3.3.1 Give negative response to all questions.
Question Answer
1.

蒋先生住在这个饭店吗?

Jiāng Xiānsheng zhù zai zhège fàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. Jiāng staying at this hotel?

不是,他不住在这个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai zhège fàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at this hotel.

2.

马先生住在那个饭店吗?

Mǎ Xiānsheng zhù zai nàge fàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. staying at that hotel?

不是,他不住在那个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai nàge fàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at that hotel.

3.

李先生住在国宾大饭店吗?

Lǐ Xiānsheng zhù zai Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. staying at the Ambassador Hotel?

不是,他不住在国宾大饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at the Ambassador Hotel.

4.

赵先生住在圆山大饭店吗?

Zhào Xiānsheng zhù zai Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. Zhào staying at the Yuánshān hotel?

不是,他不住在圆山大饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at the Yuánshān hotel.

5.

刘先生住在圆山大饭店吗?

Liú Xiānsheng zhù zai Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. Liú staying at the Yuánshān hotel?

不是,他不住在圆山大饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai Yánshān Dàfàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at the Yuánshān hotel.

6.

唐先生住在那个饭店吗?

Táng Xiānsheng zhù zai nàge fàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. Táng staying at that hotel?

不是,他不住在那个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai nàge fàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at that hotel.

7.

宋先生住在这个饭店吗?

Sòng Xiānsheng zhù zai zhège fàndiàn ma?

Is Mr. Sòng staying at this hotel.

不是,他不住在这个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai zhège fàndiàn.

No, he is not staying at this hotel.

11.3.4 Response drill

Table 11.3.4.1 Give either a negative or an affirmative response, according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

唐同志在在这个饭店吗?

Táng Tóngzhì zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn ma?

Is comrade Táng staying at this hotel?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

是,他/她住在这个饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

Yes, he/she is staying at this hotel.

2.

马同志住在那个饭店吗?

Mǎ Tóngzhì zhù zai nèige fàndiàn ma?

Is comrade staying at that hotel?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

不是,他/她不住在那个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai nèige fàndiàn.

No, he/she is not staying at that hotel.

3.

李同志住在北京饭店吗?

Lǐ Tóngzhì zhù zai Běijīng fàndiàn ma?

Is comrade staying at the Běijīng Hotel?

北京饭店

Běijīng Fàndiàn

Běijīng Hotel

是,他/她住在北京饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn.

Yes, he/she is staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

4.

赵同志住在民族饭店吗?

Zhào Tóngzhì zhù zai Mínzǔ fàndiàn ma?

Is comrade Zhào staying at the Nationalities Hotel?

北京饭店

Běijīng Fàndiàn

Běijīng Hotel

不是,他/她不住在民族饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn.

No, he/she is not staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

5.

刘同志住在这个饭店吗?

Liú Tóngzhì zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn ma?

Is comrade Liú staying at this hotel?

那个饭店

nèige fàndiàn

that hotel

不是,他/她不住在这个饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

No, he/she is not staying at this hotel.

6.

蒋同志住在那个饭店?

Jiāng Tóngzhì zhù zai nèige fàndiàn ma?

Is Comrade Jiāng staying at that hotel?

那个饭店

nèige fàndiàn

that hotel

是,他/她住在那个饭店。

Shì, tā zhù zai nèige fàndiàn.

Yes, he/she is staying at that hotel.

7.

张同志住在北京饭店吗?

Zhāng Tóngzhì zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn ma?

Is Comrade Zhāng staying at the Běijīng Hotel?

民族饭店

Mínzǔ Fàndiàn

Nationalities Hotel

不是,他/她不住在北京饭店。

Bú shi, tā bú zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn.

No, he/she is not staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

11.3.5 Transformation drill

Table 11.3.5.1 Change the less polite form Nèige rén and Zhèige rén to the more polite form Nèiwèi and Zhèiwèi.
Question Answer
1.

那个人是李同志。

Nèige rén shi Lǐ Tóngzhì

That person is comrade .

那位是李同志。

Nèiwèi shi Lǐ Tóngzhì.

That one is comrade .

2.

这个人是方同志。

Zhèige rén shi Fāng Tóngzhì.

This person is comrade Fāng.

这位是方同志。

Zhèiwèi shi Fāng Tóngzhì.

This one is comrade Fāng.

3.

那个人是蒋同志。

Nèige rén shi Jiāng Tóngzhì.

That person is comrade Jiāng.

那位是蒋同志。

Nèiwèi shi Jiāng Tóngzhì.

That one is comrade Jiāng.

4.

这个人是周同志。

Zhèige rén shi Zhōu Tóngzhì.

This person is comrade Zhōu.

这位是周同志。

Zhèiwèi shi Zhōu Tóngzhì.

This one is comrade Zhōu.

5.

那个人是张同志。

Nèige rén shi Zhāng Tóngzhì.

That person is comrade Zhāng.

那位是张同志。

Nèiwèi shi Zhāng Tóngzhì.

That one is comrade Zhāng.

6.

这个人是陈同志。

Zhèige rén shi Chén Tóngzhì.

This person is comrade Chén.

这位是陈同志。

Zhèiwèi shi Chén Tóngzhì.

This one is comrade Chén.

7.

那个人是胡同志。

Nèige rén shi Hú Tóngzhì.

That person is comrade .

那位是胡同志。

Nèiwèi shi Hú Tóngzhì.

That one is comrade .

11.3.6 Response drill

Table 11.3.6.1 Respond to něige fàndiàn? "which hotel according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她住在哪个饭店?

Tā zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is he/she staying at?

民族饭店

Mínzú Fàndiàn

the Nationalities Hotel

他/她住在民族饭店。

Tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

2.

张同志住在哪个饭店?

Zhāng Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Zhāng staying at?

北京饭店

Běijīng fàndiàn

the Běijīng Hotel

他/她住在

Tā zhù zai Běijīng fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

3.

蒋同志住在哪个饭店?

Jiāng Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Jiāng staying at?

哪个饭店

nèige fàndiàn

that hotel

他/她住在

Tā zhù zai nèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at that hotel.

4.

王同志住在哪个饭店?

Wáng Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Wáng staying at?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

5.

黄同志住在哪个饭店?

Huáng Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Huáng staying at?

民族饭店

Mínzú Fàndiàn

the Nationalities Hotel

他/她住在民族饭店。

Tā zhù zai Mínzú fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

6.

林同志住在哪个饭店?

Lín Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Lín staying at?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

7.

刘同志住在哪个饭店?

Liú Tóngzhì zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

Which hotel is comrade Liú staying at?

这个饭店

zhèige fàndiàn

this hotel

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

11.3.7 Response drill

Table 11.3.7.1 Respond to něige rén "which person" with Nèige rén, "that person".
Question Answer
1.

请问,哪个人是王德贤?

Qǐnwèn, něige rén shi Wáng Déxián?

May I ask, which person is Wáng Déxián?

那个人是王德贤。

Nèige rén shi Wáng Déxián.

That person is Wáng Déxián.

2.

请问,哪个人是赵世民?

Qǐngwèn, něige rén shi Zhào Shìmín?

May I ask, which person is Zhào Shìmín?

那个人是赵世民。

Nèige rén shi Zhào Shìmín.

That person is Zhào Shìmín.

3.

请问,哪个人是林宝兰?

Qǐngwèn. něige rén shi Lín Bǎolán?

May I ask, which person is Lín Bǎolán?

那个人是林宝兰。

Neìge rén shi Lín Bǎolán.

That person is Lín Bǎolán.

4.

请问,哪个人是高廷峰?

Qǐngwèn, něige rén shi Gāo Tíngfēng?

May I ask, which person is Gāo Tíngfēng?

那个人是高廷峰。

Neìge rén shi Gāo Tíngfēng.

That person is Gāo Tíngfēng.

5.

请问,哪个人是张婉如?

Qǐngwèn, něige rén shi Zhāng Wǎnrú?

May I ask, which person is Zhāng Wǎnrú?

那个人是张婉如。

Nèige rén shi Zhāng Wǎnrú.

That person is Zhāng Wǎnrú.

6.

请问,哪个人是胡美玲?

Qǐngwèn, něige rén shi Hú Měilíng?

May I ask, which person is Hú Měilíng?

那个人是胡美玲。

Nèige rén shi Hú Měilíng.

That person is Hú Měilíng.

7.

请问,哪个人是宋知远?

Qǐngwèn, něige rén shi Sòng Zhīyuǎn?

May I ask, which person is Sòng Zhīyuǎn?

那个人是宋知远。

Nèige rén shi Sòng Zhīyuǎn.

That person is Sòng Zhīyuǎn.

11.3.8 Transformation drill

Table 11.3.8.1 Ask the appropriate "which" or "where" question according to the statement.
Statement Question
1.

他/她老家在青岛。

Tā lǎojiā zài Qīngdǎo.

His/her family is from Qīngdǎo.

他/她老家在哪儿?

Tā lǎojiā zài nǎr?

Where is his/her family from?

2.

他/她现在在加拿大。

Tā xiànzài zài Jiānádà.

He /she is in Canada now.

他/她现在在哪儿?

Tā xiànzài zài nǎr?

Where is he/she now?

3.

他/她住在北京饭店。

Tā zhù zai Běijīng Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Běijīng Hotel.

他/她住在哪个饭店?

Tā zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

In which hotel is he/she staying?

4.

他/她现在在山东。

Tā xiànzài zài Shāndōng.

He /she is in Shāndōng now.

他/她现在在哪儿?

Tā xiànzài zài nǎr?

Where is he/she now?

5.

他/她住在民族饭店。

Tā zhù zai Mínzú Fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at the Nationalities Hotel.

他/她住在哪个饭店?

Tā zhù zai něige fàndiàn.

In which hotel is he/she staying?

6.

他/她老家在湖北。

Tā lǎojiā zài Húběi.

His/her family is from Húběi.

他/她老家在那儿?

Tā lǎojiā zài nǎr?

Where is his/her family from?

7.

他/她现在在美国。

Tā xiànzài zài Měiguó.

He/she is in America now.

他/她现在在哪儿?

Tā xiànzài zài nǎr?

Where is he/she now?

8.

他/她住在这个饭店。

Tā zhù zai zhèige fàndiàn.

He/she is staying at this hotel.

他/她住在哪个饭店?

Tā zhù zai něige fàndiàn?

In which hotel is he/she staying?

9.

他/她老家在广东

Tā lǎojiā zài Guǎngdōng.

His/her family is from Guǎngdōng.

他/她老家在那儿?

Tā lǎojiā zài nǎr?

Where is his/her family from?

12 Unit 2

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Where people are staying (houses).

  2. Where people are working.

  3. Addresses.

  4. The marker de.

  5. The marker ba.

  6. The prepositional verb zài.

12.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes9 the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The 2D-1 tape.

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn. 我住在国宾大饭店。 I'm staying at the Ambassador Hotel.
2. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài zhèli. 我住在这理。 I'm staying here.
A: Tā ne? 他呢? How about him?
B: Tā zhù zài nàli. 他住在那理。 He is staying there.
3. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài péngyou jiā. 我住在朋友家。 I'm staying at a friend's home.
4. A: Nǐ péngyou jiā zài náli? 你朋友家在哪理? Where is your friend's house?
B: Tā jiā zài Dàlǐ Jiē. 他家在大力街。 His house is on Dàlǐ Street.
5. A: Nǐ péngyoude dìzhǐ shì ...? 你朋友的地质是……? What is your friend's address?
B: Tā de dìzhǐ shì jiē Sìshièrhào. 他的地质是大力街四十二号。 His address is № 42 Dàlǐ Street.
6.a A: Nǐ shì Wèi Shàoxiào ba? 你是魏少校吧? You are Major Weiss, aren't you?
B: Shìde. 是的。 Yes.
7.b A: Nà shì Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ba? 那是国宾大饭店吧? That is Ambassador Hotel, isn't it?
B: Shìde. 是的。 Yes.
8. A: Nǐ péngyou xiànzài zài náli gōngzuò? 你朋友现在在哪里工作? Where does your friend work now?
B: Tā zài Táinán gōngzuò. 他在台南工作。 He works in Táinán.
9.c A: Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? 你在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò. 我在武官处工作。 I work at the Defense Attache's Office.
10.d A: Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? 你在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài yínháng gōngzuò. 我在银行工作。 I work at a bank.
11.e A: Nǐ péngyou zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma? 你朋友在台北工作吗? Does your friend work in Taipei?
B: Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò. Tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò. 他不在台北工作。他在台中工作。 He doesn't work in Taipei; he works in Taichung.
a

This exchange occurs on the C-1 tape only

b

This exchange occurs on the P-1 tape only

c

This exchange occurs on the C-1 tape only

d

This exchange occurs on the P-1 tape only

e

This exchange occurs on the C-1 tape only

12.2.2 Vocabulary

ba question marker expressing supposition of what answer will be
dàfàndiàn 大饭店 hotel
-de possessive marker
dìzhǐ 地址 address
gōngzuò 工作 to work
Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn 国宾大饭店 Ambassador Hotel
-hào —号 number (in address)
jiā home, house
jiē street
road
nà- 那— that
nàge 那个 that (one)
náli 哪里 where
nàli 那里 there
péngyou 朋友 friend
shàoxiào 少校 major (military title)
Shìde 是的 Yes, that's so.
Wǔguānchù 武官处 defense attache office
yínháng 银行 bank
zài to be in/at/on (prepositional verb)
zhè- this
zhège 这个 this (one)
zhèli 这里 here
Dìyī Dàfàndiàn 第一大饭店 First Hotel
Měiguó Guójì Jiāoliú Zǒngshǔ 美国国际通信高 U.S. International Communications Agency
Měiguó Yínháng 美国银行 Bank of America
Táiwān Yínháng 台湾银行 Bank of Taiwan
Yóuzhèngjǘ 邮政高 post office

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №1-2
1. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn. 我住在国宾大饭店。 I'm staying at the Ambassador Hotel.
2. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài zhèli. 我住在这理。 I'm staying here.
A: Tā ne? 他呢? How about him?
B: Tā zhù zài nàli. 他住在那理。 He is staying there.

The word guóbǐn actually refers to any official state guest, not just an ambassador. (The word for "ambassador" is dàshǐ) The translation "Ambassador Hotel" has been used for years by that hotel and, although inaccurate, has been retained in this text.

Dàfàndiàn means "great hotel" or "grand hotel." It is commonly used in the names of Taiwan and Hong Kong hotels.

Náli, nàli, and zhèli are common variants of nǎr, nàr, and zhèr in non-Peking dialects of Standard Chinese. The forms with r are Peking dialect forms.

Compare:

Peking Other
nǎr náli where
nàr nàli there
zhèr zhèli here
Notice the difference in tone "between nǎr and náli. This is because -li has a basic Low tone, and the first of two adjoining Low-tone syllables changes to a Rising tone: + - = náli.

12.2.3.2 Notes on №3-4
3. A: Nǐ zhù zài náli? 你住在哪理? Where are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù zài péngyou jiā. 我住在朋友家。 I'm staying at a friend's home.
4. A: Nǐ péngyou jiā zài náli? 你朋友家在哪理? Where is your friend's house?
B: Tā jiā zài Dàlǐ Jiē. 他家在大力街。 His house is on Dàlǐ Street.

The possessive relationships in péngyou jiā, "friend's house," nǐ péngyou jiā, "your friend’s house," and tā jiā, "his house," are unmarked, while the English must include -'s or the possessive form of the pronoun ("your," "his".) In Chinese, possessive relationships may be expressed by simply putting the possessor in front of the possessed when the relationship between the two is particularly close, like the relationship between a person and his home, family, or friends.

12.2.3.3 Notes on №5
5. A: Nǐ péngyoude dìzhǐ shì ...? 你朋友的地质是……? What is your friend's address?
B: Tā de dìzhǐ shì jiē Sìshièrhào. 他的地质是大力街四十二号。 His address is № 42 Dàlǐ street.

Péngyoude dìzhǐ: "The marker -de in this phrase is Just like the English possessive ending -'s. With the exception of close relationships, this is the usual way to form the possessive in Chinese.

nǐ péngyǒu -de dìzhǐ
your friend 's address
Unlike the English -'s ending, -de is also added to pronouns.
wǒde my
nǐde your
tāde his/her
You are learning possessive phrases in which the marker -de is used (tāde dìzhǐ) and some possessive phrases which do not contain -de (nǐ péngyou jiā). There are certain reasons for the inclusion or omission of -de. If a close relationship exists between the possessor and the possessed, the marker -de might not be used. If a phrase is long and complex, as Lǐ Xiānsheng péngyoude tàitai , the marker -de is used to separate the possessor from the possessed.
short or simple long or complex
jiā Hú Měilíng -de lǎojiā
péngyou nǐ péngyou -de dìzhǐ
Lǐ Xiānsheng péngyou -de tàitai

But these are not hard and fast rules. The use or omission of -de is not determined solely by the number of syllables in a phrase or by the closeness between the possessor and the possessed, although both of these considerations do play a big part in the decision.

While some common nouns are usually used without -de "before them, most nouns are more likely to be preceded by -de, and many even require it. Dìzhǐ, "address," is the only noun you have learned which REQUIRES the possessive marker -de added to the possessor. But other nouns such as jiā are not always preceded by -de. This is also the case with nouns indicating personal relationships, like fùmǔ, "father," and tàitai "wife." Péngyou, "friend,"xuésheng," student and lǎoshī "student are commonly used without -de, but may also be used with the marker.

You might expect the question Nǐ péngyoude dìzhǐ...? to "be completed with a word such as shénme?, what. However, the incomplete form given in this exchange, with the voice trailing off, inviting completion, is also commonly used.

Addresses: The order in which addresses are given in Chinese is the reverse of that used in English. In Chinese, the order is from the general to the specific: country, province or state, city, street name, street number.

-hào: A street number is always given with the bound word -hào, "number," after it. 4

12.2.3.4 Notes on №6-7
6. A: Nǐ shì Wèi Shàoxiào ba? 你是魏少校吧? You are Major Weiss, aren't you?
B: Shìde. 是的。 Yes.
7. A: Nà shì Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ba? 那是国宾大饭店吧? That is Ambassador Hotel, isn't it?
B: Shìde. 是的。 Yes.

Ba is a marker for a question which expresses the speaker's supposition as to what the answer will be. It is the type of question which asks for a confirmation from the listener.

There are three ways to translate the two questions in exchanges 6 and 7 into English:

Nǐ shi Wèi Shàoxiào ba?

Aren't you Major Weiss?

You are Major Weiss, aren't you?

You must be Major Weiss.

Nà shi Guóbǐn Dàfàndiàn ba?

Isn't that the Ambassador Hotel?

That is the Ambassador Hotel, isn't it?

That must be the Ambassador Hotel.

Each translation reflects a different degree of certainty on the part of the speaker. (While the differences in certainty are expressed in English by variation in wording, they can be expressed in Chinese by intonation.) You will probably find that the "isn’t it", "aren't you" translation fits most situations.

The short answer shìde is an expanded form of the short answer shì, with the same meaning: "Yes, that's so." Shìde is also the word used for the "yes" in the military "Yes, sir."

(nèi): In the subject position, (nèi), "that," and zhè (zhèi), "this," may be used either as free words or as bound words, with -ge following.

Compare:

shì Guóbǐn Dàfàndiàn.
That is the Ambassador Hotel.
-ge shì Guóbǐn Dàfàndiàn.
That one is the Ambassador Hotel.
However, the question form - (něi-) is a bound word.
Nǎge (fàndiàn) shì Guóbǐn Dàfàndiàn? Which one is the Ambassador Hotel?

12.2.3.5 Notes on №8-11
8. A: Nǐ péngyou xiànzài zài náli gōngzuò? 你朋友现在在哪里工作? Where does your friend work now?
B: Tā zài Táinán gōngzuò. 他在台南工作。 He works in Táinán.
9. A: Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? 你在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò. 我在武官处工作。 I work at the Defense Attache's Office.
10. A: Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? 你在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài yínháng gōngzuò. 我在银行工作。 I work at a bank.
11. A: Nǐ péngyou zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma? 你朋友在台北工作吗? Does your friend work in Taipei?
B: Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò. Tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò. 他不在台北工作。他在台中工作。 He doesn't work in Taipei; he works in Taichung.

Wǔguānchù, "defense attache’s office," literally means "military attache's office."

Zài gōngzuò: Compare these two sentences:

zài Táinán.
He is in Tainan.
zài Táinán gōngzuò.
He in Tainan works.

The sentence Tā zài Táinán gōngzuò seems to have two verbs: zài, "to be in/at/on," and gōngzuò," to work." But there is only one verb in the translation: "He works in Tainan." The translation reflects the fact that zài loses its full verb status in this sentence and plays a role like that of the English preposition "in" The zài phrase in Chinese, like the "in" phrase in English, gives more information about the main verb gōngzuò; that is, it tells where the action takes place. "He works," and the work takes place "in Tainan." In sentences like this, the word zài is a prepositional verb. Most relationships expressed by prepositions in English are expressed by prepositional verbs in Chinese.

You have also seen zài used as a prepositional verb in the sentence nǐ zhù zài náli? "Where do you live?" —literally, "You live at where?" Notice that in this sentence the prepositional verb phrase zài náli comes after the main verb zhù. In the sentence Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? the prepositional verb phrase zài náli conies before the main verb gōngzuò. Many things, such as stress, contrast, and other objects in the sentence, can influence the order of the prepositional verb phrase and the main verb.

In some cases, either order may be used, as in Nǐ zài náli zhù? or Nǐ zhù zài náli?. In other cases, the word order is fixed, as in Nǐ zài náli gōngzuò? For text examples, it will be pointed out whether or not the word order may be changed, and the reasons will be given.

Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò, "He doesn't work in Taipei": In this sentence, the negative adverb comes before the prepositional verb zài (which starts the complete predicate zài Táiběi gōngzuò, not before the main verb gōngzuò. This makes sense, for you are not saying "He does NOT WORK," but you are saying "He does NOT work IN TAIPEI."

gōngzuò.
gōngzuò.
zài Táiběi gōngzuò.
zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

12.3 Drills

12.3.1 Response drill

Table 12.3.1.1 Answer according to the cue
Question Cue Answer
1.

李先生住在那里?

Lǐ Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. staying?

国宾大饭店

Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn

Ambassador Hotel

他住在国宾大饭店。

Tā zhù zai Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn.

He is staying at the Ambassador Hotel.

2.

高先生住在那里?

Gāo Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. Gāo staying?

圆山大饭店

Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn

Yuánshān hotel

他住在圆山大饭店。

Tā zhù zai Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn.

He is staying at the Yuánshān hotel.

3.

杨先生住在哪里?

Yáng Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. Yáng staying?

第一大饭店

Dìyī Dàfàndiàn

Grand Hotel

他住在第一大饭店。

Ta zhù zai Dìyī Dàfàndiàn.

He is staying at the Grand Hotel.

4.

唐先生住在哪里?

Táng Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. Táng staying?

这里

zhèli

here

他住在这里。

tā zhù zài zhèli.

He is staying here.

5.

司马先生住在哪里?

Sǐmǎ Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. Sǐmǎ staying?

那里

nàli

there

他住在那里?

Tā zhù zai nàli.

He is staying there.

6.

王住在哪里?

Wáng Xiānsheng zhù zai náli?

Where is Mr. Wáng staying?

第一大饭店

Dìyī Dàfàndiàn

Grand Hotel

他住在第一大饭店。

Tā zhù zai Dìyī Dàfàndiàn.

He is staying at the Grand Hotel.

12.3.2 Response drill

Table 12.3.2.1 Answer according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他朋友家在那里?

Tā péngyou jiā zài náli?

Where is your friend's house?

博愛路

Bóài Lù

Bóài road

他家在博愛路。

Tā jiā zài Bóài Lù.

Hi/her house is on Bóài road.

2.

李先生家在那里?

Lǐ Xiānsheng jiā zài náli?

Where is Mr. house?

敦化路

Dūnhuà Lù

Dūnhuà road

他家在敦化路。

Tā jiā zài Dūnhuà Lù

His house is on Dūnhuà road.

3.

王先生家在那里?

Wáng Xiānsheng jiā zài náli?

Where is Mr. Wáng's house?

农安街

Nóngān Jiē

Nóngān street

他家在農安街。

Tā jiā zài Nóngān Jiē.

His house is on Nóngān street.

4.

胡先生家在那里?

Hú Xiānsheng jiā zài náli?

Where is Mr. 's house?

南京路

Nánjīng Lù

Nánjīng road

他家在南京路。

Tā jiā zài Nánjīng Lù

His house is on Nánjīng road.

5.

马先生家在那里?

Mǎ Xiānsheng jiā zài náli?

Where is Mr. 's house?

中山路

Zhōngshān Lù

Zhōngshān road

他家在中山路。

Tā jiā zài Zhōngshān.

His house is on Zhōngshān road.

6.

林先生家在那里?

Lín Xiānsheng jiā zài náli?

Where is Mr. Lín's house?

浙江街

Zhèjiāng Jiē

Zhèjiāng street

他家在浙江街。

Tā jiā zài Zhèjiāng Jiē.

His house is on Zhèjiāng street.

12.3.3 Response drill

Table 12.3.3.1 According to each cue, respond with the appropriate street number on dàlǐ Jiē
Question Cue Answer
1.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

四十二号

42 hào

number 42

他/她的地质是大理解四十二号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

His/her address is number 42 dàlǐ street.

2.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

十四号

40 hào

number 40

他/她的地质是大理解十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Sìshihào.

His/her address is number 40 dàlǐ street.

3.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

九十五号

95 hào

number 95

他/她的地质是大理解九十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Jiǔshiwǔhào.

His/her address is number 95 dàlǐ street.

4.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

二十六号

26 hào

number 26

他/她的地质是大理解二十六号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Èrshiliùhào.

His/her address is number 26 dàlǐ street.

4.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

七十七号

77 hào

number 77

他/她的地质是大理解七十七号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Qīshiqīhào.

His/her address is number 77 dàlǐ street.

6.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

六十八号

68 hào

number 68

他/她的地质是大理解六十八号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Liùshibáhào.

His/her address is number 68 dàlǐ street.

7.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi ...?

What is your friend's address?

四十四号

44 hào

number 44

他/她的地质是大理解四十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi dàlǐ Jiē Sìshisìhào.

His/her address is number 44 dàlǐ street.

12.3.4 Response drill

Table 12.3.4.1 Give the appropriate Táiwān street addresses according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

大理解十四三号

Dàlǐ Jiē 43 hào

43 dàlǐ street

他/她的地质是大理解十四三号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

His/her address is number 43

dàlǐ street.

2.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

博愛路九十四号

Bóài Lù 94 hào

94 Bóài road

他/她的地质是博愛路九十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Bóài Lù Jiǔshisìhào.

His/her address is number 95 Bóài road.

3.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

敦化路五十五好

Dūnhuà Lù 55 hào

55 Dūnhuà road

他/她的地质是敦化路五十五好。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dūnhuà Lù Wǔshiwǔhào.

His/her address is number 55 Dūnhuà road.

4.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

農安街七十五号

Nóngān Jiē 75 hào

75 Nóngān street

他/她的地质是農安街七十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Qīshiwǔhào.

His/her address is number 75 Nóngān street.

5.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

大理解四十二号

Dàlǐ Jiē 42 hào

42 dàlǐ street

他/她的地质是大理解四十二号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

His/her address is number 42 dàlǐ street.

6.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyou de dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

敦化路五十五号

Dūnhuà Lù 55 hào

55 Dūnhuà road

他/她的地质是敦化路五十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dūnhuà Lù Wǔshiwǔhào.

His/her address is number 55 Dūnhuà road.

7.

你朋友的地质是……?

Nǐ péngyoud e dìzhǐ shi...?

What is your friend's address?

博愛路九十四号

Bóài Lù 94 hào

94 Bóài road

他/她的地质是博愛路九十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Bóài Lù Jiǔshisìhào.

His/her address is number 94 Bóài road.

12.3.5 Transformation drill

Table 12.3.5.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

马太太家在大理解四十二号。

Mǎ Tàitai jiā zài Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

's house is at N°42 Dàlǐ street.

她的地质是大理解四十二号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

Her address is N°42 Dàlǐ street.

2.

赵太太家在博愛路九十四号。

Zhào Tàitai jiā zài Bóài Lù Jiǔshisìhào.

Mrs. Zhào's house is at N°94 Bóài road.

她的地质是博愛路九十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Bóài Lú Jiǔshisìhào.

Her address is N°94 Bóài road.

3.

李太太家在敦化路五十五号。

Lǐ Tàitai jiā zài Dūnhuà Lù Wíshiwǔhào.

Mrs. 's house is at Dūnhuà road.

她的地质是敦化路五十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dūnhuà Lù Wǔshiwǔhào.

Her address is N°55 Dūnhuà road.

4.

胡太太家在農安街七十五号

Hú Tàitai jiā zài Nóngān Jiē Qīshiwǔhào.

Mrs. 's house is at N°75 Nóngān street.

她的地质是農安街七十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Nóngān Jiē Qīshiwǔhào.

Her address is N°75 Nóngān street.

5.

高太太家在大理解四十二号。

Gāo Tàitai jiā zài Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

Mrs. Gāo's house is at N°42 Dàlǐ street.

她的地质是大理解四十二号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dàlǐ Jiē Sìshièrhào.

Her address is N°42 Dàlǐ street.

6.

王太太家在博愛路九十四号。

Wáng Tàitai jiā zài Bóài Lù Jiǔshisìhào.

Mrs. Wáng's house is at N°94 Bóài road.

她的地质是博愛路九十四号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Bóài Lú Jiǔshisìhào.

Her address is N°94 Bóài road.

7.

林太太家在敦化路五十五号。

Lín Tàitai jiā zài Dūnhuà Lù Wúshiwǔhào.

Mrs. Lín's house is at N°55 Dūnhuà road

她的地质是敦化路五十五号。

Tā de dìzhǐ shi Dūnhuà Lù Wúshiwǔhào.

Her address is N°55 Dūnhuà road.

12.3.6 Transformation drill

Table 12.3.6.1 Change each ma? question to a ba? question.
Statement Answer
1.

您是魏少校吗?

Nín shì Wèi shàoxiào ma?

Are you Major Weiss?

您是卫

Nín shì Wèi shàoxiào ba?

You are Major Weiss, aren't you?

2.

他是张少校吗?

Tā shì Zhāng shàoxiào ma?

Is he Major Zhāng?

他是张少校把?

Tā shì Zhāng shàoxiào ba?

He is Major Zhāng, isn't he?

3.

您是黄小姐吗?

Nín shì Huáng xiǎojiě ma?

Are you Miss Huáng?

您是黄小姐把?

Nín shì Zhāng xiǎojiě ba?

You are Miss Huáng, aren't you?

4.

那是国宾大饭店吗?

Nà shì Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ma?

Is that the Nationalities Hotel?

那是国宾大饭店把?

Nà shì Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn ba?

That is the Nationalities Hotel, isn't it?

5.

这是第一大饭店吗?

Zhè shì Dìyī dàfàndiàn ma?

Is this the Grand Hotel?

这是第一大饭店把?

Zhè shì Dìyī dàfàndiàn ba?

This is the Grand Hotel, isn't it?

6.

那位是王太太吗?

Nàwèi shì Wáng tàitai ma?

Is that person Mrs. Wáng?

那位是王太太把。

Nàwèi shì Wáng tàitai ba?

This person is Mrs. Wáng, isn't it?

7.

那是圆山大饭店吗?

Nà shì Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn ma?

Is that the Yuánshān hotel?

那是圆山大饭店把?

Nà shì Yuánshān Dàfàndiàn ba?

That is the Yuánshān hotel, isn't it?

12.3.7 Response drill

Table 12.3.7.1 Answer according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

台北

Táiběi

Taipei

他/她在台北工作。

Tā zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

He/she works in Taipei.

2.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

台南

Táinán

T'ai-nan

他/她在台南工作。

Tā zài Táinán gōngzuò.

He/she works in T'ai-nan.

3.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

台中

Táizhōng

T'ai-chung

他/她在台中工作。

Tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò.

He/she works in T'ai-chung.

4.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

高雄

Gāoxióng

Kao-hsiung

他/她在高雄工作。

Tā zài Gāoxióng gōngzuò.

He/she works in Kao-hsiung.

5.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

基隆

Jīlóng

Chi-lung

他/她在基隆工作。

Tā zài Jīlóng gōngzuò.

He/she works in Chi-lung.

6.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

台北

Táiběi

Taipei

他/她在台北工作。

Tā zài Táiběi Gōngzuò.

He/she works in Taipei.

7.

他/她在那里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where dos he/she works?

台中

Táizhōng

T'ai-chung

他/她在台中工作。

Tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò.

He/she works in T'ai-chung.

12.3.8 Response drill

Table 12.3.8.1 Answer with a positive answer.
Question Answer
1.

他/她在邮政高工作吗?

Tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work at the post office?

对了,他/她在邮政高工作。

Duì le, tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the post office.

2.

他/她在武官处工作吗?

Tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the military attache's office?

对了,他/她在武官处工作。

Duì le, tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the military attache's office.

3.

他/她在银行工作吗?

Tā zài yínháng gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the bank?

对了,他/她在银行工作。

Duì le, tā zài yínháng gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the bank?

4.

他/她在美国银行工作吗?

Tā zài Měiguó yínháng gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the American bank?

对了,他/她在美国银行工作。

Duì le, tā zài Měiguó yínháng gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the American bank.

5.

他/她在台湾银行工作吗?

Tā zài Táiwān yínháng gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the Táiwān bank?

对了,他/她在台湾银行工作。

Duì le, tā zài Táiwān yínháng gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the Táiwān bank.

6.

他/她在武官处工作吗?

Tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the military attache's office?

对了,他/她在武官处工作。

Duì le, tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the military attache's office.

7.

他/她在邮政高工作吗?

Tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she works at the post office?

对了,他/她在邮政高工作。

Duì le, tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the post office.

12.3.9 Transformation drill

Table 12.3.9.1 Add xiànzài, "now" to each statement.
Statement Answer
1.

周先生在台北工作。

Zhōu xiānsheng zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhōu works in Táiběi.

周先生在现在在台北工作。

Zhōu xiānsheng xiànzài zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhōu is working in Táiběi now.

2.

张先生在台中工作。

Zhāng xiānsheng zài Táizhōng gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhāng works in Táizhōng.

张先生在现在在台中工作。

Zhāng xiānsheng xiànzài zài Táizhōng gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhāng is working in Táizhōng now.

3.

胡小姐在台南工作。

Hú xiǎojiě zài Táinán gōngzuò.

Miss works in Táinán.

胡小姐在现在在台南工作。

Hú xiǎojiě xiànzài zài Táinán gōngzuò.

Miss is working in Táinán now.

4.

马小姐在高雄工作。

Mǎ xiǎojiě zài Gāoxióng gōngzuò.

Miss works in Gāoxióng.

马小姐在现在在高雄工作。

Mǎ xiǎojiě xiànzài zài Gāoxióng gōngzuò.

Miss is working in Gāoxióng now.

5.

赵先生在基隆工作。

Zhào xiānsheng zài Jīlóng gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhāo works in Jīlóng.

赵先生在现在在基隆工作。

Zhào xiānsheng xiànzài zài Jīlóng gōngzuò.

Mr. Zhāo is working in Jīlóng now.

6.

陈先生在台北工作。

Chén xiānsheng zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

Mr. Chén works in Táiběi.

陈先生在现在在台北工作。

Chén xiānsheng xiànzài zài Táiběi gōngzuò.

Mr. Chén is working in Táiběi now.

7.

蒋小姐在高雄工作。

Jiāng xiǎojiě zài Gāoxióng gōngzuò.

Miss Jiāng works in Gāoxióng.

蒋小姐在现在在高雄工作。

Jiāng xiǎojiě xiànzài zài Gāoxióng gōngzuò.

Miss Jiāng is working in Gāoxióng now.

12.3.10 Transformation drill

Table 12.3.10.1 Make each statement negative by changing zài to bú zài.
Statement Answer
1.

胡同志在北京工作。

Hú tōngzhì zài Běijīng gōngzuò.

Comrade works in Běijīng.

胡同志不在北京工作。

Hú tōngzhì bú zài Běijīng gōngzuò.

Comrade doesn't work in Běijīng.

2.

李同志在南京工作。

Lǐ tóngzhì zài Nánjīng gōngzuò.

Comrade works in Nánjīng.

李同志不在南京工作。

Lǐ tóngzhì bú zài Nánjīng gōngzuò.

Comrade doesn't work in Nánjīng.

3.

他/她在青岛工作。

Tā zài Qīngdǎo gōngzuò.

He/she works in Qīngdǎo.

他/她不在青岛工作。

Tā bú zài Qīngdǎo gōngzuò.

He/she doesn't work in Qīngdǎo.

4.

林同志在广州工作。

Lín tóngzhì zài Guǎngzhōu gōngzuò.

Comrade Lín works in Guǎnzhōu.

林同志不在广州工作。

Lín tóngzhì bú zài Guǎngzhōu gōngzuò.

Comrade Lín doesn't work in Guǎnzhōu.

5.

赵同志在上海工作。

Zhào tōngzhì zài Shànghǎi gōngzuò.

Comrade Zhào works in Shànghǎi.

赵同志不在上海工作。

Zhào tōngzhì bú zài Shànghǎi gōngzuò.

Comrade Zhào doesn't work in Shànghǎi.

6.

陈同志在青岛工作。

Chén tóngzhì zài Qīngdǎo gōngzuò.

Comrade Chén works in Qīngdǎo.

陈同志不在青岛工作。

Chén tóngzhì bú zài Qīngdǎo gōngzuò.

Comrade Chén doesn't work in Qīngdǎo.

7.

黄同志在北京工作。

Huáng tóngzhì zài Běijīng gōngzuò.

Comrade Huáng works in Běijīng.

黄同志不在北京工作。

Huáng tóngzhì bú zài Běijīng gōngzuò.

Comrade Huáng doesn't work in Běijīng.

12.3.11 Response drill

Table 12.3.11.1 Give negative responses to the questions, adding correct information according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

胡小姐在台北工作吗?

Hú xiǎojiě zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma?

Does Miss work in Taipei?

台南

Táinán

Tainan

她不在台北工作。她在台南工作。

Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò; tā zài Táinán gōngzuò.

She doesn't work in Taipei; she works in Tainan.

2.

李太太在台中工作吗?

Lǐ tàitai zài Táizhōng gōngzuò ma?

Does Ms work in Táizhōng?

基隆

Jīlóng

Jīlóng

她不在台中工作。 她在基隆工作。

Tā bú zài Táizhōng gōngzuò; tā zài Jīlóng gōngzuò.

She doesn't work in Táizhōng; she works in Jīlóng.

3.

马先生在这里工作吗?

Mǎ xiānsheng zài zhèli gōngzuò ma?

Does Mr. work here?

高雄

Gāoxióng

Gāoxióng

他不在这里工作。 他在高雄工作。

Tā bú zài zhèli gōngzuò; tā zài Gāoxiōng gōngzuò.

He doesn't work here; he works in Gāoxióng.

4.

他/她在武官处工作吗?

Tā zài Wúguānchù gōngzuò ma?

Does he work in the military attaché's office.

台湾银行

Táiwān yínháng

Bank of Taiwan

他/她不在武官处工作。 他/她在台湾银行工作。

Tā bú zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò; tā zài Táiwān yínháng gōngzuò.

He doesn't work in the military attaché's office; he works in the Bank of Taiwan.

5.

林先生在那里工作吗?

Lín xiānsheng zài nàli gōngzuò ma?

Does Mr. Lín work there?

这里

zhèli

here

他不在那里工作。 他在这里工作。

Tā bú zài nàli gōngzuò; tā zài zhèli gōngzuò.

He doesn't work there; he works here.

6.

刘小姐在台北工作吗?

Liú xiǎojiě zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma?

Does Miss Liú work in Taipei?

台中

Táizhōng

Táizhōng

她不在台北工作。她在台中工作。

Tā bú zài Táiběi gōngzuò; tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò.

She doesn't work in Taipei; she works in Táizhōng.

12.3.12 Response drill

Table 12.3.12.1 Give an affirmative or negative response according to each cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她在台北工作吗?

Tā zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work in Taipei?

台北

Táiběi

Taipei

对了,他/她在台北工作。

Duì le, tā zaì Táiběi gōngzuo.

Yes, he/she works in Taipei.

2.

他/她在台北工作吗?

Tā zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work in Taipei?

台南

Táinán

T'ai-nan

他/她不在台北工作。他/她在台南工作。

Tā bú zaì Táiběi gōngzuò; tā zài Táinán gōngzuò.

No, he/she doesn't work in Taipei. he/she works in T'ai-nan.

3.

他/她在台中工作吗?

Tā zài Táizhōng gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work in T'ai-chung.

基隆

Jīlóng

Chi-lung

他/她不在台中工作吗。他/她在基隆工作。

Tā bú zài Táizhōng gōngzuò; tā zài Jīlóng gōngzuò.

No he/she doesn't work in T'ai-chung. He/she works in Chi-lung.

4.

他/她在这里工作吗?

Tā zài zhèli gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work here?

这里

zhèli

here

对了,他/她在这里工作。

Duì le, tā zài zhèli gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works here.

5.

他/她在邮政高工作吗?

Tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work at the post office?

台湾银行

Táiwān yínháng

bank of Taiwan

他/她不在邮政高工作。他/她在台湾银行工作吗。

Tā bú zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuo; tā zài Táiwān yínháng gōngzuò.

He/she doesn't work at the post office. He/she works at the bank of Taiwan.

6.

他/她在武官处工作吗?

Tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work at the defense attache office?

这里

zhèli

here

他/她不在武官处工作。他/她在这里工作。

Tā bú zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò; tā zài zhèli gōngzuò.

No, he/she doesn't work at the defense attache office. He/she works here.

7.

他/她在美国银行工作吗?

Tā zài Měiguó yínháng gōngzuò ma?

Does he/she work at the bank of America?

美国银行

Měiguó yínháng

bank of America

对了,他/她在美国银行工作。

Duì le, tā zài Měiguó yínháng gōngzuò.

Yes, he/she works at the bank of America.

13 Unit 3

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Members of a family.

  2. The plural ending -men.

  3. The question word - "how many."

  4. The adverb dōu "all."

  5. Several ways to express "and."

13.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The 3D-1 tape.

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nǐmen yǒu háizi ma? 你们有孩子吗? Do you have children?
B: Yǒu, wǒmen yǒu. 有,我们有。 Yes, we have.
2. B: Liú xiānsheng yǒu Měiguó péngyou ma? 刘先生有美国朋友吗? Does Mr Liú have any American friends?
B: Tā meíyǒu Měiguó péngyou. 他没有美国朋友。 He doesn't have any American friends.
A: Tā yǒu Yīngguó péngyou. 他有英国朋友。 He has English friends. (or an English friend)
3. A: Nǐmen yǒu jǐge háizi? 你们有几个孩子? How many children do you have?
B: Wǒmen yǒu sānge háizi. 我们有三个孩子。 We have three children.
4. A: Nǐmen yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi? 你们有几个男孩子,几个女孩子? How many boys and how many girls do you have?
B: Wǒmen yǒu liǎngge nánháizi, yīge nǚháizi. 我们有两个男孩子,一个女孩子。 We have two boys and one girl.
5. B: Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi? 是男孩子,是女孩子? Are they boys or girls?
A: Tāmen dōu shì nǚháizi. 他们都是女孩子。 All of them are girls.
6. B: Hú xiānsheng, tàitai ne? tāmen yǒu jǐge háizi? 胡先生,太太呢?他们有几个孩子? How about Mr. and Mrs. ? How many children do they have?
A: Tāmen yǒu liǎngge háizi. 他们有两个孩子。 They have two children.
B: Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi? 是男孩子,是女孩子? Are they boys or girls?
A: Dōu shì nǚháizi. 都是女孩子。 Both of them are girls.
7. A: Nǐmen háizi dōu zài zhèli ma? 你们孩子都在这里吗? Are all your children here?
B: Bù, liǎngge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Měiguó. 不,两个在这里,一个还在美国。 No. Two are here, and one is still in America.
8. A: Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are (there) in your family?
B: Yǒu wǒ tàitai gēn sānge háizi. 有我太太跟三个孩子。 There's my wife and three children.
9. B: Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are (there) in your family?
A: Jiù (yǒu) wǒ fùqin, mǔqin. 就(有)我父亲,母亲。 Just my father and mother.

13.2.2 Vocabulary

zhǐ only
dìdi 弟弟 younger brother
gēge 哥哥 older brother
jiějie 姐姐 older sister
mèimei 妹妹 younger sister
xiōngdì 兄弟 brothers
jiěmèi 姐妹 sisters
xiōngdì jiěmèi 兄弟姐妹 brothers and sisters
fùmǔ 父母 parents
zǔfù 祖父 paternal grandfather
zǔmǔ 祖母 paternal grandmother
wàizǔfù 外祖父 maternal grandfather
wàizǔmǔ 外祖母 maternal grandmother
bàba 爸爸 papa, dad, father
māma 吗吗 momma, mom, mother
dōu all, both
fùqin 父亲 father
gēn and, with, and (in addition to)
hái still, yet
háizi 孩子 children, child
jǐ- 几- how many
jiāli 家里 family
jǐge 几个 how many
jiù only, just
liǎng- two
méi not, not to have
mèiyou 没有 not to have, there is not
-men plural suffix
mǔqin 母亲 mother
nán- 男- male
nánháizi 男孩子 boy
nǐmen 你们 you (plural)
nǚ- 女- female
nǚháizi 女孩子 girl
tāmen 他们 they, them
wǒmen 我们 we, us
yǒu to have, there is
zhǐ only
yíng le 赢了 I('ve) won

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Nǐmen yǒu háizi ma? 你们有孩子吗? Do you have children?
B: Yǒu, wǒmen yǒu. 有,我们有。 Yes, we have.

The plural pronouns are formed by adding -men to the singular pronouns

singular plural
I wǒmen we
you nǐmen you
he/she tāmen they

(You have already seen these pronoun forms used as possessives: "my," "our," etc. Later you will find that they are also used as objects: "me," "us," etc.)

Háizi: Chinese nouns have the same form for singular and plural.

Háizi may be either "child" or "children."5Usually the context will make clear whether a noun should be translated as singular or as plural, but not always. Chinese does not require that the matter be pinned down to the same extent that English does.

Wǒmen yǒu háizi is a perfectly good sentence, even though the only accurate translation is the clumsy "We have one or more children." We would prefer to have enough information to translate it either as "We have a child" or as "We have children."

At times this ambiguity is an advantage. When you ask Nǐmen yǒu háizi ma? you do not, after all, know whether you are referring to one child or to more than one child. To cover both bets in the same way in English, we have to say "Do you have any children?"

13.2.3.2 Notes on №2
2. B: Liú xiānsheng yǒu Měiguó péngyou ma? 刘先生有美国朋友吗? Does Mr Liú have any American friends?
B: Tā meíyǒu Měiguó péngyou. 他没有美国朋友。 He doesn't have any American friends.
A: Tā yǒu Yīngguó péngyou. 他有英国朋友。 He has English friends. (or an English friend)

Méi you: All the verbs discussed so far form the negative with , with the single exception of yǒu, "to have," which has the irregular negative form méiyou.

13.2.3.3 Notes on №3-4
3. A: Nǐmen yǒu jǐge háizi? 你们有几个孩子? How many children do you have?
B: Wǒmen yǒu sānge háizi. 我们有三个孩子。 We have three children.
4. A: Nǐmen yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi? 你们有几个男孩子,几个女孩子? How many boys and how many girls do you have?
B: Wǒmen yǒu liǎngge nánháizi, yīge nǚháizi. 我们有两个男孩子,一个女孩子。 We have two boys and one girl.

In Peking speech, jǐ-, "how many," is usually used only when the number expected in an answer is about 10 or less. In many other parts of China, speakers use jl- no matter how large a number is expected in the answer.

Counters: In Chinese, a noun cannot be counted or specified (i.e., used with něi- "which," nèi-, "that," zhèi-, "this") without the addition of a bound word, a counter, to indicate the sort of thing being specified or counted. English has a few such counters, as "head" in "how many head of cattle" and "loaves" in " seven loaves of bread."

The counter used in a particular instance depends on the noun "being specified or counted. Many nouns have special counters. You have already learned the polite counter for persons, -wèi. Other special counters refer in some way to the kind of thing the noun represents. The word for "hotel," for instance, has a special counter -jiā, "house," used for counting or specifying business establishments.

The general counter -ge is used with nouns that do not have special counters. For example, there is no special counter for the word pùbù, "waterfall," so you would say yíge pùbù, "one waterfall." You have already found the general counter -ge in specifying expressions such as něige háizi, "which child," and zhèige fàndiàn,"this hotel."

You may find that, in colloquial speech, nouns that have special counters are sometimes used with -ge anyway, but this tendency is looked down upon by many speakers.

Here are the numbers 1 through 10 with the counter -ge:

yíge liǎngge sānge sìge wǔge liùge qíge báge jiǔge shíge

The number 2 has a special form before a counter: liǎng-. Notice that the words for 1, 2, and 8 have Rising tones before -ge, because -ge is basically a Falling-tone syllable. (See also Unit 5, notes on No. 9 and No. 10.)

Nán- nǚ-: The "bound words nán- "male," and nǚ-, "female," are often used in compounds; for example, nánpéngyou, "boyfriend," and nǚtóngzhì "(woman) Comrade."

"And": In Chinese, a word for "and" is not needed between parallel phrases like liǎngge nánháizi, yíge nǚháizi "two boys, (and) one girl."

A pause is usual between the two phrases, but even the pause is sometimes omitted.

13.2.3.4 Notes on №5-7
5. B: Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi? 是男孩子,是女孩子? Are they boys or girls?
A: Tāmen dōu shì nǚháizi. 他们都是女孩子。 All of them are girls.
6. B: Hú xiānsheng, tàitai ne? tāmen yǒu jǐge háizi? 胡先生,太太呢?他们有几个孩子? How about Mr. and Mrs. ? How many children do they have?
A: Tāmen yǒu liǎngge háizi. 他们有两个孩子。 They have two children.
B: Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi? 是男孩子,是女孩子? Are they boys or girls?
A: Dōu shì nǚháizi. 都是女孩子。 Both of them are girls.
7. A: Nǐmen háizi dōu zài zhèli ma? 你们孩子都在这里吗? Are all your children here?
B: Bù, liǎngge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Měiguó. 不,两个在这里,一个还在美国。 No. Two are here, and one is still in America.

Shi nánháizi, shi nǚháizi? In Chinese, an "or" question (i.e., a question asking which of two alternatives is true) may be asked simply by stating the two alternatives with a pause between. In this kind of question, the verb must appear in each alternative. (You will learn other ways of making "or" questions in later modules.)

Dōu may usually be translated in a sentence as "all (of)," or, if it refers to only two things, as both (of)." Literally, dōu means "in all cases," "uniformly," "entirely," "completely." Since it is an adverb), it must be placed after the subject of a sentence and before the verb (like the adverb , "also".)

13.2.3.5 Notes on №8-9
8. A: Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are (there) in your family?
B: Yǒu wǒ tàitai gēn sānge háizi. 有我太太跟三个孩子。 There's my wife and three children.
9. B: Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? 你家里有什么人? What people are (there) in your family?
A: Jiù yǒu wǒ fùqin, mǔqin. 就有我父亲,母亲。 Just my father and mother.

Literally, the phrase nǐ jiāli means "in your home" (jiā, "home"; -li, "in"). In this sentence it is extended to mean "the people in your home, " that is, "your family."

Nǐ jiāli - yǒu - shénme rén? Phrase by phrase, this question is: "In your family - there are - what people?,’ The word "family" can be taken to mean either all your relatives or only those living in your household.

By itself, the verb yǒu means "to "be," "to exist." You have now seen it translated two ways:

  1. as "have," with a personal subject: Wǒmen yǒu sānge háizi . "We have three children."

  2. as "there is/are," in the so-called impersonal construction: Nǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén? "What people are (there) in your family?"

In exchange 8, the verb yǒu in the answer is translated as "there's." Some English speakers may find this translation too colloquial. The answer can also be translated Just by listing the family members, with no verb in the English, as was done in exchange 9« Chinese almost always keeps the verb in the answer to a question, while English tends to leave it out.

How to say "and": Chinese has several words for "and." Gēn is the word for "and" when joining nouns or noun phrases. is the word for "and" when Joining verbs, verb phrases, or whole sentences:

Wǒ bú xìng Lǐ, yě bú xìng Lǔ. Wǒ xìng Lǚ.

I'm not surnamed and I'm not surnamed . I'm surnamed .

Example 13.2.3.5.1 Example:

Chinese tends to use a word for "and" when the noun phrases being Joined are not parallel and not to use one when the phrases are parallel:

Not parallel
Yǒu

wǒ tàitai

Possessor noun

gēn

sānge háizi.

number noun

There's my wife and 3 children.
Parallel
Yǒu

liǎngge nánháizi

number noun

,

yíge nǚháizi.

number noun

There are 2 boys and one girl.

While "and" is often omitted in Chinese, it may be added for emphasis between nouns and between noun phrases just as in English.

Jiù, "only," "Just," is an advert (like and dōu. The use of jiù to mean "only" is probably mostly confined to the Peking dialect.6 Speakers from other parts of the country will not necessarily use jiù to mean "only" or understand it as such. A more widely used and understood word for "only" is zhǐ. Thus the answer in exchange 9 could also be: Zhǐ yǒu wǒ fùqin, mǔqin.

13.2.3.6 Notes on additional vocabulary

Chinese is much more precise than English in its terms for family members. There is not Just one word for "brother," or "sister" but words for "older brother," "younger brother," "older sister," and "younger sister."

older younger
brother gēge dìdi brothers xiōngdì
sister jiějie mèimei sisters jiěmèi

When referring to both older and younger sisters, the term jiěmèi is used. When referring to both older and younger brothers, the term xiōngdì is used. When referring to sisters and brothers, the phrase xiōngdì jiěmèi is used.

Chinese also distinguishes between grandparents on the father's side of the family and grandparents on the mother's side:

father's side mother's side
grandfather zǔfù wàizǔfù
grandmother zǔmǔ wàizǔmǔ

The syllable wài- in wàizǔfù and wàizǔmǔ literally means "outer" or "outside."

13.3 Drills

13.3.1 Response Drill

Table 13.3.1.1 Give affirmative answers, using yǒu.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她有美国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Měiguó pényou ma?

Does he/she have any American friend?

有,他/她有美国朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Měiguó péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some American friend.

2.

他/她有中国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Zhōngguó péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any Chinese friend?

有,他/她有中国朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Zhōngguó péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some Chinese friend.

3.

他/她有德国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Déguó péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any German friend?

有,他/她有德国朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Déguó péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some German friend.

4.

他/她有日本朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Rìběn péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any Japanese friend?

有,他/她有日本朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Rìběn péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some Japanese friend.

5.

他/她有加拿大朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Jiānádà péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any Canadian friend?

有,他/她有加拿大朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Jiānádà pényou.

Yes, he/she has some Canadian friend.

6.

他/她有俄国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu èguó péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any Russian friend?

有,他/她有俄国朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu èguó péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some Russian friend.

7.

他/她有英国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Yīngguó péngyou ma?

Does he/she have any English friend?

有,他/她有英国朋友。

Yǒu, tā yǒu Yīngguó péngyou.

Yes, he/she has some English friend.

13.3.2 Response drill

Table 13.3.2.1 Give affirmatives answers using yǒu.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她有哥哥吗?

Tā yǒu gēge ma?

Does he/she have an older brother?

有,他/她有哥哥。

Yǒu, tā yǒu gēge.

Yes, he/she has an older brother.

2.

他/她有姐姐吗?

Tā yǒu jiějie ma?

Does he/she have an older sister?

有,他/她有姐姐。

Yǒu, tā yǒu jiějie.

Yes, he/she has an older sister.

3.

他/她有弟弟马?

Tā yǒu dìdi ma?

Does he/she have a younger brother?

有,他/她有弟弟。

Yǒu, tā yǒu dìdi.

Yes, he/she has a younger brother.

4.

他/她有妹妹?

Tā yǒu mèimei ma?

Does he/she have a younger sister?

有,他/她有妹妹。

Yǒu, tā yǒu mèimei.

Yes, he/she has a younger sister.

5.

他/她们有孩子吗?

Tāmen yǒu háizi ma?

Does he/she have children?

有,他/她们有孩子。

Yǒu, tāmen yǒu háizi.

Yes, he/she has children.

6.

他/她们有男孩子?

Tāmen yǒu nánháizi ma?

Does he/she have boys?

有,他/她们有男孩子。

Yǒu, tāmen yǒu nánháizi.

Yes, he/she has boys.

7.

他/她们有女孩子?

Tāmen yǒu nǚháizi ma?

Does he/she have girls?

有,他/她们有女孩子?

Yǒu, tāmen yǒu nǚháizi.

Yes, he/she has girls.

13.3.3 Response drill

Table 13.3.3.1 Give negative answers using méiyou.
Statement Answer
1.

张先生有姐姐吗?

Zhāng xiānsheng yǒu jiějie ma?

Does Mr. Zhāng have an older sister?

没有,张先生没有姐姐。

Méi you, Zhāng xiānsheng méiyou jiějie.

No, Mr. Zhāng doesn't have an older sister.

2.

王先生有路女子吗?

Wáng xiānsheng yǒu nǚháizi ma?

Does Mr. Wáng have a daughter?

没有,王先生没有女孩子。

Méi you, Wáng xiānsheng méiyou nǚháizi.

No, Mr. Wáng doesn't have a daughter.

3.

林先生有妹妹吗?

Lín xiānsheng yǒu mèimei ma?

Does Mr. Lín have a younger sister?

没有,林先生没有妹妹。

Méi you, Lín xiānsheng méiyou mèimei.

No, Mr. Lín doesn't have a younger sister.

4.

马太太有哥哥吗?

Mā tàitai yǒu gēge ma?

Does Mrs. have an older brother?

没有,马太太没有哥哥。

Méi you, Mā tàitai méiyou gēge.

No, Mrs. doesn't have an older brother.

5.

黄小姐有弟弟吗?

Huáng xiǎojiě yǒu dìdi ma?

Does Miss Huáng have a younger brother?

没有,黄小姐没有弟弟。

Méi you, Huáng xiǎojiě méiyou dìdi.

No, Miss Huáng doesn't have a younger brother.

6.

马先生,马太太有孩子吗?

Mǎ xiānsheng, Mǎ tàitai yǒu háizi ma?

Do Mr. , Mrs. have children?

没有,马先生,马太太没有孩子。

Méi you, Mǎ xiānsheng, Mǎ tàitai méiyou háizi.

No, Mr. , Mrs. don't have children.

7.

杨太太有男孩子吗?

Yáng tàitai yǒu nánháizi ma?

Does Mrs. Yáng have boys?

没有,杨太太没有男孩子。

Méi you, Yáng tàitai méiyou nánháizi.

No, Mrs. Yáng doesn't 'have boys.

13.3.4 Response drill

Table 13.3.4.1 Give a negative or affirmative response to each question according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

你有弟弟吗?

Nǐ yǒu dìdi ma?

Do you have a younger brother?

yǒu

yes

有,我有弟弟。

Yǒu, wǒ yǒu dìdi.

Yes, I have a younger brother.

2.

你有弟弟吗?

Nǐ yǒu dìdi ma?

Do you have an older brother?

没有

méiyou

no

没有,我没有弟弟。

Méi you, wǒ méiyou dìdi.

No, I don't have an older brother.

3.

他/她有妹妹吗?

Tā yǒu mèimei ma?

Does he/she have a younger sister?

没有

méiyou

no

没有, 他/她没有妹妹。

Méi you, tā méiyou mèimei.

No, he/she doesn't have a younger sister.

4.

王同志有哥哥吗?

Wáng tóngzhì yǒu gēge ma?

Does comrade Wáng have an older brother?

yǒu

yes

有, 王同志有哥哥。

Yǒu, Wáng tóngzhì yǒu gēge.

Yes, comrade Wáng has an older brother.

5.

他们有孩子吗?

Tāmen yǒu háizi ma?

Do you have children?

yǒu

yes

有他们有孩子。

Yǒu, tāmen yǒu háizi.

Yes, we have children.

6.

高同志有英国朋友吗?

Gaō tóngzhì yǒu Yīngguó péngyou ma?

Does comrade Gaō have an English friend?

没有

méiyou

no

没有,高同志没有英国朋友。

Méi you, Gaō tóngzhì méiyou Yīngguó oéngyou.

No, comrade Gaō doesn't have an English friend.

7.

陈先生有法国朋友吗?

Chén xiānsheng yǒu Fàguó péngyou ma?

Does Mr. Chén have a French friend?

yǒu

yes

有,陈先生有法国朋友。

Yǒu, Chén xiānsheng yǒu Fàguó péngyou.

Yes, Mr. Chén has a French friend.

13.3.5 Transformation drill

Table 13.3.5.1 Change each ma question to a question.
Statement Answer
1.

他们有孩子吗?

Tāmen yǒu háizi ma?

Do they have any children?

他们有几个孩子?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge háizi?

How many children do they have?

2.

王先生有姐姐吗?

Wáng xiānsheng yǒu jiějie ma?

Does Mr. Wáng have an older sister?

王先生有几个姐姐?

Wáng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge jiějie?

How many older sisters does have Mr Wáng?

3.

他们有男孩子吗?

Tāmen yǒu nánháizi ma?

Do they have any boys?

他们有几个男孩子?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge nánháizi?

How many boys do they have?

4.

你们有女孩子吗?

Nǐmen yǒu nǚháizi ma?

Do you have daughters?

你们有几个女孩子?

Nǐmen yǒu jǐge nǚháizi?

How many daughters do you have?

5.

方小姐有哥哥吗?

Fāng xiǎojiě yǒu gēge ma?

Does Miss Fāng have an older brother?

方小姐有几个哥哥?

Fāng xiǎojiě yǒu jǐge gēge?

How many older brothers does Miss Fāng have?

6.

赵太太有弟弟吗?

Zhào tàitai yǒu dìdi ma?

Does Mrs. Zhào have a younger brother?

赵太太有几个弟弟?

Zhào tàitai yǒu jǐge dìdi?

How many younger brothers does Mrs. Zhào have?

7.

他/她有中国朋友吗?

Tā yǒu Zhōngguó péngyou ma?

Does he/she have a Chinese friend?

他/她有几个中国朋友?

Tā yǒu jǐge Zhōngguó péngyou?

How many Chinese friends does he/she have?

13.3.6 Response drill

Table 13.3.6.1 Respond to the questions according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

张同志有几个孩子?

Zhāng tóngzhì yǒu jǐge háizi?

How many children does comrade Zhāng have?

2

张同志有两个孩子。

Zhāng tóngzhì yǒu liǎngge háizi.

Comrade Zhāng has 2 children.

2.

赵同志有几个女孩子?

Zhào tóngzhì yǒu jǐge nǚháizi?

How many daughters does comrade Zhào have?

1

赵同志有一个女孩子。

Zhào tóngzhì yǒu yíge nǚháizi.

Comrade Zhào has 1 daughter.

3.

陈同志有几个男孩子?

Chén tóngzhì yǒu jǐge nánháizi?

How many boys does comrade Chén have?

3

陈同志有三个男孩子。

Chén tóngzhì yǒu sānge nánháizi.

Comrade Chén has 3 boys.

4.

江同志有几个美国朋友?

Jiāng tóngzhì yǒu jǐge Měiguó péngyou.

How many American friends does comrade Jiāng have?

5

江同志有五个美国朋友。

Jiāng tōngzhì yǒu wǔge Měiguó péngyou.

Comrade Jiāng has 5 American friends.

5.

方同志有几个妹妹?

Fāng tóngzhì yǒu jǐge mèimei?

How many younger sisters does comrade Fāng have?

1

方同志有一个妹妹。

Fāng tóngzhì yǒu yíge mèimei.

Comrade Fāng has 1 younger sister.

6.

王先生有几个中国朋友?

Wáng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge Zhōngguó péngyou?

How many Chinese friends does Mr. Wáng have?

2

王先生有两个中国朋友。

Wáng xiānsheng yǒu liǎngge Zhōngguó péngyou.

Mr. Wáng has 2 Chinese friends.

7.

他/她有几个哥哥?

Tā yǒu jǐge gēge?

How many older brothers does he/she have?

3

他/她有三个哥哥。

Tā yǒu sānge gēge.

He/she has 3 older brothers.

13.3.7 Expansion drill

Table 13.3.7.1 Add te cues to the questions.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她有一个男孩子?

Tā yǒu jǐge nánháizi?

How many sons does he/she have?

女孩子

nǚháizi

daughter

他有几个男孩子,几个女孩子?

Tā yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters does he/she have?

2.

黄先生有几个美国朋友?

Huáng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge Měiguó péngyou?

How many American friends does Mr. Huáng have?

法国朋友

Fàguó péngyou

French friend

黄先生有几个美国朋友,几个法国朋友?

Huáng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge Měiguó péngyou, jǐge Fàguó péngyou?

How many American friends and how many French friends does Mr. Huáng have?

3.

李太太有几个哥哥?

Lǐ tàitai yǒu jǐge gēge?

How many older brothers does Mrs. have?

弟弟

dìdi

younger brother

李太太有几个哥哥,几个弟弟?

Lǐ tàitai yǒu jige gēge, jǐge dìdi?

How many older brothers and how many younger brothers does Mrs. have?

4.

孙小姐有几个姐姐?

Sūn xiǎojiě yǒu jǐge jiějie?

How many older sisters does Miss Sūn have?

妹妹

mèimei

younger sister

孙小姐有几个姐姐,几个妹妹?

Sūn xiǎojiě yǒu jǐge jiějie, jǐge mèimei?

How many older sisters and how many younger sisters does Miss Sūn have?

5.

他们有几个英国朋友?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge Yīngguó péngyou?

How many English friends do they have?

德国朋友

Déguó péngyou

German friend

他们有几个英国朋友,几个德国朋友?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge Yīngguó péngyou, jǐge Déguó péngyou?

How many English and German friends do they have?

6.

宋先生有几个男孩子?

Sòng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge nánháizi?

How many sons does Mr. Sòng have?

女孩子

nǚháizi

daughter

宋先生有几个男孩子,几个女孩子?

Sòng xiānsheng yǒu jǐge nānháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters does Mr. Sòng have?

7.

他/她有几个哥哥?

Tā yǒu jǐge gēge?

How many older brothers does he/she have?

姐姐

jiějie

older sister

他/她有几个哥哥,几个姐姐?

Tā yǒu jǐge gēge, jǐge jiějie?

How many older brother sand how many older sisters does he/she have?

13.3.8 Response drill

Table 13.3.8.1 Answer according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她有几个男孩子,几个女孩子?

Tā yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters does he/she have?

2

他/她就有两个男孩子,没有女孩子。

Tā jiù yǒu liǎngge nánháizi, méiyou nǚháizi.

He/she has only two sons, no daughters.

2.

李先生有几个哥哥,几个姐姐?

Lǐ xiānsheng yǒu jǐge gēge, jǐge jiějie?

How many older brothers and how many older sisters does Mr. have?

1

他/她就有一个哥哥,没有姐姐。

Tā jiù yǒu yíge gēge, méiyou jiějie.

He/she has only one older brother and no older sister.

3.

张小姐有几个姐姐,几个妹妹?

Zhāng xiǎojiě yǒu jǐge jiějie, jǐge mèimei?

How many older sisters and how many younger sisters does Miss Zhāng have?

2

他/她就有两个姐姐,没有妹妹。

Tā jiù yǒu liǎngge jiějie, méiyou mèimei.

He/she has only two older sisters nad no younger sister.

4.

周太太有几个哥哥,几个弟弟?

Zhōu tàitai yǒu jǐge gēge, jǐge dìdi?

How many older brothers and how many younger brothers does Mrs. Zhōu have?

1

他/她就有一个哥哥,没有弟弟。

Tā jiù yǒu yíge gēge, méiyou dìdi.

He/she has only one older brother, no younger brother.

5.

胡先生有几个弟弟,几个妹妹?

Hú xiānsheng yǒu jǐge dìdi, jǐge mèimei?

How many younger brothers and how many younger sisters does Mr. have?

2

他就有两个弟弟,没有妹妹。

Tā jiù yǒu liǎngge dìdi, méiyou mèimei.

He has only two younger brothers and no younger sister.

6.

他/她有几个法国朋友,几个德国朋友?

Tā yǒu jǐge Fàguó péngyou, jǐge Déguó péngyou?

How many French friends and how many German friends does he/she have?

2

他/她就有两个法国朋友,没有德国朋友。

Tā jiù yǒu liǎngge Fàguó péngyou, méiyou Déguó péngyou.

He/she has only two French friends and no German friend.

7.

他们有几个男孩子,几个女孩子?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters do they have?

1

他们就有一个男孩子,没有女孩子。

Tāmen jiù yǒu yíge nánháizi, méiyou nǚháizi.

They have only one son and no daughter.

13.3.9 Response drill

Table 13.3.9.1 Respond according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她有几个男孩子,几个女孩子?

Tā yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters does he/she have?

2, 3

他/她有两个男孩子, 三个女孩子。

Tā yǒu liǎngge nánháizi, sānge nǚháizi.

He/she has 2 sons and 3 daughters.

2.

周同志有几个哥哥, 几个弟弟?

Zhōu tóngzhì yǒu jǐge gēge, jǐge dìdi?

How many older brothers and how many younger brothers does comrade Zhōu have ?

1, 2

周同志有一个哥哥,两个弟弟。

Zhōu tóngzhì yǒu yíge gēge, liǎngge dìdi.

Comrade Zhōu has one older brother and two younger brothers.

3.

张同志有几个姐姐,几个妹妹?

Zhāng tóngzhi yǒu jǐge jiějie, jǐge mèimei?

How many older sisters and how many younger sisters does comrade Zhāng have.

3, 1

张同志有三个姐姐,一个妹妹。

Zhāng tóngzhì yǒu sānge jiějie, yíge mèimei.

Comrade Zhāng has 3 older sisters and one younger sister.

4.

他们有几个中国朋友,几个日本朋友?

Tāmen yǒu jǐge Zhōngguó péngyou, jǐge Rìběn péngyou?

How many Chinese friends and how many Japanese friends do they have?

5, 1

他们有五个中国朋友,一个日本朋友。

Tāmen yǒu wǔge Zhōngguó péngyou, yíge Rìběn péngyou.

They have 5 Chinese friends and one Japanese friend.

5.

陈同志有几个英国朋友, 几个德国朋友?

Chén tóngzhì yǒu jǐge Yīngguó péngyou, jǐge Déguó péngyou?

How many English friends and how many German friends does comrade Chén have?

3, 2

陈同志有三个英国朋友,两个德国朋友。

Chén tóngzhì yǒu sānge Yīngguó péngyou, liǎngge Déguó péngyou.

Comrade Chén has 3 English friends and 3 German friends.

6.

刘同志有几个男孩子, 几个女孩子?

Liú tóngzhì yǒu jǐge nánháizi, jǐge nǚháizi?

How many sons and how many daughters does comrade Liú have?

2, 2

刘同志有两个男孩子,两个女孩子。

Liú tóngzhì yǒu liǎngg nánháizi,liǎngge nǚháizi.

Comrade Liú has 2 sons and 2 daughters.

7.

他/她有几个姐姐,几个哥哥?

Tā yǒu jǐge jiějie, jǐge gēge?

How many older sisters and how many older brothers does he/she have?

1, 3

他/她有一个姐姐, 三个哥哥。

Tā yǒu yíge jiějie, sānge gēge.

He/she has one older sister and 3 older brothers.

13.3.10 Response drill

Table 13.3.10.1 The speaker will ask you 2 questions for each exchange. Use the number cue to answer the first question. Answer the second question with Dōu and the first alternative.
Question Cue Answer
1.

请问, 他们有几个孩子?

Qǐnwèn, tāmen yǒu jǐge háizi?

May I ask, how many children do you have?

2

2

2

他们有两个孩子。

Tāmen yǒu liǎngge háizi.

They have 2 children.

2.

是男孩子,是女孩子?

Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi?

Are they boys or girls?

Dōu

all

都是男孩子。

Dōu shì nānháizi.

Both of them are boys.

3.

请问,他/她有几个兄弟?

Qǐnwèn, tā yǒu jǐge xiōngdì?

May I ask, how many brothers does he/she have?

3

3

3

他/她有三个兄弟。

Tā yǒu sānge xiōngdì.

He/she has 3 brothers.

4.

是哥哥,是弟弟?

Shì gēge, shì dìdi?

Are they older or younger brothers?

Dōu

all

都是哥哥。

Dōu shì gēge.

All of them are older brothers.

5.

请问,他/她有几个姐妹?

Qǐngwèn, tā yǒu jǐge jiěmèi?

May I ask, how many sisters does he/she have?

2

2

2

他/她有两个姐妹。

Tā yǒu liǎngge jiěmèi.

He/she has 2 sisters.

6.

是姐姐,是妹妹?

Shì jiějie, shì mèimei?

Are they older or younger sisters?

Dōu

all

都是姐姐。

Dōu shì jiějie.

Both of them are older sisters.

7.

请问,他/她有几个中国朋友?

Qǐngwèn, tā yǒu jǐge Zhōngguó péngyou?

May I ask, how many Chinese friends does he/she have?

4

4

4

他/她有四个中国朋友。

Tā yǒu sìge Zhōngguò péngyou.

He/she has 4 Chinese friends.

8.

是男朋友,是女朋友?

Shì nánpéngyou, shì nǚpéngyou?

Are they male or female friends?

Dōu

all

都是男朋友。

Dōu shì nánpéngyou.

All of them are male friends.

9.

请问,他/她有几个美国朋友?

Qǐngwèn, tā yǒu jǐge Měiguó péngyou?

May I ask, how many American friends does he/she have?

2

2

2

他/她有两个美国朋友。

Tā yǒu liǎngge Měiguó péngyou.

He/she has 2 American friends.

10.

是男朋友,是女朋友?

Shì nánpéngyou, shì nǚpéngyou?

Are they male or female friends?

Dōu

all

都是男朋友。

Dōu shì nánpéngyou.

Both of them are male friends.

11.

请问,他/她有几个孩子。

Qǐngwèn, tā yǒu jǐge háizi?

May I ask, how many children does he/she have?

3

3

3

他/她有三个孩子。

Tā yǒu sānge háizi.

He/she has 3 children.

12.

是男孩子,是女孩子?

Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi?

Are they boys or girls?

Dōu

all

都是男孩子。

Dōu shì nánháizi.

All of them are boys.

13.

请问,他们有几个孩子。

Qǐngwèn, tāmen yǒu jǐge háizi?

May I ask, how many children do they have?

5

5

5

他们有五个孩子。

Tāmen yǒu wǔge háizi.

They have 5 children.

14.

是男孩子,是女孩子?

Shì nánháizi, shì nǚháizi?

Are they boys or girls?

Dōu

all

都是男孩子。

Dōu shì nánháizi.

All of them are boys.

13.3.11 Substitution drill

Table 13.3.11.1 Substitute the cue .
Question Cue Answer
1.

请问,你们家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, nǐmen jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your family?

他们

tāmen

they

请问,他们家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, tāmen jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in their family?

2.

请问,他们家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, tāmen jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in their family?

方先生

Fāng xiānsheng

Mr. Fāng

请问,方先生有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, Fāng xiānsheng jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Mr. Fāng family?

3.

请问,方先生家里有什么人?

Qǐngwen, Fāng xiānsheng jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Mr. Fāng family?

张小姐

Zhāng xiǎojiě

Miss Zhāng

请问,张小姐家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, Zhāng xiǎojiě jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Miss Zhāng family?

4.

请问,张小姐家里有什么人?

Qǐngwen, Zhāng xiǎojiě jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Miss Zhāng family?

李明理

Lǐ Mínglǐ

Lǐ Mínglǐ

请问,李明理家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, Lǐ Mínglǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Lǐ Mínglǐ family?

5.

请问,李明理家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, Lǐ Mínglǐ jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in Lǐ Mínglǐ family?

你哥哥

nǐ gēge

your older brother

请问,你哥哥家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ gēge jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your older brother's family?

6.

请问,你哥哥家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ gēge jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your older brother's family?

你朋友

nǐ péngyou

your friend

请问,你朋友家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn nǐ péngyou jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your friend's family?

7.

请问,你朋友家里有什么人?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ péngyou jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your friend's family?

你爸爸

nǐ bàba

your father

请问,你爸爸家里有什么人?

Qíngwèn, nǐ bàba jiāli yǒu shénme rén?

May I ask, what people are (there) in your father's family?

13.3.12 Expansion drill

Table 13.3.12.1 Add the cue and gēn to each sentence.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她有一个孩子。

Tā yǒu yíge háizi.

He/she has one child.

太太

tàitai

wife

有他/她太太跟一个孩子。

Yǒu tā tàitai gēn yíge háizi.

There are his wife and one child.

2.

胡先生有一个妹妹。

Hú xiānsheng yǒu yíge mèimei.

Mr. has one younger sister.

母亲

mǔqin

mother

有他母亲跟一个妹妹。

Yǒu tā mǔqin gēn yíge mèimei.

There are his mother and one younger sister.

3.

李小姐有两个弟弟。

Lǐ xiǎojiě yǒu liǎngge dìdi.

Miss has 2 younger brothers.

姐姐

jiějie

older sister

有她姐姐跟两个弟弟。

Yǒu tā jiějie gēn liǎngge dìdi.

There are her older sister and two younger brothers.

4.

刘先生有一个女孩子。

Liú xiānsheng yǒu yíge nǚhaizi.

Mr. Liú has one daughter.

母亲

mǔqin

mother

有他母亲跟一个女孩子。

Yǒu tā mǔqin gēn yíge nǚháizi.

There are his mother and one daughter.

5.

林太太有三个男孩子。

Lín tàitai yǒu sānge nánháizi.

Mrs. Lín has 2 boys.

先生

xiānsheng

husband

有她先生跟三个男孩子。

Yǒu tā xiānsheng gēn sānge nánháizi.

There are her husband and 3 boys.

6.

他/她有一个姐姐。

Tā yǒu yíge jiějie.

He has one older sister.

父亲

fùqin

father

有他/她父亲跟一个姐姐。

Yǒu tā fùqin gēn yíge jiějie.

There are his/her older sister and his/her father.

7.

王先生有四个孩子。

Wāng xiānsheng yǒu sìge háizi.

Mr. Wāng has 4 children.

太太

tàitai

wife

有他太太跟四个孩子。

Yǒu tā tàitai gēn sìge háizi.

There are his wife and 4 children.

13.3.13 Response drill

Table 13.3.13.1 Answer to the question according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他们孩子都在这里吗?

Tāmen háizi dōu zài zhèli ma?

Are all of their children here?

美国

Měiguó

America

不,一个在这里,一个还在美国。

Bù, yíge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Měiguó.

No, one is here, and one is still in America.

2.

他/她哥哥,姐姐都在这里吗?

Tā gēge, jiějie dōu zài zhèli ma?

Are his/her older brother and older sister both here?

加州

Jiāzhōu

California

不,一个在这里,一个还在加州。

Bù, yíge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Jiāzhōu.

No, one is here, and one is still in California.

3.

他/她美国朋友都在这里吗?

Tā měiguó péngyou dōu zài zhèli ma?

Are his/her American friends all here?

台中

Táizhōng

T'ai-chung

不,一个在 ,一个还在台中。

Bù, yíge zài zhèli, yíge hái zài Táizhōng.

No, one is here, and one is still in T'ai-chung.

4.

他/她弟弟,妹妹都在中国吗?

Tā dìdi, mèimei dōu zài Zhōngguó ma?

Are his/her younger brother and younger sister both here?

德州

Dézhōu

Texas

不,一个在中国,一个还在德州。

Bù, yíge zài Zhōngguó, yíge hái zài Dézhōu.

No, one is is in China, one is still in Texas.

5.

王先生的孩子都在德州吗?

Wáng ziānsheng de háizi dōu zài Dézhōu ma?

Are Mr. Wáng's children all here?

加州

Jiāzhōu

California

不,一个在德州,一个还在加州。

Bù, yíge zài Dézhōu, yíge hái zài Jiāzhōu.

No, one is in Texas, and one is still in California.

6.

那两位先生都在上海吗?

Nèi liǎngwèi xiānsheng dōu zài Shànghǎi ma?

Are they both in Shànghǎi?

青岛

Qīngdǎo

Qīngdǎo

不,一个在上海,一个还在青岛。

Bù, yíge zài Shànghǎi, yíge hái zài Qīngdǎo.

No, one is in Shànghǎi, one is in Qīngdǎo.

7.

他们孩子都在香港吗?

Tāmen háizi dōu zài Xiāngǎng ma?

Are their children all in Hong-Kong?

美国

Měiguó

America

不,一个在香港,一个还在美国。

Bù, yíge zài Xiāngǎng, yíge hái zài Měiguó.

No, one is in Hong-Kong, one is still in America.

14 Unit 4

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Arrival and departure times,

  2. The marker le

  3. The shì … de construction.

14.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes» the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes» the Workbook.

  3. The UD-1 tape.

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

in Běijīng

1. A: Nǐ àiren lái ma? 你爱人来吗? Is your wife coming?
B: Tā lái. 她来。 She is coming.
2. A: Nǐ àiren lái le ma? 你爱人来了吗? Has your wife come?
B: Lái le, tā lái le. 来了,她来了。 Yes, she has come.
3. A: Nǐ àiren yě lái le ma? 你爱人也来了吗? Has your wife come too?
B: Tā hái méi lái. 她还没来。 She hasn't come yet.
4. A: Tā shénme shíhou lái? 她什么时候来? When is she coming?
B: Tā míngtiān lái. 她明天来。 She is coming tomorrow.
5. A: Nǐ péngyou shénme shíhou dào? 你朋友什么时候到? When is your friend arriving?
B: Tā yǐjīng dào le. 他已经到了。 He has already arrived.
6. A: Tā shì shénme shíhou dàode? 她是什么时候到的? When did she arrive?
B: Tā shì zuótiān dàode. 她是昨天到的。 She arrived yesterday.
7. A: Nǐ shì yíge rén láide ma? 你是一个人来的吗? Did you come alone?
B: Bú shì, wǒ bú shì yíge rén láide. 不是,我不是一个人来的。 No, I didn't come alone.
8. A: Nǐ shénme shíhou zǒu? 你什么时候走? When are you leaving?
B: Wǒ jīntiān zǒu. 我今天走。 I'm leaving today.
9. A: Nǐ něitiān zǒu? 你哪天走? What day are you leaving?
B: Wǒ jīntiān zǒu. 我今天走。 I'm leaving today.

14.2.2 Vocabulary

érzi 二字 son
dào to arrive
érzi 二字 son
hòutiān (hòutian) 后天 the day after tomorrow
jīntiān (jīntian) 今天 today
lái to come
le combined le: new-situation and completion marker
míngtiān (mīngtian) 明天 tomorrow
něitiān 哪天 what day
nǚér 女儿 daughter
qiántiān (qiántian) 前天 the day before Yesterday
shénme shíhou 什么时候 when
shì de 是的 emphatic agreement
-tiān day
tiāntiān 天天 every day
yíge rén 一个人 singly, alone
yǐjīng (yǐjing) 已经 already
zǒu to leave
zuótiān 昨天 Yesterday
jiéhūn 结婚 to get married, to be married
méi jiéhūn 没结婚 not to be married
kěshi 可是 but
xiǎng to think, to think that

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Nǐ àiren lái ma? 你爱人来吗? Is your wife coming?
B: Tā lái. 她来。 She is coming.

These sentences refer to future time, but lái is not a future-tense form. Strictly speaking, Chinese verbs do not have tenses. The same form of the verb can be used in present, past, and future contexts.

We translated the sentence Tā zài Táinán gōngzuò. as "He works in Tainan" assuming a present context. But in a past context we could translate It as "He worked in Tainan; and in a future context we could translate it as "He will work in Tainan." The verb form gōngzuò does not tell you what time is being talked about. You have to look elsewhere for that information, perhaps to a time expression like "last year" or "now" or "tomorrow," or to the conversational setting.

14.2.3.2 Notes on №2
2. A: Nǐ àiren lái le ma? 你爱人来了吗? Has your wife come?
B: Lái le, tā lái le. 来了,她来了。 Yes, she has come.

Aspect: Le is an aspect marker. Through the use of and other one-syllable markers (de, zhe, ne, guo), the Chinese language indicates whether the occurrence being talked about is completed, ongoing, about to occur, or experienced for the first time. Aspect markers may also be used to indicate whether the whole situation in the sentence is a new, changed situation.

"Completion" and "new situation" are not tenses but aspects. Aspect is a way of talking about events or activities in relation to time. While tenses categorize action in terms of features such as completeness and change. Aspect markers are very different from tense markers because the same aspect may be used in past, present, and future contexts. We may speak of an action that will be completed as of a future time, for example, or of a situation that was new as of a past time. English communicates these ideas to a certain extent through the use of many different tenses for the verb (future perfect, simple past, etc,). Chinese does this through the use of aspect markers and time words. The verbs themselves do not change form.

Le is used in exchange 2 to indicate two aspects-completion and new situation, (it is, however, often used to indicate only one aspect.)

Here, it indicates that the person has come, meaning that the action is completed, and that the person is now here, a changed situation. When the marker le refers to both these aspects, we call it "combined le." Combined le can be thought of as a telescoping of the completion le followed by a new-situation le: le le becomes le. In the next two units, you will see the marker le used to indicate each of these aspects separately.

14.2.3.3 Notes on №3
3. A: Nǐ àiren yě lái le ma? 你爱人也来了吗? Has your wife come too?
B: Tā hái méi lái. 她还没来。 She hasn't come yet.

Negative of combined le: Compare these affirmative and negative forms:

affirmative lái is coming.
negative lái isn't coming.
affirmative lái le has come (now).
negative hái méi(you) lái hasn't come (yet).

Notice that the marker le does not appear in the negative answer in the exchange.

Hái: The negative of a sentence containing combined le_ will include the adverb hái, "yet," as well as the negative méi(you). In English, the "yet" is frequently left out.

Like other adverbs such as , hái always precedes the verb, although not always directly. Elements such as the negatives and méi may come between an adverb and a verb,

Méi you, "not have" is used to negate the aspect of completion; that is, to say that a certain event did not take place. Méi you may be shortened to méi. Here are three possible negative answers to the question.

Tā lái le ma? "Has he come?"

hái méiyou lái. He hasn't come yet.
hái méi lái. He hasn't come yet.
hái méiyou. Not yet.

14.2.3.4 Notes on №4-5
4. A: Tā shénme shíhou lái? 她什么时候来? When is she coming?
B: Tā míngtiān lái. 她明天来。 She is coming tomorrow.
5. A: Nǐ péngyou shénme shíhou dào? 你朋友什么时候到? When is your friend arriving?
B: Tā yǐjīng dào le. 他已经到了。 He has already arrived.

Position of time words: Time phrases occupy the same position in a sentence as adverbs such as and hái between the subject and the verb.

14.2.3.5 Notes on №6-7
6. A: Tā shì shénme shíhou dàode? 她是什么时候到的? When did she arrive?
B: Tā shì zuótiān dàode. 她是昨天到的。 She arrived Yesterday.
7. A: Nǐ shì yíge rén láide ma? 你是一个人来的吗? Did you come alone?
B: Bú shì, wǒ bú shì yíge rén láide. 不是,我不是一个人来的。 No, I didn't come alone.

(shì)...de: 7 This is another way to indicate the aspect of completion. The aspect marker le and the pattern (shì...de) perform different functions and convey different meanings. This is how they are different:

The aspect marker le or its negative méi (you) is used when the center of interest is whether or not an action took place. For example, if you do not know whether Mr. Sun came or not, you would ask:

Tā léile méiyou? Did he come?

and you would be answered either

Tā láile. He came.

or

Tā méi lái. He didn't come.

In this question and answer, you use le or its negative méi(you) because the focus is on whether the action took place or not.

The purpose of the (shì)...de construction, on the other hand, is to focus on additional information about a completed action; that is, the construction is used when the center of interest is NOT whether or not a certain action took place.

For example, once it has been established that Mr. Sun did in fact come, the (shì)...de construction will probably be used for any additional questions and answers about his coming. For example:

Tā shi shénme shíhou láide? When did he come?
Tā shi zuótiān láide. He came yesterday.
Tā shi yíge rén láide ma? Did he come alone?
Tā shi yíge rén láide. He came alone.

These questions and answers use the (shì)...de construction because you already know that Mr. Sun came and now you are asking for additional information about his visit. Many types of additional information can be focus points for which the (shì)...de construction is used.

In Tā shi shénme shíhou láide? the additional information is the time when something happens.

In Tā shi yíge rén láide ma? the information asked for is the manner in which something takes place.

Other possible focus points are place, cause of action, goal of action, and performer of action.

Now let's take a look at how shì and de function separately in this construction. The verb shì, coming before the phrase which is the center of interest, serves as a signal that what follows is emphasised. The verb "to "be" is often used in a similar way in English to mark the center of interest:

Tā shi zuótiān láide ma? Was it yesterday that he came?

Another way of showing the center of interest in English is by word stress. Here is a comparison between focusing in Chinese with (shì)...de and focusing in English with stress:

Tā lái le ma? Has he come?
Lái le. Yes, he has.
Tā shi zuótiān láide ma? Did he come YESTERDAY?
Shì, tā shi zuótiān láide. Yes, YESTERDAY.

The marker de coming after the verb indicates completion. When the marker de is not used in the sentence, that sentence no longer describes a completed event. The marker shì by itself emphasizes something about the action.

Compare these sentences:

Tā shi jīntiān lái. She is coming (later) today.
Tā shi jīntiān láide. She came (earlier) today.

For the time being, you will not use shì without de.

The negative form of the (shì)...de construction is bú shi...de . Compare this with the negatives you have already learned:

shi zuótiān lái -de It was YESTERDAY that he came.
zuótiān lái -de It wasn't YESTERDAY that he came.
lái le. He has come.
hái méi lái. He hasn't come.
míngtiān lái. He is coming tomorrow.
míngtiān lái. He isn't coming tomorrow.

Notice that in a (shì)...de construction the negative precedes the verb shì rather than the main verb. Short answers are also formed with shì rather than with the main verb:

Nǐ shi yíge rén láide ma? Did you come alone?
Shì, wǒ shì yíge rén láide. Yes, I came alone.
Búshì, wǒ bú shi yíge rén láide. No, I didn't come alone.

The (shì)...de construction is not used in every completed-action sentence containing a time, place, or manner phrase. If the center of interest is still whether or not the action took place, le is used. If, for example, you knew that someone was expected to come yesterday and you wanted to find out only whether he actually did come, the conversation might go as follows:

A: Tā zuótiān méi lái ma? Didn't he COME yesterday?
B: Tā zuótiān lái le. He DID COME yesterday.

Literally, yíge rén means "one person." When the expression is used to describe how someone does something, translate it as "alone"

14.2.3.6 Notes on №8-9
8. A: Nǐ shénme shíhou zǒu? 你什么时候走? When are you leaving?
B: Wǒ jīntiān zǒu. 我今天走。 I'm leaving today.
9. A: Nǐ něitiān zǒu? 你哪天走? What day are you leaving?
B: Wǒ jīntiān zǒu. 我今天走。 I'm leaving today.

The word for "day" is the bound word -tiān. To ask "what day" (literally "which day"), the bound word něi- "which," is combined with the bound word -tiān, "day": něitiān (like něiguó, "which country").

něitiān? what day?/which day?
qiántiān day before yesterday
zuótiān yesterday
jīntiān today
míngtiān tomorrow
hòutiān day after tomorrow

Some speakers say the -tiān in these words in the Neutral tone: qiántian,zuótian, jīntian, míngtian, hòutian.

14.3 Drills

14.3.1  Transformation drill

Table 14.3.1.1 Transform the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

你爱人来吗?

Nǐ àiren lái ma?

Is your spouse coming?

你爱人来了吗?

Nǐ àiren lái le ma?

Has your spouse come?

2.

你父母走吗?

Nǐ fùmǔ zǒu ma?

Are your parents leaving?

你父母走了吗?

Nǐ fùmǔ zǒu le ma?

Have your parents left?

3.

你朋友走吗?

Nǐ péngyou zǒu ma?

Is your friend leaving?

你朋友走了吗?

Nǐ péngyǒu zǒu le ma?

Has your friend left?

4.

你哥哥走吗?

Nǐ gēge zǒu ma?

Is your older brother leaving?

你哥哥走了吗?

Nǐ gēge zǒu le ma?

Has your older brother left?

5.

你姐姐来吗?

Nǐ jiějie lái ma?

Is your older sister coming?

你姐姐来了吗?

Nǐ jiějie lái le ma?

Has your older sister come?

6.

你妹妹来吗?

Nǐ mèimei lái ma?

Is your younger sister coming?

你妹妹来了吗?

Nǐ mèimei lái le ma?

Has your younger sister come?

7.

你弟弟走吗?

Nǐ dìdi zǒu ma?

Is your younger brother leaving?

你弟弟走了吗?

Nǐ dìdi zǒu le ma?

Has your younger brother left?

14.3.2  Transformation drill

Table 14.3.2.1 Transform the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

他/她已经来了吗?

Tā yǐjīng lái le ma?

Has he/she already come?

2.

毛同志到了吗?

Máo tóngzhì dào le ma?

Has comrade Máo arrived?

毛同志已经到了吗?

Máo tóngzhì yǐjīng dào le ma?

Has comrade Máo already arrived?

3.

李同志走了吗?

Lǐ tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade left?

李同志已经走了吗?

Lǐ tóngzhì yǐjīng zǒu le ma?

Has comrade already left?

4.

⻢同志走了吗?

Mǎ tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade left?

⻢同志已经走了吗?

Mǎ tóngzhì yǐjīng zǒu le ma?

Has comrade already left?

5.

张同志来了吗?

Zhāng tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Zhāng come?

张同志已经来了吗?

Zhāng tóngzhì yǐjīng lái le ma?

Has comrade Zhāng already come?

6.

⻩同志到了吗?

Huáng tóngzhì dào le ma?

Has comrade Huáng arrived?

⻩同志已经到了吗?

Huáng tóngzhì yǐjīng dào le ma?

Has comrade Huáng already arrived?

7.

孙同志走了吗?

Sūn tōngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade Sūn left?

孙同志已经走了吗?

Sún tóngzhì yǐjīng zǒu le ma?

Has comrade Sūn already left?

14.3.3  Response drill

Table 14.3.3.1 Answer to the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

他/她还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He/she hasn't come yet.

2.

王同志走了吗?

Wáng tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has Comrade Wáng left?

他还没走。

Tā hái méi zǒu.

Comrade Wáng hasn't left yet.

3.

李同志到了吗?

Lǐ tóngzhì dào le ma?

Has Comrade arrive yet?

他还没到。

Tā hái méi dào.

He hasn't arrive yet.

4.

胡同志来了吗。

Hú tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade come?

他还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He hasn't come yet.

5.

赵同志来了吗?

Zhào tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Zhào come?

他还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He hasn't come yet.

6.

刘同志走了吗?

Liú tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has Comrade Liú left?

他还没走。

Tā héi méi zǒu.

He hasn't left yet.

7.

孙同志来了吗?

Sūn tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Sūn come?

他还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He hasn't come yet.

14.3.4  Response drill

Table 14.3.4.1 Answer to the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

走了,他/她已经走了。

Zǒu le, tā yǐjīng zǒu le.

Yes, he/she has already left.

2.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也已经走了。

Tā àiren yě yǐjīng zǒu le.

His/her spouse has already left too.

3.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

来了,他/她

Lái le, tā yǐjīng lái le.

Yes, he/she has already come.

4.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也已经来了。

Tā àiren yě yǐjīng lái le.

His/her spouse has already come too.

5.

他/她到了吗?

Tā dào le ma?

Has he/she arrived?

到了,他/她已经到了。

Dào le, tā yǐjīng dào le.

Yes, he/she has already arrived.

6.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也已经到了。

Tā àiren yě yǐjīng dào le.

His/her spouse has already arrived too.

7.

李同志走了走吗?

Lǐ tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade left?

走了,他已经走了。

Zǒu le, tā yǐjīng zǒu le.

Yes, he has already left.

8.

他/她哥哥呢?

Tā gēge ne?

And his older brother?

他/她哥哥也已经走了。

Tā gēge yě yǐjīng zǒu le.

His older brother has already left too.

9.

王同志来了吗?

Wáng tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Wáng come?

来了,他已经来了。

Lái le, tā yǐjing lái le.

Yes, he has already come.

10.

他爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his spouse?

他爱人也已经来了。

Tā àiren yě yǐjīng lái le.

His spouse has already come too.

11.

赵先生到了吗?

Zhào xiānsheng dào le ma?

Has Mr. Zhào arrived?

到了,他已经到了。

Dào le, tā yǐjīng dào le.

Yes, he has already arrived.

12.

他弟弟呢?

Tā dìdi ne?

And his younger brother.

他弟弟也已经到了。

Tā dìdi yě yǐjing dào le.

His younger brother has already arrived too.

13.

张同志走了吗?

Zhāng tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade Zhāng left?

走了,他已经走了。

Zǒu le, tā yǐjīng zǒu le.

Yes, he has already left.

14.

陈同志呢?

Chén tóngzhì ne?

And comrade Chén?

陈同也已经走了。

Chén tóngzhì yě yǐjīng zǒu le.

Comrade Chén has already left too.

14.3.5  Response drill

Table 14.3.5.1 Answer to the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

他/她还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He/she hasn't come yet.

2.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也还没来。

Tā àiren yě hái méi lái.

His/her spouse hasn't come yet either.

3.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

他/她还没走。

Tā hái méi zǒu.

He/she hasn't left yet.

4.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也还没走。

Tā àiren yě hái méi zǒu.

His/her spouse hasn't left yet either.

5.

他/她到了吗?

Tā dào le ma?

Has he/she arrived?

他/她还没到。

Tā hái méi dào.

He/she hasn't arrived yet.

6.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人也还没到。

Tā àiren yě hái méi dào.

His/her spouse hasn't arrived yet either.

7.

方女士来了吗?

Fāng nǚshì lǎi le ma?

Has Ms. Fāng come?

方女士还没来。

Fāng nǚshì hái méi lái.

Ms. Fāng hasn't come yet.

8.

她弟弟呢?

Tā dìdi ne?

And her younger brother?

她弟弟也还没来。

Tā dìdi yě hái méi lái.

Her younger brother hasn't come yet either.

9.

李先生到了吗?

Lǐ xiānsheng dào le ma?

Has Mr. arrived?

李先生还没到。

Lǐ xiānsheng hái méi dào.

Mr. hasn't arrived yet.

10.

他父母呢?

Tā fùmǔ ne?

And his parents?

她父母也还没到。

Tā fùmǔ yě hái méi dào.

His parents haven't come yet either.

11.

陈同志走了马?

Chén tóngzhì zǒu le ma?

Has comrade Chén left?

陈同志还没走。

Chén tóngzhì hái méi zǒu.

Comrade Chén hasn't left yet?

12.

江同志呢?

Jiāng tóngzhì ne?

And comrade Jiāng?

江同志也还没走。

Jiāng tóngzhì yě hái méi zǒu.

Comrade Jiāng hasn't left yet either.

13.

他/她母亲到了马?

Tā mǔqin dào le ma?

Has his/her mother arrived?

他/她母亲还没到。

Tā mǔqin hái méi dào.

His/her mother hasn't arrived yet.

14.

他/她姐姐呢?

Tā jiějie ne?

And his/her older sister?

他/她姐姐也还没到。

Tā jiějie yě hái méi dào.

His/her older sister hasn't arrived yet either.

14.3.6  Response drill

Table 14.3.6.1 Give an affirmative response to the first question in each exchange, and include hái and méi. in your response to the second question.
Question Answer
1.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

他/她已经走了。

Tā yǐjīng zǒu le.

He/she has already left.

2.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人还没走。

Tā àiren hái méi zǒu.

His/her spouse hasn't left yet.

3.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

他/她已经来了。

Tā yǐjīng lái le.

He/she has already come.

4.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人还没来。

Tā àiren hái méi lái.

His/her spouse hasn't come yet.

5.

他/她到了吗?

Tā dào le ma?

Has he/she arrived?

他/她已经到了。

Tā yǐjīng dào le.

He/she has arrived.

6.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人还没到。

Tā àiren hái méi dào.

His/her spouse hasn't arrived yet.

7.

王先生走了吗?

Wáng xiānsheng zǒu le ma?

Has Mr. Wáng left?

王先生已经走了。

Wáng xiānsheng yǐjīng zǒu le.

Mr. Wáng has already left.

8.

他母亲呢?

Tā mǔqin ne?

And his mother?

她母亲还没走。

Tā mǔqin hái méi zǒu.

His mother hasn't left yet.

9.

钱同志来了吗?

Qián tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Qián come?

钱同志已经来了。

Qián tóngzhì yǐjīng lái le.

Comrade Qián has already come.

10.

江同志呢?

Jiāng tóngzhì ne?

And comrade Jiāng?

江同志还没来。

Jiāng tóngzhì hái méi lái.

Comrade Jiāng hasn't come yet.

11.

毛女士到了吗?

Máo nǚshì dào le ma?

Has Mrs. Máo arrived?

毛女士已经到了。

Máo nǚshì yǐjīng dào le.

Mrs. Máo has already arrived.

12.

她妹妹呢?

Tā mèimei ne?

And her younger sister?

他妹妹还没到。

Tā mèimei hái méi dào.

Her younger sister hasn't arrived yet.

13.

曾夫人走了吗?

Zēng fūren zǒu le ma?

Has Mrs. Zēng left?

曾副人已经走了。

Zēng fūren yǐjīng zǒu le.

Mrs. Zēng has already left.

14.

他母亲呢?

Tā mǔqin ne?

And his mother?

他母亲还没走。

Tā mǔqin hái méi zǒu.

His mother hasn't left yet.

14.3.7  Response drill

Table 14.3.7.1 Respond to the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Has he/she come?

他/她还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He/she hasn't come yet.

2.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And is/her spouse?

他/她爱人已经来了。

Tā àiren yǐjīng lái le.

His/her spouse has already come.

3.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

他/她还没走。

Tā hái méi zǒu.

He/she hasn't left yet.

4.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人已经走了。

Tā àiren yǐjīng zǒu le.

His/her spouse has already left.

5.

他/她到了吗?

Tā dào le ma?

Has he/she arrived?

他/她还没到。

Tā hái méi dào.

He/she hasn't arrived yet.

6.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

他/她爱人已经到了。

Tā àiren yǐjīng dào le.

His/her spouse has already arrived.

7.

高同志来了吗?

Gāo tóngzhì lái le ma?

Has comrade Gāo come?

高同志还没来。

Gāo tóngzhì hái méi lái.

Comrade Gāo hasn't come yet.

8.

孙同志呢?

Sūn tóngzhì ne?

And comrade Sūn?

孙同志已经来了。

Sūn tóngzhì yǐjīng lái le.

Comrade Sūn has already come.

9.

张先生来了吗?

Zhāng xiānsheng lái le ma?

Has Mr. Zhāng come?

张先生还没来。

Zhāng xiānsheng hái méi lái.

Mr. Zhāng hasn't come yet.

10.

他弟弟呢?

Tā dìdi ne?

And his younger brother?

他弟弟已经来了。

Tā dìdi yǐjǐng lái le.

His younger brother has already come.

11.

他/她母亲到了吗?

Tā mǔqin dào le ma?

Has his/her mother arrived?

他/她母亲还没到。

Tā mǔqin hái méi dào.

His/her mother hasn't arrived yet.

12.

他/她妹妹呢?

Tā mèimei ne?

And his/her younger sister?

他/她妹妹已经到了。

Tā mèimei yǐjīng dào le.

His/her younger sister has already arrived.

13.

王女士走了吗?

Wāng nǚshì zǒu le ma?

Has Mrs. Wāng left.

王女士还没走。

Wāng nǚshì hái méi zǒu.

Mrs. Wāng hasn't left yet.

14.

张女士呢?

Zhāng nǚshì ne?

And Mrs. Zhāng?

张女士已经走了。

Zhāng nǚshì yǐjīng zǒu le.

Mrs. Zhāng has already left.

14.3.8  Response drill

Table 14.3.8.1 Respond to each question with a completed-action answer or a yet-to-be-completed answer, depending on the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她已经走了。

Tā yǐjīng zǒu le.

He/she has already left.

2.

他/她呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她爱人也已经走了。

Tā àiren yě yǐjīng zǒu le.

His/her spouse has already left too.

3.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lǎi le ma?

Has he/she come?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He/she hasn't come yet.

4.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她爱人也还没来。

Tā àiren yě hái méi lái.

His/her spouse hasn't come either.

5.

他/她到了?

Tā dào le ma?

Has he/she arrived?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她已经到了。

Tā yǐjīng dào le.

He/she hasn't already yet.

6.

他/她爱人呢?

Tā àiren ne?

And his/her spouse?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她爱人还没到。

Tā àiren hái méi dào.

His/her spouse hasn't arrived either.

7.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Has he/she left?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她还没走。

Tā hái méi zǒu.

He/she hasn't left yet.

8.

他/她哥哥呢?

Tā gēge ne?

And his/her older brother?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她哥哥已经走了。

Tā gēge yǐjīng zǒu le.

His/her older brother hasn't left either.

9.

赵同志到了吗?

Zhào tóngzhì dào le ma?

Has comrade Zhào arrived?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

赵同志已经到了。

Zhào tóngzhì yǐjīng dào le.

Comrade Zhào has already arrived.

10.

王同志呢?

Wáng tóngzhì ne?

And comrade Wáng?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

王同志也已经到了。

Wáng tóngzhì yě yǐjīng dào le.

Comrade Wáng has already arrived too.

11.

他/她父母走了马?

Tā fùmǔ zǒu le ma?

Have his/her parents left?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她父母还没走。

Tā fùmǔ hái méi zǒu.

His/her parents hasn't left yet.

12.

他们孩子呢?

Tāmen háizi ne?

And their children?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他们孩子已经走了。

Tāmen háizi yǐjīng zǒu le.

Their children have already left.

13.

他/她爱人来了呢?

Tā àiren lái le ma?

Has his/her spouse come?

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她爱人已经来了。

Tā àiren yǐjīng lái le.

His/her spouse has already come.

14.

他们孩子呢?

Tāmen háizi ne?

And his children?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他们孩子还没来。

Tāmen háizi hái méi lái.

His children haven't come yet.

14.3.9  Response drill

Table 14.3.9.1 Respond according to the clue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她什么时候来?

Tā shénme shíhou lái?

When is he/she coming?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她明天来。

Tā míngtiān lái.

He/she is coming tomorrow.

2.

李先生什么时候走?

Lǐ xiānsheng shénme shíhou zǒu?

When is Mr. leaving?

今天

jīntiān

today

他今天走。

Tā jīntiān zǒu.

He is leaving today.

3.

胡小姐设么时候到?

Hú xiǎojiě shénme shíhou dào?

When is Miss arriving?

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

她明天到。

Tā míngtiān dào.

She is arriving tomorrow

4.

张个什么时候来

Zhāng xiānsheng shénme shíhou lái?

When is Mr. Zhāng coming?

后天

hòutian

the day after tomorrow

他后滩来。

Tā hòutiān lái.

He is coming the day after tomorrow.

5.

王小姐什么时候到?

Wáng xiǎojiě shénme shíhou dào?

When is Miss Wáng arriving?

今天

jīntiān

today

她今天到。

Tā jīntiān dào.

She is arriving today.

6.

他/她什么时候走?

Tā shénme shíhou zǒu?

When is he/she leaving?

后天

hòutiān

the day after tomorrow

他/她后天走。

Tā hòutiān zǒu.

He/she is leaving the day after tomorrow.

14.3.10  Transformation drill

Table 14.3.10.1 For each item, ask "which day..."
Cue Answer
1.

他/她lai .

Tā lái.

He/she is coming.

他/她哪天来?

Tā něitiān lái?

What day is he/she coming?

2.

王先生走。

Wáng xiānsheng xǒu.

Mr. Wáng is leaving.

王先生哪天走?

Wáng xiānsheng něitiān zǒu?

What day is Mr. Wáng leaving?

3.

李太太到。

Lǐ tàitai dào.

Mrs. is arriving?

李太太哪天道?

Lǐ tàitai něitiān dào?

What day is Mrs. arriving?

4.

胡太太走。

Hú tàitai zǒu.

Mrs. is leaving.

胡太太哪天走?

Hú tàitai něitiān zǒu.

What day is Mrs. leaving?

5.

张先生到。

Zhāng xiānsheng dào.

Mr. Zhāng is arriving.

张先生哪天到?

Zhāng xiānsheng něitiān dào?

What day is Mr. Zhāng arriving?

6.

⻩太太来。

Huáng táitai lái.

Mrs. Huáng is coming.

⻩太太哪天来。

Huáng tàitai něitiān lái?

What day is Mrs. Huáng coming?

7.

他/她走。

Tā zǒu.

He/she is leaving.

他/她哪天走?

Tā něitiān zǒu?

What day is he/she leaving?

14.3.11  Transformation drill

Table 14.3.11.1 Transform the statement according to the model
Statement Answer
1.

他/她什么时候来?

Tā shénme shíhou lái?

When is he/she coming?

他/她是什么时候来的?

Tā shì shénme shíhou láide?

When did he/she come?

2.

王先生什么时候到?

Wáng xiánsheng shénme shíhou dào?

When is Mr. Wáng arriving?

王先生是什么时候到的?

Wáng xiánsheng shì shénme shíhou dàode?

When did Mr. Wáng arrive?

3.

李太太什么时候走?

Lǐ tàitai shénme shíhou zǒu?

When is Mrs. leaving?

李太太是什么时候走的?

Li tàitai shì shénme shíhou zǒude?

When did Mrs. leave?

4.

胡先生什么时候来?

Hú xiānsheng shénme shíhou lái?

When is Mr. coming?

胡先生是什么时候来的?

Hú xiānsheng shì shénme shíhou láide?

When did Mr. come?

5.

⻩太太什么时候到?

Huáng tàitai shénme shíhou dào?

When is Mrs. Huāng arriving?

⻩太太是什么时候到的?

Huáng tàitai shì shénme shíhou dàode?

When did Mrs. Huāng arrive?

6.

林太太什么时候走?

Lín tàitai shénme shíhou zǒu?

When is Mrs. Lín leaving?

林太太是什么时候走的?

Lín tàitai shì shénme shíhou zǒude?

When did Mrs. Lín leave?

7.

他/她什么时候来?

Tā shénme shíhou lái?

When is he/she coming?

他/她是什么时候来的?

Tā shì shénme shíhou láide?

When did he/she come?

14.3.12  Transformation drill

Table 14.3.12.1 Respond with a shì...de. sentence when the cue makes it appropriate.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她来。

Tā lái.

He/she is coming.

明天

míngtiān

tomorrow

他/她明天来。

Tā míngtiān lái.

He/she is coming tomorrow.

2.

他/她来了。

Tā lái le.

He/she has come.

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她是昨天来的。

Tā shì zuótiān láide.

He/she has come yesterday.

3.

王太太走。

Wáng tàitai zǒu.

Mrs. Wáng is leaving.

今天

jīntiān

today

王太太今天走。

Wáng tàitai jīntiān zǒu.

Mrs. Wáng is leaving today.

4.

⻩太太走了。

Huáng tàitai zǒu le.

Mrs. Huáng has left.

前天

qiántiān

the day before yesterday

⻩太太是前天走的。

Huáng tàitai shì qiántiān zǒude.

Mrs. Huáng left the day before yesterday.

5.

李先生来。

Lǐ xiānsheng lái.

Mr. is coming.

后天

hòutiān

the day after tomorrow

李先生后天来。

Lǐ xiánsheng hòutiān lái.

Mr. is coming the day after tomorrow.

6.

林先生来了。

Lín xiānsheng lái le.

Mr. Lín has come.

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

林先生是昨天来的。

Lín xiānsheng shì zuótiān láide.

Mr. Lín came yesterday.

7.

⻢小姐到了。

Mǎ xiǎojiě dào le.

Miss has arrived.

前天

qiántiān

the day before yesterday

⻢小姐是前天到的。

Mǎ xiǎojiě shì qiántiān dàode.

Miss has arrived the day before yesterday.

14.3.13  Response drill

Table 14.3.13.1 Give affirmative responses to the questions.
Question Answer
1.

他/她是昨天来的?

Tā shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did he/she come yesterday?

是的。他/她是昨天来的。

Shìde. Tā shì zuótiān láide.

Yes, he/she came yesterday.

2.

王先生是今天到的马?

Wáng xiānsheng shì jīntiān dàode ma?

Did Mr. Wáng arrived today?

是的。王先生是今天到的。

Shìde. Wáng xiānsheng shì jīntiān dàode.

Yes, Mr. Wáng arrived today.

3.

李同志是前天走的马?

Lǐ tóngzhì shì qiántiān zǒude ma?

Did comrade leave the day before yesterday?

是的。李同志是前天走的。

Shìde. Lǐ tóngzhì shì qiántiān zǒude.

Yes, comrade left the day before yesterday.

4.

毛夫人明天来马?

Máo fūren míngtiān lái ma?

Is Mrs. Máo coming tomorrow?

是的。毛夫人明天来。

Shìde. Máo fūren míngtiān lái.

Yes, Mrs. Máo is coming tomorrow.

5.

他们孩子后天到马?

Tāmen háizi hòutiān dào ma?

Are their children arriving the day after tomorrow?

是的。他们孩子后天到。

Shìde. Tāmen háizi hòutian dào.

Yes, their children are arriving the day after tomorrow.

6.

他/她父母今天走马?

Tā fùmǔ jīntiān zǒu ma?

Are his/her parents leaving?

是的。他/她父母今天走。

Shìde. Tā fùmǔ jīntiān zǒu.

Yes, his/her parents are leaving today.

7.

张女士是昨天来的马?

Zhāng nǚshì shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did Mrs. Zhāng come yesterday?

是的。张女士是昨天来的。

Shìde. Zhāng nǚshì shì zuótiān láide.

Yes, Mrs. Zhāng did come yesterday.

14.3.14  Response drill

Table 14.3.14.1 Give negative responses to the shì... de questions.
Question Answer
1.

他/她是昨天来的马?

Tā shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did he/she come yesterday?

不。他/她不是昨天来的。

Bù. Tā bú shì zuótiān láide.

No, he/she didn't come yesterday.

2.

蒋先生是今天道德马?

Jiāng xiānsheng shì jīntiān dàode ma?

Did Mr. Jiāng arrive today?

不。蒋先生不是今天到的。

Bù. Jiāng xiānsheng bú shì jīntiān dàode.

No, Mr. Jiāng didn't arrive today.

3.

张同志是前天走的马?

Zhāng tóngzhì shì qiántiān zǒude ma?

Did Comrade Zhāng leave the day before yesterday?

不。张同志不是前天走的。

Bù. Zháng tóngzhì bú shì qiántian zǒude.

No, Comrade Zhāng didn't leave day before yesterday.

4.

他们是昨天来的马?

Tāmen shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did they come yesterday?

不。他们不是昨天来的。

Bù. Tāmen bú shì zuótiān láide.

No, they didn't come yesterday.

5.

他们孩子是前天到的马?

Tāmen háizi shì qiántiān dàode ma?

Did their children arrive the day before yesterday?

不。他们孩子不是前天到的。

Bù. Tāmen háizi bú shì qiántian dàode.

No, theit children didn't arrive the day before yesterday.

6.

何同志是今天走的马?

Hé tóngzhì shì jīntiān zǒude ma?

Did comrade leave today?

不。何 不是今天走的。

Bù. Hé tóngzhì bú shì jīntiān zǒude.

No, comrade didn't leave today.

7.

他/她爱人是昨天来的马?

Tā àiren shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did his/her spouse come yesterday?

不。他/她爱人不是昨天来的。

Bù. Tā àiren bú shì zuótiān láide.

No, his/her spouse didn't come yesterday.

14.3.15  Response drill

Table 14.3.15.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是昨天来的马?

Tā shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did he/she come yesterday?

affirmative

是的。他/她是昨天来的。

Shìde. Tā shì zuótiān láide.

Yes, he/she came yesterday.

2.

他/她是昨天来的马?

Tā shì zuótiān láide ma?

Did he/she come yesterday?

negative

不。他/她不是昨天来的.

Bù. Tā bú shì zuótiān láide.

No, he/she didn't come yesterday.

3.

王同志是前天到的马?

Wáng tóngzhì shì qiántiān dàode ma?

Did comrade Wáng arrive the day before yesterday?

negative

不。王同志不是前天到的。

Bù. Wáng tóngzhì bú shì qiántiān dàode.

No, comrade Wáng didn't arrive the day before yesterday.

4.

他/她哥哥是今天来的马?

Tā gēge shì jīntiān láide ma?

Did his/her older brother come today?

negative

不。他/她哥哥不是今天来的。

Bù. Tā gēge bú shì jīntiān láide.

No, his/her older brother didn't come today.

5.

李先生是今天走的马?

Lǐ xiānsheng shì jīntiān zǒude ma?

Did Mr. leave today?

negative

不。李先生不是今天走的。

Bù. Lǐ xiānsheng bú shì jīntiān zǒude.

No, Mr. didn't leave today.

6.

赵夫人是昨天到的马?

Zhào fūren shì zuótiān dàode ma?

Did Mrs. Zhào arrive yesterday?

affirmative

是的。赵夫人是昨天到的。

Shìde. Zhào fūren shì zuótiān dàode.

Yes, Mrs. Zhào did arrive yesterday.

7.

他们孩子是前天走的马?

Tāmen háizi shì qiántiān zǒude ma?

Did their children leave the day before yesterday?

negative

不。他们孩子不是前天走的。

Bù. Tāmen háizi bú shì qiántiān zǒude.

No, their children didn't leave the day before yesterday.

8.

孙女士是昨天到的马?

Sūn nǚshì shì zuótiān dàode ma?

Did Mrs. Sūn arrive yesterday?

negative

B不。孙女士不是昨天到的。

Bù. Sūn nǚshì bǔ shì zuótiān dàode.

No, Mrs. Sūn didn't arrive yesterday

15 Unit 5

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Date and Place of birth.

  2. Days of the week.

  3. Ages.

  4. The marker le for new situations.

15.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-1 and P-1 tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes.

  3. The 5D-1 tape.

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Andesen Fūren, nǐ shì zài nǎr shēngde? 安德森夫人,你是在哪儿生的? Mrs. Andersen, where were you born?
B: Wǒ shì zài Dézhōu shēngde. 我是在得州生的。 I was born in Texas.
2. A: Nǐmen shì Xīngqīsì dàode ma? 你们是星期四到的吗? Did you arrive on Thursday?
B: Bú shì, wǒmen shì Xīngqīwǔ dàode. 不是,我们是星期五到的。 No, we arrived on Friday.
3. A: Nǐmen xīngqījǐ zǒu? 你们星期几走? What day of the week are you leaving?
B: Wǒmen Xīngqītiān zǒu. 我们星期天走。 We are leaving on Sunday.
4. A: Nǐ shì něinián shēngde? 你是哪年生的? What year are you born?
B: Wǒ shì Yī jiǔ sān jiǔ nián shēngde. 我是一九三九年生的。 I was born in 1939.
5. A: Nǐ shì jǐyüè shēngde? 你是几月生的? What month were you born?
B: Wǒ shì Qíyüè shēngde. 我是七月生的。 I was born in July.
6. A: Nǐ shì jǐhào shēngde? 你是几号生的? What day of the month were you born?
B: Wǒ shì Sìhào shēngde. 我是四号生的。 I was born on the fourth.
7. A: Nǐ duó dà le? 你多大了? How old are you?
B: Wǒ èr shi sì le. 我二十四了。 I'm 24.
8. A: Nǐ duó dà le? 你多大了? How old are you?
B: Wǒ sān shi wǔ le. 我三十五了。 I'm 35.
9. A: Nǐmen nǚháizi jǐsuì le? 你们女孩子几岁了? How old is your girl?
B: Tā básuì le. 她八岁了。 She's eight years old.
10. A: Nǐmen nánháizi dōu jǐsuì le? 你们男孩子都几岁了? How old are your boys?
B: Yíge jiǔsuì le, yíge liùsuì le. 一个九岁了, 一个六岁了。 One is nine, and one is six.

15.2.2 Vocabulary

duó dà 多大 how old
hòunián (hòunian) 后年 the year after next
jǐhào 几号 what day of the month?
jīnnián (jīnnian) 今年 this year
jǐsuì 几岁 how old
jǐyüè 几月 what month
míngnián (míngnian) 明年 next year
něinián 哪年? which year
niánnián (niánnian) 年年 every year
qiánnián (qiánnian) 前年 the year before last
qǜnián (qǜnian) 去年 last year
shàngge yüè 上个月 last month
shēng to be born
-suì year (of age)
xiàge yüè 下个月 next month
Xīngqīèr 星期二 Tuesday
xīngqījǐ 星期几 what day of the week
Xīngqīliù 星期六 Saturday
Xīngqīsān 星期三 Wednesday
Xīngqīsì 星期四 Thursday
Xīngqītiān 星期日,星期天 Sunday
Xīngqīwǔ 星期五 Friday
Xīngqīyī 星期一 Monday
zheìge yüè 这个月 this month

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Andesen Fūren, nǐ shì zài nǎr shēngde? 安德森夫人,你是在哪儿生的? Mrs. Andersen, where were you born?
B: Wǒ shì zài Dézhōu shēngde. 我是在得州生的。 I was born in Texas.

The shì...de construction is used to focus on place expressions as well as on time and manner expressions.

shi zài Měiguó shēng -de. I was born in America. WHERE
shi zuótiān dào -de. I arrived yesterday. WHEN
shi yíge rén lái -de. I came alone. HOW

15.2.3.2 Notes on №2-3
2. A: Nǐmen shì Xīngqīsì dàode ma? 你们是星期四到的吗? Did you arrive on Thursday?
B: Bú shì, wǒmen shì Xīngqīwǔ dàode. 不是,我们是星期五到的。 No, we arrived on Friday.
3. A: Nǐmen xīngqījǐ zǒu? 你们星期几走? What day of the week are you leaving?
B: Wǒmen Xīngqītiān zǒu. 我们星期天走。 We are leaving on Sunday.

Days of the week:

Xīngqījǐ What day of the week?
Xīngqīyī Monday
Xīngqīèr Tuesday
Xīngqīsàn Wednesday
Xīngqīsì Thursday
Xingqīwǔ Friday
Xīngqīliù Saturday
Xīngqītiān Sunday

Until now, you have always seen , "how many," at the beginning of a word (jǐge háizi, jǐwèi xiānsheng, jǐhào). In xīngqījǐ, -jǐ is at the end of the word. In both places, occupies the position of a number and acts like a number: xīngqījǐ, "What number day of the week?"

15.2.3.3 Notes on №4
4. A: Nǐ shì něinián shēngde? 你是哪年生的? What year are you born?
B: Wǒ shì Yī jiǔ sān jiǔ nián shēngde. 我是一九三九年生的。 I was born in 1939.

The word for "year," -nián is a bound word (like the word for "day," -tiān). The question word něinián, "which year," is formed with the bound word něi "which."

The year is given as a sequence of digits, so that 1972, Yījiǔqīèrnián would literally be "one-nine-seven-two year." In a sequence of digits, the word èr- (not liǎng- is used for 2, and the words for 1, 7, and 8 keep their basic high tones. (See notes on No. 10 for cases in which these tones change.)

15.2.3.4 Notes on №5
5. A: Nǐ shì jǐyüè shēngde? 你是几月生的? What month were you born?
B: Wǒ shì Qíyüè shēngde. 我是七月生的。 I was born in July.

Months:

jǐyüè? What month?
yíyüè January qíyüè July
èryüè February báyüè August
sānyüè March jiǔyüè September
sìyüè April shíyüè October
wǔyüè May shǐyīyüè November
liùyüè June shíèryüè December

Since the names of the months are formed with numbers, jǐ- "how many," is the appropriate question word to use for "what month." Jǐ- is used in Běijīng to ask for a number expected to be around 10 or 11.

Notice the tones on the words for 1, 7 and 8, which most Peking speakers pronounce as Rising before Falling-tone words such as yüè. The syllable -yī- in the word for "November," however, is usually pronounced with the High tone: shíyīyüè (See the notes on No, 10 for a summary of tone changes.)

15.2.3.5 Notes on №6
6. A: Nǐ shì jǐhào shēngde? 你是几号生的? What day of the month were you born?
B: Wǒ shì Sìhào shēngde. 我是四号生的。 I was born on the fourth.

Days of the month are expressed by the number of the day followed by the bound word -haò. You will remember that -hào is also used in giving addresses.

In asking about days of the month, "how many," is used, even though the question may be answered by a number as high as 31. The month and day of the month may be given together. For example:

Nǐ shi jǐyüè jǐhào shēngde? What is your month and day of birth?
Wǒ shi bāyüè jiǔhào shēngde. I was born on August 9.
15.2.3.6 Notes on №7-8
7. A: Nǐ duó dà le? 你多大了? How old are you?
B: Wǒ èr shi sì le. 我二十四了。 I'm 24.
8. A: Nǐ duó dà le? 你多大了? How old are you?
B: Wǒ sān shi wǔ le. 我三十五了。 I'm 35.

Nǐ duō dà le? "How old are you?" literally means "How big (in years of age) are you?" This is a common way to ask a person's age. The question is appropriate for asking the age of a child or a young adult, but the expression is not considered polite enough for asking an older adult his age. (More formal ways to ask a person's age will be introduced on the C-2, P-2, and drill tapes.)

The marker le which ends these sentences calls attention to the fact that something is true now that was not true before.

🛈︎
Note

Ages may also be asked and given without using the new-situation le.

Le has only this new-situation meaning in these sentences. It has no meaning of completion, since in fact, there is no completed event.

One way to reflect the new-situation le in the English translation is to add the word "now": I'm 35 now." Essentially, however, "new situation" (sometimes called change of state") is a Chinese grammatical category with no simple English equivalent.

The marker le for new situations is always found at the end of a sentence and is sometimes called "sentence le."

Notice that neither answer contains a verb. The verb that has been left out is yǒu "to have." The verb may not be left out in the negative: Wǒ méiyou sānshiwǔ. "I’m not 35."

15.2.3.7 Notes on №9
9. A: Nǐmen nǚháizi jǐsuì le? 你们女孩子几岁了? How old is your girl?
B: Tā básuì le. 她八岁了。 She's eight years old.

-suì: In the traditional Chinese system of giving ages, a person is one -sui old at birth and becomes another -suì old on the New Year's following his birth. A baby born the day before New Year's would thus be two -suì old on the day after his birth. Most Chinese, however, have now switched to the Western style of computing age and use -suì just as we use years old.

The word -suì like the word -hào, is a bound word shoving what kind of thing a number is counting.

In a date or address you are listing a number and use èr for 2, while in giving an age you are counting an amount of something and use liǎng: liǎngsuì, "two years old."

15.2.3.8 Notes on №10
10. A: Nǐmen nánháizi dōu jǐsuì le? 你们男孩子都几岁了? How old are your boys?
B: Yíge jiǔsuì le, yíge liùsuì le. 一个九岁了, 一个六岁了。 One is nine, and one is six.

The word dōu is used when "both" or "all" would probably not be used in English, namely, when expecting different information about each of the things (or persons) being discussed. "All" tends to be collective, asking or telling about something the members of a group have in common. Dōu can be distributive, asking or telling something about the members of a group as individuals.

Yí, qí, bá: In the spoken language of Peking, the basic High tones of , and usually change to Rising tones before Falling-tone words (such as -hào, yüè, and -suì). This change is most common when the complete number given has only one digit. When there are two or more digits, the and of numbers ending in 7 and 8 are more likely to have Rising tones than the of numbers ending in 1 (which is usually in the High tone).

Compare:

shíqīhào the 17th
shíyīyüè November

In all cases, the High tone is more likely to be kept in rapid speech. You may also encounter speakers who never make changes in the tones of , and .

Remember that, in the digit-by-digit form of giving the year, the numbers 1, 7, and 8 keep their basic High tones: Yījiǔbāliùnián 1986.

15.2.3.9 Notes on additional required vocabulary
Days qiántiān zuótiān jīntiān mīngtiān hòutiān
Years qiánnián qǜnián jīnnián míngnián hòunián

In the Chinese system of expressing relative time in terms of days and years, only one pair of terms is not parallel: zuótiān "yesterday," and qǜnián "last year."

🛈︎
Note

added by Eric Streit with the explanations given by a Chinese native about the drills I and the use of suìshu 岁数 and Niánjì 年纪

  • suìshu 岁数 and Niánjì 年纪 usually and mostly refer to OLDER people that you ask for. suìshu 岁数 is very spoken though. And less polite.

  • For kids especially, you only need to do 多大了? duó dà le? or 几岁了? jǐsuì le?

  • with 几岁了? neither suìshu 岁数 nor Niánjì 年纪 .

15.3 Drills

15.3.1  Response Drill

Table 15.3.1.1 According to the cues, give an answer to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

请问,他/她是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, tā shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was he/she born?

德州

Dézhōu

Texas

他/她是在德州生的。

Tā shì zài Dézhōu shēngde.

He/she was born in Texas.

2.

请问,你爱人是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ àiren shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was your spouse born?

加州

Jiāzhōu

California

他/她是在加州生的。

Tā shì zài Jiāzhōu shēngde.

He/she was born in California.

3.

请问,他/她爱人是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, tā àiren shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was his/her spouse born?

上海

Shànghǎi

Shànghǎi

他/她是在上海生的。

Tā shì zài Shànghǎi shēngde.

He/she was born in Shànghǎi.

4.

请问,你孩子是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ háizi shì zài nǎr shēnde?

May I ask, where was your child born?

四川

Sìchuān

Sìchuān

他/她是在四川生的。

Tā shì zài Sìchuān shēngde.

He/she was born in Sìchuān

5.

请问,你们女孩子是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, nǐmen nǚháizi shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was your daughter born?

北京

Běijīng

Běijīng

她是在北京生的。

Tā shì zài Běijīng shēngde.

She was born in Běijīng.

6.

请问,你们男孩子是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, nǐmen nánháizi shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was your son born?

我住在马萨诸塞州

mǎsàzhūsāi zhōu (Mázhōu)

Massachusetts

他是在我住在马萨诸塞州生的。

Tā shì zài mǎsàzhūsāi zhōu (Mázhōu) shēngde.

He was born in Massachusetts.

7.

请问,曾先生是在那儿生的?

Qǐngwèn, Zēng xiānsheng shì zài nǎr shēngde?

May I ask, where was Mr. Zēng born?

纽约

Niǔ Yüē

New York

他是在纽约生的。

Tā shì zài Niǔ Yüē shēngde.

He was born in New York.

15.3.2  Substitution drill

Table 15.3.2.1 Transform the question according to the model.
Question Answer Answer
1.

请问,你是什么时候走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ shénme shíhou zǒu?

May I ask, when are you leaving?

哪天

něitiān

what day

请问,你哪天走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ něitiān zǒu?

May I ask, what day are you leaving?

2.

请问,你哪天走?

Qǐngwen, nǐ něitiān zǒu?

May I ask, what day are you leaving?

几月

jǐyüe

what month

请问,你几月走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐyüe zǒu?

May I ask, what month are you leaving?

3.

请问,你几月走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐyüe zǒu?

May I ask, what month are you leaving?

几号

jǐhào

what day of the month

请问,你几号走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐhào zǒu?

May I ask, what day of the month are you leaving?

4.

请问,你几号走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐhào zǒu?

May I ask, what day of the month are you leaving?

哪年

něinián

what year

请问,你哪年走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ něinián zǒu?

May I ask, what year are you leaving?

5.

请问,你哪年走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ něinián zǒu?

May I ask, May I ask, what year are you leaving?

几月几号

jǐyüe jǐhào

what month and what day of the month

请问,你几月几号走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐyüe jǐhào zǒu?

May I ask, what month, what day of the month are you leaving?

6.

请问,你几月几号走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ jǐyüe jǐhào zǒu?

May I ask, what month, what day of the month are you leaving?

星期几

xīngqījǐ

what day of the week

请问,你星期几走?

Qǐngwèn, nǐ xīngqījǐ zǒu?

May I ask, what day of the week are you leaving?

15.3.3  Substitution drill

Table 15.3.3.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

我们星期一走。

Wǒmen xXngqīyǐ zǒu.

We are leaving on Monday.

星期二

Xīngqīèr

Tuesday

我们星期二走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīèr zǒu.

We are leaving on Tuesday.

2.

我们星期二走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīèr zǒu.

We are leaving on Tuesday.

星期三

Xīngqīsān

Wednesday

我们星期三走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīsān zǒu.

We are leaving on Wednesday.

3.

我们星期三走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīsān zǒu.

We are leaving on Wednesday.

星期四

Xīngqīsì

Thursday

我们星期四走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīsì zǒu.

We are leaving on Thursday.

4.

我们星期四走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīsì zǒu.

We are leaving on Thursday.

星期几

Xīngqījǐ

what day of the week

我们星期几走?

Wǒmen Xīngqījǐ zǒu?

What day of the week are we leaving?

5.

我们星期几走?

Wǒmen Xīngqījǐ zǒu?

What day of the week are we leaving?

星期五

Xīngqīwǔ

Friday

我们星期五走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīwǔ xǒu.

We are leaving on Friday.

6.

我们星期五走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīwǔ zǒu.

We are leaving on Friday.

星期天

Xīngqītiān

Sunday

我们星期天走。

Wǒmen Xīngqītiān zǒu.

We are leaving on Sunday.

7.

我们星期天走。

Wǒmen Xīngqītiān zǒu.

We are leaving on Sunday.

星期六

Xīngqīliù

Saturday

我们星期六走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīliù zǒu.

We are leaving on Saturday.

8.

我们星期六走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīliù zǒu.

We are leaving on Saturday.

星期一

Xīngqīyī

Monday

我们星期一走。

Wǒmen Xīngqīyī zǒu.

We are leaving on Monday.

15.3.4  Response drill

Table 15.3.4.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

你孩子是哪天生的?

Nǐ háizi shì něinián shēngde?

What year was your child born?

1971

他/她是一九七一年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔqīyīnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1971.

2.

李先生是哪年生的?

Lǐ xiānsheng shì něinián shēngde?

What year was Mr. born?

1944

他是一九四四年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔsìsìnián shēngde.

He was born in 1944.

3.

你弟弟是哪年生的?

Nǐ dìdi shì něinián shēngde?

What year was your younger brother born?

1940

他是一九四零年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔsìlíngnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1940.

4.

哪个孩子是哪年生的?

Něige háizi shì něinián shēngde?

What year was that child born?

1967

他/她是一九六七年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔliùqīnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1967.

5.

这个男孩子是哪年生的?

Zhèige nánháizi shì něiniān shēngde?

What year was this boy born?

1968

他是一九六八生的。

Tā shì yījiǔliùbānián shēngde.

He was born in 1968.

6.

那个人是哪年生的?

Nèige rén shì něinián shēngde?

What year was that person born?

1927

他/她是一九二七年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔèrqīnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1927.

7.

他/她是哪年生的?

Tā shì něinián shēngde?

What year was he/she born?

1933

他/她是一九三三年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔsānsānnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1933.

15.3.5  Response drill

Table 15.3.5.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是几月生的?

Tā shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was he/she born?

二月

Èryüe

February

他/她是二月生的。

Ta shì Èryüè shēngde.

He/she was born in February.

2.

他/她爱人是几月生的?

Tā àiren shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was his/her spouse born?

五月

Wǔyüè

May

他/她是五月生的。

Tā shì Wǔyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in May.

3.

张同志是几月生的?

Zhāng tóngzhì shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was comrade Zhāng born?

四月

Sìyüè

April

他/她是四月生的。

Tā shì Sìyüè shēngde.

He was born in April.

4.

王同志是几月生的?

Wāng tóngzhì shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was comrade Wāng born?

十一月

Shíyīyüè

November

他/她是十一月生的。

Tā shì Shíyīyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in November.

5.

你爱人是几月生的?

Nǐ àiren shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was your spouse born?

八月

Bāyüè

August

他/她是八月生的。

Tā shì Bāyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in August.

6.

你哥哥是几月生的?

Nǐ gēge shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was your older brother born?

十二月

Shíèryüè

December

他是十二月生的。

Tā shì Shíèryüè shēngde.

He was born in December.

7.

他/她妹妹是几月生的?

Ta mèimei shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was your younger sister born?

六月

Liùyüè

June

她是六月生的。

Tā shì Liùyüè shēngde.

She was born in June.

15.3.6  Expansion drill

Table 15.3.6.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是一月生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

一号

yíhào

first

他/她是一月一号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè yíhào shēngde.

He/she was born in January first.

2.

他/她是一月生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

十一号

shíyīhào

11th

他/她是一月十一号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shíyīhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 11th of January.

3.

他/她是一月生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

二十六号

èrshiliùhào

26th

他/她是一月二十六号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè èrshiliùhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 26th of January.

4.

他/她是一月上的。

Ta shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

七号

qīhào

7th

他/她是一月七号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè qīhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 7th of January.

5.

他/她是一月生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

十四号

shísìhào

14th

他/她是一月十四号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shísìhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 14th of January.

6.

他/她是一月生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

二十八号

èrshibāhào

28th

他/她是一月二十八号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè èrshibāhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 28th of January.

7.

他/她是⼀⽉⽣的。

Tā shì yíyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in January.

十号

shíhào

10th

他/她是一月十号生的。

Tā shì yíyüè shíhào shēngde.

He/she was born on the 10th of January.

15.3.7  Response drill

Table 15.3.7.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

你们女孩子几岁了?

Nǐmen nǚhāizi jǐsuì le?

How old is your daughter?

5

她五岁了。

Ta wǔsuì le.

She is five.

2.

他们男孩子几岁了?

Tāmen nánháizi jǐsuì le?

How old is their boy?

11

他十一岁了。

Tā shíyīsuì le.

He is 11.

3.

胡太太女孩子几岁了?

Hú tàitai nǚháizi jǐsuì le?

How old is Mrs. daughter?

13

她十三岁了。

Tā shísānsuì le.

She is 13.

4.

他/她妹妹几岁了?

Ta mèimei jǐsuì le?

How old is his/her younger sister?

7

她七岁了。

Ta qísuì le.

She is 7.

5.

你男孩子几岁了?

Nǐ nánháizi jǐsuì le?

How old is your boy?

6

他六岁了。

Ta liùsuì le.

He is 6.

6.

你女孩子几岁了?

Nǐ nǚháizi jǐsuì le?

How old is your daughter?

4

她四岁了。

Tā sìsuì le .

She is 4.

7.

那个男孩子几岁了?

Nèige nánháizi jǐsuì le?

How old is that boy?

8

他八岁了。

Tā bāsuì le.

He is 8.

15.3.8  Response drill

Table 15.3.8.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她多大了?

Tā duó dà le?

How old is he/she?

35

他/她三十五了。

Tā sānshiwǔ le.

He/she is 35.

2.

你哥哥多大了?

Nǐ gēge duó dà le?

How old is your older brother?

44

他四十四了。

Tā sìshisì le.

He is 44.

3.

你弟弟多大了?

Nǐ dìdi duó dà le?

How old is your younger brother?

30

他三十了。

Tā sānshi le.

He is 30.

4.

他/她姐姐多大了?

Ta jiějie duó dà le?

How old is his/her older sister?

47

她四十七了。

Tā sìshiqī le.

She is 47.

5.

你妹妹多大了?

Nǐ mèimei duó dà le?

How old is your younger sister?

32

她三十二了。

Tā sānshièr le.

She is 32.

6.

他/她爱人多大了?

Ta àiren duó dà le?

How old is his/her spouse?

28

他/她二十八了。

Tā èrshibā le.

He/she is 28.

7.

王同志多大了?

Wáng tóngzhì duó dà le?

How old is comrade Wáng?

41

他四十一了。

Ta sìshiyī le.

He/she is 41.

15.3.9  Response drill

Table 15.3.9.1 According to the cues, give an affirmative or a negative response to each shì...de question.
Question Cue Answer
1.

您母亲多大岁数了?

Nín mǔqin duó dà suìshu le?

How old is your mother?

65

她六十五岁了。

Tā liùshiwǔsuì le.

She is 65.

2.

您父亲多大岁数了?

Nín fùqin duódà suìshu le?

How old is your father?

67

她六十七岁了。

Tā liùshiqīsuì le.

He is 67.

3.

他/她姐姐多大岁数了?

Tā jiějie duódà suìshu le?

How old is his/her older sister?

46

她四十六岁了。

Tā sìshiliùsuì le.

She is 46.

4.

他/她哥哥多大岁数了?

Tā gēge duó dà suìshu le?

How old is his/her older brother?

44

他四十四岁了。

Tā sìshisìsuì le.

He is 44.

5.

张先生多大 岁数了?

Zhāng xiānsheng duódà suìshu le?

How old is is Mr. Zhāng?

72

他七十二岁了。

Tā qīshièrsuì le.

He is 72.

6.

王太太多大岁数了?

Wáng tàitai duó dà suìshu le?

How old is Mrs. Wáng?

59

她五十九岁了。

Tā wǔshijiǔsuì le.

She is 59.

7.

王太太妹妹多大岁数了?

Wáng tàitai mèimei duó dà suìshu le?

How old is Mrs. Wáng's younger sister?

58

她五十八岁了。

Tā wǔshibāsuì le.

She is 58.

15.3.10  Substitution drill

Table 15.3.10.1 Transform the question according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她是五月来的。

Tā shì wǔyüè láide.

He/she came in May.

哦。他/她山个月来的。

Où. Tā shì shàngge yüè láide.

Oh. He/she came last month.

2.

他/她七月来。

Tā qíyüè lái.

He/she is coming in July.

哦。他/她下个月来。

Où. Tā xiàge yüè lái.

Oh. He/she is coming next month.

3.

他/她六月来。

Tā liùyüè lái.

He/she is coming in June.

哦。他/她这个月来。

Où. Tā zhèige yüè lái.

Oh. He/she is coming this month.

4.

他/她是六月来的。

Tā shì liùyüè láide.

He/she is came in June.

哦。他/她这个月来的。

Où. Tā shì zhèige yüè láide.

Oh. He/she came in June.

6.

他/她是五月到的。

Tā shì wǔyüè dàode.

He/she arrived in May.

哦。他/她是上个月到的。

Où. Tā shì shàngge yüè dàode.

Oh. He/she is arrived last month.

7.

他/她是六月走的。

Tā shì liùyüè zǒude.

He/she left on June.

哦。他/她是这个月走的。

Où. Tā shì zhèige yüè zǒude.

Oh. He/she left this month.

15.3.11  Transformation drill

Table 15.3.11.1 Transform the question according to the model.
Statement Question
1.

他/她是一九三五年生的。

Tā shì yījiǔsānwǔnián shēngde.

He/she was born in 1935.

他/她是哪年生的?

Tā shì něinián shēngde?

What year was he/she born?

2.

他/她是四月来的。

Tā shì sìyüè láide.

He/she came in April.

他/她是几月来的?

Tā shì jǐyüè láide?

What month did he/she come?

3.

他/她是星期五走的。

Tā shì xīngqīwǔ zǒude.

He/she left on Friday.

他/她是星期几走的?

Tā shì xīngqījǐ zǒude?

What day of the week did he/she leave?

4.

他/她是七号到的。

Tā shì qīhào dàode.

He/she has arrived on the seventh.

他/她是几号到的?

Tā shì jǐhào dàode?

What day of the month did he/she arrive?

5.

他/她是一九七四年来的。

Tā shì yījiǔqīsìnián láide.

He/she has come in 1974.

他/她是哪年来的?

Tā shì něinián láide?

What year did he/she came?

6.

他/她是星期天走的。

Tā shì xīngqītiān zǒude.

He/she has left on Sunday.

他/她是星期几走的?

Tā shì xīngqījǐ zǒude?

What day did he/she leave.

7.

他/她是九月生的。

Tā shì jiǔyüè shēngde.

He/she was born in September.

他/她是几月生的?

Tā shì jǐyüè shēngde?

What month was he/she born?

16 Unit 6

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Duration phrases

  2. The marker le for completion.

  3. The "double le" construction.

  4. The marker -guo.

  5. Action verbs.

  6. State verbs.

16.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The 6D-1 tape.

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nǐ zhù duō jiǔ? 你住多久? How long are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù yìnián. 我住一年。 I'm staying one year.
2. A: Nǐ tàitai zhù duō jiǔ? 你太太住多久? How long is your wife staying?
B: Ta zhù liǎngtiān. 她住两天。 She is staying two days.
3. A: Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhù duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住多久? How long is your wife staying in Hong Kong?
B: Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liǎngtiān. 我想她住两天。 I think she is staying two days.
4. A: Nǐ xiǎng zhù duò jiǔ? 你想住多久? How long are you thinking of staying?
B: Wǒ xiǎng zhù yìnián. 我想住一年。 I'm thinking of staying one year.
5. A: Nǐ xiǎng zài Táiwān zhù duō jiǔ? 你想在台湾住多久? How long are you thinking of staying in Taiwan?
B: Wǒ xiǎng zhù báge yüè. 我想住八个月。 I'm thinking of staying eight months.
6. A: Nǐ péngyou xiǎng zhù duō jiǔ? 你朋友想住多久? How long is your friend thinking of staying?
B: Tā xiǎng zhù liǎngge xīngqī. 他想住两个星期。 He is thinking of staying two weeks.
7. A: Nǐ láile duō jiǔ le? 你来了多久了? How long have you been there?
B: Wǒ láile sāntiān le. 我来了三天了。 I have been here three days.
8. A: Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhùle duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住了多久? How long did your wife stay in Hong Kong?
B: Tā zhùle liǎngtiān. 她住了两天。 She stayed two days.
9. A: Tā lái le ma? 他来了吗? Did he come?
B: Lái le, tā lái le. 来了,他来了。 Yes, he came.
10. A: Tā lái le ma? 他来了吗? Did he come?
B: Méi lái, tā méi lái. 没来,他没来。 No, he didn't come.
11. A: Nǐ cóngqián láiguo ma? 你从前来过吗? Have you ever been here before?
B: Wǒ cóngqián méi láiguo. 我从前没来过。 I have never been here before.

16.2.2 Vocabulary

to go
Niǔ Yüē 纽约 New York
cóngqián 从前 in the past
duō jiǔ 多久 how long
-guo —过 experiential marker
xiǎng to think that, to want to, would you like to
Xiānggǎng 香港 Hong Kong
xīngqī 星期 week
zhù to live somewhere

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Nǐ zhù duō jiǔ? 你住多久? How long are you staying?
B: Wǒ zhù yìnián. 我住一年。 I'm staying one year.

Expressions like duō jiǔ, "how long," and yìnián "one year," called duration phrases, come after the verb.

🛈︎
Note

"One day" is yìtiān. The tone on changes to Falling before a High-tone.

Notice the contrast with time-when phrases, like shénme shíhou, "when," and jīnnián "this year," which comes before the verb.

shénme shíhou When are you leaving?
zhù duō jiǔ? How long are you staying?

If a duration phrase is used with the verb zhù, this phrase preempts the position after the verb; and any place phrase, like zài Běijīng, must come before the verb.

zhù zài Běijīng. I'm l living in Běijīng.
zài Běijīng zhù duō jiǔ? How long are you staying in Běijīng?

Yìnián: In telling how many years (giving an amount) no counter is used. The tone on , "one," changes to Falling before a Rising tone.

16.2.3.2 Notes on №2
2. A: Nǐ tàitai zhù duō jiǔ? 你太太住多久? How long is your wife staying?
B: Ta zhù liǎngtiān. 她住两天。 She is staying two days.

Liǎngtiān: -tiān, "day," like -nián, "year," is used without a counter. When telling how many of something, the number 2 takes the form liǎng. (See Unit 3, notes on Nos. 3-4.)

16.2.3.3 Notes on №3-4
3. A: Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhù duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住多久? How long is your wife staying in Hong Kong?
B: Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liǎngtiān. 我想她住两天。 I think she is staying two days.
4. A: Nǐ xiǎng zhù duò jiǔ? 你想住多久? How long are you thinking of staying?
B: Wǒ xiǎng zhù yìnián. 我想住一年。 I'm thinking of staying one year.

The verb xiǎng, "to think that," "to want to," "would like to," may be used as a main verb or as an auxiliary verb. As a main verb it means "to think that." It is used this way in the answer of exchange 3 and in the following examples.

Wǒ xiǎng tā míngtián lái. I think he is coming tomorrow.
Wǒ xiǎng tā bú qù. I think he is not going.

When xiǎng is used as a main verb meaning "to think that," it is not made negative. This may be a special problem for English speakers who are used to saying "I don't think he is going."

In Chinese, it is: "I think he is not going" Wǒ xiǎng tā bú qù.

When xiǎng is used as an auxiliary verb, it means, "to want to," "would like to." It is used this way in exchange 4, which could also be translated as, "How long would you like to stay?"

Here are other examples:

Nǐ xiǎng zǒu ma? Would you like to leave? OR Do you want to go?
Wǒ bù xiǎng zǒu. I don't want to leave.
Nǐ xiǎng zài Táiběi gōngzuò ma?

Do you want to work in Taipei?

16.2.3.4 Notes on №5-6
5. A: Nǐ xiǎng zài Táiwān zhù duō jiǔ? 你想在台湾住多久? How long are you thinking of staying in Taiwan?
B: Wǒ xiǎng zhù báge yüè. 我想住八个月。 I'm thinking of staying eight months.
6. A: Nǐ péngyou xiǎng zhù duō jiǔ? 你朋友想住多久? How long is your friend thinking of staying?
B: Tā xiǎng zhù liǎngge xīngqī. 他想住两个星期。 He is thinking of staying two weeks.

You already know that yìnián and yìtiān are used without counters. The words for "month" and "week," however, are used with counters.

Compare:

sāntiān 3 days
sānnián 3 years
sānge xīngqī 3 weeks
sānge yüè 3 months

16.2.3.5 Notes on №7
7. A: Nǐ láile duō jiǔ le? 你来了多久了? How long have you been there?
B: Wǒ láile sāntiān le. 我来了三天了。 I have been here three days.

le...le, "up until now," "so far": The use of completed-action le after the verb and of new-situation le after the duration phrase tells you how long the activity has been going on and that it is still going on. The answer could also have been translated "I have been here three days so far." This pattern is sometimes called "double le."

Notice that when le is in the middle of a sentence (in this case, because it is followed by a duration phrase), we write it attached to the verb before it: láile duō jiǔ le.

16.2.3.6 Notes on №8
8. A: Nǐ tàitai zài Xiānggǎng zhùle duō jiǔ? 你太太在香港住了多久? How long did your wife stay in Hong Kong?
B: Tā zhùle liǎngtiān. 她住了两天。 She stayed two days.

Completion le: Here you see the marker le used to indicate one aspect, completion. Compare a sentence with one le to a sentence with two le's:

Wǒ zài nàr zhùle sāntiān. I stayed there three days.
Wǒ zài nàr zhùle sāntiān le. I have been here (stayed here) for three days now (so far).

Completion le is used with verbs that describe actions or processes, not with verbs that describe a state or condition, or a continuing situation. The following sentences, describing states or ongoing situations, have past-tense verbs in English but no le in Chinese.

Nèige shíhou tāmen zhǐ yǒu liǎnge háizi. At that time they had only two children.
Tā qǜnián bú zài Shànghǎi, zài Běijīng. He wasn't in Shànghǎi last year; he was in Běijīng.

Verb types in Chinese: In studying some languages, it is important to learn whether a noun is masculine, feminine, or neuter. In Chinese, it is important to learn whether a verb is an action, state, or process verb. These three verb categories are meaning (semantic) groups. A verb is a member of one group or another depending on the meaning of the verb. For instance, "running" and "dancing" are actions; "being good" and "being beautiful" are states; and "getting sick" and "melting" are processes. In Chinese, grammatical rules are applied differently to each semantic verb category. For the most part, you have learned only action and state verbs in this course; so these comments will be confined to those two verb categories. (See Unit 8 of this module for process verbs,)

Action verbs: These are verbs which describe physical and mental activities. The easiest to classify are verbs of movement such as "walking," "running," and "riding", however, action verbs also include verbs with not too much motion, such as "working" and "writing," and verbs with no apparent motion, such as "studying." One test for determining if a verb is an action is asking "What did he do?" "He arrived," "He spoke," and ’"He listened" are answers which contain action verbs. "He knew" "He wanted" and "He is here" are answers which contain state verbs, not action verbs. Some of the action verbs you have learned are:

dào (to arrive) lái (to come)
gōngzuò (to work) zhù (to live, to stay)

State verbs: These verbs describe qualities, conditions, and states. All adjectival verbs, such as hǎo "to be good," and jiǔ, "to be long (in time)," are state verbs. Emotions, such as "being happy" and "being sad," are expressed with state verbs. "Knowing," "liking," "wanting," and "understanding," which may be called mental states, are also expressed with state verbs. Also, all auxiliary verbs, such as xiǎng, "to want to," "would like to," are state verbs. Here are some of the state verbs:

to be large shì to be
duì to be correct jiào to be called
xìng to be surnamed zài to be at
xiǎng to want to zhīdào to know

Aspect and verb types: Not every aspect marker in Chinese may be used with all typs8 of verbs. Completion le does not occur with state verbs. It does occur with action verbs.

ACTION Tā yǐjīng dào le. He has already arrived.
Tā gōngzuòle yìnián. He worked one year.
Tā lái le ma? Did he come?
STATE Tā qǜnián bú zài zhèr. He wasn't here last year.
Tā zuótiān xiǎng qù. Yesterday he wanted to go.
Tā zuótiān bú zhīdào. He didn't know yesterday.

16.2.3.7 Notes on №9-10
9. A: Tā lái le ma? 他来了吗? Did he come?
B: Lái le, tā lái le. 来了,他来了。 Yes, he came.
10. A: Tā lái le ma? 他来了吗? Did he come?
B: Méi lái, tā méi lái. 没来, 他没来。 No, he didn't come.

Compare the two possible interpretations of the question Tā lái le ma? and the answers they receive:

Completion le
lái le ma? Did she come?
lái le. She came.
méi lái She didn't come.
Combined le
lái le ma? Has he come?
lái le. She has come. OR She's here.
hái méi lái. She hasn't come yet.

The first question, with completion le, asks only if the action took place. The second question, with combined le asks both whether the action has been completed and whether the resulting new situation still exists.

16.2.3.8 Notes on №11
11. A: Nǐ cóngqián láiguo ma? 你从前来过吗? Have you ever been here before?
B: Wǒ cóngqián méi láiguo. 我从前没来过。 I have never been here before.

The aspect marker -guo means literally "to pass over," "to cross over. The implication is that an event took place and then ceased at some time in the past.

It may help you to conceptualize -guo in terms of a bridge. The whole bridge is the event. The marker -guo stresses the fact that not only have you crossed over the bridge but at present you are no longer standing on it.

The meaning of -guo changes slightly depending on what type of verb it is used with: action or process, (-guo may not be used with state verbs.) With an action verb, -guo means that the action took place and then ceased at some time before the present. With a process verb, -guo means that the process took place and that the state which resulted from the process ended at some time before the present.

Remember that aspect markers like le and -guo are used only when the speaker feels it necessary to stress some feature or aspect of an event. Le is used to stress finishing, or completion, -guo is used to stress that a situation occurred in the past and was "over or "undone," before the time of speaking (that is, the absence of that situation followed the situation).

Let's contrast -guo with completion le: both le and -guo express completion, but -guo stresses that an action is no longer being performed, or that a state resulting from a process no longer exists.

For example, Tā lái le. means "He came," or "He has come," not indicating whether or not he is still there.

But Tā láiguo means "He came" with the specification that he is not there anymore –that is, he came and left.

One of the uses of the aspect marker -guo,is in sentences which express experience or having experienced something at least once in the past, that is, "to have had the experience of doing something." This is how -guo is used in exchange 11. In a question, the marker -guo can he reflected by the English word "ever," and in a negative statement by "never."

cóngqiān lái -guo ma? Have you ever been (come) here before?
cóngqián méi lái -guo I have never been (come) here before.
cóngqián lái -guo I have been (come) here before

The negative of Tā lái le. does not include a le, but the negative of Tā láiguo. does have a -guo . The negative adverb méi is used to negate both completion le and -guo.

lái le.
méi lái
lái -guo.
Ta méi lái -guo.

16.3 Drills

Table 16.3.1 Respond according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

张先生住多久?

Zhāng xiānsheng zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mr. Zhāng staying?

一个月

yíge yüè

one month

张先生住一个月。

Zhāng xiānsheng zhù yíge yüè.

Mr. Zhāng is staying one month.

2.

王小姐住多久?

Wáng xiǎojiě zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss Wáng staying?

两个星期

liǎngge xīnqī

two weeks

王小姐住两个星期。

Wáng xiǎojiě zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

Miss Wáng is staying two weeks.

3.

胡太太住多久?

Hú tàitai zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mrs. staying?

三个月

sānge yüè

three months

胡太太住三个月。

Hú tàitai zhù sānge yüè.

Mrs. is staying three months.

4.

他/她住多久?

Tā zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is he/she staying?

四个星期

sìge xīngqī

four weeks

他/她住四个星期。

Tā zhù sìge xīngqī.

He/she is staying four weeks.

5.

他太太住多久?

Tā tàitai zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his wife staying?

两个星期

liǎngge xīngqī

two weeks

他太太住两个星期。

Tā tàitai zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

His wife is staying two weeks.

6.

李小姐住多久?

Lǐ xiǎojiě zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss staying?

五个月

wǔge yüè

five months

李小姐住五个月。

Lǐ xiǎojiě zhù wǔge yüè.

Miss is staying five months.

7.

她先生住多久?

Tā xiānsheng zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is her husband staying?

六个星期

liùge xīngqī

six weeks

她先生住六个星期。

Tā xiānsheng zhù liùge xīngqī.

Her husband is staying six weeks.

16.3.1  Response drill

Table 16.3.1.1 Respond according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

张同志住多久?

Zhāng tōngzhi zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Zhāng staying?

三天

sāntiān

three days

张同志住三天。

Zhāng tóngzhì zhù sāntiān.

Comrade Zhāng is staying three days.

2.

他/她母亲住多久?

Tā mǔqin zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her mother staying?

一年

yìnián

one year

他/她母亲住一年。

Tā mǔqin zhù yìnián.

His/her mother is staying one year.

3.

他/她父亲住多久?

Tā fùqin zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her father staying?

五天

wǔtiān

five days

他/她住五天。

Tā fùqin zhù wǔtiān.

His/her father is staying five days.

4.

王同志住多久?

Wáng tóngzhì zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Wáng staying?

八天

bātiān

eight days

王同志住八天。

Wáng tongzhì zhù bātiān.

Comrade Wáng is staying eight days.

5.

李姐姐住多久?

Nǐ jiějie zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is your older sister staying.

两年

liǎngnián

two years

我姐姐住两年。

Wǒ jiějie zhù liǎngnián.

My older sister is staying two years.

6.

胡同志住多久?

Hú tóngzhì zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade staying?

四天

sìtiān

four days

胡同志之四天。

Hú tóngzhì zhù sìtiān.

Comrade is staying four days.

7.

他/她住多久?

Tā zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is How long is he/she staying?

三年

sānnián

three years

他/她住三年。

Tā zhù sānnián.

He/she is staying three years.

16.3.2  Response drill

Table 16.3.2.1 Respond according to the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她母亲住多久?

Tā mǔqin zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her mother staying?

两个月

liǎngge yüè

two months

他/她母亲住两个月。

Tā mǔqin zhù liǎngge yüè.

His/her mother is staying two months.

2.

他/她妹妹住多久?

Tā mèimei zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her younger sister staying?

一个星期

yíge xīngqī

one week

他/她妹妹住一个星期。

Tā mèimei zhù yíge xīngqī.

His/her younger sister is staying one week.

3.

张太太住多久?

Zhāng tàitai zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mrs. Zhāng staying?

九天

jiǔtiān

nine days

张太太住九天。

Zhāng tàitai zhù jiǔtiān.

Mrs. Zhāng is staying nine days.

4.

他/她哥哥住多久?

Tā gēge zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her older brother staying?

四个星期

sìge xīngqī

four weeks

他/她哥哥住四个星期。

Tā gēge zhù sìge xīngqī.

His/her older brother is staying four weeks.

5.

王先生住多久?

Wáng xiānsheng zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mr. Wáng staying?

一个月

yíge yüè

one month

王先生住一个月。

Wáng xiānsheng zhù yíge yüè.

Mr. Wáng is staying one month.

6.

他/她弟弟住多久?

Tā dìdi zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her younger brother staying?

一年

yìnián

one year

他/她弟弟住一年。

Tā dìdi zhù yínián.

His/her younger brother is staying one year.

7.

他/她姐姐住多久?

Tā jiějie zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is his/her older sister staying?

十天

shítiān

ten days

他/她姐姐住十天。

Tā jiějie zhù shítiān.

His/her older sister is staying ten days.

16.3.3  Response drill

Table 16.3.3.1 Expand the respoonse according to the model and the cue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

张太太的哥哥 住多久?

Zhāng tàitaide gēge zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mrs. Zhāng's older brother staying?

香港

xiānggǎng

Hong Kong

张太太的哥哥在香港住多久?

Zhāng tàitaide gēge zài xiānggǎng zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mrs. Zhāng's older brother staying in Hong Kong?

2.

曾小姐的妹妹住多久?

Zēng xiǎojiěde mèimei zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss Zēng's younger sister staying?

中国

Zhōngguó

China

曾小姐的妹妹在中国住多久?

Zēng xiǎojiěde mèimei zài Zhōngguó zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss Zēng's younger sister staying in China?

3.

陈同志的姐姐住多久?

Chén tóngzhìde jiějie zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Chén's older sister staying?

上海

Shānghǎi

Shānghǎi

陈同志的姐姐在上海住多久?

Chén tóngzhìde jiějie zài Shānghǎi zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Chén's older sister staying in Shānghǎi?

4.

钱同志的爱人住多久?

Qián tóngzhìde àiren zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Qián's spouse staying?

美国

Měiguó

America

钱同志的爱人在美国住多久?

Qián tóngzhìde àiren zài Měiguó zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is comrade Qián's spouse staying in America?

5.

曹小姐的父亲住多久?

Cáo xiǎojiěde fùqin zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss Cáo's father staying?

青岛

Qīngdǎo

Qīngdǎo

曹小姐的父亲在青岛住多久?

Cáo xiǎojiě de fùqin zài Qīngdǎo zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Miss Cáo's father staying in Qīngdǎo?

6.

夏先生的母亲住多久?

Xià xiāngshengde mǔqin zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mr. Xià's mother staying?

北京

Běijīng

Běijīng

夏先生的母亲在北京住多久?

Xià xiāngshengde mǔqin zài Běijīng zhù duō jiǔ?

How long is Mr. Xià's mother staying in Běijīng?

16.3.4  Expansion drill

Table 16.3.4.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她几天?

Tā zhù jǐtiān?

How many days is he/she staying?

他/她想住几天?

Tā xiǎng zhù jǐtiān?

How many days is he/she planning on staying?

2.

胡先生住几个月?

Hú xiānsheng zhù jǐge yüè?

How many months is Mr. staying?

胡先生想住几个月?

Hú xiānsheng xiǎng zhù jǐge yüè?

How many months is Mr. planning on staying?

3.

王太太住几个星期?

Wáng tàitai zhù jǐge xīngqī?

How many weeks is Mrs. Wáng staying?

王太太想住几个星期?

Wáng tàitai xiǎng zhù jǐge xīngqī?

How many weeks is Mrs. Wáng planning on staying?

4.

他先生住几年?

Tā xiānsheng zhù jǐnián?

How many years is Mr. staying?

他先生想住几年?

Tā xiānsheng xiǎng zhù jǐnián?

How many years is Mr. planning on staying?

5.

周小姐住几个月?

Zhōu xiǎojiě zhù jǐge yüè?

How many months is Miss Zhōu staying?

周小姐想住几个月?

Zhōu xiǎojiě xiǎng zhù jǐge yüè?

How many months is Miss Zhōu planning on staying?

6.

我父亲住几个星期?

Wǒ fùqin zhù jǐge xīngqī?

How many weeks is my father staying?

我父亲想住几个星期?

Wǒ fùqin xiǎng zhù jǐge xīngqī?

How many weeks is my father planning on staying?

7.

他/她妹妹住几天?

Tā mèimei zhù jǐtiān?

How many days is hi/her younger sister staying?

他/她妹妹想住几天?

Tā mèimei xiǎng zhù jǐtiān?

How many days is hi/her younger sister planning on staying?

16.3.5  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.5.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她住一个星期。

Tā zhù yíge xīngqī.

He/she is staying one week.

我想他/她住一个星期。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù yíge xīngqī.

I think he/she is staying one week.

2.

他/她住两年。

Tā zhù liǎngnián.

He/she is staying two years.

我想他/她住两年。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liǎngnián.

I think he/she is staying two years.

3.

他/她住三个月。

Tā zhù sānge yüè.

He/she is staying three months.

我想他/她住三个月。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù sānge yüè.

I think he/she is staying three months.

4.

他/她住两个星期。

Tā zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

He/she is staying two weeks.

我想他/她住两个星期。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

I think he/she is staying two weeks.

5.

他/她七天。

Tā zhù qītiān.

He/she is staying seven days.

我想他/她住七天。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù qītiān.

I think he/she is staying seven days.

6.

他/她住十年。

Tā zhù sìnián.

He/she is staying four years.

我想他/她住十年。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù sìnián.

I think he/she is staying four years.

7.

他/她六个月。

Tā zhù liùge yüè.

He/she is staying six months.

我想他/她住六个月。

Wǒ xiǎng tā zhù liùge yüè.

I think he/she is staying six months.

16.3.6  Expansion drill

Table 16.3.6.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她住一个星期。

Tā zhù yíge xīngqī.

He/she is staying one week.

他/她住了一个星期。

Tā zhùle yíge xīngqī.

He/she stayed one week.

2.

⻢同志住一年。

Mǎ tóngzhì zhù yìnián.

Comrade is staying one year.

⻢同志住了一年。

Mǎ tóngzhì zhùle yìnián.

Comrade stayed one year.

3.

王同志住四个月。

Wáng tóngzhì zhù sìge yüè.

Comrade Wáng is staying four months.

王同志住了四个月。

Wáng tóngzhì zhùle sìge yüè.

Comrade Wáng stayed four months.

4.

曾同志住五天。

Zēng tóngzhì zhù wǔtiān.

Comrade Zēng is staying five days.

曾同志住了五天。

Zēng tóngzhì zhùle wǔtiān.

Comrade Zēng stayed five days.

5.

我住两个星期。

Wǒ zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

I'm staying two weeks.

我住了两个星期。

Wǒ zhùle liǎngge xīngqī.

I stayed two weeks.

6.

他/她孩子住刘天。

Tā háizi zhù liùtiān.

His/her children are staying six days.

他/她孩子住了刘天。

Tā háizi zhùle liùtian.

His/her children stayed six days.

7.

他/她妹妹住两年。

Tā mèimei zhù liǎngnián.

His/her younger sister is staying two years.

他/她妹妹住了两年。

Tā mèimei zhùle liǎngnián.

His/her younger sister stayed two years.

16.3.7  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.7.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她住了三天。

Tā zhùle sāntiān.

He/she stayed three days

他/她住了三天了。

Tā zhùle sāntiān le.

He/she has stayed three days.

2.

我住了一个星期。

Wǒ zhùle yíge xīngqī.

I stayed one week.

我住了一个星期了。

Wǒ zhùle yíge xīngqī le.

I have stayed one week.

3.

他/她住了两个月。

Tā fùqin zhùle liǎngge yüè.

His/her father stayed two months.

他/她父亲住了两个月了。

Tā fùqin zgùle liǎngge yüè le.

His/her father has stayed two months.

4.

他/她姐姐住了十一天。

Tā jiějie zhùle shíyītiān.

His/her older sister stayed eleven days.

他/她姐姐住了十一天了。

Tā jiějie zhùle shíyītiān le.

His/her older sister has stayed eleven days.

5.

王先生住了一年。。

Wáng xiānsheng zhùle yìnián.

Mr. Wáng stayed one year.

王先生住了一年了。

Wáng xiānsheng zhùle yìnián le.

Mr. Wáng has stayed one year.

6.

王太太住了三个星期。

Wáng tàitai zhùle sānge xīngqī.

Mrs. Wáng stayed three weeks.

王太太住了三个星期了。

Wáng tàitai zhùle sānge xīngqī le.

Mrs. Wáng has stayed three weeks.

7.

胡小姐住了七天。

Hú xiǎojiě zhùle qītiān.

Miss stayed seven days.

胡小姐住了七天了。

Hú xiǎojiě zhùle qītiān le.

Miss has stayed seven days.

16.3.8  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.8.1 Respond by adding xiǎng zhù, or zhùle + duration phrase + le to each statement, according to the clue.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她住一天。

Tā zhù yìtiān.

He/she is staying one day.

还没来

hái měi lái

didn't come yet

他/她想住一天。

Tā xiǎng zhù yìtiān.

He/she is planning on staying one day.

2.

他/她住一天。

Tā zhù yìtiān.

He/she is staying one day.

已经走了

yǐjīng zǒu le

already left

他/她住了一天。

Tā zhùle yìtiān.

He/she stayed one day.

3.

他/她住一天。

Tā zhù yìtiān.

He/she is staying one day.

还在这儿

hái zài zhèr

already here

他/她住了一天了。

Tā zhùle yìtiān le.

He/she has stayed one day.

4.

他/她住两个星期。

Tā zhù liǎngge xīngqī.

He/she is staying two weeks.

已经周了

yǐjīng zǒu le

already left

他/她住了两个星期。

Tā zhùle liǎngge xīngqī.

He/she stayed two weeks.

5.

他/她住三天。

Tā zhù sāntiān.

He/she is staying three days.

还没来

hái méi lái

didn't come yet

他/她想住三天。

Tā xiǎng zhù sāntiān.

He/she is planning of staying three days.

6.

他/她住一年。

Tā zhù yìnián.

He/she is staying one year.

还在这儿

hái zài zhèr

already here

他/她住了一年了。

Tā zhùle yìnián le.

He/she has stayed one year.

7.

他/她住五个星期。

Tā zhù wǔge xīngqī.

He/she is staying five weeks.

已经周了

yǐjīng zǒu le

already left

他/她住了五个星期。

Tā zhùle wǔge xīngqī.

He/she stayed five weeks.

16.3.9  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.9.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她星期一来,星期三走。

Tā xīngqīyī lái, xīngqīsān zǒu.

He/she is coming on Monday, leaving on Wednesday.

他/他想住兩天。

Tā xiǎng zhù liǎngtiān.

He/she is planning on staying two days.

2.

他/她一月来,四月走。

Tā yíyüè lái, sìyüè zǒu.

He/she is coming on January, leaving on April.

他/她想住三个月。

Tā xiǎng zhù sānge yüè.

He/she is planning on staying three months.

3.

他/她五月来,七月走。

Tā wǔyüè lái, qíyüè zǒu.

He/she is coming on May, leaving on September.

他/她想住两个月。

Tā xiǎng zhù liǎngge yüè.

He/she is planning on staying four months.

4.

他/她一号来,六号走。

Tā yíhào lái, liùhào zǒu.

He/she is coming the first of the month, leaving the sixth.

他/她想住五天。

Tā xiǎng zhù wǔtiān.

He/she is planning on staying five days.

5.

他/她六月来,十月走。

Tā liùyüè lái, shíyüè zǒu.

He/she is coming on June, leaving on October.

他/她想住四个月。

Tā xiǎng zhù sìge yüè.

He/she is planning on staying four months.

6.

他/她一九七六年来,一九七八年走。

Tā yījiǔqīliùnián lái, yījiǔqībānián zǒu.

He/she is coming in 1976, leaving in 1978.

他/她想住两年。

Tā xiǎng zhù liǎngnián.

He/she is planning on staying two years.

7.

他/她星期五来,下个星期一走。

Tā xīngqīwǔ lái, xiàge xīngqīyī zǒu.

He/she is coming on Friday, leaving next Monday .

他/她想住三天。

Tā xiǎng zhù sāntiān.

He/she is planning on staying three days.

16.3.10  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.10.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Statement Answer
1.

他/她是二号来的,四号走的。

Tā shì èrhào láide, sìhào zǒude.

He/she came on the second, left on the fourth.

他/她住了年天。

Tā zhùle liǎngtiān.

He/she stayed two days.

2.

他/她是一九七一年来的,一九七四年走的。

Tā shì yǐjiǔqīyīnián láide, yījiǔqīsìnián zǒude.

He/she came in 1971, left in 1974.

他/她住了三年。

Tā zhùle sānnián.

He/she stayed three years.

3.

他/她是三月来的,五月走的。

Tā shì sānyüè láide, wǔyüè zǒude.

He/she came in April , left in May.

他/她住了两个月。

Tā zhùle liǎngge yüè.

He/she stayed two months.

4.

他/她是星期二来的,星期六走的。

Tā shì xīngqīèr láide, xīngqīliù zǒude.

He/she came on Tuesday , left on Saturday.

他/她住了四天。

Tā zhùle sìtiān.

He/she stayed four days.

5.

他/她是九号来的,十一号走的。

Tā shì jiǔhào láide, shíyīhào zǒude.

He/she came on the ninth, left on the eleventh.

他/她住了两天。

Tā zhùle liǎngtiān.

He/she stayed two days.

6.

他/她是昨天来的,今天走的。

Tā shì zuótiān láide, jīntiān zǒude.

He/she came yesterday , left today.

他/她住了一天。

Tā zhùle yìtiān.

He/she stayed one day.

7.

他/她是上个月三十一号来的, 这个月五号走的。

Tā shì shànge yüè sānshiyíhào láide, zhèige yüè wǔhào zǒude.

He/she came the 31st last month, left on the 5th this month.

他/她住了五天。

Tā zhùle wǔtiān.

He/she stayed five days.

16.3.11  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.11.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她明天不来。

Tā míngtiān bù lái.

He/she isn't coming tomorrow.

昨天

zuótiān

yesterday

他/她昨天没来。

Tā zuótiān méi lái.

He/she didn't come yesterday.

2.

他/她后天不走。

Tā hòutiān bú zǒu.

He/she isn't leaving the day after tomorrow.

前天

qiántiān

the day before yesterday

他/她前天美走。

Ta qiántiān méi zǒu.

He/she didn't leave the day before yesterday.

3.

他/她明天不来。

Tā míngtiān bù lái.

He/she isn't coming tomorrow.

去年

qǜnián

last year

他/她去年美来。

Tā qǜnián méi lái.

He/she didn't come last year..

4.

他/她下个月不走。

Tā xiàge yüè bù zǒu.

He/she isn't leaving next month.

上个月

shàngge yüè

last month

他/她上个月美走。

Tā shàngge yüè méi zǒu.

He/she didn't leave last month.

5.

他/她下个星期不来。

Tā xiàge xīngqī bù lái.

He/she isn't coming next week.

上个星期

shàngge xīngqī

last week

他/她上个星期美来。

Tā shàngge xīngqī méi lái.

He/she didn't come last week.

6.

他/她后年不来。

Tā hòunián bù lái.

He/she isn't coming the year after next.

天年

qiánnián

the year before last

他/她天年沒來

Tā qiánnián méi lái.

He/she didn't come the year before last.

7.

他/她今天不走。

Tā jīntiān bú zòu.

He/she isn't leaving today.

今天

jintiān

today

他/她今天美走。

Tā jīntiān méi zǒu.

He/she didn't leave today.

16.3.12  Transformation drill

Table 16.3.12.1 Transform the sentence according to the model.
Question Answer
1.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Did he/she come?

他/她来过吗?

Tā láiguo ma?

Has he/she ever been here?

2.

他/她爱人来了吗?

Tā àiren lái le ma?

Did his/her spouse come?

他/她爱人来过吗?

Tā àiren láiguo ma?

Has his/her spouse ever been here?

3.

他/她母亲来了吗?

Ta mǔqin lái le ma?

Did his/her mother come?

他/她母亲来过吗?

Ta mǔqin láiguo ma?

Has his/her mother ever been here?

4.

胡同志来了吗?

Hú tóngzhì lái le ma?

Did comrade come?

胡同志来过吗?

Hú tóngzhì láiguo ma?

Has comrade ever been here?

5.

他/她弟弟来了吗?

Tā dìdi lái le ma?

Has his/her younger brother come?

他/她弟弟来过吗?

Tā dìdi láiguo ma?

Did his/her younger brother ever been here?

6.

王大年来了吗?

Wáng Dànián lái le ma?

Did Wáng Dànián come?

王大年来过吗?

Wáng Dànián láiguo ma?

Has Wáng Dànián ever been here?

7.

赵同志来了吗?

Zhào tóngzhì lái le ma?

Did comrade Zhào come?

赵同志来过吗?

Zhào tóngzhì láiguo ma?

Has comrade Zhào ever been here?

16.3.13  Response drill

Table 16.3.13.1 Give a negative response to each question.
Question Answer
1.

王小姐来了吗?

Wáng xiǎojiě lái le ma?

Did Miss Wáng come?

王小姐没来。

Wáng xiǎjiě méi lái.

Miss Wáng didn't come.

2.

林先生来了吗?

Lín xiānsheng lái le ma.

Did Mr. Lín come?

林先生没来。

Lín xiānsheng méi lái.

Mr. Lín didn't come.

3.

刘太太来了吗?

Liú tàitai lái le ma?

Did Mrs. Liú come?

刘太太没来。

Liú tàitai méi lái.

Mrs. Liú didn't come.

4.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Did he/she come?

他/她没来。

Tā méi lái.

He/she didn't come.

5.

⻩先生来了吗?

Huáng xiānsheng lái le ma?

Did Mr. Huáng come?

⻩先生没来。

Huāng xiānsheng méi lái.

Mr. Huáng didn't come.

6.

陈小姐来了吗?

Chén xiǎojiě lái le ma?

Did Miss Chén come?

陈小姐没来。

Chén xiǎojiě mái lái.

Miss Chén didn't come.

7.

孙太太来了吗?

Sūn tàitai lái le ma?

Did Mrs. Sūn come?

孙太太没来。

Sūn tàitai méi lái.

Mrs. Sūn didn't come.

17 Unit 7

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. Topics Covered In This Unit

  2. Where someone works.

  3. Where and what someone has studied.

  4. What languages someone can speak.

  5. Auxiliary verbs.

  6. General objects.

17.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes,

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The TD-1 tape.

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nín zài náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài Měiguó Guówùyuàn gōngzuò. 我在美国国务院工作。 I work with the State Department.
2. A: Nín zài náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ shì xüésheng. 我是学生。 I'm a student.
3. A: Nín lái zuò shénme? 您来做什么? What did you come here to do?
B: Wǒ lái niàn shū. 我来念书。 I came here to study.
4. A: Ò, wǒ yě shì xüésheng. 哦,我也是学生。 Oh, I'm a student too.
B: Qǐngwèn, nǐ niàn shénme? 请问,你念什么? May I ask, what are you studying?
B: Wǒ niàn lìshǐ. 我念历史。 I'm studying history.
5. A: Kē xiānsheng, nǐ niàn shénme? 柯先生,你念什么? What are you studying, Mr. Cook?
B: Wǒ zài zhèli xüé zhōngwén. 我在这里学中文。 I'm studying Chinese here.
6. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ xüéguo Yīngwén ma? 请问,你学过英文吗? May I ask, have you ever studied English?
B: Xüéguo 学过。 Yes.
7. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ huì shuō Yīngwén ma? 请问,你会说英文吗? May I ask, can you speak English?
B: Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn. 我会说一点。 I can speak a little.
8. A: Nǐ tàitai yě huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma? 你太太也会说中国话吗? Can your wife speak Chinese too?
B: Bú huì, tā bú huì shuō. 不会,她不会说。 No, she can't.
9. A: Nǐde Zhōngguó huà hěn hǎo. 你的中国话很好。 Your Chinese is very good.
B: Náli, náli. wǒ jiù shuō yìdiǎn. 哪里,哪里。我就说一点。 Not at all, not at all. I can speak only a little.
10. A: Nǐ shì zài náli xüéde? 你是在哪里学的? Where did you study it?
B: Wǒ shì zài Huáshèngdùn xüéde. 我是在华盛顿学的。 I studied it in Washington.
11. A: Nǐ shì zài dàxüé xüéde Yīngwén ma? 你是在大学学的英文吗? Did you study English at college?
B: Shìde, wǒ shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé xüéde Yīngwén. 是的,我是在台湾大学学的英文。 Yes, I studied English at Taiwan University.

17.2.2 Vocabulary

jīngxüé 经学 Confucian classics
Rìwén 日文 Japanese language
wénxüé 文学 literature
zhèngzhixüé 政治学 political science
nán to be difficult
róngyi 容易 to be easy
dàxüé 大学 university
huà language, words
Huáshèngdùn 华盛顿 Washington
huì to know how to, to can
jīngjixüé 经济学 economics
lìshǐ 历史 history
Měiguó Guówùyüàn 美国国务院 U.S. Department of State
nán to be difficult
niàn (shū) 念书 to study
shuō (huà) 说话 to speak, to talk
xüé to study
xüéshēng (xüésheng) 学生 student
xüéxí (xüéxi) 学习 to study, to learn (PRC)
yìdiǎn 一点 a little
Yīngwén 英文 English
Zhōngwén 中文 Chinese
zuò to do
shénme dìfang 什么地方 where, what place

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №1-2
1. A: Nín zài náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ zài Měiguó Guówùyüàn gōngzuò. 我在美国国务院工作。 I work with the State Department.
2. A: Nín zài náli gōngzuò? 您在哪里工作? Where do you work?
B: Wǒ shì xüésheng. 我是学生。 I'm a student.

Zài Měiguó Guówùyüàn gōngzuò means either "work at the State Department" (i.e., at main State in Washington, D,C.) or "work in the organisation of the State Department" (no matter where assigned). Here the expression is translated loosely as "work with the State Department," meaning "in the organization.

17.2.3.2 Notes on №3-4
3. A: Nín lái zuò shénme? 您来做什么? What did you come here to do?
B: Wǒ lái niàn shū. 我来念书。 I came here to study.
4. A: Ò, wǒ yě shì xüésheng. 哦,我也是学生。 Oh, I'm a student too.
B: Qǐngwèn, nǐ niàn shénme? 请问,你念什么? May I ask, what are you studying?
B: Wǒ niàn lìshǐ. 我念历史。 I'm studying history.

Purpose: When lái, "to come," is followed by another verb, the second verb expresses the purpose of the subject's coming. The "purpose of coming" may be emphasized by the shì...de construction, with the marker shì before the verb lái.

Wǒ shì lái nián shūde. I came to study.

Niàn shū: Niàn by itself means "to read aloud." When followed by an object, the expression means "to study." Shū is "book(s)," but niàn shū simply means "to study." Shū is used as a general object, standing for whatever is being studied.

Niàn lìshǐ: When you are talking about studying a particular subject, niàn is followed by the name of that subject rather than by the general object shū.

To have the meaning "to study," niàn must be followed by either the general object shū or a specific object such as the name of a subject.

Verb types: Zuò, "to do," and niàn (shū), "to study," are action verbs. Both are made negative with bu when referring to actions not yet finished Both may take completion le_or its negative méi.

Tā bú niàn shū. He doesn't study.
Tā méi niàn shū. He didn't study.
Tā yǐjǐng niàn shù le. He has already studied.

17.2.3.3 Notes on №5-6
5. A: Kē xiānsheng, nǐ niàn shénme? 柯先生,你念什么? What are you studying, Mr. Cook?
B: Wǒ zài zhèli xüé zhōngwén. 我在这里学中文。 I'm studying Chinese here.
6. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ xüéguo Yīngwén ma? 请问,你学过英文吗? May I ask, have you ever studied English?
B: Xüéguo 学过。 Yes.

Xüé, "to study" an action verb): You will recognize xüé from the word for "student," xüésheng. Xüé may refer to acquiring either knowledge or a skill. For example, you can xüé history, economics, a language, piano, and tennis. On the other hand, niàn is used for "study" in the sense of taking a course or courses in a field of knowledge. Niàn is not used for a skill.

In some contexts, the verb xüé means "to learn." The following sentence may be interpreted two ways, depending on the situation.

Wǒ zài Měiguó yǐjīng xüéguo. I learned it in America.(e.g., how to use chopsticks)
OR

I studied it in America.

(e.g., the Chinese language)

Zhōngwén is used for either the Chinese spoken language or the written language, including literature. In general, use xüé for "learning" to speak Chinese and niàn for "studying’ Chinese literature.

17.2.3.4 Notes on №7-8
7. A: Qǐngwèn, nǐ huì shuō Yīngwén ma? 请问,你会说英文吗? May I ask, can you speak English?
B: Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn. 我会说一点。 I can speak a little.
8. A: Nǐ tàitai yě huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma? 你太太也会说中国话吗? Can tour wife speak Chinese too?
B: Bú huì, tā bú huì shuō. 不会,她不会说。 No, she can't.

Huì, "to know how to," "can," is an auxiliary verb. It is used before the main verb to express an attitude toward the action or to express the potential of action. Xiǎng, "to want to," "would like to," is also an auxiliary verb. "Should," "must," and "may" are other examples of auxiliary verbs. All auxiliary verbs in Chinese are state verbs, which means that is always used to make them negative. Auxiliary verbs never take the aspect marker le for completed action, regardless of whether you are talking about past, present, or future.

Tā qǜnián bú huì shuō Yīngwén. He couldn’t speak English last year.

When the marker le is used, it is the aspect marker for new situations.

Tā qǜnián bú huì shuō Yīngwén, xiànzài huì le,

Last year he couldn’t speak English, but now he can.

Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn, "I can speak a little": The word yìdiǎn, literally "a dot," functions as a noun. It is used in a sentence to mean "a little bit" where a noun object, such as Yīngwén, "English," might be used.

Yìdiǎn may not be used directly after an auxiliary verb, which must be followed by another verb.

Shuō, "to speak," "to talk," is another example of a verb which must always have an object. Shuō must be followed by either:

  1. the general object huà, "words," in which case the meaning of shuō huà is simply "to speak," "to talk," as in:

    Tā hái méi shuō huà. He hasn't yet spoken.

    OR

  2. a specific object such as the name of a language.

Bú huì: The short yes/no answer to a question containing the auxiliary verb huì is formed with huì rather than with the main verb.

Zhōngguó huà: This expression refers only to the spoken language, in contrast to Zhōngwén, which refers to both the spoken and written language.

17.2.3.5 Notes on №9
9. A: Nǐde Zhōngguó huà hěn hǎo. 你的中国话很好。 Your Chinese is very good.
B: Náli, náli. wǒ jiù shuō yìdiǎn. 哪里,哪里。我就说一点。 Not at all, not at all. I can speak only a little.

Literally, náli means "where." As a reply to a compliment, we have translated náli as "not at all." In China, it has traditionally been considered proper and a matter of course to deny any compliment received, no matter how much truth there is to it. Many people still regard xièxie "thank you," as an immodest reply to a compliment, since that would amount to agreeing that the compliment was completely correct.

Jiù, "only": As was noted in Unit 3, notes on Nos. 8-9, jiù meaning "only" is not as widely understood as zhǐ. The last sentence in exchange 9 could Just as well be Wǒ zhǐ huì shuō yìdiǎn.

17.2.3.6 Notes on №10-11
11. A: Nǐ shì zài dàxüé xüéde Yīngwén ma? 你是在大学学的英文吗? Did you study English at college?
B: Shìde, wǒ shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé xüéde Yīngwén. 是的,我是在台湾大学学的英文。 Yes, I studied English at Taiwan University.

In the Peking dialect of Standard Chinese, which is the model for grammatical patterns presented in this course, the -de of a shì...de construction comes between the verb and its object. The object, therefore, is outside the shì...de construction. Compare "I studied here" with "I studied English here":

However, you may hear some Standard Chinese speakers who place the object inside the shì...de construction.

shì zài zhèr xüé -de.
shì zài zhèr xüé -de Yīngwén.

17.3 Drills

17.3.1  Response drill

Table 17.3.1.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

国务院

Guówùyüàn

Department of State

他/她在国务院工作。

Tā zài Guówùyüàn gōngzuò.

He/she works with the Department of State.

2.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

邮政高

yóuzhèngjǘ

post office

他/她在邮政高工作。

Tā zài yóuzhèngjǘ gōngzuò.

He/she works at the post office.

3.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

银行

yínháng

bank

他/她在银行工作。

Tā zài yínháng gōngzuò.

He/she works at the bank.

4.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

武官处

Wǔguānchù

defense attache office

他/她在武官处工作。

Tā zài Wǔguānchù gōngzuò.

He/she works at the defense attache office.

5.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

国宾大饭店

Guóbīn Dàfàndiàn

Ambassador Hotel

他/她在国宾大饭店工作。

Tā zài Guóbín Dàfàndiàn gōngzuò.

He/she works at the Ambassador Hotel.

6.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

北京大饭店

Běijīng Dàfàndiàn

Běijīng Grand Hotel

他/她在北京大饭店工作。

Tā zài Běijīng Dàfàndiàn gōngzuò.

He/she works at the Běijīng Grand Hotel.

7.

他/她在哪里工作?

Tā zài náli gōngzuò?

Where does he/she works?

⺠族饭店

Mínzǔ Fàndiàn

Nationalities Hotel

他/她在族饭店工作。

Tā zài Mínzú Fàndiàn gōngzuò.

He/she works at the Nationalities Hotel.

17.3.2  Expansion drill

Table 17.3.2.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是学生,他/她学中文。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā xüé zhōngwén.

He/she is a student, he/she studies Chinese.

这里

zhèli

here

他/她是学生,他/她在这里学中文。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài zhèli xüé zhōngwén.

He/she is a student, he/she studies Chinese here.

2.

他/她是学生,他/她学中国化。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā xüé zhōngguó huà.

He/she is a student, he/she studies Chinese.

那里

nàli

there

他/她是学生,他/她在那里学中国花。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài nàli xüé zhōngguó huà.

He/she is a student, he/she studies Chinese there.

3.

他/她是学生,他/她念什么?

Tā shì xüésheng, tā nián shénme?

He/she is a student, what does he/she study?

这里

zhèli

here

他/她是学生,他/她在这⾥念什么?

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài zhèli nián shénme?

He/she is a student, what does he/she study here?

4.

他/她是学生,他/她念历史。

Tā shì xǘsheng, tā nián lìshǐ.

He/she is a student, he/she studies history.

哪里

náli?

there?

他/她是学生,他/她在那里念历史?

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài náli nián lìshǐ?

He/she is a student, does he/she study history there?

5.

他/她是学生,他/她念文学。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā nián wénxüé.

He/she is a student, he/she studies literature.

这里

zhèli

here

他/她是学生,他/她这里念文学。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài zhèli nián wénxüé.

He/she is a student, he/she studies literature here.

6.

他/她是学生,他/她学法文。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā xüé fàwén.

He/she is a student, he/she studies French.

那里

nàli

there

他/她是学生,他/她在那里学法文。

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài nàli xüé fàwén.

He/she is a student, he/she studies French there.

7.

他/她是学生,他/她学什么?

Tā shì xüésheng, tā xüé shénme?

He/she is a student, what does he/she study?

这里

zhèli

here

他/她是学生,他/她在这里学什么?

Tā shì xüésheng, tā zài zhèli xüé shénme?

He/she is a student, what does he/she study here?

17.3.3  Response drill

Table 17.3.3.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

请问,他/她念什么?

Qǐngwèn, tā niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is he/she studying?

经济学

jīngjixüé

economics

他/她念经济学。

Tā niàn jīngjixüé.

He/she studies economics.

2.

请问,王⼤年念什么?

Qǐngwèn, Wáng Dànián niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is Wáng Dànián studying?

文学

wénxüé

literature

他念文学。

Tā niàn wénxüé.

He studies literature.

3.

请问,方小姐念什么?

Qǐngwèn, Fāng xiǎojiě niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is Miss Fāng studying?

中国文学

zhōngguó wénxüé

Chinese literature

她念中国文学。

Tā nián zhōngguó wénxüé.

She studies Chinese literature.

4.

请问,他/她妹妹念什么?

Qǐngwèn, tā mèimei niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is his/her younger sister studying?

政治学

zhèngzhixüé

political science

她念政治学。

Tā niàn zhèngzhixüé.

She studies political science.

5.

请问,他/她爱人念什么?

Qǐngwèn, tā àiren niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is his/her spouse studying?

历史

lìshǐ

history

他/她念历史。

Tā niàn lìshǐ.

He/she studies history.

6.

请问,孙蕙然念什么?

Qǐngwèn, Sūn Huìrán niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is Sūn Huìrán studying?

中国历史

zhōngguó lìshǐ

Chinese history

她念中国历史。

Tā niàn Zhōngguó lìshǐ.

She studies Chinese history.

7.

请问,他/她男孩子念什么?

Tā nánháizi niàn shénme?

May I ask, what is his/her boy studying?

经济学

jīngjixüé

economics

他念经济学。

Tā niàn jīngjixüé.

He/she studies economics.

17.3.4  Transformation drill

Table 17.3.4.1 
Question Answer
1.

王先生念历史。

Wáng xiānsheng niàn lìshǐ.

Mr. Wáng is studying history.

王先生来念历史

Wáng xiānsheng lái niàn lìshǐ.

Mr. Wáng is coming to study history.

2.

⻢先生念文学。

Mǎ xiānsheng niàn wénxüé.

Mr. is studying literature.

⻢先生来念文学。

Mǎ xiānsheng lái niàn wénxüé.

Mr. is coming to study literature.

3.

张先生念经济学。

Zhāng xiānsheng niàn jīngjixüé.

Mr. Zhāng is studying economics.

张先生来念经济学。

Zhāng xiānsheng lái niàn jīngjixüé.

Mr. Zhāng is coming to study economics.

4.

李先生念日文。

Lǐ xiānsheng niàn rìwén.

Mr. is studying the Japanese language.

李先生来念日文。

Lǐ xiānsheng lái niàn rìwén.

Mr. is coming to study the Japanese language.

5.

他/她念历史。

Tā niàn lìshǐ.

He/she is studying history.

他/她来念历史。

Tā lái niàn lìshǐ.

He/she is coming to study history.

6.

胡先生念英文。

Hú xiānsheng niàn yīngwén.

Mr. is studying English.

胡先生来念英文。

Hú xiānsheng lái niàn yīngwén.

Mr. is coming to study English.

7.

陈先生念法文。

Chén xiānsheng niàn fàwén.

Mr. Chén is studying French.

陈先生来念法文。

Chén xiānsheng lái niàn fàwén.

Mr. Chén is coming to study French.

17.3.5  Response drill

Table 17.3.5.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

孙同志来做什么?

Sūn tóngzhì lái zuò shénme?

What did comrade Sūn come to do?

工作

gōngzuò

to work

他/她来工作。

Tā lái gōngzuò.

He/she is coming to work.

2.

⻢孙同志来做什么?

Mǎ tóngzhì lái zuò shénme?

What did comrade come to do?

念书

niàn shū

to study

他/她来念书。

Tā lái niàn shū.

He/she is coming to study.

3.

陈孙同志来做什么?

Chén tóngzhì lái zuò shénme?

What did comrade Chén come to do?

学日文

xüé rìwén

to study Japanese

他/她来学日文。

Tā lái xüé rìwén.

He/she is coming to study Japanese.

4.

他/她来做什么?

Tā lái zuò shénme?

What did he/she Chén come to do?

念历史

niàn lìshǐ

to study history

他/她来念历史。

Tā lái niàn lìshǐ.

He/she is coming to study history.

5.

⻩先生来做什么?

Huáng xiānsheng lái zuò shénme?

What did Mr. Huáng come to do?

念政治学

niàn zhèngzhixüé

to study political science

他来念政治学。

Tā lái niàn zhèngzhixüé.

He is coming to study political science.

6.

钱同志来做什么?

Qián tóngzhì lái zuò shénme?

What did comrade Qián come to do?

学英文

xüé yīngwén

to study English

他/她来学英文。

Tā lái xüé yīngwén.

He/she did is coming to study English.

7.

他/她来做什么?

Tā lái zuò shénme?

What did he/she come to do?

工作

gōngzuò

to work

他/她来工作。

Tā lái gōngzuò.

He/she is coming to work.

17.3.6  Response drill

Table 17.3.6.1 
Question Answer
1.

请问,他/她来念书吗?

Qǐngwèn, tā lái niàn shū ma?

May I ask, did he/she come to study?

对了,他/她来念书。

Duì le, tā lái niàn shū.

Yes, he/she came to study.

2.

请问他/她来念中文吗?

Qǐngwèn, tā lái niàn zhōngwén ma?

May I ask, did he/she come to study Chinese?

对了,他/她 来念中文。

Duì le, tā lái niàn zhōngwén.

Yes, he/she came to study Chinese.

3.

请问,他/她来念经济学吗?

Qǐngwèn, tā lái niàn jīngjixüé ma?

May I ask, did he/she come to study economics?

对了,他/她 来念经济学

Duì le, tā lái niàn jīngjixüě.

Yes, he/she came to study economics.

4.

请问他/她妹妹来念英文吗?

Qǐngwèn, tā mèimei lái niàn yīngwén ma?

May I ask, did his/her younger sister come to study English?

对了,她来念英文。

Duì le, tā lái niàn yīngwén.

Yes, she came to study English.

5.

请问,陈先生来念政治学吗?

Qǐngwèn, Chén xiānsheng lái niàn zhèngzhixüé ma?

May I ask, did Mr. Chén come to study political science?

对了,他来念政治学。

Duì le, tā lái niàn zhèngzhixüé.

Yes, he came to study political science.

6.

请问,王先生来学法文吗?

Qǐngwèn, Wáng xiānsheng lái xüé fàwén ma?

May I ask, did Mr. Wáng come to learn French?

对了,他来学法文。

Duì le, tā lái xüé fàwén.

Yes, he came to learn French.

7.

请问,张小姐来学日文吗?

Qǐngwèn, Zhāng xiǎojiě lái xüè rìwén ma?

May I ask, did Miss Zhāng come to learn Japanese?

对了,她来学日文。

Duì le, tā lái xüé rìwén.

Yes, she came to learn Japanese.

17.3.7  Response drill

Table 17.3.7.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她是在大学学的中文吗?

Tā shì zài dàxüé xüéde zhōngwén ma?

Did he/she study Chinese in college?

是的,他/她是在大学学的中文。

Shìde, tā shì zài dàxüé xüéde zhōngwén.

Yes, he/she studied Chinese in college.

2.

他/她是在美国学的中文吗?

Tā shì zài Měiguo xüéde zhōngwén ma?

Did he/she learn Chinese in America?

是的,他/她是在美国学的中文。

Shìde, tā shì zài Měiguó xüéde zhōngwén.

Yes, he/she learned Chinese in America.

3.

他/她是在台湾大学念的英文吗?

Tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde yīngwén ma?

Did he/she study English in Taiwan?

是的,他/她是在台湾大学念的英文。

Shìde, tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde yīngwén.

Yes, he/she studied English in Taiwan.

4.

他/她是在美国念的历史吗?

Tā shì zài Měiguó niànde lìshǐ ma?

Did he/she study history in America?

是的,他/她是在美国念的历史。

Shìde, tā shì zài Měiguó niànde lìshǐ.

Yes, he/she studied history in America.

5.

他/她是在加州念的政治学吗?

Tā shì zài Jiāzhōu niànde zhèngzhixüé ma?

Did he/she study political science in California?

是的,他/她是在加州念的政治学。

Shìde, tā shì zài Jiāzhōu niànde zhèngzhixüé.

Yes, he/she studied political science in California.

6.

他/她是在中国念的中国文学吗?

Tā shì zài zhōngguó niànde zhōngguó wénxüé ma?

Did he/she study Chinese literature in China?

是的,他/她是在中国念的中国文学。

Shìde, tā shì zài Zhōngguó niànde zhōngguó wénxüé.

Yes, he/she studied Chinese literature in China.

7.

他/她是在华盛顿念的经济学吗?

Tā shì zài Huáshèngdùn niànde jīngjixüé ma?

Did he/she study economics in Washington?

是的,他/她是在华盛顿念的经济学。

Shìde, tā shì zài Huáshèngdùn niànde jīngjixüé.

Yes, he/she studied economics in Washington.

🛈︎
Note

All these sentences could be translated with "is coming" instead of "did come".

17.3.8  Response drill

Table 17.3.8.1 Give negative responses to all the questions, and complete your answers according to the cues.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是在中国学的中国话吗?

Tā shì zài zhōngguó xüéde Zhōngguó huà ma?

Did he/she study Chinese in China?

美国

Měiguó

America

不是,他/她是在美国学的中国话。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Měiguó xüéde Zhōngguó huà.

No, he/she studied Chinese in America.

2.

他/她是在美国念的法文吗?

Tā shì zài Měiguó niànde Fàwén ma?

Did he/she study French in America.

加拿大

Jiānádà

Canada

不是,他/她是在加拿大念的法文。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Jiānádà niànde Fàwén.

No, he/she studied French in Canada.

3.

他/她是在台湾大学念的政治学吗?

Tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde zhēngzhixüé ma?

Did he/she study political science in a Taiwan University?

美国大学

Měiguó Dàxüé

American University

不是,他/她是在美国大学念的政治学。

Bú shi, tā shì zài Měiguó Dàxüé niànde zhèngshixüé.

No, he/she studied political science in an American University.

4.

他/她是在英国念的英国文学吗?

Tā shì zài Yīngguó niànde Yīngguó wénxüé ma?

Did he/she study English literature in England?

美国大学

Měiguó Dàxüé

American University

不是,他/她是在美国大学念的英国文学。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Měiguó Dàxüé niànde Yīngguó wénxüé.

No, he/she studied English literature in an American University.

5.

他/她是在加州念的经济学吗?

Tā shì zài Jiāzhōu niànde jīngjixüé ma?

Did he/she study economics in California?

台湾大学

Táiwān Dàxüé

National Taiwan University

不是,他/她是在台湾大学念的经济学。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde jīngjixüé.

No, he/she studied economics in a Taiwan national university.

6.

他/她是在中国念的中国历史吗?

Tā shì zài Zhōngguó niànde Zhōngguó lìshǐ ma?

Did he/she study Chinese history in China?

加州大学

Jiāzhōu Dàxüé

University of California

不是,他/她是在加州大学念的中国历史。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Jiāzhōu Dàxüé niànde Zhōngguó lìshǐ.

No, he/she studied Chinese history in the California university.

7.

他/她是在加拿大念的中文吗?

Tā shì zài Jiānádà niànde Zhōngwén ma?

Did he/she study the Chinese language in Canada?

台湾

Táiwān

Taiwan

不是,他/她是在台湾念的中文。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Táiwān niànde zhōngwén.

No, he/she studied the Chinese language in Taiwan.

17.3.9  Response drill

Table 17.3.9.1 Give negative or affirmative responses to all the questions according to the cues.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她是在华盛顿学的中国话吗?

Tā shì zài Huáshèngdùn xüéde Zhōngguó huà ma?

Did he/she study Chinese in Washington?

华盛顿

Huáshèngdùn

Washington

是的,他/她是在华盛顿学的中国话。

Shìde, tā shì zài Huáshèngdùn xüéde Zhōnggúo huà.

he/she studied Chinese in Washington.

2.

他/她是在台湾大学念的中国历史吗?

Tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde Zhōngguó lìshǐ ma?

Did he/she study Chinese history in Taiwan University?

美国大学

Měiguó Dàxüé

American University

不是,他/她是在美国大学念的中国历史。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Měiguó Dàxüé niànde Zhōngguó lìshǐ.

No, he/she studied Chinese history in an American University.

3.

他/她是在大学学的中文吗?

Tā shì zài dàxüé xüéde Zhōngwén ma?

Did he/she learn Chinese in college?

大学

dàxüé

college

是的,他/她是在大学学的中文。

Shìde, tā shì zài dàxüé xüéde Zhōngwén.

Yes, he/she learned Chinese in college.

4.

他/她是在台湾大学念的中国文学吗?

Tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde Zhōngguó wénxüé ma?

Did he/she study Chinese literature in National Taiwan University?

加州大学

Jiāzhōu Dàxüé

University of California

不是,他/她是在加州大学念的中国文学。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Jiāzhōu Dàxüé niànde Zhōngguó wénxüé.

No, he/she studied Chinese literature in the University of California.

5.

他/她是在美国大学念的文学吗?

Tā shì zài Měiguó Dàxüé niànde wénxüé ma?

Did he/she study literature in the American University?

美国大学

Měiguó Dàxüé

American University

是的,他/她是在美国大学念的文学。

Shìde, tā shì zài Měiguó Dàxüé niànde wénxüé.

Yes, he/she studied literature in the University of America.

6.

他/她是在加州念的政治学吗?

Tā shì zài Jiāzhōu Dàxüé niànde zhèngzhixüé ma?

Did he/she study political science in a University of California?

台湾大学

Táiwān Dàxüé

Taiwan University

不是,他/她是在台湾大学念的政治学。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Táiwān Dàxüé niànde shèngzhixüé.

No, he/she studied political science in Taiwan University.

7.

他/她是在法国念的法文吗?

Tā shì zài Fàguó niànde Fàwén ma?

Did he/she study French in France?

美国

Měiguó

America

不是,他/她是在美国念的法文。

Bú shì, tā shì zài Měiguó niànde Fàwén.

No, he/she studied French in University of America.

17.3.10  Substitution drill

Table 17.3.10.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

你会说英文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Yīngwén ma?

Can you speak English?

德文

Déwén

German

你会说德文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Déwén ma?

Can you speak German?

2.

你会说德文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Déwén ma?

Can you speak German?

日文

Rìwén

Japanese

你会说日文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Rìwén ma?

Can you speak Japanese?

3.

你会说日文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Rìwén ma?

Can you speak Japanese?

法文

Fàwén

French

你会说法文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Fàwén ma?

Can you speak French?

4.

你会说法文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Fàwén ma?

Can you speak French?

中国话

Zhōngguó huà

Chinese (language)

你会说中国话吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma?

Can you speak Chinese?

5.

你会说中国话吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma?

Can you speak Chinese?

德国花

Déguó huà

German (language)

你会说德 国花吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Déguó huà ma?

Can you speak German?

6.

你会说的国花吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Déguó ma?

Can you speak German?

俄国花

èguó huà

Russian (language)

你会说俄国花吗?

Nǐ huì shuō èguó huà ma?

Can you speak Russian?

17.3.11  Combination drill

Table 17.3.11.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

我学中文。

Wǒ xüé Zhōngwén.

I'm studying Chinese.

日文

Rìwén

Japanese

我学中文,我也学日文。

Wǒ xüé Zhōngwén, wǒ yě xüé Rìwén.

I'm studying Chinese, and I'm studying Japanese too.

2.

我学法文。

Wǒ xüé Fàwén.

I'm studying French.

他/她

he/she

我学中文,他/她也学中文。

Wǒ xüé Zhōngwén, tā yě xüé Zhōngwén.

I'm studying French, and he/she is studying Chinese too.

3.

他/她学法文。

Tā xüé Fàwén.

He/she is studying French.

德文

Déwén

German

他/她学法文,他/她也学德文。

Tā xüé Fàwén, tā yě xüé Déwén.

He/she is studying French, and he/she is studying German too.

4.

我学法文。

Wǒ xüé Fàwén.

I'm studying French.

他/她

he/she

我学法文,他/她也学法文。

Wǒ xüé Fàwén, tā yě xüé Fàwén.

I'm studying French, and he/she is studying French too.

5.

我学政治学。

Wǒ xüé zhèngzhixüé.

I'm studying political science.

他/她

he/she

我学政治学,他/她也学政治学。

Wǒ xüé zhèngzhixüé, tā yě xüé zhèngzhixüé.

I'm studying political science, and he/she is studying political science too.

6.

我学政治学。

Wǒ xüé zhèngzhixüé.

I'm studying political science.

经济学

jīngjixüé

economics

我学政治学,我也学经济学。

Wǒ xüé zhèngzhixüé, wǒ yě xüé jīngjixüé.

I'm studying political science, and I'm studying economics too.

7.

我学文学。

Wǒ xüé wénxüé.

I'm studying literature.

历史

lìshǐ

history

我学文学,我也学历史。

Wǒ xüé wénxüé, wǒ yě xüé lìshǐ.

I'm studying literature, and I'm studying history too.

17.3.12  Combination drill

Table 17.3.12.1 
Question Answer
1.

林先生在华盛顿。他学过法文。

Lín xiāngsheng zài Huáshèngdùn. Tā xüéguo Fàwén.

Mr. Lín was in Washington. He studied French.

林先生在华盛顿学过法文。

Lín xiānsheng zài Huáshèngdùn xüéguo Fàwén.

Mr. Lín studied French in Washington.

2.

⻩小姐在美国。她念过政治学。

Huáng xiǎojiě zài Měiguó. Tā niànguo zhèngzhixüé.

Miss Huáng was in America. She studied political science.

⻩小姐在美国念过政治学。

Huáng xiǎojiě zài Měiguó niànguo zhènghixüé.

Miss Huáng studied political science in America.

3.

刘太太在加州大学。她念过经济学。

Liú tàitai zài Jiāzhōu Dàxüé. Tā niànguo jīngjixüé.

Mrs. Liú was in the University of California. She studied economics.

刘太太在加州大学念过经济学。

Liú tàitai zài Jiāzhōu Dàxüé niànguo jīngjixüé.

Mrs. Liú studied economics in the University of California.

4.

宋先生在美国。他念过历史。

Sòng xiānsheng zài Měiguó. Tā niànguo lìshǐ.

Mr. Sòng was in America. He studied history.

宋先生在美国念过历史。

Sòng xiānsheng zài Měiguó niànguo lìshǐ.

Mr. Sòng studied history in America.

5.

他/她在北京。他/她学过中文。

Ta zài Běijīng. Tā xüéguo Zhōngwén.

He/she was in Běijīng. He/she learned Chinese.

他/她在北京学过中文。

Tā zài Běijīng xüéguo zhōngwén.

He/she learned Chinese in Běijīng.

6.

孙小姐在加拿大他念英国文学。

Sūn xiǎojiě zài Jiānádà. Tā niànguo Yīngguó wénxüé.

Miss Sūn was in Canada. She studied English.

孙小姐在加拿大念过英国文学。

Sūn xiǎojiě zài Jiānádà niànguo Yīngguó wénxüé.

Miss Sūn studied English in Canada.

7.

他/她在中国。他/她念过中国文学。

Tā zài Zhōngguó. Tā niànguo Zhōngguó wénxüé.

He/she was in China. He/she studied Chinese literature.

他/她在中国念过中国文学。

Tā zài Zhōngguó niànguo Zhōngguó wénxüé.

He/she studied Chinese literature in China.

17.3.13  Response drill

Table 17.3.13.1  Give an affirmative or a negative response to each question, according to the cues.
Question Cue Answer
1.

你会说英文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Yīngwén ma?

Can you speak English?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

我会说一点。

Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn.

I can speak a little.

2.

你会说英文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Yīngwén ma?

Can you speak English?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

我不会说。

Wǒ bú huì shuō.

I can't speak it.

3.

你会说中文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Zhōngwén ma?

Can you speak Chinese?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

我会说一点。

Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn.

I can speak Chinese a little.

4.

他/她会说德文吗?

Tā huì shuō Déwén ma?

Can he/she speak German?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

他/她不会说。

Tā bú huì shuō.

He cannot speak it.

5.

你会说日文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Rìwén ma?

Can you speak Japanese?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

我会说一点。

Wǒ huì shuō yìdiǎn.

I can speak Japanese a little.

6.

他/她会说英国话吗?

Tā huì shuō Yīngguó huà ma?

Can he/she speak English?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

他/她会说一点。

Tā huì shuō yìdiǎn.

He/she can speak a little.

7.

你会说法文吗?

Nǐ huì shuō Fàwén ma?

Can you speak French?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

我不会说。

Wǒ bú huì shuō.

I cannot speak it.

17.3.14  Response drill

Table 17.3.14.1  Give an affirmative or a negative response to each question, according to the cues.
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她会说中国话吗?

Tā huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma?

Can he/she speak Chinese?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

会,他/她会说中国话。

Huì, tā huì shuō Zhōngguó huà.

Yes, he/she can speak Chinese.

2.

他/她会说中国吗?

Tā huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma?

Can he/she speak Chinese?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

不会,他/她会说中国话。

Bú huì, tā bú huì shuō Zhōngguó huà.

No, he/she cannot speak Chinese.

3.

他/她爱人会说法文吗?

Tā àiren huì shuō Fàwén ma?

Can his/her spouse speak French?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

会,他/她爱人会说法文。

Huì, tā airen huì shuō Fàwén.

Yes, his/her spouse can speak French.

4.

他/她父亲会说日文吗?

Tā fùqin huì shuō Rìwén ma?

Can his/her father speak Japanese?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

不会,他父亲不会说日文。

Bú huì, tā fùqin bú huì shuō Rìwén.

No, his/her father cannot speak Japanese.

5.

李同志会说德文吗?

Lǐ tóngzhì huì shuō Déwén ma?

Can comrade speak German?

没学过

méi xüéguo

haven't studied

不会,李同志不会说德文。

Bú huì, Lǐ tóngzhì bú huì shuō Déwén.

No, comrade cannot speak German.

6.

王同志会说英文吗?

Wáng tóngzhì huì shuō Yīngwén ma?

Can comrade Wáng speak English?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

会,王同志会说英文。

Huì, Wáng tóngzhì huì shuō Yīngwén.

Yes, comrade Wáng can speak English.

7.

陈同志会说法文吗?

Chén tóngzhì huì shuō Fàwén ma?

Can comrade Chén speak French?

学过

xüéguo

have studied

会,陈同志会说法文。

Huì, Chén tóngzhì huì shuō Fàwén.

Yes, comrade Chén can speak French.

18 Unit 8

18.1 Introduction

18.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

  1. More on duration phrases.

  2. The marker le for new situations in negative sentences.

  3. Military titles and 'branches of service,

  4. The marker ne.

  5. Process verbs.

18.1.2 Material you will need

  1. The C-l and P-l tapes, the Reference List and Reference Notes.

  2. The C-2 and P-2 tapes, the Workbook.

  3. The 8D-1 tape.

18.2 References

18.2.1 Reference List

1. A: Nǐ jīntiān hái yǒu kè ma? 你今天还有课吗? Do you have any more classes today?
B: Měiyou kè le. 没有课了。 I don't have any more classes.
2. A: Nǐ cóngqián niàn Yīngwén niànle duō jiǔ? 你从前念英文念了多久? How long did you study English?
B: Wǒ niàn Yīngwén niànle liùnián. 我念英文念了六年。 I studied English for six years.
3. A: Nǐ xiànzài niàn shénme ne? 你现在念什么呢? What are you studying now?
B: Wǒ niàn Fàwén ne. 我念法文 I'm studying French.
4. A: Nǐ niàn Fàwén niànle duō jiǔ le? 你念法文念了多久了? How long have you studying French?
B: Wǒ niànle yìnián le. 我念了一年了。 I've have been studying it for one year.
5. A: Nǐ huì xiě Zhōngguo zì ma? 你会写中国字吗? Can you write Chinese characters?
B: Huì yìdiǎn. 会一点。 I can a little.
6. A: Qùnián wǒ hái bú huì xiě. 去年我还不会写。 Last year, I couldn't write them.
B: Xiànzài wǒ huì xiě yìdiǎn le. 现在我会写一点了。 Now, I can write a little.
7. A: Nǐ fùqin shi jǖnrén ma? 你父亲是军人吗? Is your father a military man?
B: Shì, tā shi hǎijǖn jǖnguān. 是,他是海军军官。 Yes, he is a naval officer.
8. A: Wǒ jīntiān bù lái le. 我今天不来了。 I'm not coming today.
B: Wǒ bìng le. 我病了。 I'm sick.
9. A: Jīntiān hǎo le méiyou? 今天好了没有? Are you better today? (Are you recovered?)
B: Jīntiān hǎo le. 今天好了。 Today I'm better.

18.2.2 Vocabulary

kōngjǖn 空军 Air Force
lùjǖn 陆军 army
shìbīng 事兵 enlisted man
zuò shì 做事 to work
Déwén 德文 German language
bìng to become ill
Déwén 德文 German language
Fàwén 法文 French language
hǎijǖn 海军 navy
jǖnguān 军官 military officer
jǖnrén 军人 military person
class
xiě to write
character

18.2.3 Reference Notes

18.2.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Nǐ jīntiān hái yǒu kè ma? 你今天还有课吗? Do you have any more classes today?
B: Měiyou kè le. 没有课了。 I don't have any more classes.

Hái, "additionally," "also": You have already learned the word hái used as an adverb meaning "still." In this exchange you learn a second way to use hái.

Nǐ hái xiǎng zǒu ma? Do you still want to leave?
Nǐ hái yào xüé shénme? What else do you want to study?

Méi you...le: You will remember that in the negative of a completed action, méi or méiyou replaces the completion marker le is never used together with it.

lái le. He came.
méi(you) lái. He did not come.

In the sentence Méi you kè le, le is a new-situation marker, and méiyou is simply the negative of the full verb yǒu. (Remember that the verb yǒu is always made negative with méi, never with .)

yǒu kè le. Now he has class. [Due to a change in the schedule, he now has class at this time.]
méi- yǒu kè le. He doesn't have any more classes.

Bù...le/méiyou...le: When the marker le for new situations is used with a negative verb, there are two possible meanings:

  1. one is that something that was supposed to happen is now not going to happen.

  2. the other is that something that was happening is not happening anymore.

Thus the following sentence is ambiguous:

Tā bù lái le.

He is not coining now. [Either he was expected to come but changed his mind, or he used to come at this time but now has stopped.]

In the context of a conversation, the meaning of the sentence would become clear.

Here are more-examples with the "anymore" meaning:

Tā bú niàn shū le. He is not going to study anymore.[He will no longer attend college.]
Tā bú shi wǒde péngyou le. He is not my friend anymore.
Méi you le. There is no more.

18.2.3.2 Notes on №2
2. A: Nǐ cóngqián niàn Yīngwén niànle duō jiǔ? 你从前念英文念了多久? How long did you study English?
B: Wǒ niàn Yīngwén niànle liǔnián. 我念英文念了六年。 I studied English for six years.

More on duration: In Unit 6 of this module, you learned to express duration in a sentence with no object (Wǒ zài Xiāngǎng zhùle liùge yüè le. ). In this unit, you learn one way to express the duration of an activity which involves using both a verb and an object (e.g. , "studying economics"). In such cases, the verb appears twice in the sentence: first when the object is stated, and again when the duration is stated.

Tā niàn jīngjixüé, niánle yìnián. He studied economics for one year.
Tā xüé Zhōngguo huà, xüéle sānge yüè le.

He has been studying Chinese for three months.

Notice that aspect markers do not occur after the first verb in each sentence, but only after the second verb and at the end of the second sentence.

18.2.3.3 Notes on №3
3. A: Nǐ xiànzài niàn shénme ne? 你现在念什么呢? What are you studying now?
B: Wǒ niàn Fàwén ne. 我念法文 I'm studying French.

Ne is an aspect marker used to emphasize the fact that something is in progress. With action verbs, ne indicates that the action is going on.

With state verbs, ne shows that the state exists. With some process verbs, ne indicates that the process is going on. Ne may not be used with certain process verbs. (See also notes on No. 8, about verbs.)

18.2.3.4 Notes on №4-5
4. A: Nǐ niàn Fàwén niànle duō jiǔ le? 你念法文念了多久了? How long have you studying French?
B: Wǒ niànle yìnián le. 我念了一年了。 I've have been studying it for one year.
5. A: Nǐ huì xiě Zhōngguo zì ma? 你会写中国字吗? Can you write Chinese characters?
B: Huì yìdiǎn. 会一点。 I can a little.

Xiě Zhōngguo zì: The verb xiě, "to write" can occur with specific objects, such as Zhōngguo zì, as well as with the general object . The combination xiě zìcan mean either "to write characters" or simply "to write."

Tā xiǎng xüé Zhōngguo zì. He wants to learn to write Chinese characters.
Xiǎo dìdi sìsuì le, yǐjīng huì xiě zì le. Little younger brother is four years old and already can write.

In the reply huì yìdiǎn, huì is used as a main verb—not as an auxiliary verb, as in the question.

As a main verb, huì means "to have the skill of," "to have the knowledge of," "to know."

Wǒ huì Yīngwén. I know English.

18.2.3.5 Notes on №6
6. A: Qùnián wǒ hái bú huì xiě. 去年我还不会写。 Last year, I couldn't write them.
B: Xiànzài wǒ huì xiě yìdiǎn le. 现在我会写一点了。 Now, I can write a little.

Qùnián wǒ hái bú huì xiě.: Notice that here it is the auxiliary verb huì, not the verb xiě, that is made negative. Auxiliary verbs such as huì and xiǎng are STATE verbs and so are made negative with the prefix , regardless of whether the context is past, present, or future.

Xiànzài wǒ huì xiě yìdiǎn le.: The marker used is le for new situations. It is always placed at the end of a sentence.

The time word xiànzài comes at the beginning of the sentence here. Most time words of more than one syllable may come either before or after the subject, but in either case before the verb.

18.2.3.6 Notes on №7-8
7. A: Nǐ fùqin shi jǖnrén ma? 你父亲是军人吗? Is your father a military man?
B: Shì, tā shi hǎijǖn jǖnguān. 是,他是海军陆军。 Yes, he is a naval officer.
8. A: Wǒ jīntiān bù lái le. 我今天不来了。 I'm not coming today.
B: Wǒ bìng le. 我病了。 I'm sick.

The verb bìng, "to get sick," "to become ill," is a process verb; that is the activity described includes some changes in the situation. Process verbs tell of an action which has caused a change from one state to another, as from whole to broken ("to break") and from frozen to melted ("to melt"). Bìng is typical of process verbs: not only is an action described (coming down with an illness) but also a resulting state (being ill). Because of this typical combination, process verbs are sometimes thought of as combining the semantic characteristics of action and state verbs.

One of the main purposes of talking about verbs in terms of action, state, and process is to draw attention to the fact that the Chinese way of expressing something may not correspond to the English.

For instance,

"I am sick" in Chinese is Wǒ bìng le. ("I have gotten sick"). For "I am not sick," you say Wǒ méi bìng. ("I didn't get sick").

Process verbs are always made negative with méi regardless of whether you are referring to past, present, or future.

Nǐ bìng le méiyou? Are you sick?
Méi you. Wǒ méi bing. No. I'm not sick.

(State verbs are always made negative with .)

Another reason for putting verbs into categories according to the type of meaning is to discover how verbs behave in sentences. Knowing whether a verb is in the action, state, or process category, you will know what aspect markers and negatives may be used with that verb. In the following charts, a check mark means that this combination of verb and aspect occurs in the language.

Aspect Markers
Completion le Combined le New-situation
Verbs Action X X X
State X
Process X X X

Examples:8

Action Tā zuótiān gōngzuò le. He worked yesterday. (completion le)
Tā yǐjīng lái le. He has already come. (combined le)
Gēge xiànzài niàn dàxüé le. Older brother goes to college now. (new-situation le)a
State Tā xiànzài huì xiě zì le. He can write now. (new-situation le)
Process Tā zuótiān bìng le. He got sick yesterday. (completion le)
Tā xiànzài bìng le. He is sick.(combined le)
Tā bìngle yíge yüé le. He has been sick for one month now. (new-situation le and completion le)
a

In affirmative sentences containing action verbs, the marker le for new situations is used to describe a change in a general habit.

Verbs
Action State Process
Negation X X
—negation of completion le X X
—negation of combined le X X

Examples:

Action Tā bú niàn shū. He doesn’t (isn't going to) study
Tā méi niàn shū. He didn't study.
Tā hái méi niàn shū. He hasn’t studied yet,
State Tā qǜnián bù xiǎng niàn shū. Last year, she didn't want to study.
Process Tā jīntiān méi bìng. He is not sick today.
Tā hái méi hǎo. He hasn't yet recovered.

Notice that only action verbs use the whole range of negatives to mark the negative of future or present action, completed action, or new situations. State verbs use the negative prefix even when referring to past states. Process verbs use the negative prefix méi even when referring to something in the present.

If you find a verb occurring with a negative or an aspect marker you had not expected, you might discuss with your teacher how the verb behaves in terms of these charts. You might discover that what you thought was a state verb is actually a process verb, or vice versa.

18.2.3.7 Notes on №9
9. A: Jīntiān hǎo le méiyou? 今天好了没有? Are you better today? (Are you recovered?)
B: Jīntiān hǎo le. 今天好了。 Today I'm better.

Jīntiān hǎo le.: Hǎo is one of many state verbs which can become process verbs. When such a verb becomes a process verb, it takes on a different meaning. While the state verb hǎo means "to be good" or "to be well," the process verb hǎo means "to get better," "to recover." Compare these sentences:

Tā hǎo. He's in good health.
Tā zuótiān bìng le. Tā jīntiān yǐjīng hǎo le. Yesterday he became sick. Today he is already recovered.

The difference between the state verb hǎo and the process verb hǎo is even more evident in negative sentences. State verbs, as you remember, are made negative only with . Process verbs are made negative only with méi or hái méi.

Tā bù hǎo.

He's not good. [He’s not a good person.]

Tā hái méi hǎo.

He hasn't yet recovered. [He is still sick.]

It can be difficult to remember that bìng and hǎo, sometimes translated as "to be sick" and "to be better," are actually process verbs in Chinese, not state verbs.

The English sentence "I am better (recovered)" translates as Wǒ hǎo le. ("I have become well") and would be incorrect without the le.

Jīntiān hǎo le méiyou? Questions may be formed from statements containing completion le or combined le by adding méiyou at the end of the statements.

You will learn more about forming questions in the first unit of the next module.

Tā láile méiyou? Did he come?
Nǐ hǎole méiyou?

Are you recovered (from your illness)?

18.3 Drills

18.3.1  Response drill

Table 18.3.1.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她今天还有课吗?

Tā jīntiān hái yǒu kè ma?

Does he have any more class today?

他/她没有课了。

Tā méiyou kè le.

He doesn't have any more classes.

2.

他/她今天还来吗?

Tā jīntiān hái lái ma?

Is he/she still coming today?

他/她不来了。

Tā bù lái le.

He/she is not coming.

3.

他/她现在还会说中国话吗?

Tā xiànzài hái huì shuō Zhōngguó huà ma?

Does he/she still speak Chinese now?

他/她不会说中国话了。

Tā bú huì shuō Zhōngguò huà le.

He/she can't speak Chinese anymore.

4.

他/她现在还有中国书吗?

Tā xiànzài hái yǒu Zhōngguó shū ma?

Does he/she still have Chinese books now?

他/她没有中国书了。

Tā méiyou Zhōngguó shū le.

He/she has no more Chinese books anymore.

5.

他/她还念历史吗?

Tā hái niàn lìshǐ ma?

Does he/she still study history?

他/她不念历史了。

Tā bú niàn lìshǐ le.

He/she doesn't study history anymore.

6.

他/她现在还在空军工作吗?

Tā xiànzài hái zài kōngjǖn gōngzuò ma?

Is he/she still working in the Air Force?

他/她不在空军工作。

Tā bú zài kōngjǖn gōngzuò.

He/she does not work in the Air Force anymore.

7.

他/她现在还想走吗?

Tā xiànzài hái xiǎng zǒu ma?

Does he/she still want to leave now?

他/她不想走了。

Tā bù xiǎng zǒu le.

He/she doesn't want to go anymore.

18.3.2  Expansion drill

Table 18.3.2.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她从前念历史。

Tā cóngqián niàn lìshǐ.

He/she formerly studied history.

他/她从前念历史,现在不念了。

Tā cóngqián niàn lìshǐ, xiànzài bú niàn le.

He/she formerly studied history, but now he/she doesn't anymore.

2.

他/她从前念书。

Tā cóngqián niàn shū.

He/she used to study.

他/她从前念书,现在不念了。

Tā cóngqián niàn shū, xiànzài bú niàn le.

He/she used to study, now he/she doesn't anymore.

3.

他/她从前在陆军做事。

Tā cóngqián zài lùjǖn zuò shì.

He/she used to be in the Army.

他/她从前在陆军做事,现在不在陆军做事了。

Tā cóngqián zài lùjǖn zuò shì, xiànzài bú zài lùjǖn zuò shì le.

He/she used to be in the Army, but he/she doesn't anymore.

4.

他/她从前不会。

Tā cóngqián bú huì.

He/she used to not.

他/她从前不会,现在会了。

Tā cóngqián bú huì, xiànzài huì le.

He/she used to not, but now he/she does.

5.

他/她从前不知道。

Tā cóngqián bù zhīdào.

He/she never knew before.

他/她从前不知道,现在知道了。

Tā cóngqián bù zhīdào, xiànzài zhīdào le.

He/she never knew before, but he/she knows now.

6.

他/她中文从前不很好。

Tāde Zhōngwén cóngqián bù hěn hǎo.

He/she wasn't very good at Chinese.

他/她中文从前不很好,现在很好了。

Tāde Zhōngwén cóngqián bù hěn hǎo, xiànzài hěn hǎo le.

He/she wasn't very good at Chinese, but he/she is now.

7.

他/她从前会说法国话。

Tā cóngqián huì shuō Fàguó huà.

He/she used to speak French.

他/她从前会说法国话,现在不会了。

Tā cóngqián huì shuō Fàguó huà, xiànzài bú huì le.

He/she used to speak French, now he/she doesn't.

18.3.3  Transformation drill

Table 18.3.3.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她念过政治学。

Tā niànguo zhèngzhixüé.

He/she has studied political science.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念政治学, 念了多久?

Tā niàn zhèngzhixüé, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long did he/she study political science?

2.

他/她念过经济学。

Tā niànguo jīngjixüé.

He/she has studied economics.

几年

jǐnián

how many years

他/她念经济学,念了几年?

Tā niàn jīngjixüé, niànle jǐnián?

How many years did he/she study economics?

3.

他/她念过中国文学。

Tā niànguo Zhōngguó wénxüé.

He/she has studied literature.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念中国文学,念了多久?

Tā niàn Zhōngguó wénxüé, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long did he/she study literature?

4.

他/她学过日文?

Tā xüéguo Rìwén.

He/she has learned Japanese.

几个月

jǐge yüè

how many months

他/她学日文,学了几个月?

Tā xüé Rìwén, xüéle jǐge yüè?

How many months did he/she learn Japanese?

5.

他/她在空军做过事。

Tā zài kōngjǖn zuòguo shì.

He/she has worked in the Air Force.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她在空军做事,做了多久?

Tā zài kōngjǖn zuò shì, zuòle duō jiǔ?

How long did he/she work in the Air Force?

6.

他/她念过中国历史。

Tā niànguo Zhōngguó lìshǐ.

He/she has studied Chinese history.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念中国历史,念了多久?

Tā niàn Zhōngguó lìshǐ, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long did he/she study history?

7.

他/她念过英国文学。

Tā niànguo Yīngguó wénxüé.

He/she has studied English literature.

几年

jǐnián

how many years

他/她念英国文学,念了几年?

Tā niàn Yīngguó wénxüé, niànle jǐniàn?

How many years did he/she study literature?

18.3.4  Transformation drill

Table 18.3.4.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她现在念历史。

Tā xiànzài niàn lìshǐ.

He/she is studying history now.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念历史,念了多久了?

Tā niàn lìshǐ, niànle duō jiǔ le?

How long has he been studying history?

2.

他/她现在学日文。

Tā xiànzài xüé Rìwén.

He/she is studying Japanese now.

几个月

jǐge yüè

how many months

他/她学日文,学了几个月?

Tā xüé Rìwén, xüéle jǐge yüè?

How many months has he been studying Japanese?

3.

他/她现在念英文。

Tā xiànzài niàn Yīngwén.

He/she is studying English now.

几个月

jǐge yüè

how many months

他/她念了英文,念了几个月了?

Tā niànle Yīngwén, niànle jǐge yüè le?

How many months has he been studying English?

4.

他/她现在在海军做事。

Tā xiànzài zài hǎijǖn zuò shì.

He/she is now working in the Navy.

几年

jǐnián

how many years

他/她在海军做事,作了几年了?

Tā zài hǎijǖn zuò shì, zuòle jǐnián le?

How many years has he been working in the Navy?

5.

他/她现在学中国话。

Tā xiànzài xüé Zhōngguó huà.

He/she is learning Chinese now.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她中国话,学了多久了?

Tā xüé Zhōngguó huà, xüéle duō jiǔ le?

How long has he/she been learning Chinese?

6.

他/她现在在陆军做事。

Tā xiànzài zài lùjǖn zuò shì.

He/she is working in the Army now.

几年

jínián

how many years

他/她在陆军做事,作了几年了?

Tā zài lùjǖn zuò shì, zuòle jǐnián le?

How many years has he/she been working in the Army?

7.

他/她现在在银行做事。

Ta xiànzài zài yínháng zuò shì.

He/she is working in a bank now.

几年

jǐnián

how many years

他/她在银行做事,作了几年了?

Tā zài yínháng zuò shì, zuòle jǐnián le?

How many years has he/she been working in the bank?

18.3.5  Transformation drill

Table 18.3.5.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她现在还念历史呢。

Tā xiànzài hái niàn lìshǐ ne.

He/she is still studying history.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念历史,还想念多久?

Tā niàn lìshǐ, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How much longer is he/she going to study history?

2.

他/她现在还念中国文学呢。

Tā xiànzài hái niàn Zhōngguó wènxüé ne.

He/she is still studying Chinese literature.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念中国历史,还想念多久?

Tā niàn Zhōngguó wènxüé, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How much longer is he/she going to study Chinese literature?

3.

他/她现在还学日文呢。

Tā xiànzài hái xüé Rìwén ne.

He/she is still learning Japanese.

几个月

jǐge yüè

how many months

他/她学日文,还想学几个月?

Tā xüé Rìwén, hái xiǎng xüé jǐge yüè?

How much longer is he/she going to learn Japanese?

4.

他/她现在还在陆军做事呢。

Tā xiànzài hái zài lùjǖn zuò shì ne.

He/she is still working for the Army.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她在陆军做事,还想做多久?

Tā zài lùjǖn zuò shì, hái xiǎng zuò duō jiǔ?

5.

他/她现在还学中国话呢。

Tā xiànzài hái xüé Zhōngguó huà ne.

He/she is still learning Chinese.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她学中国话 他/她在陆军做事,还想学多久?

Tā xüé Zhōngguó huà, hái xiǎng xüé duō jiǔ?

How long is he/she going to learn Chinese?

6.

他/她现在还念政治学呢。

Tā xianzài hái niàn zhèngzhixüé ne.

He/she is still studying political science.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念政治学,还想念多久?

Tā niàn zhèngzhixüé, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How long is he/she going to study political science?

7.

他/她现在还念经济学呢。

Tā xiànzài hái niàn jīngjixüé ne.

He/she is still studying economics.

多久

duō jiǔ

how long

他/她念经济学,还想年多久?

Tā niàn jīngjixüé, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How long is he/she going to study economics?

18.3.6  Transformation drill

Table 18.3.6.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她现在念历史。

Tā xiànzài niàn lìshǐ.

He is studying history now.

他/她念历史,念了多久了?

Tā niàn lìshǐ, niànle duō jiǔ le?

How long has he studied history?

2.

他/她念过历史。

Tā niànguo lìshǐ.

He studied history.

他/她念历史,念了对久?

Tā niàn lìshǐ, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long did he study history?

3.

他/她现在还念历史。

Tā xiànzài hái niàn lìshǐ.

He/she is still studying history.

他/她念历史,还想念多久?

Tā niàn lìshǐ, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How long does he/she plan to study history?

4.

他/她现在念中国文学。

Tā xiànzài niàn Zhōngguó wènxüé.

He/she is now studying Chinese literature.

他/她念中国文学,念了多久了?

Tā niàn Zhōngguó wènxüé, niànle duō jiǔ le?

How long has he/she been studying Chinese literature?

5.

他/她念过中国文学。

Tā niànguo Zhōngguó wènxüé.

He/she has studied Chinese literature.

他/她念中国文学,念了多久?

Tā niàn Zhōngguó wènxüé, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long did he/she study Chinese literature?

6.

他/她现在还念日文。

Tā xiànzài hái niàn Rìwén.

He/she is still studying Japanese.

他/她念日文,还想念多久?

Tā niàn Rìwén, hái xiǎng niàn duō jiǔ?

How long does he/she plan to study Japanese?

7.

他/她念过日文。

Tā niànguo Rìwén.

He/she has studied Chinese.

他/她念日文,念了多久?

Tā niàn Rìwén, niànle duō jiǔ?

How long has he/she been studying Japanese?

8.

他/她学过英文。

Tā xüéguo Yīngwén.

He/she has learned English.

他/她学英文,学了多久?

Tā xüé Yīngwén, xüéle duō jiǔ?

How long has he/she been learning English?

9.

他/她现在还学英文。

Tā xiànzài hái xüé Yīngwén.

He/she is still learning English.

他/她学英文,还想学多久?

Tā xüé Yīngwén, hái xiǎng xüé duō jiǔ?

How long does he/she plan to learn English.

10.

他/她现在在空军做事。

Tā xiànzài zài kōngjǖn zuò shì.

He/she now works for the Air Force.

他/她在空军做事,做了多久了?

Tā zài kōngjǖn zuò shì, zuòle duō jiǔ le?

how long has he/she been working for the Air Force?

18.3.7  Expansion drill

Table 18.3.7.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她写了吗?

Tā xiě le ma?

Did he/she write?

他/她还没写。

Tā hái méi xiě.

He/she still hasn't written.

2.

他/她来了吗?

Tā lái le ma?

Did he/she come?

他/她还没来。

Tā hái méi lái.

He/she still hasn't come.

3.

他/她好了吗?

Tā hǎo le ma?

Did he/she get better?

他/她还没好。

Tā hái méi hǎo.

He/she still hasn't got better.

4.

他/她懂了吗?

Tā dǒng le ma?

Did he/she understand?

他/她还没懂。

Tā hái méi dǒng.

He/she still hasn't understood.

5.

他/她走了吗?

Tā zǒu le ma?

Did he/she leave?

他/她还没走。

Tā hái méi zǒu.

He/she still hasn't left?

6.

他/她听了吗?

Tā tīng le ma?

Did he/she listen?

他/她还没听。

Tā hái méi tīng.

He/she still hasn't listened?

7.

他/她学了吗?

Tā xüé le ma?

Did he/she learn?

他/她还没学。

Tā hái méi xüé.

He/she still hasn't learned.

18.3.8  Response drill

Table 18.3.8.1 
Question Answer
1.

他/她从前不会写中国字。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bú huì xiě Zhōngguó zì. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she couldn't write Chinese characters. And now?

他/她还不会写中国字。

Tā hái bú huì xiě Zhōngguó zì.

He/she still can't write Chinese characters.

2.

他/她从前不想学日文。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé Rìwén. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she didn't want to learn Japanese. And now?

他/她还不想学日文。

Tā hái bù xiǎng xüé Rìwén.

He/she still doesn't want to learn Japanese.

3.

他/她从前不念历史。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bú niàn lìshǐ. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she didn't learn history. And now?

他/她还不念历史。

Tā hái bú niàn lìshǐ.

He/she still doesn't learn history.

4.

他/她从前不董法文。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bù dǒng Fàwén. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she didn't understand French. And now?

他/她还不董法文。

Tā hái bù dǒng Fàwén.

He/she still doesn't understand French.

5.

他/她们没有孩子。现在呢?

Tāmen cóngqián méiyou háizi. Xiànzài ne?

In the past they didn't have children. And now?

他/她们还没有孩子。

Tāmen hái méiyou háizi.

They still doesn't have any children.

6.

他/她从前不会说德国话 。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bú huì shuō Déguó huà. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she couldn't speak German. And now?

他/她还不会说德国话 。

Tā hái bú huì shuō Déguó huà.

He/she still doesn't speak German.

7.

他/她从前不想学英文。现在呢?

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé Yīngwén. Xiànzài ne?

In the past he/she didn't want to learn English. And now?

他/她还不想学英文。

Tā hái bù xiǎng xüé Yīngwén.

He/she still doesn't want to learn English.

18.3.9  Response drill

Table 18.3.9.1 
Question Cue Answer
1.

他/她从前不会写中国字。

Tā cóngqián bú huì xiě Zhōngguó zì.

In the past, he/she couldn't write Chinese characters.

now he/she can

他/她从前不会写,现在会写了。

Tā cóngqián bú huì xiě, xiànzài huì xiě le.

In the past, he/she couldn't write, now he/she can.

2.

他/她从前会写中国字。

Tā cóngqián huì xiě Zhōngguó zì.

In the past he/she could write Chinese characters

no longer

他/她从前会写,现在不会写了。

Tā cóngqián huì xiě, xiànzài bú huì xiě le.

In the past he/she could write, now he/she can't.

3.

他/她从前不会写中国字。

Tā cóngqián bú huì xiě Zhōngguó zì.

In the past he/she couldn't write Chinese characters.

still can't

他/她从前不会写,现在还不会写。

Tā cóngqián bú huì xiě, xiànzài hái bú huì xiě.

In the past he/she couldn't write, now he/she still can't.

4.

他/她从前不董法文。

Tā cóngqián bù dǒng Fàwén.

In the past he/she didn't understand French.

now he/she can

他/她从前不董,现在董了。

Tā cóngqián bù dǒng, xiànzài dǒng le.

In the past he/she didn't understand, now he/she can.

5.

他/她从前董法文。

Tā cóngqián dǒng Fàwén.

In the past he/she did understand French.

no longer

他/她从前董,现在不董了。

Tā cóngqián dǒng, xiànzài bù dǒng le.

In the past he/she did understand, now he/she cannot anymore.

6.

他/她从前不董法文。

Tā cóngqián bù dǒng Fàwén.

In the past he/she didn't understand French.

still can't

他/她从前不董,现在还不董。

Tā cóngqián bù dǒng, xiànzài hái bù dǒng.

In the past he/she didn't understand, now he/she still can't.

7.

他/她从前不想学英文。

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé Yīngwén.

In the past he/she didn't want to learn English.

now he/she does

他/她从前不想学,现在想学了。

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé, xiànzài xiǎng xüé le.

In the past he/she didn't want to learn, now he/she wants to.

8.

他/她从前想学英文。

Tā cóngqián xiǎng xüé Yīngwén.

In the past he/she did want to learn English.

no longer

他/她从前想学,现在不想学了。

Tā cóngqián xiǎng xüé, xiànzài bù xiǎng xüé le.

In the past he/she did want to learn, now he/she doesn't want to anymore.

9.

他/她从前不想学英文。

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé Yīngwén.

In the past he/she didn't want to learn English.

still doesn't

他/她从前不想学,现在还不想学。

Tā cóngqián bù xiǎng xüé, xiànzài hái bù xiǎng xüé.

In the past he/she didn't want to learn, now he/she still doesn't want to.

10.

他/她从前不念历史。

Tā cóngqián bú niàn lìshǐ.

In the past he/she didn't study history.

now he/she does

他/她从前不念,现在念了。

Tā cóngqián bú niàn, xiànzài niàn le.

In the past he/she didn't study, now she does study.

11.

他/她从前念历史。

Tā cóngqián niàn lìshǐ.

In the past he/she did study history.

no longer

他/她从前念,现在不念了。

Tā cóngqián niàn, xiànzài bú niàn le.

In the past he/she did study, now he/she doesn't anymore.

12.

他/她从前不念历史。

Tā cóngqián bú niàn lìshǐ.

In the past he/she didn't study history.

still doesn't

他/她从前不念,现在还不念。

Tā cóngqián bú niàn, xiànzài hái bú niàn.

In the past he/she didn't study, now he/she still doesn't.

18.3.10  Transformation drill

Table 18.3.10.1 
Question Answer
1.

我写字了。

Wǒ xiě zì le.

I wrote.

我写字了,他/她没写字。

Wǒ xiě zì le, tā méi xiě zì.

I wrote, he/she didn't write.

2.

我懂了。

Wǒ dǒng le.

I understood.

我懂了,他/她没董。

Wǒ dǒng le, tā méi dǒng.

I understood, he/she didn't.

3.

我来了。

Wǒ lái le.

I came.

我来了,他/她没来。

Wǒ lái le, tā méi lái.

I came, he/she didn't.

4.

我走了。

Wǒ zǒu le.

I left.

我走了,他/她没走。

Wǒ zǒu le, tā méi zǒu.

I left, he/she didn't.

5.

我坐了。

Wǒ zuò le.

I sat.

我坐了,她没坐。

Wǒ zuò le, tā méi zuò.

I sat, he/she didn't.

6.

我听了。

Wǒ tīng le.

I listened.

我听了,他/她没听。

Wǒ tīng le, tā méi tīng.

I listened, he/she didn't.

7.

我学了。

Wǒ xüé le.

I learned.

我学了,她没学。

Wǒ xüé le, tā méi xüé.

I learned, he/she didn't.

Chapter 3. Module 3: Money

The Money Module (MON) will provide you with the skills needed to exchange moneys make simple purchases, and discuss your purchases in Chinese.

Before starting this module, you must take and. pass the BIO Criterion Test. Prerequisites to units 4 and 5 of this module are tapes 5 and 6. Numbers resource module and tapes 3 and 4, Time and Dates resource module.

The Criterion Test will focus largely on this module, but material from ORN, BIO and associated resource modules may also be included.

1 Objectives

Upon successful completion of this module, the student should be able to:

  1. Comprehend the numbers 1 through 99,999 including those numbers used In money expressions, and say them in Chinese when given English equivalents.

  2. Give the English equivalent for any Chinese sentence in the MON Target Lists.

  3. Say any Chinese sentence in the MON Target Lists when cued with its English equivalent.

  4. Give the Chinese names, when given the English, for fifteen items to be bought .

  5. Say that he wants to make a purchases, find out if the item is sold, ask to see it, find out the price, ask to see other similar items and either make the purchase or say he does not want to buy the item.

  6. Talk in Chinese about the items he bought, the quantity he bought, the size and color of the items , and the price (cost) (including a comparison of his purchases with other Items).

  7. Ask for change (specific denominations).

  8. Say he wants to change money into local currency, find out where to change it, ask what the current exchange rate is, and complete the exchange using cash or traveler's checks.

2 Unit 1 Target List

1. Wǒ xiǎng mǎi Yīngwén bào.
我想买英文报。
I would like to buy an English-language newspaper.
Hǎo. Jiù zài zhèli.
好。就在这里。
Fine. They are right here.
2. Zhège bào duōshao qián?
这个报多少钱?
How much is this newspaper?
Zhège bào wǔkuài qián yífèn.
这个报五块钱一份。
This newspaper is five dollars a copy.
3. Zhèli yǒu Měiguó zázhì meiyou?
这里有美国杂志没有?
Are there any American magazines here?
Zhèli méiyou Měiguó zázhì.
这里没有美国杂志。
There aren't any American magazines here.
4. Nǐmen zhèli mài Měiguó shū bu mai?
你们这里卖美国书不卖?
Do you sell American books here?
Duìbuqǐ, Měiguó shū wǒmen bú mài.
对不起,美国书我们不卖。
I'm sorry, we don't sell American books.
5. Bào, zázhì, yígòng duōshao qián?
报,杂志一共多少钱?
How much are the newspaper and magazine altogether?
Yígòng sānshiwǔkuài qián.
一共三十五块钱。
Altogether, it's thirty-five dollars.
6. Zhè liǎngzhāng dìtú duōshao qián?
这两张地图多少钱?
How much are these two maps?
Sānshièrkuài qián.
三十二块钱。
Thirty-two dollars.
7. Zhège duōshao qián? Sānshikuài qián yìběn.
这个多少钱?三十块钱一本。
How much is this one? Thirty dollars a copy.
Hǎo, wǒ mǎi yìběn.
好,我买一本。
Fine, I'll buy one.
Additional required vocabulary (not presented on P-l and P-l tapes)
8. yífèn (r) bàozhǐ
—份(儿)报纸
one newspaper
9. yìzhī bǐ
一支笔
one pen
10. yìzhāng zhǐ
一张纸
one piece of paper
11. yìběn zìdiǎn
一本字典
one dictionary
12. Hàn-Yīng zìdiǎn
汉英词典
Chinese-English dictionary
13. Yīng-Hàn zìdiǎn
英汉词典
English-Chinese dictionary
14. huàxué
化学
chemistry
15. shùxué
数学
mathematics

3 Unit 2 Target List

1. Zhèige diǎnxin duōshao qián yìjīn?
这个小的点心多少钱一斤?
How much is this kind of pastry per catty?
Bāmáo qián yìjīn.
八毛钱一斤.
Eighty cents a catty.
Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ liǎngjīn.
请你给我两斤。
Please give me two catties.
2. Nín hái yào diǎnr shénme?
您还要点儿什么?
What else do you want?
Wǒ bú yào shénme le.
我不要什么了。
I don't want anything else.
3. Qìshuǐ duōshao qián yìpíng?
汽水多少钱一瓶?
How much per bottle is the soda?
Liǎngmáo wǔ.
两毛五
Twenty-five cents.
4. Zhèi shì sānkuài qián.
这是三快钱。
Here's 3 dollars.
Zhǎo nǐ liùmáo wǔfēn qián.
找你六毛五分钱。
Here's sixty-five cents change.
Xièxie. Zàijiàn.
谢谢。再见。
Thanks you. Good-bye.
5. Nèige dà píngguǒ duōshao qián?
那个大苹果多少钱?
How much are those large apples.
Dàde sìmáo wǔfēn qián yìjīn.
大的四毛五分钱一斤。
The large ones are forty-five cents a catty.
Qǐng gěi wǒ sānjīn nèige xiǎode.
请给我三斤那个小的
Please give me three catties of the small ones.
Hǎo. Sānjīn yíkuài líng wǔ.
好。三斤一块令五。
Certainly. Three catties are $1.05.
6. júzi
橘子
oranges, tangerines
7. píjiǔ
睥酒
beer
8. yíkuài féizào
一块肥皂
one bar of soap
9. zuò mǎimai
做买卖
to do business
10. dǎrén
大人
adult
11. xiǎoháizi
小孩子
child

4 Unit 3 Target List

1. Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ kànkan nèige huāpíng.
请你给我看看那个花瓶。
Please give me that vase to look at.
Něige? Zhèige lánde háishi zhèige hóngde?
哪个?这个蓝的还是这个红的?
Which one? This blue one or this red one?
Nèi liǎngge dōu gěi wǒ kànkan, hǎo ma?
那两个都给我看看,好吗?
Give me both of them to look at. All right?
2. Zhèi liǎngge xuésheng, něige hǎo?
这两个学生,哪个好?
Which of these two students is better?
Sīmǎ Xìn hǎo.
司马信好。
Sīmǎ Xìn is better.
3. Nèige hóng huāpíng zhēn hǎokàn.
哪个红花瓶真好看。
That red vase is really beautiful.
Nín yǒu dà yìdiǎnrde ma?
您有大一点儿的吗?
Do you have one little larger?
Yǒu. Nǐ kàn zhèige zěnmeyàng?
有。你看这个怎么样?
We do. What do you think of this one?
Hěn hǎo. Hǎo, qǐng gěi wǒ liǎngge ba.
很好。好,请给我两个吧。
It's very nice. Okay, how about giving me two, please.
4. Něige lánde tài guì le.
那个蓝得太贵了。
That blue one is too expensive.
Wǒ yào hóngde. Hóngde piányi.
我要红的. 红的便宜
I want the red one. The red one is cheaper.
5. bái
to be white
6. hēi
to be black
7. huáng
to be yellow, to be brown
8.
绿
to be to be green
9. jiù
to be old, to be used, to be worn
10. xīn
to be new
11. gāo
to be tall
12. ǎi
to be short (of stature)
13. gāoxìng
高兴
to be happy
14. nánkàn
难看
to be ugly
15. yìbǎ yǔsǎn
一把雨伞
one umbrella
16. kàn
to read, to look at, to visit

5 Unit 4 Target List

1. Wǒmen jiālide dōngxi, yǒude dào le, yǒude hái méi dào.
我们家里的东西,有的到了,有的还没到。
Some of our household things have arrived, and some haven't arrived yet.
2. Tāmen màide pánziwǎn, yǒude zhēn hǎokàn.
他们卖的盘子碗,有的真好看。
Some of the dishes they sell are really beautiful.
Kěshi guì yìdiǎn.
可是贵一点。
But they are a little expensive.
3. Wǒ mǎide nàxie pánziwǎn dōu bú tài guì.
我买的那些盘子碗都不太贵。
All those dishes I bought were not too expensive.
Guìde wǒ méi mǎi.
贵的我没买。
I didn't buy the expensive ones.
4. Nín mǎi shénme le?
您买什么了?
What did you buy?
Wǒ mǎile shíge dà pánzi.
我买了十个大盘子。
I bought ten large plates.
5. Nǐde fànwǎn shì shénme yánsède?
你的饭碗是什么颜色的?
What color are your rice bowls?
Shì lánde.
是蓝的。
They're blue ones.
Wǒ yě xǐhuān lánde.
我也喜欢蓝的。
I like blue ones too.
6. Nǐde zhège chábēi hěn hǎo.Shì zài shěnme dìfang mǎide?
你的这个茶杯很好。是在什么地方买的?
This teacup of yours is very nice. Where was it bought?
Shǐ zài Dìyī Gōngsī mǎide.
是在第一公司买的。
It was bought at the First Company.
7. yíge bīngxiāng
一个冰箱
one refrigerator
8. yìzhāng dìtǎn
一张地毯
one rug
9. yíge shūjiàzi
一个书架子
one bookcase
10. yìbǎ yǐzi
一把椅子
one chair
11. yìzhāng zhuōzi
一张作桌子
one table

6 Unit 5 Target List

1. Máfan nǐ, wǒ zhèr yǒu yìbǎikuài Měijīnde lǚxíng zhǐpiào.
那烦你,我这儿有一百块美金的旅行支票。
Sorry to bother you. I have one hundred U.S. dollars in traveler's checks here.
Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ huànhuan.
请你给我换换.
Please change it for me.
2. Nǐ yào zěnme huàn?
你要怎么换?
How do you want to change it?
Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ liǎngzhāng wǔkuàide ba.
请你给我两张五块的把。
How about giving me two fives?
3. Nǐmen shōu Měijīn ma?
你们收美金吗?
Do you accept U.S. currency?
Duìbuqǐ, wǒmen bù shōu Měijīn.
对不起,我们不受美金。
I'm sorry. We don't accept U.S. currency.
4. Zhèr yǒu méiyou yínháng?
这儿有没有银行?
Is there a bank?
Yǒu. Yínháng jiù zài nàr.
有。银行在那儿。
There is. The bank is right over there.
5. Qǐngwèn, shì bu shi zài zhèr huàn qián?
请问,是不是在这儿换钱?
May I ask, is it here that I change money?
Shì, shì zài zhèr huàn.
是,是在这儿换。
Yes, you change here.
6. Jīntiānde páijià shì duōshao?
今天的牌价是多少?
What is today's exchange rate?
Jīntiānde páijià shi yíkuài Mèijīn huàn yíkuài jiǔmáo liù Rénmínbì.
今天的牌价是一块美金换一块九毛六人民币。
Today's exchange rate is one U.S. dollar to one dollar and ninety-six cents in People currency.
7. Xièxie.
谢谢。
Thank you.
8. Búkèqi.
不客气。
You are welcome.
9. yíge diànshàn
一个电扇
one electric fan
10. yíge diánshì
一个电视
one television
11. yíge shōuyīnjī
一个收音机
one radio
12. yíge zhōng
一个钟
one clock
13. yíge shǒubiǎo
一个手表
one wristwatch

7 Unit 6 Target List

1. Nǐmen zhèli kéyi huàn Měijīn ma?
你们这里可以换美金吗?
Can U.S. currency be changed here?
Duìbuqǐ, bù kéyi. Nín děi zài Táiwān Yínháng huàn.
对不起,不可以。您得在台湾银行换。
I'm sorry, that's not possible. You must change it at the Bank of Taiwan.
Yínháng jǐdiǎn zhōng kāi mén, jǐdiǎn zhōng guān mén?
银行几点中开门,几点中关门?
What time does the bank open, and what time does it close?
Jiǔdiǎn zhōng kāi mén, sāndiǎn bàn guān mén.
九点中开门,三点半关门。
It opens at nine o'clock and close at three-thirty.
Wǒ yào huàn yìdiǎn Táibì.
我要换一点台币。
I want to change some money into Taiwan currency.
Hǎo. Yíkuài Měijīn huàn sānshibākuài Táibì.
好。一块美金换三十八块台币。
Certainly. One U.S. dollar is thirty-eight dollars in Taiwan currency.
Qǐng nǐ děngyiděng. Wǒ jiù lái.
请你等一等。我就来。
Please wait a moment. I'll be right back.
Qǐng gěi wǒ diǎn xiǎo piàozi, xíng bu xíng?
请给我点小票子,行不行?
Please give me some small bills. Would that be all right?
Méi shenme.
没什么。
It's nothing.
zǎochen (zǎochén)
早晨
early morning
zǎoshang (zǎoshàng)
早上
morning
shàngwǔ (shàngwu)
上午
forenoon, morning
zhōngwǔ (zhōngwu)
中午
noon
xiàwǔ (xiàwu)
下午
afternoon
wǎnshang (zǎnshàng)
晚上
evening
yèli
夜里
night
bànyè
半夜
midnight
jiàn
to meet
mámahūhū
马马虎虎
so-so, fair

8 Unit 1

8.1 References

8.1.1 Reference List

1. A: Zhèli yǒu Yīngwén bào ma?
这里有英文报吗?
Are there any English-language newspapers here?
B: Yǒu. Jiù zài nàli.
有。就在那里
Yes. They're right over there.
2. A: Zhèli yǒu Yīngwén bào meiyou?
这里有英文报没有?
Are there any English-language newspapers here?
B: Yǒu. Jiù zài nàli.
有。就在那里。
Yes. They're right there.
3. A: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi Yīngwén bào.
我想买英文报。
I would like to buy English-language newspaper.
B: Hǎo. Jiù zài zhèli.
好。就在那里。
Fine. They're right here.
4. A: Zhège duōshao qián?
这个多少钱?
How much is this one?
B: Wǔkuài qián.
五块钱。
Five dollars.
5. A: Zhège Zhōngwén bào duōshao qián?
这个中文报多少钱?
How much is the Chinese-language newspaper?
B: Sānkuài qián yífèn.
三块钱一份。
Three dollars a copy.
6. A: Nǐmen zhèli mài Měiguó zázhì bu mài?
你们这里卖美国杂志不卖?
Do you sell American magazines here?
B: Mài. Wǒmen zhèli mài.
卖。我们这里卖。
Yes, we sell them here.
7. A: Zhège duōshao qián?
这个多少钱?
How much is this one?
B: Sānshikuài qián yìběn.
三十块钱一本。
Thirty dollars a copy.
A: Hǎo, wǒ mǎi yìběn.
好。我买一本。
Fine, I'll buy one.
8. A: Nǐmen zhèli yǒu Měiguó shū meiyou?
你们这里有美国书没有?
Do you have American books here?
B: Duìbuqǐ, Měiguó shū wǒmen bú mài.
对不起,美国书我们不卖。
I'm sorry, we don't sell American books here.
9. A: Bào, zázhì, yígòng duōshao qián?
报、杂志、一共多少钱?
How much are the newspaper, the magazine altogether?
B: Bào wǔkuài, zázhì sānshikuài.
报无怪;杂志三十块。
The newspaper is five dollars; the magazine is thirty dollars.
B: Yígòng sānshiwǔkuài qián.
一共三十五块钱。
Altogether, it's thirty-five dollars.
10. A: Nǐmen zhèli mài dìtú bu mài?
你们这里卖地图不卖?
Do you sell maps here?
B: Mài. Zài nàli.
卖。在那里。
We do. They are other here.
11. A: Nín xiǎng mǎi shénme dìtú?
您想买什么地图?
What kind of map would you like to buy?
B: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi yìzhāng Táiběi dìtú.
我想买一张台北地图。
I would like to buy a map of Taipei.
12. A: Zhèzhāng Táiběi dìtú duōshao qián?
这张台北地图多少钱?
How much is this map of Taipei?
B: Shíèrkuài qián.
十二块钱。
Twelve dollars.

8.1.2 Vocabulary

yífèn (r) bàozhǐ —份(儿)报纸 one newspaper
yìzhī bǐ 一支笔 one pen
yìzhāng zhǐ 一张纸 one piece of paper
yìběn zìdiǎn 一本字典 one dictionary
Hàn-Yīng zìdiǎn 汉-英字典 Chinese-English dictionary
Yīng-Hàn zìdiǎn 英-汉字典 English-Chinese dictionary
huàxué 化学 chemistry
shùxué 数学 mathematics
bào (yífèn) 报(一份) newspaper
bàozhǐ (yífèn) 报纸(一份) newspaper
-běn -本 volume
bǐ (yìzhī) 笔(一支) pen
dìtú (yìzhāng) 地图(一张) map
duìbuqǐ 对不起 I'm sorry
duōshao 多少 how much, how many
-fèn (r) -份(儿) copy
jiù right, exactly (with reference to space)
-kuài -块 dollar (in context)
mǎi to buy
mài to sell
qián money
shū (yìběn) 书(一本) book
xiǎng to want to
xiǎngyixiǎng 想一想 to think it over
yīgòng 一共 altogether
zázhì (yìběn) 杂志(一本) magazine
-zhāng -张 (counter for flat things, tables, paper, pictures, etc ...)
zhǐ (yìzhāng) 纸(一张) paper
-zhī -支 (counter for straight, stick-like objects)
zìdiǎn (yìběn) 字典(一本) dictionary

8.1.3 Reference Notes

8.1.3.1 Notes on № 1
1. A: Zhèli yǒu Yīngwén bào ma?
这里有英文报吗?
Are there any English-language newspapers here?
B: Yǒu. Jiù zài nàli.
有。就在那里
Yes. They're right over there.

Zhèli yǒu: The Chinese verb yǒu sometimes means "to have" and sometimes means "to be" in the sense of "to exist". In exchange 1, yǒu has the latter meaning. With this meaning, it often translates into English as "there is/are."

Topic-comment sentences: The subject of a Chinese sentence need not be the person who performs an action or experiences a state. Often, the relation ship between the subject and the rest of the sentence Is looser and can be analyzed as topic-comment.

A topic is a word or phrase at the beginning of a sentence which sets the scene for the rest of the sentence. The topic is a starting point for understanding a sentence, giving background Information and establishing the perspective for listeners. For this reason, time and place phrases are often used as topics.

Zhèli yǒu Yíngwén báo.
Here there are English-language newspapers.

A comment is the rest of the sentence which follows the topic. Here are some examples:

Bǐ, tā yǒu; zhǐ, tā méiyou . He has a pen; he doesn't have paper. (literally, "Pen he has; paper he doesn't)
A: Nǐ shi nǎr? Where are you calling from?
B: Wǒ shi Táiwān Dàxué. Taiwan University
Zhèzhāng dìtú mài shíkuài qián. As for this map, they sell it for ten dollars.

Clearly, the last two examples are meaningful only when the relationship between the initial nouns/pronouns and verbs is understood to be one of topic-comment, not the usual subject-predicate relation of actor-action.

While there is no single rule that tells you when to use topic-comment sentences in Chinese, some helpful generalizations can be made. These generalizations will be discussed as example-sentences appear in the Reference lists.

Jiù zài nàli, "They are right over here": You have learned jiù as "only," a synonym of zhǐ. In exchange 1, you see another use of jiù: "right," "exactly," "precisely." This word is often used to describe "right" where something is, and is followed by zài, "in/on."

8.1.3.2 Notes on № 2

2. A: Zhèli yǒu Yīngwén bào meiyou?
这里有英文报没有?
Are there any English-language newspapers here?
B: Yǒu. Jiù zài nàli.
有。就在那里。
Yes. They're right there.

Yǒu...méiyǒu: The first sentence in exchange 2 is a yes/no-choice question. This type of question is formed "by explicitly offering the listener a choice between an affirmative and a negative answer. The negative alternative is tacked onto the end of the sentence. Similar questions exist in English. But the English question would be an impatient one, while the Chinese question is an ordinary on:

Zhèli yǒu Yīngwén bào méiyou?

Are there any English-language newspaper here, or aren't there?

Neutral tones: Whether or not a syllable is pronounced in the Neutral tone often depends on the speed of speech and the mood the speaker is trying to convey, In informal conversation between native speakers, there are many more Neutral tones than in the more careful, deliberate speech of a language teacher speaking to foreign student . (Bear this point in mind when you find a discrepancy between the textbook marking of a word and the pronunciation of that word on tape.)

Most syllables in any stretch of spoken Chinese are neither completely ”Neutral"(i. e., with no audible change in pitch for the duration of the syllable) nor completely "full" in length and amplitude, These syllables will usually be somewhere in between the two extremes.

Zhèli yǒu Yīngwen bào meiyou? Are there any English-language newspapers here?

Zhěli yǒu Yīngwén bào méiyou"?

Often a syllable will not Bound like a full tone. But if you ask "Then is this syllable in the Neutral tone?" the answer will be "No, not exactly." There is no distinct dividing line between a syllable with a tone and a syllable in the Neutral tone. Very often, the most helpful answer to the question "Should this be pronounced in the Neutral tone?" is "Pronounce it the way you hear it." The language is taught in terms of four tones, but your ears hear more.

8.1.3.3 Notes on № 3

3. A: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi Yīngwén bào.
我想买英文报。
I would like to buy English-language newspaper.
B: Hǎo. Jiù zài zhèli.
好。就在那里。
Fine. They're right here.

The auxiliary verb xiǎng is sometimes translated as "would like to" or "to want to." Here are some examples of translations you have learned for xiǎng;

Wǒ xiǎng mǎi Yīngwén bào.

I'm thinking of buying an English-language newspaper.

OR

I would like to buy an English-language newspaper.

OR

I want to buy an English-language newspaper.

Wǒ xiǎng tā xiǎng míngtiān zǒu. I think he is planning to leave tomorrow.
Wǒ hěn xiǎng niàn shú. I very much want to study.
Wǒ bú tài xiǎng qù. I don't want to go very much. ("tài" meaning "too," "excessively," appears in Unit 3)

8.1.3.4 Notes on № 4
4. A: Zhège duōshao qián?
这个多少钱?
How much is this one?
B: Wǔkuài qián.
五块钱。
Five dollars.

Zhège duōshao qián? In Chinese sentences that ask for and give prices, the word shì is usually omitted.

Shì reappears, however, in negative and contrastive sentences: Zhège bú shì sìkuài qián, shì wǔkuài qián. "This (item) isn't four dollars; it's five dollars."

Wǔkuài qián literally means "five dollars money." The counter -kuài, "dollars," indicates the units of the general class "money" that are being counted (i.e., dollars as opposed to cents.)

8.1.3.5 Notes on № 5
5. A: Zhège Zhōngwén bào duōshao qián?
这个中文报多少钱?
How much is the Chinese-language newspaper?
B: Sānkuài qián yífèn.
三块钱一份。
Three dollars a copy.

Notice in the sentence Zhège Zhōngwén bào duōshao qián? that the general counter -ge is used rather than the specific counter -fèn, "copy." The counter -ge is often used in talking about the KIND of thing. In this case the question is about the price of ea newspaper as a publication, not about the price of a copy. The specific counter would be used to talk about a particular concrete object, as in a sentence like: "This copy of the China Post is torn."

Yífèn: In Chinese, when you talk about the unit price of an item, the unit is a counter. Notice that yífèn comes at the end of the sentence, just as "copy" does in English.

8.1.3.6 Notes on № 6
6. A: Nǐmen zhèli mài Měiguó zázhì bu mài?
你们这里卖美国书不卖?
Do you sell American magazines here?
B: Mài. Wǒmen zhèli mài.
卖。我们这里卖。
Yes, we sell them here.

Mài, "to sell," differs from the word mǎi, "to buy," only in its tone.

Nǐmen zhèli, "your place here," literally, "you here": Use Nǐmen zhèli when talking to someone who represents a stores a bank, or other institutions. By putting zhèli (zhèr), "here," or nàli (nàr), "there," after a person's name or a pronoun, you make a phrase referring to a place associated with the person. For example, nì nàli means "over there where you are now," and wǒ zhèli means "here where I am now," Use these phrases when you want to express the idea of an item being close to a person (not necessarily ownership).

Nǐ nàli yǒu bǐ méiyou? Do you have a pen over there? (i.e., Is there a pen over there where you are?")

This kind of phrase is also used to mean a person's home: nǐ nàli, "your place" (used when the speaker is not at "your house"); wǒ zhèli: "my place" (used when the speaker is at home.)

A: Chén xǎojiě zài náli? Where is Miss Chén?

B: Tā zài Liú tàitài nàli She is at Mrs. Liú house.

Nǐmen zhèli mài Měiguó zázhì bu mài? In this sentence, Nǐmen zhèli is used as a topic. Literally, the sentence means: "As for your place here, are American magazines sold?"

8.1.3.7 Notes on № 7
7. A: Zhège duōshao qián?
这个多少钱?
How much is this one?
B: Sānshikuài qián yìběn.
三十块钱一本。
Thirty dollars a copy.
A: Hǎo, wǒ mǎi yìběn.
好。我买一本。
Fine, I'll buy one.

The counter běn, "volume", "copy," is used for both books and magazines.

8.1.3.8 Notes on № 8
8. A: Nǐmen zhèli yǒu Měiguó shū meiyou?
你们这里有美国书没有?
Do you have American books here?
B: Duìbuqǐ, Měiguó shū wǒmen bú mài.
对不起,美国书我们不卖。
I'm sorry, we don't sell American books here.

Duìbuqǐ, literally means "unable to face (you)." This word is used to say "I'm sorry" when you bump into a person, arrive late, and so on. It is not the word for "I'm sorry" when you sympathize with someone else's misfortune (e.g., when a relative dies.)

Měiguó shū wǒmen bú mài.: In this sentence, Měiguó shū, the object of the verb mài, occurs at the beginning, in topic position. Here the order of the sentence element is : topic - subject - verb. Some speakers of English use the same word order. Compare:

Měiguó shū wǒmen bú mài.
American books we don't sell.

Notice that bú mài is not the ending of a yes/no-choice question. The phrase keeps its tones in this sentence.

8.1.3.9 Notes on № 9
9. A: Bào, zázhì, yígòng duōshao qián?
报、杂志、一共多少钱?
How much are the newspaper, the magazine altogether?
B: Bào wǔkuài, zázhì sānshikuài.
报无怪、杂志三十块。
The newspaper is five dollars; the magazine is thirty dollars.
B: Yígòng sānshiwǔkuài qián.
一共三十五块钱。
Altogether, it's thirty-five dollars.

Yígòng, "altogether,": In totaling something up, the items being totaled begin the sentence, in topic position, and are followed by the adverb Yígòng.

In many situations you will hear prices given without the word qián.

8.1.3.10 Notes on № 10-11
10. A: Nǐmen zhèli mài dìtú bu mài?
你们这里卖地图不卖?
Do you sell maps here?
B: Mài. Zài nàli.
卖。在那里。
We do. They are other here.
11. A: Nín xiǎng mǎi shénme dìtú?
您想买什么地图?
What kind of map would you like to buy?
B: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi yìzhāng Táiběi dìtú.
我想买一张台北地图。
I would like to buy a map of Taipei.

shénme dìtú literally means "what map." In exchange 11, this phrase is used to mean "what kind of map."

yìzhāng: the counter -zhāng is used for flat objects. Literally, yìzhāng Táiběi dìtú means "one sheet Taipei map." In exchange 11, the phrase is translated as "a map of Taipei."

8.1.3.11 Notes on № 12
12. A: Zhèzhāng Táiběi dìtú duōshao qián?
这张台北地图多少钱?
How much is this map of Taipei?
B: Shíèrkuài qián.
十二块钱。
Twelve dollars.

Zhèzhāng dìtú: compare the two phrases which follow.

zhè -zhāng dìtú this map
zhè liǎng -zhāng dìtú these two maps

In the first phrase, the counter -zhāng does not have a number in front of it. In effect, the number 1 was dropped after the specifier zhè. Notice that when a specifier and a number occur together in Chinese, the word order is just like English: Zhè liǎngzhāng dìtú, "these two maps."

13. yífèn (r) bàozhǐ 一份(儿)报纸 one newspaper
14. yìzhī bǐ 一支笔 one pen
15. yìzhāng zhǐ 一张纸 one piece of paper
16. yìběn zìdiǎn 一本字典 one dictionary
17. Hàn-Yīng zìdiǎn 汉英字典 Chinese-English dictionary
18. Yīng-Hàn zìdiǎn 英汉字典 English-Chinese dictionary
19. huàxué 化学 chemistry
20. shùxué 数学 mathematics

🛈︎
Notes on additional required vocabulary:

bàozhǐ and bào, two words for "newspaper," are interchangeable.

Yìzhī bǐ: The counter for pens, -zhī, is the counter for straight, stick-like objects.

Hàn-Yīng zìdiǎn, Yīng-Hàn zìdiǎn: The word for "Chinese" in these expressions comes from the Han Dynasty (206 B.C. to A.D. 219.) Hàn is often used in titles to refer to the Chinese people and their language.

8.2 Drills

8.2.1 

8.2.2 

8.2.3 

8.2.4 

8.2.5 

8.2.6 

8.2.7 

8.2.8 

8.2.9 

8.2.10 

9 Unit 2

9.1 References

9.1.1 Reference List

1. A: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi diǎnr diǎnxin.
我想买点儿点心。
I'm going to buy some pastries.
2. A: Zheìge xiǎo diǎnxin duōshao qián yìjīn?
这个小点心多少钱一经?
How much are these small pastries per catty?
B: Bāmáo qián yìjīn.
八毛钱一斤 。
Eighty cents a catty.
3. A: Gěi wǒ liǎngjīn.
给我两斤 。
Give me two catties.
4. A: Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ liǎngjīn.
清李给我两斤 。
Please give me two catties.
5. B: Nín hái yào diǎnr shénme?
您还要点儿什么?
What else do you want?
A: Wǒ hái yào qìshuǐ.
我还要汽水
I want some soda.
6. A: Duōshao qián yìpíng?
多少钱一平?
How much is it per bottle?
B: Liǎngmáo wǔfēn qián.
两毛五分钱。
It's twenty-five cents.
7. A: Zhèi shi sānkuài qián.
这是三块钱。
Here's three dollars.
B: Zhǎo nǐ liùmáo wǔfēn qián.
找你牛六毛五分钱。
Here's sixty-five cents (in) change.
A: Xièxie. Zàijiàn.
谢谢。再见。
Thank you. Good-bye
B: Zàijiàn.
再见。
Good-bye
8. A: Dà píngguǒ duōshao qián yìjīn?
大苹果多少钱一斤??
How much are the large apples per catty?
B: Dàde sìmáo wǔfēn qián yìjīn.
大的四毛五分钱一经。
The large ones are forty-five cents a catty.
9. A: Xiǎode duōshao qián yìjinq?
小的多少钱一经?
How much per catty are the small ones?
B: Sānmáo wǔ.
三毛五。
Thirty-five cents.
10. A: Qǐng gěi wǒ sānjīn nèige xiǎode.
清给我三经那个小的。
Please give me three catties of the small ones.
B: Hǎo. Sānjīn yíkuài líng wǔ.
好。三经一块零五。
Certainly. Three catties are $1.05.
11. B: Nín hái yào shénme?
您还要什么?
What else do you want?
A: Wǒ búyào shénme le.
我不要什么了。
I don't want anything else.

9.1.2 Vocabulary

júzi 橘子 oranges, tangerines
píjiǔ 啤酒 beer
yíkuài féizào 一块肥皂 one bar of soap
zuò mǎimai 做买卖 to do business
dàrén 大人 adult
xiǎoháizi 小孩子 child
to be large
-de marker of modification
diǎnr 点儿 a little, some
diǎnxin (yíkuài, yìjīn) 点心 (一块,一斤) pastry, snack
-fēn cent
gěi to give
hái also, additionally
-jīn catty (1.1 pound)
-kuài piece (counter)
líng zero
mǎimai 买卖 business
-máo dime
-píng bottle
píngguǒ 苹果 apple
qǐng please
qìshuǐ 汽水 soda, carbonated soft drink
xiǎo to be small
xiǎohaízi 小孩子 child
yào to want
zàijiàn 再见 good-bye
zhǎo to give change
zuò mǎimai 做买卖 to do business
gōngxiāo hézuòshè 供销合作社 supply and marketing cooperative

9.1.3 Reference Notes

9.1.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Wǒ xiǎng mǎi diǎnr diǎnxin.
我想买点儿点心。
I'm going to buy some pastries.

Diǎnr: The word yìdiǎnr (or yìdiǎn) is a combination of the number , "one," and the counter diǎn, "a dot", "a little bit." The number is often toneless, or, in this case, dropped when its meaning is "a" rather than "one".

The Běijīng version of this word, written diǎnr or yīdiǎnr is actually pronounced as if written diǎr or yídiǎr. These words rhyme with the English "tar,"

9.1.3.2 Notes on №2
2. A: Zheìge xiǎo diǎnxin duōshao qián yìjīn?
这个小点心多少钱一斤?
How much are these small pastries per catty?
B: Bāmáo qián yìjīn.
八毛钱一斤。
Eighty cents a catty.

A jīn is a unit of weight, usually translated as "catty." In most

parts of China a jīn equals 1.1 pound.

Bāmáo i You must use the equivalent of "eight dimes" to say "eighty cents." It is wrong to say bāshifēn for "eighty cents."

9.1.3.3 Notes on №3-4
3. A: Gěi wǒ liǎngjīn.
给我两斤。
Give me two catties.
4. A: Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ liǎngjīn.
清李给我两斤。
Please give me two catties.

Indirect object: Notice that the indirect object, , precedes the direct object, liǎngjīn, just as "me" precedes "two catties" in English.

Gěi liǎngjīn.
Give me two catties.

Polite request: A blunt imperative in Chinese has the same word order as a command in English: (), verb, indirect object, direct object. To make a polite request in Chinese, start off with qǐng, "please," or qǐng nǐ "please you." More literally qǐng means "to ask," "to request," but the idiomatic equivalent of qǐng and qǐng nǐ is "please." Here are the three types of imperatives.

gěi liǎngjīn. Give me two catties.
Qǐng gěi liǎngjīn. Please give me two catties OR Give me two catties, please.
Qǐng gěi liǎngjīn.
9.1.3.4 Notes on №5
5. B: Nín hái yào diǎnr shénme?
您还要点儿什么?
What else do you want?
A: Wǒ hái yào qìshuǐ.
我还要汽水
I want some soda.

Hái: in exchange 5, hái something like "in addition": "What do you want a little of in addition?" Since hái is an adverb, it is placed before the verb.

Qìshuǐ, "soda," refers to a carbonated soft drink, not to club soda.

9.1.3.5 Notes on №6
6. A: Duōshao qián yìpíng?
多少钱一瓶?
How much is it per bottle?
B: Liǎngmáo wǔfēn qián.
两毛五分钱。
It's twenty-five cents.

Tone change for : The number 1, , changes tone when followed by another syllable. When followed by a syllable with a Falling tone, has a Rising tone. When followed "by syllables with High, Rising, or Low tones, has a Falling tone.

High Tone follows Rising Tone follows Low Tone follows Falling Tone follows
yìjīn yìpíng yìběn yífèn
yìzhāng yìmáo yìdiǎn yíkuài
yìzhī yìnián yíyuè
yìtiān

Liǎngmáo wǔfēn qián: Notice that "twenty-five cents" is expressed in Chinese as dimes plus cents: "two dimes and five cents."

9.1.3.6 Notes on №7
7. A: Zhèi shi sānkuài qián.
这是三块钱。
Here's three dollars.
B: Zhǎo nǐ liùmáo wǔfēn qián.
找你六毛五分钱。
Here's sixty-five cents (in) change.
A: Xièxie. Zàijiàn.
谢谢。再见。
Thank you. Good-bye
B: Zàijiàn.
再见。
Good-bye

Zhèi: In the first sentence of exchange 7, zhèi is used without an attached counter. A specifier was also used without a counter in Nèi shi Mínzú Fàndiàn. "That's the Nationalities Hotel."

The verb zhǎo means "to give change." Zhǎo nǐ liùmáo wǔfēn qián means something like "I'm giving you sixty-five cents in change."

9.1.3.7 Notes on №8-9
8. A: Dà píngguǒ duōshao qián yìjīn?
大苹果多少斤?
How much are the large apples per catty?
B: Dàde sìmáo wǔfēn qián yìjīn.
大的四毛五分钱一斤。
The large ones are forty-five cents a catty.
9. A: Xiǎode duōshao qián yìjīn?
小的多少钱一斤?
How much per catty are the small ones?
B: Sānmáo wǔ.
三毛五。
Thirty-five cents.

The words dàde and xiǎode are translated as "large ones" and ""small ones." The nonspecific noun "ones" may be used because the specific thing being talked about (apples) was mentioned in an earlier sentence. The marker -de shows that and xiǎo modify a noun mentioned earlier in the conversation. Like their English translations "big ones" and "small ones," dàde and xiǎode act as nouns.

Sānmáo wǔ is an abbreviated way of giving a price. The last unit of money (ln this case, fēn "cent") and the word for "money," qián are left out. The unit omitted is always the next unit below the unit which is expressed. For instance, "three dollars and fifty cents" is sānkuài wǔ.

You know that the unit omitted is máo "dimes," because it is the next unit below kuài, "dollars." A one-unit price such as "three dollars" or cents"can never be abbreviated this way, because there would he no way of determining the unit marker omitted.

9.1.3.8 Notes on №10
10. A: Qǐng gěi wǒ sānjīn nèige xiǎode.
清给我三经那个小的。
Please give me three catties of the small ones.
B: Hǎo. Sānjīn yíkuài líng wǔ.
好。三经一块零五。
Certainly. Three catties are $1.05.

Sānjīn nèige xiǎode: The elements of this phrase appear in the following order: number, counter, specifier, noun, (in Chinese, units of measure, like jīn, act as counters.) Earlier, you learned phrases whose element a appeared in a different order: specifier, number, counter, noun, (zhèi liǎngzhāng dìtú). In both cases, the word order for the constructions Is the same in Chinese and English.

sān -jīn nèige xiǎode
three catties of those small ones
nèi sān -jīn xiǎode
those three catties of small ones

Zèige is translated as "those" in the first sentence of exchange 10. Strictly speaking, nèige can refer only to one item, since -ge is the counter for units. The apples, however, are regarded collectively as one category of things.

Yíkuài líng wǔ: In a price, the word líng is always used for a "zero" in the dimes position. In yíkuài líng wǔ, líng appears in the "dimes" place, so you know that must refer to cents.

9.1.3.9 Notes on №11
11. B: Nín hái yào shénme?
您还要什么?
What else do you want?
A: Wǒ búyào shénme le.
我不要什么了。
I don't want anything else.

Bú yào shenme: The unstressed (and often toneless) word shenme corresponds to the indefinite pronoun "anything" in negative sentences.

yào shénme? bú yào shénme
You want what thing? I don't want anything.

This construction is commonly used to say "I don't want (I'm not buying, I'm not reading) anything MUCH."

Nǐ mǎi shénme? What are you buying?
Wǒ bù mǎi shenme, zhǐ mǎi yífèn bào. I'm not buying anything much; I'm just buying a newspaper.

Le: In the second sentence of exchange 11, new situation le is used in a negative sentence. The sentence says that NOW Mr. Andersen does not want anything (while before, of course, he did want things.)

12. júzi 橘子 oranges
13. píjiǔ 啤酒 beer
14. yíkuài féizào 一块肥皂 one bar of soap
15. zuò mǎimai 做买卖 to do business
16. dàren 大人 adult
17. xiǎoháizi 小孩子 child
🛈︎
Notes on Additional Required Vocabulary

Júzi: In earlier modules, this word would have been written jǘzi. Starting in the Money Module, the umlaut (") will be written only after n and l, following the normal spelling rule in Pinyin romanization. You will have to remember that the letter u after j, q, x, and y is pronounced as if it were written ü.

Yíkuài féizào: The counter used for soap is -kuài. It literally means "a lump" but is also translated as a "piece."

Zuò mǎimai, "to do business/trade"

Tā lái zuò mǎimai le. He has come to do business.
Dàren, "adult," literally, "big person"

Tā yǐjīng shi dàren le. He is already an adult.

Xiǎoháizi: Although háizi means "child," the expression more commonly used is xiǎohāizi, literally, "small child."

9.2 Drills

9.2.1 

9.2.2 

9.2.3 

9.2.4 

9.2.5 

9.2.6 

9.2.7 

9.2.8 

9.2.9 

9.2.10 

10 Unit 3

10.1 References

10.1.1 Reference List

(in Běijīng)

1. A: Qǐng ni gěi wǒ kànkan nèige huāpíng. 请你给我看看那个花瓶? Please give me that vase to look at.
2. B: Něige? Zhèige lánde, háishi zhèige hóngde? 哪个?这个兰的,还是这个红的? Which one? This blue one or this red, one?
3. A: Nèi liǎngge dōu gěi wǒ kànkan, hǎo ma? 那两个都给我看看,好吗? Give me both of them to look at. All right?
B: Hǎo. 好。 Certainly.
4. A: Lánde tài guì le. 蓝的太贵了。 The blue one is too expensive.
5. A: Wǒ mǎi hóngde ba. Hóngde pyányi. 我买红的把。红的便宜。 I'll buy the red one, I guess. The red one is cheaper.
B: Èng, hóngde piányi. ??,红的便宜。 Mm, the red one is cheaper.
6. C: Zhèi liǎngge xuésheng, něige hǎo? 这两个学生,哪个好? Which of these two students is better?
D: Sīmǎ Xìn hǎo. 司马信好。 Sīmǎ Xìn is better.
7. A: Nǐ yǒu dà yìdiǎnrde ma? 你有大一点儿的吗? Do you have one a little larger?
B: Yǒu. Nín kàn zhèige zěnmeyàng? 有。您看这个怎么样? We do. What do you think of this one?
8. A: Zhèige dàde zhēn hǎokàn. 这个大的真好看。 This large one is really nice looking.
9. A: Hǎo, wǒ mǎi dàde ba. 好我买大的把。 Okay, I'll' buy the large one, I guess.
B: Nín yào jǐge? 您要几个? How many do you want?
A: Qǐng gěi wǒ liǎngge ba. 请给我两个把。 How about giving me two, please.
Additional required vocabulary (not presented on C-l and P-I tapes)
10. bái to be white
11. hēi to be black
12. huáng to be yellow, to be brown
13. 绿 to be green
14. jiù to be old, to be used, to be worn
15. xīn to be new
16. gāo to be tall
17. ǎi to he short (of stature)
18. gāoxìng 高兴 to be happy
19. nánkàn 难看 to be ugly
20. yìbǎ yǔsǎn 一把雨伞 one umbrella
21. kàn to read, to look at, to visit

10.1.2 Vocabulary

ǎi to be short (of stature)
-bǎ counter for things with handles
bái to be white
gāo to be tall
gāoxìng 高兴 to be happy
guì to be expensive
háishi 还是 or
hǎo to be better
hǎokàn 好看 to be beautiful, to be nice looking
hēi to be black
hóng to be red
huáng to be yellow, to te brown
huāpíng 花瓶 vase
jiù to be old, to be used, to be worn
kàn to think (express an opinion)
kànkan 看看 to read, to look at, to visit, to look at
lán to be blue
绿 to be green
nánkàn 难看 to be ugly
piányi 便宜 to be inexpensive, to be cheap
tài too (excessive)
xīn to be new
yǔsǎn 雨伞 umbrella
zěnmeyàng 怎么样 to be how, how is __?
zhēn really

10.1.3 Reference Notes

10.1.3.1 Notes on №1
1. A: Qǐng ni gěi wǒ kànkan nèige huāpíng. 请你给我看看那个花瓶? Please give me that vase to look at.

Reduplication of action verbs: In the sentence above, the action verb kàn appears in reduplicated form: kànkan [stress on first syllable; second syllable unstressed, usually toneless]. The reduplicated verb could also have been formed with between the two syllables: kànyikan , literally, "to look one look." kànyikan or kàn is used when you want to say "to have/take a look (at something.)

Many but not all, action verbs may be reduplicated, Of the verbs you learned, niàn, shuō, tīng, xiě, and xiǎng may be reduplicated this way.

Reduplication is another my of indicating aspect.

🛈︎
Note

The aspect marker -guo, le, and ne have already been introduced. For the meaning of the word "aspect," see BIO, Unit 4.

By using a reduplicated verb, you express the INDEFIHITENESS of an action. Use a reduplicated verb when the duration or extent of an action or the amount verb object is indefinite. For example, saying Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ kànkan indicate an indefinite duration for the action of looking at the vase.

There are several reasons for using a reduplicated verb to Indicate finite action. In the Reference List sentence above, a speaker asks permission to look at something; therefore, his request must be tentative and undemanding,

Reduplicated verbs are not commonly used with the aspect marker le (perhaps because stressing both the indefiniteness and the completion of action would not be consistent). When completion le does occur with reduplicated verb, the marker is placed after the first half of that verb before the second half. The second half of the reduplicated verb then resembles an object, as in "looked one look" or "thought a thought."

Wǒ kànle kàn nèige huāpíng. I looked at that vase.

kàn and xiǎng are the two verbs you have learned which may take le when reduplicated.

To make a reduplicated verb negative (with or méi) would be as wrong as saying in English "I don't look at it a little." To say that an action was not performed, is habitually not performed, or will not be performed, use the simple form of the verb, not the reduplicated form:

Zhèifèn bào, wǒ hái méiyou kàn. I haven't read this paper yet.
Wǒ bú kàn Zhōngwén bào. I don't read Chinese newspapers.
Wǒ bú kàn zhèige. I'm not going to read this.

The objects of reduplicated action verbs cannot be indefinite. For example, it is wrong to say because Qǐng nǐ gěi wǒ kànkan yige huāpíng, because yige huāpíng "a vase," is indefinite—which vase is not known, However, reduplicated verbs may have noun objects which are specified, like "that vase."

Niànnian shū, kànkan bào dōu hěn hǎo. Studying a little and reading a little are both nice.
Tā jiù shi shuōshuo. He's just talking.
Nǐ tīngting tā shuō shénme. Listen to what he is saying.
Tā tiāntian dōu kànkan shū, xiěxie zì. Every day he reads a little and writes characters a bit.
Ni xiǎngxiang tā xìng shénme. Try to think what his surname is.
Example 9.1 Examples

🛈︎
Note

Notice that in some of the examples the verb kàn means "to read," not "to look at."

10.1.3.2 Notes on №2
2. B: Něige? Zhèige lánde, háishi zhèige hóngde? 哪个?这个兰的,还是这个红的? Which one? This blue one or this red, one?

means 11 or.If In a cboice-type ^estion without hilshi,bpth choices muet include a vert; but in & guestion containing hlīshi> the second verb may be omitted-

10.1.3.3 Notes on №3
3. A: Nèi liǎngge dōu gěi wǒ kànkan, hǎo ma? 那两个都给我看看,好吗? Give me both of them to look at. All right?
B: Hǎo. 好。 Certainly.
10.1.3.4 Notes on №4
4. A: Lánde tài guì le. 蓝的太贵了。 The blue one is too expensive.
10.1.3.5 Notes on №5
5. A: Wǒ mǎi hóngde ba. Hóngde pyányi. 我买红的把。红的便宜。 I'll buy the red one, I guess. The red one is cheaper.
B: Èng, hóngde piányi. ??,红的便宜。 Mm, the red one is cheaper.
10.1.3.6 Notes on №6
6. C: Zhèi liǎngge xuésheng, něige hǎo? 这两个学生,哪个好? Which of these two students is better?
D: Sīmǎ Xìn hǎo. 司马信好。 Sīmǎ Xìn is better.
10.1.3.7 Notes on №7
7. A: Nǐ yǒu dà yìdiǎnrde ma? 你有大一点儿的吗? Do you have one a little larger?
B: Yǒu. Nín kàn zhèige zěnmeyàng? 有。您看这个怎么样? We do. What do you think of this one?
10.1.3.8 Notes on №8-9
8. A: Zhèige dàde zhēn hǎokàn. 这个大的真好看。 This large one is really nice looking.
9. A: Hǎo, wǒ mǎi dàde ba. 好我买大的把。 Okay, I'll' buy the large one, I guess.
B: Nín yào jǐge? 您要几个? How many do you want?
A: Qǐng gěi wǒ liǎngge ba. 请给我两个把。 How about giving me two, please.

10.2 Drills

10.2.1 

10.2.2 

10.2.3 

10.2.4 

10.2.5 

10.2.6 

10.2.7 

10.2.8 

10.2.9 

10.2.10 

11 Unit 4

11.1 Reference List

11.2 Vocabulary

11.3 Reference Notes

11.3.1 Notes on №

11.3.2 Notes on №

11.3.3 Notes on №

11.3.4 Notes on №

11.3.5 Notes on №

11.3.6 Notes on №

11.3.7 Notes on №

11.3.8 Notes on №

11.4 Drills

11.4.1 

11.4.2 

11.4.3 

11.4.4 

11.4.5 

11.4.6 

11.4.7 

11.4.8 

11.4.9 

11.4.10 

12 Unit 5

12.1 Reference List

12.2 Vocabulary

12.3 Reference Notes

12.3.1 Notes on №

12.3.2 Notes on №

12.3.3 Notes on №

12.3.4 Notes on №

12.3.5 Notes on №

12.3.6 Notes on №

12.3.7 Notes on №

12.3.8 Notes on №

12.4 Drills

12.4.1 

12.4.2 

12.4.3 

12.4.4 

12.4.5 

12.4.6 

12.4.7 

12.4.8 

12.4.9 

12.4.10 

13 Unit 6

13.1 Reference List

13.2 Vocabulary

13.3 Reference Notes

13.3.1 Notes on №

13.3.2 Notes on №

13.3.3 Notes on №

13.3.4 Notes on №

13.3.5 Notes on №

13.3.6 Notes on №

13.3.7 Notes on №

13.3.8 Notes on №

13.4 Drills

13.4.1 

13.4.2 

13.4.3 

13.4.4 

13.4.5 

13.4.6 

13.4.7 

13.4.8 

13.4.9 

13.4.10 

Chapter 4. Module 4: Directions

Student Textbook

1 Objectives

2 Tapes for BIO and associated modules

3 Unit 1 Target List

4 Unit 2 Target List

5 Unit 3 Target List

6 Unit 4 Target List

7 Unit 5 Target List

8 Unit 6 Target List

9 Unit 7 Target List

10 Unit 8 Target List

11 Unit 1

11.1 Introduction

11.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

11.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

11.1.3 Material you will need

11.2 References

11.2.1 Reference List

11.2.2 Vocabulary

11.2.3 Reference Notes

11.2.3.1 Notes on №

11.2.3.2 Notes on №

11.2.3.3 Notes on №

11.2.3.4 Notes on №

11.2.3.5 Notes on №

11.2.3.6 Notes on №

11.2.3.7 Notes on №

11.2.3.8 Notes on №

11.3 Drills

11.4 Criterion test

11.5 Appendices

11.5.1 Appendix

11.5.2 Appendix

11.5.3 Appendix

11.5.4 Appendix

11.5.5 Appendix

12 Unit 2

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

12.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

12.1.3 Material you will need

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

12.2.2 Vocabulary

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №

12.2.3.2 Notes on №

12.2.3.3 Notes on №

12.2.3.4 Notes on №

12.2.3.5 Notes on №

12.2.3.6 Notes on №

12.2.3.7 Notes on №

12.2.3.8 Notes on №

12.3 Drills

12.4 Criterion test

12.5 Appendices

12.5.1 Appendix

12.5.2 Appendix

12.5.3 Appendix

12.5.4 Appendix

12.5.5 Appendix

13 Unit 3

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

13.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

13.1.3 Material you will need

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

13.2.2 Vocabulary

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №

13.2.3.2 Notes on №

13.2.3.3 Notes on №

13.2.3.4 Notes on №

13.2.3.5 Notes on №

13.2.3.6 Notes on №

13.2.3.7 Notes on №

13.2.3.8 Notes on №

13.3 Drills

13.4 Criterion test

13.5 Appendices

13.5.1 Appendix

13.5.2 Appendix

13.5.3 Appendix

13.5.4 Appendix

13.5.5 Appendix

14 Unit 4

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

14.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

14.1.3 Material you will need

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

14.2.2 Vocabulary

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №

14.2.3.2 Notes on №

14.2.3.3 Notes on №

14.2.3.4 Notes on №

14.2.3.5 Notes on №

14.2.3.6 Notes on №

14.2.3.7 Notes on №

14.2.3.8 Notes on №

14.3 Drills

14.4 Criterion test

14.5 Appendices

14.5.1 Appendix

14.5.2 Appendix

14.5.3 Appendix

14.5.4 Appendix

14.5.5 Appendix

15 Unit 5

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

15.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

15.1.3 Material you will need

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

15.2.2 Vocabulary

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №

15.2.3.2 Notes on №

15.2.3.3 Notes on №

15.2.3.4 Notes on №

15.2.3.5 Notes on №

15.2.3.6 Notes on №

15.2.3.7 Notes on №

15.2.3.8 Notes on №

15.3 Drills

15.4 Criterion test

15.5 Appendices

15.5.1 Appendix

15.5.2 Appendix

15.5.3 Appendix

15.5.4 Appendix

15.5.5 Appendix

16 Unit 6

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

16.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

16.1.3 Material you will need

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

16.2.2 Vocabulary

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №

16.2.3.2 Notes on №

16.2.3.3 Notes on №

16.2.3.4 Notes on №

16.2.3.5 Notes on №

16.2.3.6 Notes on №

16.2.3.7 Notes on №

16.2.3.8 Notes on №

16.3 Drills

16.4 Criterion test

16.5 Appendices

16.5.1 Appendix

16.5.2 Appendix

16.5.3 Appendix

16.5.4 Appendix

16.5.5 Appendix

17 Unit 7

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

17.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

17.1.3 Material you will need

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

17.2.2 Vocabulary

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №

17.2.3.2 Notes on №

17.2.3.3 Notes on №

17.2.3.4 Notes on №

17.2.3.5 Notes on №

17.2.3.6 Notes on №

17.2.3.7 Notes on №

17.2.3.8 Notes on №

17.3 Drills

17.4 Criterion test

17.5 Appendices

17.5.1 Appendix

17.5.2 Appendix

17.5.3 Appendix

17.5.4 Appendix

17.5.5 Appendix

18 Unit 8

18.1 Introduction

18.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

18.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

18.1.3 Material you will need

18.2 References

18.2.1 Reference List

18.2.2 Vocabulary

18.2.3 Reference Notes

18.2.3.1 Notes on №

18.2.3.2 Notes on №

18.2.3.3 Notes on №

18.2.3.4 Notes on №

18.2.3.5 Notes on №

18.2.3.6 Notes on №

18.2.3.7 Notes on №

18.2.3.8 Notes on №

18.3 Drills

18.4 Criterion test

18.5 Appendices

18.5.1 Appendix

18.5.2 Appendix

18.5.3 Appendix

18.5.4 Appendix

18.5.5 Appendix

Chapter 5. Module 5: Transportation

Student Textbook

1 Objectives

Upon successful completion of this module, the student should be able to

  1. Give the English equivalent for any Chinese sentence in the TRN Target Lists.

  2. Say any Chinese sentence in the TRN Target Lists when cued with its English equivalent.

  3. Use the bus system: find out which buses go to a specific destination, at what times they leave, how often they run, where to buy tickets, where to change buses (if necessary), when the last bus of the day leaves, and where his stop is.

  4. Take a taxi: hail one, tell the driver where to go, and use commands such as “hurry,” “slow down,” and “stop here.”

  5. Use the train system: find out which trains go to a specific destination, at what times they leave, when and where to buy tickets, whether or not tickets are available for a train leaving on a specific date at a specific time, the distance to the destination, the duration of the train trip to that place, which platform the train leaves from, what to do with luggage, and whether or not the train has a dining car.

  6. Take a plane: reserve a ticket for a certain date and time; find out whether or not the flight is direct, the duration of the flight, and traveling time to the airport; and arrange for transportation to the airport.

  7. Describe in detail a trip (taken in the past or planned for the future): places visited (which places and what they are like), traveling companions, transportation for the trip, length of stay, number of previous trips to the same places.

2 Unit 1 Target List

1. Dào Xīméndīng qù, zuò jǐlù chē?
到西門町去,坐幾路車?
What bus do you take to get to Ximénding?
Zuò Shíbālù.
坐十八路。
Take Number 18.
2. Shíbālù chē duō bu duo?
十八路車多不多?
Are there many Number 18 buses?
Bù hěn duō.
不很多。
Not very many.
3. Měi gé jǐfēn zhōng yǒu yìbān chē?
每隔幾分鐘有一班車?
How often is there a bus?
4. Wǒ měige Xīngqīliù dōu qù kàn diànyǐng.
我每個星期六都去看電影。
I go to see a movie every Saturday.
5. Zuìhòu yìbān chē shi jǐdiān zhōng?
最後一班車是幾點鐘?
What time is the last bus?
6. Zhèbān chē shì bu shi qù Xīméndīng?
這班車是不是去西門町?
Does this bus go to Xīméndīng?
Shì. Shàng chē ba!
是。上車吧!
Yes. Get on!
7. Dào Xīméndīngde shíhou, qǐng gàosong wǒ.
到西門町的時候,請告誦我。
When we get to Xīméndīng, please tell me.
8. Wǒ shì bu shi zài zhèli xià chē?
我是不是在這裏下車?
Is it here that I get off?
Bú shi. Xià yízhàn.
不是。下一站。
No. The next stop.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

9. shàng-
last, previous (something)
10. tóu-
first (something)
11. gàosu
告訴
to tell, to inform (alternate pronunciation for gàosong)
12. shǎo
to be few
13. xià chē
下車
to get off the bus; “Out, please!”
14. yǒu(de) shíhou
有(的)時候
sometimes
15. chéng
city

3 Unit 2 Target List

1. Dào zhǎnlǎnguǎn yǒu meiyou zhídáchē?
到展覽館有沒有直達車?
Is there a direct bus to the exhibition hall?
Měiyou. Zuò Yīlù chē, zuò dao Xīdān huàn chē.
沒有。坐一路車,坐到西單換車。
No. Take the Number 1 bus; take it to Xīdān and change buses.
2. Zánmen zài nǎr mǎi piào?
咱們在哪兒買票?
Where do we buy tickets?
Zài chēshang mǎi piào.
在車上買票。
We buy tickets on the bus.
3. Hǎo, xiànzài zǒu ba!
好,現在走吧。
Okay, let’s go now!
4. Èi! Zánmen bú shi zuòguò zhàn le ba?
誒!咱們不是坐過站了吧?
Hey! Haven’t we gone past our stop?
Hái méi ne. Xià yízhàn cái xià chē.
還沒呢。下一站才下車。
Not yet. We don’t get off until the next stop.
5. Láojià, Shíwǔlù qìchēzhàn zài nǎr?
勞駕,十五路汽車站在哪兒?
Excuse me, where is the Number 15 bus stop?
Jiù zài nèige lùkǒurshang.
就在那個路口兒上。
It’s (just) on that corner.
6. gōnggòng qìchē
公共汽車
public bus (local)

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

7. -li
in (locational ending)
8. -shang
on
9. shàng ban
上班
to start work, to go to work
10. xià bān
下班
to get off from work, to leave work

4 Unit 3 Target List

1. Wǒ yào zuò jìchéngchē dào huǒchēzhàn qu.
我要計程車到火車站去。
I want to take a taxi to the train station.
2. Wǒ zhǐ yǒu zhè liǎngjiàn xíngli.
我只有這兩件行李。
I have only these two suitcases.
Hǎo, wǒ ba xíngli fàng zai qiánbǐan.
好,我把行李放在前邊。
Okay, I’ll put the suitcases in front.
3. Nǐ kāide tài kuài le!
你開得太快了!
You are driving too fast!
4. Tā kāi chē, kāide bú kuài.
他開車,開得不快。
He doesn’t drive fast.
5. Wǒmen yǒu shíjiān, láidejí.
我們有時間,來得及。
We have time. We can make it in time.
6. Qǐng màn yìdiǎn kāi.
請慢一點開。
Please drive a little slower.
7. Bié kāi nàme kuāi!
別開那麽快!
Don’t drive so fast!
8. Qǐng ni zài qiánbian nèige yínháng tíng yíxià.
請你在前邊那個銀行聼一下。
Please stop at that bank up ahead for a moment.
9. Bú yòng zhǎo le.
不用找了。
Keep the change.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

10. chūzū qìchē
出租汽車
taxi (PRC)
11. láibují
來不及
can’t make it in time
12. qìchē
汽車
car, motor vehicle
13. zhème
這麽
so, to this extent, in this way
14. zènme
怎麽
so, to this extent, in this way

5 Unit 4 Target List

1. Wǒ xiǎng qù Táinán wán jitiān.
我想去臺南玩幾天。
I’m thinking of going to Tainan to relax for a few days.
2. Nǐ shuō shi zuò huǒchē qu hǎo ne, háishi zuò Gōnglùjú qu hǎo e?
你説是坐火車去好呢,還是坐公路局去好呢?
Would you say it’s better to go by train or to go by bus?
Zuò huǒchē qu hǎo. Dào Táinán qù zuò Gōnglùjú bú dǎ fāngbian.
坐火車去好。到臺南去坐公路局不大方便。
It’s better to go by train. To go to Tainan, it's not very convenient to take the bus.
3. Zuò huǒchē děi xiān mǎi piào ma?
坐火車得先買票嗎?
If I take the train, is it necessary to buy tickets ahead of time?
Nǐ zuìhǎo liǎngsāntiān yǐqián qù mǎi piào.
你最好兩三天以前去買票。
It would be best for you to go to buy your tickets two or three days ahead of time.
Zuò Gōnglùjú ne?
坐公路局呢?
And if I take the bus?
Bú bì xiān mǎi piào.
不必先買票。
It's not necessary to buy tickets ahead of time.
4. Nǐ yào zuò shénme shíhoude chē?
你要做什麽時候的車?
What train do you want to take?
Wǒ yào zuò shàngwǔde chē.
我要坐上午的車。
I want to take a morning train.
5. Duìbuqǐ, shàngwǔde piào dōu màiwán le.
對不起,上午的票都賣完了。
I’m sorry, the tickets for the morning trains are all sold out.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

6. chuán
boat, ship
7. dìtiě
地鐵
subway (abbreviation for dìxià tiědào)
8. dìxià huǒchē
地下火車
underground train, subway
9. wán (wǎnr)
玩(兒)
to play, to relax, to enjoy oneself
10. -wán
to be finished (occurs in compound verbs of result)

6 Unit 5 Target List

1. Wǒ xiǎng dào Nánjīng qù kànkan.
我想到南京去看看。
I would like to go to Nánjīng to look around.
Nǐ jìhua něitiān qù?
你計劃哪天去?
What day do you plan to go?
Míngtiān huòshi hòutiān qù dōu kéyi.
明天或是後天去都可以。
Tomorrow and (or) the day after are both possible.
2. Shànghǎi lí Nánjīng yǒu duó yuǎn?
上海離南京有多遠。
How far is Shanghai from Nánjīng?
Yǒu liǎngbǎiwǔshiduō gōnglī.
有兩百五十多公里。
It’s over 250 kilometers.
3. Zuò huǒchē yào zǒu duōshao shíhou?
坐火車要走多少時候。
How long does it take to go by train?
Yào zǒu sìge bàn xiǎoshí.
要走四個半小時。
It takes four and a half hours.
4. Zhèi shi wǒ dìyīcì dào Nánjīng qù. Yǐqiǎn méi qùguo.
這是我第一次到南京去。以前沒去過。
This will be the first time I have gone to Nánjīng. I haven’t gone there before.
5. Bànge xiǎoshí gòu le.
半個小時夠了。
Half an hour is enough.
6. Wǒ xīwang xiàwǔ líkāi zhèr.
我希望下午離開這兒。
I hope to leave here in the afternoon.
Shísāndiǎn líng wǔfēn yǒu yítàng tèkuài.
十三點零五分有一趟特快。
There’s an express at 1305.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

7. dǎsuan
打算
to plan to
8. huòzhě (huòzhe)
或者
or (alternate form of huòshi)
9. yǐhòu
以後
afterwards, later on, in the future
10. zhōngtóu
鐘頭
hour (alternate word for xiǎoshí)

7 Unit 6 Target List

1. Huǒchē jǐdiǎn zhōng kāi?
火車幾點鐘開?
What time does the train leave?
Shíbādiǎn wǔshiwǔfēn fā chē.
十八點五十五分發車。
It departs at 1855.
2. Qǐng nǐ bǎ nǐde hùzhào hé lǚxíngzhèng gěi wo.
請你把你的護照和旅行證給我。
Please give me your passport and travel permit.
3. Dào Shànghǎi qùde chē zài dìjǐ zhàntái?
到上海取得車在第幾站臺?
On which platform is the train to Shànghǎi?
4. Bú yòng jí. Hái zǎo ne. Nǐ xiān zài zhèige jiēdàishì xiūxi xiuxi.
不用急。還早呢。你先在這個接待室休息休息。
No need to be anxious. It’s still early. First, rest a bit in this waiting room.
5. Wǒ zhèijiàn xíngli zěnme bàn? Shì bu shi kéyi náshang chē qu?
我這件行李怎麽辦?是不是可以拿上車去。
What should I do about this suitcase of mine? May I take it onto the train?
Kéyi bǎ xíngli náshang chē qu.
可以把行李拿上車去。
You may take the suitcase onto the train.
6. Zhèibān chē yǒu cānchē ba?
這班車有餐車吧?
This train has a dining car, I suppose?
Yǒu. Yǒu Zhōngcān, yě yǒu Xīcān.
有。有中餐,也有西餐。
Yes. There’s Chinese food and there’s also Western food.
Hǎojíle.
好極了。
Great.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

7. bān
to move
8. náshangqu
拿上去
to take up
9. náshanglai
拿上來
to bring up
10. áxiaqu
拿下去
to take down
11. náxialai
拿下來
to bring down
12. pǎo
to run
13. wǎn
to be late
14. yuètái
月臺
train platform (alternate word for zhàntái, more common in Taiwan)

8 Unit 7 Target List

1. Lǎo Sòng, zěnmeyàng? Máng ne?
老宋,怎麽樣?忙呢?
Song, how are things going? Are you busy?
Bù zěnme máng.
不怎麽忙。
Not especially busy.
2. Qǐng ni gěi wo dìng yìzhāng fēijī piào.
請你給我訂一張飛機票。
Please reserve a plane ticket for me.
3. Piào dìnghǎo le.
票訂好了。
The ticket has been reserved.
Něibān fēijī? Jǐdiǎn zhōng qǐfēi?
哪班飛機?幾點鐘起飛?
Which flight? What time does it take off?
4. Zhèibān fēijī zhí fēi Guǎngzhōuma?
這班飛機直飛廣州嗎?
Does this flight go directly to Guǎngzhōu?
5. Cóng Sānlǐtún dào fēijīchǎng yào duōshao shíjiān?
從三里屯到飛機場要多少時間?
How much time does it take to go from Sānlǐtún to the airport?
6. Rúguǒ wǒ bādiǎn zhōng líkāi jiā, láidejí ba?
如果我八點鐘離開家,來得及吧?
If I leave home at eight o’clock, I can make it in time. Right?
7. Qǐng ni pài ge chē lái jiē wo, sòng wo dào fēijīchǎng qu.
請你派個車來接我,送我到飛機場去。
Please send a car to pick me up and take me to the airport.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

8. hǎo le
好了
to be satisfactorily completed
9. ǚguǎn
旅館
hotel
10. shuōhǎo le
説好了
to have come to an agreement (about something); (something) has been agreed on
11. xiǎnghǎo le
想好了
to have reached a conclusion (about something); (something) has been thought out
12. yàoshi
要是
if (alternate word for rúguǒ)
13. zuòhǎo le
做好了
to have finished doing (something); (something) has been finished

9 Unit 8 Target List

1. Hǎo jiǔ méi jiàn, nín chū mén le ba?
好久沒見,您出門了吧?
I haven’t seen you in a long time. You have been away, I suppose?
2. Nín wèishénme gāng huílai yòu qù le ne?
您為什麽剛回來又去了呢?
Why did you go again when you had just come back from there?
Wǒ zhèicì dào Guǎngzhōu qù shi yīnwei wǒ yǒu yige hěn hǎode péngyou cóng Xiānggǎng lái.
我這次到廣州去是因爲我有一個很好的朋友從香港來。
This time I went to Guǎngzhōu because I had a very good friend coming there from Hong Kong.
3. Wǒmen yǒu yìnián méi jiàn le.
我們有一年沒見了。
We had not seen each other for a year.
Tā qǐng wo péi ta yìqǐ qù lǚxíng.
她請我陪她一起去旅行。
She asked me to accompany her (in her) travels.
4. Sānge yuè yǐqián tā hái bù zhīdào néng bu néng lái.
三個月以前她還不知道能不能來。
Three months ago she didn’t know yet whether she would be able to come or not.
5. Nǐmen dōu qùguo shénme dìfang?
你們都去過什麽地方?
What places did you go to?
6. Hángzhōu gēn Sūzhōu zhēn shi piàoliang.
杭州跟蘇州真是漂亮。
Hángzhōu and Sūzhōu are really beautiful.
7. Yǒu jīhui wǒ yào zài qù yícì.
有機會我要再去一次。
If I have the chance, I would like to go again.
8. Zhèixiē dìfang nǐ dōu qùguo le ba?
這些地方你都去過了吧?
You have gone to all those places, I suppose?
Méi dōu qùguo.
沒都去過。
I haven’t been to all of them.
9. huí guó
回國
to return to one’s native country
10. huí jiā
回家
to come/go home
11. huíqu
回去
to go back

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

12. rènao
熱鬧
to be lively/bustling/noisy
13. yǒu yìsi
有意思
to be interesting
14. méi(yǒu) yìsi
沒(有)意思
to be uninteresting
15. suǒyǐ (suóyi)
所以
therefore, so

10 Unit 1

10.1 References

10.1.1 Reference List

1. A: Dào Xīméndīng qù, zuò jǐlù chē?
到西門町去,坐幾路車?
What bus do you take to get to Xīméndīng?
B: Zuò Shíbālù.
坐十八路。
Take Number 18.
2. A: Shíbālù chē duō bu duo?
十八路車多不多?
Are there many Number 18 buses?
B: Bù hěn duō.
不很多。
Not very many.
3. A: Měi gé duōshao shíhou yǒu yìbān chē?
每隔多少時候有一班車。
How much time is there between buses?
B: Měi gé èrshifēn zhōng yǒu yìbān.
每隔二十分鐘有一班。
There’s one every twenty minutes.
4. C: Wǒ měige Xīngqīliù dōu qù kàn diànyǐng.
我每個星期六都去看電影。
I go to see a movie every Saturday.
5. A: Zuìhòu yìbān chē shi jǐdiǎn zhōng?
最後一班車是幾點鐘?
What time is the last bus?
B: Shíyīdiǎn shífēn.
十一點十分。
Eleven-ten.
十一點十分。
6. D: Zhèbān chē shì bu shi qù Xīméndīng?
這班車是不是去西門町?
Does this bus go to Xīméndīng?
E: Shì. Shàng chē ba!
是。上車吧!
Yes, Get on!
7. A: Dào Xīméndīngde shíhou, qǐng gàosong wǒ.
到西門町的時候,請告誦我。
When we get to Xīméndīng, please tell me.
F: Hǎo.
好。
Okay.
8. A: Hái yǒu jǐzhàn dào Xīméndīng?
還有幾站到西門町?
How many more stops are there to (before) Xīméndīng?
F: Xià yízhàn jiù shi Xīměndīng.
下一站就是西門町。
The next stop is Xīméndīng.

DDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-1 and P-1 tapes)

9. shàng-
last, previous (something)
shàng-
10. tóu-
first (something)
11. gàosu
告訴
to tell, to inform (alternate pronunciation for gàosong)
12. shǎo
to be few
13. xià chē
下車
to get off the bus; "Out, please!"
14. yǒu(de) shíhou
有(的)時候
sometimes
15. chéng
city

10.1.2 Vocabulary

-bān (counter for regularly scheduled trips of buses, planes, subways, trains, etc.)
chē vehicle, bus, car
chéng city
duō to be many
-fēn a minute
gàosong 告誦 to tell, to inform
gàosu 告訴 to tell, to inform
to separate, to divide off
jǐlù chē 幾路車 what number bus
měi- every, each
shàng to get on
shàng- last, previous (something)
shǎo to be few
tóu- first (something)
xià to get off
xià- next (something)
xià chē 下車 to get off the bus; “Out, please!”
Xīmēndīng 西門町 (an area of Taipei)
yǒu(de) shíhou 有(的)時候 sometimes
zhàn a stop, a station
zuìhòu 最後 last, final (something)
(introduced on C-2 and P-2 tapes)
Běihǎi Gōngyuán 北海公園 (a famous park in Běijīng)
biěde shíhou 別的時候 other times
Dōngjīng 東京 Tokyo
fàng jià 放假 to close for a holiday
hǎowán 好玩 to “be fun (lit. , “good for relaxing”)
huì will
sījī 司機 driver of a hired vehicle
zǒu ba 走吧 let’s go

10.1.3 Reference Notes

10.1.3.1 Notes on №1-2
1. A: Dào Xīméndīng qù, zuò jǐlù chē?
到西門町去,坐幾路車?
What bus do you take to get to Xīméndīng?
B: Zuò Shíbālù.
坐十八路。
Take Number 18.
2. A: Shíbālù chē duō bu duo?
十八路車多不多?
Are there many Number 18 buses?
B: Bù hěn duō.
不很多。
Not very many.

Xīméndīng literally means “West Gate ding”—dīng being a Japanese term for “district.” Xīméndīng is the area of Taipei which surrounds the former west gate of the city. Today the district includes many shops, department stores, and movie theaters.

is the word for “route.” The question jǐlù? asks for the route number of the bus.

Zuò, “to ride/to go by/to take [a conveyance]”:

🛈︎
Note

Zuò appeared earlier in Zuò diàntī dào èrlou, “Take the elevator to the second floor.

Here zuò (literally, “to sit”) means to go by some means of transportation which the passenger is inside of (e.g., car, plane, boat, train, bus, elevator—NOT a motor- cycle or a horse). In exchange 1, zuò is used as a main verb. It can also be used as a prepositional verb, as in
Nǐ zěnme qù?
你怎麽去?
How are you going? (i.e., by what means of transportation)
Wǒ zuò huǒchē qù.
我坐火車去。
I am going by train.

Duō, “to be many/much,” is an adjectival verb. There are several points to remember about duō:

🛈︎

Note

Adjectival verbs are one type of STATE verb. See BIO, Unit 6.

  1. Adjectival verbs are sometimes used before a noun to modify it (e.g., xīn zhuōzi, “new table”; dà fángzi, “big house”). However, when duō is used in this way, it must be modified, for example, by hěn or tài.

    Tā mǎile hěn duō dōngxi.

    他買了很多東西。

    He bought a lot of things.

    Běijīng jiēshang yǒu hěn duō cèsuǒ.

    比較街上有很多厠所。

    There are many toilets on the streets of Běijīng.

  2. Much more often, however, duō is used as the main verb of a sentence.

    Nǐde shū zhēn duō!

    你的書很多。

    You really have a lot of books!

    Jīntiān jiēshangde rén hěn duō.

    今天的街上的人很多。

    There are a lot of people out today, (literally, “on the streets today”) [16]

  3. Often it does not occur to students to use duō as the main verb of a sentence because in English they do not usually say “The students are many.” They would say “There are many students,” with “many” as an adjective preceding “students.” Compare:

    Zhèrde rén hěn duō.

    這兒的人很多。

    There are a lot of people here.

    Láide rén hěn duō.

    來的人很多。

    A lot of people came.

    NOTE: Shǎo, “to be few,” is used in almost the same ways as duō. (See Notes on Additional Required Vocabulary.)

10.1.3.2 Notes on №3
3. A: Měi gé duōshao shíhou yǒu yìbān chē?
每隔多少時候有一班車。
How much time is there between buses?
B: Měi gé èrshifēn zhōng yǒu yìbān.
每隔二十分鐘有一班。
There’s one every twenty minutes.

Měi- is the word for “each,” “every.”

is a verb meaning “to separate,” “to divide.” It is used for intervals of time between regularly occurring events (e.g., “every half hour”). In exchange 3, gé refers to the length of time between buses.

měi gé duōshao shíhou

每 隔 多少 時候

(every divide-off [interval] how much time) “(every) how often”

The first sentence could also be translated as “How often is there a bus?” or “How often do the buses run?”

The counter -bān is used for scheduled trips, or runs, of a vehicle. Yìbān chē is one bus run.

Example 10.1.3.2.1 Yìbān chē:

The counter -fēn, for minutes, is usually followed by zhōng, “clock.” (Zhōng means “o’clock” in telling time.) “One minute” is yìfēn zhōng.

Example 10.1.3.2.2 Èrshifēn zhōng:

Měi èrshifēn zhōng yǒu yìbān chē.
二十分鐘 一班 車。
each interval twenty minutes there is one [run] bus
“There’s a bus every twenty minutes.”

10.1.3.3 Notes on №4
4. C: Wǒ měige Xīngqīliù dōu qù kàn diànyǐng.
我每個星期六都去看電影。
I go to see a movie every Saturday.

Měige: When used with a noun, měi- acts as a specifier and must be followed by a counter or a noun that does not require a counter.

měi(ge) rěn

每(個)人

every person

měizhāng zhuōzi

每個桌子

every table

měitiān

每天

every day

Dōu, “all”: Here the adverb dōu implies “each and every,” or “without exception”—“every Saturday, without exception.” When the subject of a sentence is specified by měi-, the following verb is usually modified by the adverb dōu.

10.1.3.4 Notes on №5
5. A: Zuìhòu yìbān chē shi jǐdiǎn zhōng?
最後一班車是幾點鐘?
What time is the last bus?
B: Shíyīdiǎn shífēn.
十一點十分。
Eleven-ten.
十一點十分。

Zuìhòu yìbān chē: Zuì is the word for “most,” or “-est.” Zuìhòu means “latest,” or “last.” Note the order in which the elements of this phrase appear:

zuìhòu -ban chē
最後
last one run bus

“the last bus”

Both the number and the counter are required in this phrase.

Compare:

tóu -ban chē “the first bus”
xià -ban chē “the next bus”
shàng -ban chē “the last (previous) bus”

(See Note on No. 8 and Notes on Additional Required Vocabulary for xià-, “next”; shàng-, “last,” “previous”; and tóu-, “first.”)

10.1.3.5 Notes on №6

6. D: Zhèbān chē shì bu shi qù Xīméndīng?
這班車是不是去西門町?
Does this bus go to Xīméndīng?
E: Shì. Shàng chē ba!
是。上車吧!
Yes, Get on!

Shì bu shi qù, “does it go to”:* The use of shì bu shi qù rather than qù bu qu in this sentence implies that the speaker has an idea that the bus does go to Xīméndīng and wants to make sure. (Zhèbān chē qù bu qu Xīméndīng? would also be correct.)

*For a discussion of the use of shì bu shi before another verb to form a question, see MON, Unit 5, notes on No. 8.

Qù Xīméndīng, “go to Xīméndīng”: The destination directly follows the main verb . You now know two ways to indicate destination:

Wo dào Xīméndīng qù.

I am going to Xīméndīng.

我到西門町去。

Wo qù Xīméndīng.

我去西門町。

The two forms are equally widely used.

Shàng chē: This verb has several meanings. In the Directions Module, the meaning was “to go up” in Shàng lóu, yòubian jiù shi mài dìtúde. In this exchange, the meaning of shàng is “to get on/in [a vehicle].”

10.1.3.6 Notes on №7
7. A: Dào Xīméndīngde shíhou, qǐng gàosong wǒ.
到西門町的時候,請告誦我。
When we get to Xīméndīng, please tell me.
F: Hǎo.
好。
Okay.

Dào Xīméndīngde shíhou means “when we arrive in Xīméndīng.” If you want to say, in Chinese, “when [something happens],” add -de shíhou to the phrase which names the happening.

In English, “when” can mean either “during the same time” (e.g., “when I was a student”) or “immediately after” (e.g., “when the light turns green”). In Chinese, however, two different expressions are used for the two meanings: -de shíhou for “at the same time” and yǐhou for “immediately after.”

Wǒ zài Xiānggǎngde shíhou hěn xǐhuan qù kàn diànyǐng.

我在香港的時候很喜歡去看電影。

When [i.e., while] I was in Hong Kong, I liked to go to the movies very much.

Wǒ dàole Táiběi yīhòu, mǎile hěn duō Zhōngwén shū.

我到了臺北以後,買了很多中文書。

When [i.e., after] I got to Taipei, I bought a lot of Chinese books.

10.1.3.7 Notes on №8
8. A: Hái yǒu jǐzhàn dào Xīméndīng?
還有幾站到西門町?
How many more stops are there to (before) Xīméndīng?
F: Xià yízhàn jiù shi Xīměndīng.
下一站就是西門町。
The next stop is Xīméndīng.

Xià yízhàn: Here xià means “the next.” It is a specifier. Xià is usually followed by a numeral or a counter, as in the following examples:

xiàge yuè

next month

下個月

xià yíbān chē

the next bus

下一班車

The phrase xià yízhàn contains no counter because -zhàn, like -nián and -tiān, is not used with a counter.

10.1.3.8 Notes on Additional Vocabulary
9. shàng-
last, previous (something)
10. tóu-
first (something)
11. gàosu
告訴
to tell, to inform (alternate pronunciation for gàosong)
12. shǎo
to be few
13. xià chē
下車
to get off the bus; "Out, please!"
14. yǒu(de) shíhou
有(的)時候
sometimes
15. chéng
city

The specifier shàng-, “last,” “previous,” is used in the same patterns as xià-.

shàngge yuè

last month

上個月

shàng yìbān chē

the previous bus

上一班車

Tóu-, “first,” literally “head”: Let’s contrast - and tóu-: - has no meaning of its own. Its function is to make a cardinal number into an ordinal number: for example, sān, “three,” becomes dìsān, “third,” as in dìsānge mén, “the third door.” Tóu- has a meaning of its own: “first,” as in tóusānge men, “the first three doors.”

Tóu- is always followed by at least a number plus a counter (or a noun that does not require a counter).

tóuliǎngge rén

the first two people

頭兩個人

tóusānběn

the first three volumes

頭三本

tóusìtiān

the first four days

頭四天

Notice that tóuliāngge, “the first two,” and dìèrge, “the second one,” must use different words for “two,” because

tóuliāngge

(COUNTING)

頭兩個

dìèrge

(NOT COUNTING)

第二個

Tóuyige, “the first one,” and dìyīge, “the first one,” are similar in meaning and often interchangeable.

Gàosu, “to tell”: Gaosong is the usual colloquial pronunciation in Běijīng speech. Gàosu is the usual colloquial pronunciation in many other places in China, including Taiwan. The fact that, in a Taipei setting, the first speaker in exchange 7 uses gàosong tells you that he is almost certainly not a native of Taiwan.

Shǎo, “to be few”: Most of the comments about duō in these Reference Notes (exchange 2) also apply to the adjectival verb shǎo. Most frequently shǎo is used as the main verb of a sentence.

Wǒde qián bù shǎo.

我的錢不少。

I have quite a bit of money.

Zài Táiwān méiyou gōngzuòde rén hěn shǎo.

在臺灣沒有工作的人很少。

There are few people in Taiwan who do not have Jobs.

One point deserves special attention: Although you may say hěn duō shū for “a lot of books,” you may not say hěn shǎo shū. Hěn shǎo can rarely modify a noun which follows—and neither can tài shǎo, zhēn shǎo, and related expressions.

Xià chē, “to get off [a vehicle],” may be used to signal that you wish to get off—that this is your stop. The expression would be translated as “Out, please,” or “Getting off, getting off,” used by passengers in crowded buses and elevators.

Yǒu(de) shíhou, “sometimes,” precedes the verb of a sentence, as other time expressions do.

Tā yǒude shíhou kàn Yīngwén bào.

He sometimes reads English newspapers.

他有的時候看英文報

Wǒ yǒu shíhou zuò Shíbālù chē.

Sometimes I take the Number 18 bus.

我有時候坐十八路車。

Originally, chéng meant “city wall.” This early meaning still affects modern usage: you must say “going INto the city,” not just “to the city.”

Tā jīntiān dào chénglǐtou qù.

He is going to the city today.

他今天到城裏頭去。

10.1.3.9 Vocabulary booster

Modes of Transportation

bicycle [Běijīng] zìxíngchē 自行車
[Táiwān] jiǎotàchē 脚踏車
boat chuán
motorboat qìtǐng 汽艇
rowboat huátǐng 划艇
sailboat fānchuán 帆船
sampan shānbǎn 舢舨
bus gōnggòng qìchē 公共汽車
coach (long-distance) chángtú qìchē 長途汽車
car (automobile) qìchē 汽車
chēzi 車子
chē
helicopter zhíshēngfēijī 直升飛機
horseback riding qí mǎ 騎馬
jeep jípǔchē 吉普車
motorcycle mótuōchē 摩托車
plane fēijī 飛機
jet [PRC] pēnqìshì fēijī 噴氣式飛機
[Táiwān] pēnshèshì fēijī 噴射式飛機
[Táiwān] pēnshèjī 噴射機
subway dìxiàtiě 地下鐵
dìtiě 地鐵
dìxià huǒchē 地下火車
taxi chūzū qìchē 出租汽車
[PRC] chūzū chē 出租車
[Táiwān] jìchéngchē 計程車
train huǒchē 火車
trolley diànchē 電車
truck kǎchē 卡車
walking zǒu lù 走路

10.2 Drills

11 Unit 2

11.1 References

11.1.1 Reference List

11.1.2 Vocabulary

11.1.3 Reference Notes

11.1.3.1 Notes on №

11.1.3.2 Notes on №

11.1.3.3 Notes on №

11.1.3.4 Notes on №

11.1.3.5 Notes on №

11.1.3.6 Notes on №

11.1.3.7 Notes on №

11.1.3.8 Notes on №

11.2 Drills

11.3 Criterion test

11.4 Appendices

11.4.1 Appendix

11.4.2 Appendix

11.4.3 Appendix

11.4.4 Appendix

11.4.5 Appendix

12 Unit 3

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

12.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

12.1.3 Material you will need

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

12.2.2 Vocabulary

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №

12.2.3.2 Notes on №

12.2.3.3 Notes on №

12.2.3.4 Notes on №

12.2.3.5 Notes on №

12.2.3.6 Notes on №

12.2.3.7 Notes on №

12.2.3.8 Notes on №

12.3 Drills

12.4 Criterion test

12.5 Appendices

12.5.1 Appendix

12.5.2 Appendix

12.5.3 Appendix

12.5.4 Appendix

12.5.5 Appendix

13 Unit 4

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

13.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

13.1.3 Material you will need

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

13.2.2 Vocabulary

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №

13.2.3.2 Notes on №

13.2.3.3 Notes on №

13.2.3.4 Notes on №

13.2.3.5 Notes on №

13.2.3.6 Notes on №

13.2.3.7 Notes on №

13.2.3.8 Notes on №

13.3 Drills

13.4 Criterion test

13.5 Appendices

13.5.1 Appendix

13.5.2 Appendix

13.5.3 Appendix

13.5.4 Appendix

13.5.5 Appendix

14 Unit 5

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

14.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

14.1.3 Material you will need

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

14.2.2 Vocabulary

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №

14.2.3.2 Notes on №

14.2.3.3 Notes on №

14.2.3.4 Notes on №

14.2.3.5 Notes on №

14.2.3.6 Notes on №

14.2.3.7 Notes on №

14.2.3.8 Notes on №

14.3 Drills

14.4 Criterion test

14.5 Appendices

14.5.1 Appendix

14.5.2 Appendix

14.5.3 Appendix

14.5.4 Appendix

14.5.5 Appendix

15 Unit 6

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

15.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

15.1.3 Material you will need

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

15.2.2 Vocabulary

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №

15.2.3.2 Notes on №

15.2.3.3 Notes on №

15.2.3.4 Notes on №

15.2.3.5 Notes on №

15.2.3.6 Notes on №

15.2.3.7 Notes on №

15.2.3.8 Notes on №

15.3 Drills

15.4 Criterion test

15.5 Appendices

15.5.1 Appendix

15.5.2 Appendix

15.5.3 Appendix

15.5.4 Appendix

15.5.5 Appendix

16 Unit 7

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

16.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

16.1.3 Material you will need

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

16.2.2 Vocabulary

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №

16.2.3.2 Notes on №

16.2.3.3 Notes on №

16.2.3.4 Notes on №

16.2.3.5 Notes on №

16.2.3.6 Notes on №

16.2.3.7 Notes on №

16.2.3.8 Notes on №

16.3 Drills

16.4 Criterion test

16.5 Appendices

16.5.1 Appendix

16.5.2 Appendix

16.5.3 Appendix

16.5.4 Appendix

16.5.5 Appendix

17 Unit 8

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

17.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

17.1.3 Material you will need

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

17.2.2 Vocabulary

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №

17.2.3.2 Notes on №

17.2.3.3 Notes on №

17.2.3.4 Notes on №

17.2.3.5 Notes on №

17.2.3.6 Notes on №

17.2.3.7 Notes on №

17.2.3.8 Notes on №

17.3 Drills

17.4 Criterion test

17.5 Appendices

17.5.1 Appendix

17.5.2 Appendix

17.5.3 Appendix

17.5.4 Appendix

17.5.5 Appendix

Chapter 6. Module 6: Arranging a meeting

he Meeting Module (MTG) will provide you with the skills needed to arrange meetings or social gatherings, to greet people, to make introductions, and to accept or decline invitations in Chinese.

Before starting this module, you must take and pass the TRN Criterion Test.

The MTG Criterion Test will focus largely on this module, but material from ORN, BIO, MON, DIR, TRN, and associated resource modules is also included.

1 Objectives

Upon successful completion of this module, the student should be able to

  1. Give the English equivalent for any Chinese sentence in the MTG Target Lists.

  2. Say any Chinese sentence in the MTG Target Lists when cued with English equivalent.

  3. Make and respond to introductions with appropriate polite questions and answers.

  4. Make phone calls and leave messages.

  5. Arrange a meeting (time and place) with someone by talking with him or his secretary either in person or by phone.

  6. Request that the time of a meeting be changed.

  7. Invite a person to lunch, deciding on the time and the restaurant.

  8. Arrange a social gathering for a specific time of day, inviting guests to his home and encouraging them to accept the invitation.

  9. Greet guests upon their arrival at his home.

  10. Accept/decline a social/business invitation with the appropriate degree of politeness.

2 Unit 1 Target List

1. Wèi, nǐ shi Zhū Kēzhǎng ma?
喂, 你是朱科長嗎?
Hello. Are you Section Chief Zhū?
Shì. Nín shi něiwèi?
是。您是哪位?
Yes. Who is this, please?
Wǒ shi Wēilián Mǎdīng
我是威廉馬丁。
I’m William Martin.
Òu, Mǎdīng Xiānsheng, hǎo jiǔ bú jiàn.
哦, 馬丁先生, 好久不見。
Oh, Mr. Martin—I haven’t seen you for a long time.
2. Wo yǒu diǎnr shì xiǎng gēn nín dāngmiàn tántan.
我有點兒事想跟您當面談談。
I have something I would like to talk with you about in person.
3. Nín yǒu gōngfu meiyou?
您有功夫沒有?
Do you have any free time?
4. Shénme shíhou duì nín héshì?
什麽時候對您合適?
What time would suit you?
5. Sāndiǎn bǐ liǎngdiǎn fāngbian yìdiǎnr. Yīnwei wǒ yìhuǐr chūqu, yěxǔ liǎngdiǎn huíbulái.
三點比兩點方便一點兒。因爲一會兒出去,也許兩點回不來。
Three would be more convenient than two. Since I’m going out in a little while, I might not be able to get back by two.
Nàme,wǒ sāndiǎn zhōng zài lóuxiàde huìkèshì děng nín.
那麽, 我三點鐘在樓下的會客室等您。
Well then, I’ll wait for you in the reception room downstairs at three o’clock.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. huídelái
回得來
to be able to get back in time
7. kòng(r)
空(兒)
free time, spare time
8. lóushàng
樓上
upstairs
9. shāngliang
商量
to discuss, to talk over
10. yǒu kòng(r)
有空(兒)
to have free time

3 Unit 2 Target List

1. Wèi, Mēidàsī.
喂, 美大司。
Hello. Department of American and Oceanic Affairs.
Wǒ shi Jiānádà Dàshiguǎnde Qiáozhì Dáfēi. Wǒ yǒu yíjiàn shì xiǎng gēn Wáng Kēzhǎng jiǎng-yijiǎng.
我是加拿大大使館的喬治達菲。我有一件事想跟王科長講一講。
I am George Duffy of the Canadian Embassy. I have something I would like to discuss with Section Chief Wáng.
2. Wáng Kēzhǎng xiànzài zài kāi huì. Děng tā kāiwán huì wǒ gàosong tā gěi ni huí diànhuà.
王科長現在在開會。等她開完會我告訴告誦她給你回電話。
Section Chief Wáng is at a meeting now. When she is finished with the meeting, I will tell her to return your call.
3. Hǎo, xièxie ni.
好,謝謝你。
Fine. Thank you.
Bú xiè.
不謝。
Don’t mention it.
4. Nǐ dǎ diànhuà láide shíhou wǒ méi shíjiān gēn ni shuō huà.
你打電話來的時候我沒時間跟你説話。
When you called here, I didn’t have time to speak with you.
Méi guānxi.
沒關係。
It doesn’t matter.
5. Wǒ gěi ni dǎ diànhuàde mùdi shi xiǎng gēn ni dāngmiàn tántan.
我給你打電話目的是想跟你當面談談。
The reason I called you is that I would like to talk with you in person.
Nǐ míngtiān něng bu néng dào wǒ zhěr lái?
你明天能不能到我這兒來?
Can you come over here tomorrow?
Kéyi. Míngtiān shénme shíhou dōu kéyi.
你明天能不能到我這兒來?
Yes. Any time tomorrow would be fine.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. guānxi
關係
relation, relationship, connection
7. jiǎng huà
講話
to speak, to talk; a speech
8. lǐngshiguǎn
領事館
consulate
9. shìqing (yíjiàn)
事情 (一件)
matter, business, affair
10. sīzhǎng
司長
department chief
11. yǒu guānxi
有關係
to relate to, to have a bearing on, to matter

4 Unit 3 Target List

1. Wǒ xiǎng xiàge Xīngqīliù qǐng nín dào wǒmen jiā lái chī ge biànfàn.
我想下個星期六請您到我們家來 吃個便飯。
I would like to invite you to come to our house for a simple meal on Saturday of next week.
Nín hébì zhème kèqi?
您何必這麽客氣?
Why is it necessary to be so polite?
2. Wǒ yǒu yige Měiguo péngyou zài Táiwān Dàxué jiāo shū. Hěn xiǎng gěi nǐmen liǎngwèi jièshao jièshao.
我有一個美國朋友在臺灣大學教書。 很想給你們兩位介紹介紹。
I have an American friend who teaches at Táiwān University. I would very much like to introduce the two of you.
Nà tài hǎo le!
你太好了!
That’s wonderful!
3. Wǒ hěn xǐwang gēn ni péngyou tántan.
我很希望跟你朋友談談。
I wish very much to talk with your friend.
Búguò, kǒngpà wǒde Yīngwén bù xíng.
不過,恐怕我的英文不行。
However, I’m afraid that my English isn’t good enough.
Búdàn shuōde bù hǎo, yǒu shíhou yě tīngbudǒng.
不但説得不好,有時候也聽不懂。
Not only don’t I speak well, (but) sometimes I can’t understand what I hear either.
4. Nǐ shuōde gēn Měiguo rén yíyàng hǎo.
你説得跟美國人一樣。
You speak as well as an American.
5. Wǒ méi qǐng shénme rén; hěn suíbiàn.
我沒請什麽人;很隨便。
I haven’t invited anyone special; it’s very informal.
Nà jiù xiān xiè le.
那就先謝了。
Well then, I’ll thank you in advance.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. bù tóng
不同
to be different
7. chá
tea
8. chī fàn
吃飯
to eat, to have a meal
9. dànshi
但是
but
10. érqiě
而且
furthermore, moreover
11. fàn
(cooked) rice
12.
to drink
13. jiāo shū
教書
to teach

5 Unit 4 Target List

1. Hé Jiàoshòu, huānyíng, huānyíng.Qǐng jìn.
何教授,歡迎,歡迎。請進。
Professor Hollins, welcome. Please come in.
Zhè shi yìdiǎn xiǎo yìsi.
這是一點小意思。
Here is a small token of appreciation.
2. Wǒ zhīdao nín xǐhuan shānshuǐ huà.
我知道您喜歡山水畫。
I know you like landscape painting.
Tèbiě qǐng péngyou gěi nín huàle yìzhāng.
特別請朋友給您畫一張。
I asked a friend to paint one especially for you.
3. Zhèiwèi shi Hé Jiàoshòu, zài Táidà jiāo shū.
這位是何教授,在台大教書。
This is Professor Hollins, who teaches at Táiwān University.
Jiǔyǎng, jiǔyǎng.
久仰,久仰。
Glad to meet you.
4. Wǒ hái yǒu hěn duō bù shóuxide dìfang yào xiàng nín qǐngjiào.
我還有很多不熟悉的地方要向您請教。
There is still much I’m not familiar with that I need to ask your advice about.
5. Xǐwang yǐhòu yǒu jīhui duō jiànmiàn.
希望以後有機會多見面。
I hope that in the future we will have an opportunity to meet more.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. fāngfǎ
方法
method, way, means
7. fázi
法子
method, way
8. huàr
畫兒
painting (Běijīng pronunciation)
9. qǐng zuò
請坐
please sit down
10. shèhuìxué
社會學
sociology
11. túshūguǎn
圖書館
library
12. zuò
to sit

6 Unit 5 Target List

1. Wài.
Hello.
Wèi, shi Wàijiāobù ma? Wǒ yào zhǎo Lín Sīzhǎng shuō huà.
喂,外交部嗎?我要找林司長説話。
Hello. Is this the Ministry of Foreign Affairs? I want to speak with Department Chief Lin.
Nín shi nǎr a?
您是那兒啊?
Who is this?
Wǒ shi Fǎguo Shāngwù Jīngjiguān.
我是法國商務經濟官。
I am the French Commercial/Economics Officer.
2. Lin Sīzhǎng zhèihuír bú zài. Nín yào liú ge huàr ma?
林司長這會兒不在。
Department Chief Lin is not here at the moment. Would you like to leave a message?
3. Wǒ bǎ nínde diànhuà hàomǎr xiěxiàlái.
我把您的電話號兒寫下來。
I’ll write down your phone number.
4. Duìbuqǐ, nǐ gāngcái gěi wo da diànhuà, wǒ bú zài.
對不起,你剛才給我打電話,我不在。
I’m sorry. When you called me just now, I wasn’t in.
5. Wǒ nèitiān gēn nín yuēhǎole jīntiān dào nín bàngōngshì qu tántan.
我那天跟您約好了今天到辦公室去談談。
The other day I made an appointment with you to go to your office today for a talk.
Yīnwei wǒ yǒu yíjiàn yàojǐnde shì, suóyi bù néng jīntiān qù.
因爲我有一件要緊的事,所以不能今天去。
Because I have an urgent business matter, I can’t go today.
Gǎi dào míngtiān xíng bu xíng?
改到明天行不行?
Would it be all right to change it [the appointment] to tomorrow?

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. háishi
還是
still
7. wàiguo
外國
foreign, abroad
8. wàiguo rén
外國人
foreigner (non-Chinese)
9. wūzi (yìjiān)
屋子 (一間)
room
10. yāo
one (telephone pronunciation)

7 Unit 6 Target List

1. Wǒmen dào Dōngmén Cāntīng qù chī zhōngfàn, hǎo bu hǎo?
我們到東門餐廳去吃中飯,好不好?
Let’s go to the East Gate Restaurant to eat lunch. Okay?
Dōngménde cài méiyou Dàhuáde cài nàme hǎo.
東門的菜沒有大華菜那麽好。
The food at the East Gate isn’t as good as the food at the Great China.
2. Suírán bú tài hǎo, kěshi lí zhèli jìn.
雖然不太好,可是離這裏近。
Even though it [East Gate] is not too good, it is close to us.
Hái yǒu yíge xīn kāide fànguǎnzi lí wǒmen zhèli gèng jìn.
還有一個新開的飯館子離我們這裏更近。
There is also a newly opened restaurant that is even closer to us.
3. Tāmen nàlide cài fēicháng hǎo. Jīntiān wǒ qǐng ni dào nàli qù chī.
它們那裏菜非常好。今天我請你到那裏去吃。
The food there is extremely good. Today I am going to invite you to go there to eat.
Nà bù hǎo yìsi!
那不好意思!
I can’t let you do that! (That would be too embarrassing!)
4. Dàhuáde cài yòu hǎo yòu piǎnyi.
大華的菜又好又便宜。
The food at the Great China is both good and cheap.
Yě yǒu hǎoxiē cài biéde dìfang chībuzháo.
也有好些菜別的地方吃不找。
They also have a good many dishes that you can’t find (at) other places.
5. Nǐ shuōde dìfang yídìng hǎo.
你説的地方一定好。
Any place you suggest is sure to be good.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

6. bù yídìng
不一定
not necessarily; it’s not definite
7. kànfa
看法
opinion, view
8. wǎnfàn
晚飯
supper, dinner
9. xiǎngfa
想法
idea, opinion
10. yìxiē
一些
some, several, a few
11. zǎofàn
早飯
breakfast
12. zuòfa
做法
way of doing things, method, practice

8 Unit 7 Target List

1. Wǒ yǒu yíjiàn shi xiǎng gēn nín dǎting dǎting.
我有一件事想跟您打聽打聽。
I have something I would like to ask you about.
Tīngshuō nín nàbian xīn láile yíwèi Fāng Xiānsheng; tāde míngzi wǒ wàngji le.
聽説您那邊新來了一位方先生;他的名字我忘記了。
I have heard that you recently had a Mr. Fāng join you. I have forgotten his given name.
2. Bú cuò, Fāng Démíng shi shàngge líbài pài dào wǒmen zhèli láide.
不錯,方德明是上個禮拜派到我們這裏 來的。
That’s right. Fāng Démíng was sent over here last week.
Zěnme? Nǐ rènshi ta ma?
怎麽?你認識他嗎?
Why? Do you know him?
3. Wǒ shi Jiāzhōu Dàxué bìyède.
我是加州大學畢業的。
I graduated from the University of California.
4. Nǐ néng bu néng mǎshàng dào wo bàngōngshì lái?
你能不能馬上到我辦公室來?
Can you come to my office right away?
Méi wèntí. Chàbuduō bànge zhōngtóu jiù dào.
沒問題。差不多半個鐘頭就到。
No problem. I’ll be there in about half an hour.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

5. jìde
記得
to remember
6. rènde
認得
to recognize, to know (alternate word for rènshi)
7. rènshi zì
認識字
to know how to read (literally, “to recognize characters”)
8. wàng
to forget (alternate word for wàngji, especially in the sense of forgetting to DO something)
9. wánquán
完全
completely
10. xiǎngqilai
想起來
to think of, to remember
11. zuǒyòu
左右
approximately

9 Unit 8 Target List

1. Wài, zhèi shi Lǐbīnsī.
喂,這是禮賓司。
Hello. This is the Protocol Department.
Wèi, wǒ shi Láidēng Dàshǐde mìshū.
喂,我是萊登大使的秘書。
Hello. I am Ambassador Leyden's secretary.
2. Dàshǐ jiēzháo nǐmende qǐngtiě le.
大使接著你們的請帖了。
The ambassador received your invitation.
Hěn kěxī yīnwei tā yǒu shì, Báyuè jiǔhào bù néng lái.
很可惜因爲他有事,八月九號不能來。
Unfortunately, because he has a previous engagement, he cannot come on August 9。
Qǐng ni zhuǎngào Qiáo Bùzhǎng.
請你轉告譙部長。
Please inform Minister Qiao.
Hěn bāoqiàn.
很抱歉。
I’m very sorry.
3. Hěn yíhàn, tā bù néng lái.
很遺憾,他不能來。
We very much regret that he cannot come.
Wǒ tì ni zhuǎngào yíxià.
我替你轉告一下。
I will pass on the message for you.
4. Xīwang yǐhòu zài zhǎo jīhui jùyijù ba.
希望以後在找機會聚一聚吧。
I hope that later we will find another opportunity to get together.
5. Zhēn bù qiǎo, méi bànfa qù.
真不巧,沒辦法去。
I really couldn’t make that; I have no way of going.
6. Wǒmen yǒu jige tóngxué jìhua dào Chángchéng qù wánr.
我們有幾個同學計劃到長城去玩兒。
A few of us students are planning to go to the Great Wall for an outing.

ADDITIONAL REQUIRED VOCABULARY

(not presented on C-l and P-1 tapes)

7. dàjiā
大家
everybody, everyone
8. jiēdào
接到
to receive (alternate form of jiēzháo)
9. tóngshì
同事
fellow worker, colleague
10. yīnggāi
應該
should, ought to, must

10 Unit 1

10.1 References

10.1.1 Reference List

1. B: Wéi.
Hello.
A: Wài, nǐ shi Zhū Kēzhǎng ma?
喂,你是朱科長嗎?
Hello. Are you Section Chief Zhū?
B: Shì. Nín shi něiwèi?
是。您是哪位?
Yes. Who is this, please?
A: Wǒ shi Wēilián Mǎdīng.
我是威廉馬丁。
I’m William Martin.
B: Òu, Madīng Xiānsheng, hǎo jiǔ bú jiàn. Nǐ hǎo a?
哦,馬丁先生,好久不見。你好啊?
Oh, Mr. Martin—I haven’t seen you for quite a while. How are you?
A: Hǎo. Nǐ hǎo a?
好。你好啊?
Fine. How are you?
2. A: Wǒ yōu diǎnr shì xiǎng gēn nín dāngmiàn tántan.
我有點兒事想跟您當面談談。
I have something I would like to talk with you about in person.
3. A: Bù zhīdào nín yǒu gōngfu meiyou.
不知道您有工夫沒有。
I don’t know whether you have the time or not.
B: Yǒu gōngfu.
有功夫。
I have the time.
4. A: Shénme shíhou duì nín héshì?
什麽時候對您合適?
What time would suit you?
B: Jīntiān, míngtiān dōu kéyi.
今天,明天都可以。
Either today or tomorrow would be fine.
5. A: Jīntiān xiàwǔ liǎngdiǎn zhōng fāngbian ma?
今天下午兩點鐘方便嗎?
Would two o’clock today be convenient?
B: Sāndiǎn bī liǎngdiǎn fāngbian yìdiǎnr.
三點比兩點方便一點兒。
Three would be more convenient than two.
6. B: Yīnwei wǒ yìhuǐr chūqu, yěxǔ liǎngdiǎn huíbulái.
因爲我一會兒出去,也許兩點回不來。
Since I’m going out in a little while, I might not be able to get back by two.
7. B: Nàme, wǒ sāndiǎn zhōng zài lóuxiàde huìkèshì děng nín.
那麽,我三點鐘在樓下的會客室等您。
Well then, I’ll wait for you in the reception room downstairs at three o’clock.
A: Hǎo, sāndiǎn jiàn.
好,三點見。
Fine. I’ll see you at three.
8. huídelái
回得來
to be able to get back in time
9. kòng(r)
空兒
free time, spare time
10. lóushàng
樓上
upstairs
11. shāngliang
商量
to discuss, to talk over
12. yǒu kòng(r)
有空兒
to have free time

10.1.2 Vocabulary

compared with, than
dāngmiàn 當面 in person, face to face
duì to, towards; with regard to, with respect to
gōngfu 功夫 free time, spare time
héshì 合適 to be suitable, to be appropriate, to fit
huíbulái 回不來 to be unable to get back
huídelái 回得來 to be able to get back in time
huìkèshì (huìkèshǐ) 會客室 reception room
kēzhǎng 科長 section chief
kòng(r) 空兒 free time, spare time
lóushàng 樓上 upstairs
lóuxià 樓下 downstairs
nàme 那麽 well, then, in that case
shāngliang 商量 to discuss, to talk over
tán to chat, to talk about
wéi hello (telephone greeting)
yěxǔ 也許 perhaps, maybe
yìhuǐr 一會兒 a moment
yǒu gōngfu 有功夫 to have free time
yǒu kòng(r) 有空兒 to have free time
chūkǒu gōngsī 出口公司 export company
huì kè 會客 to receive guests
xiē several, some
yǒu yòng 有用 to be useful

10.1.3 Reference Notes

10.1.3.1 Notes on №1
1. B: Wéi.
Hello.
A: Wài, nǐ shi Zhū Kēzhǎng ma?
喂,你是朱科長嗎?
Hello. Are you Section Chief Zhū?
B: Shì. Nín shi něiwèi?
是。您是哪位?
Yes. Who is this, please?
A: Wǒ shi Wēilián Mǎdīng.
我是威廉馬丁。
I’m William Martin.
B: Òu, Madīng Xiānsheng, hǎo jiǔ bú jiàn. Nǐ hǎo a?
哦,馬丁先生,好久不見。你好啊?
Oh, Mr. Martin—I haven’t seen you for quite a while. How are you?
A: Hǎo. Nǐ hǎo a?
好。你好啊?
Fine. How are you?

Wéi is a greeting used in telephone conversations for “hello.” Some speakers pronounce this greeting as wài. Unlike most Chinese words, wèi has no fixed tone. The intonation varies according to the speaker’s mood.

Kēzhǎng: means “section,” and zhǎng means “head of an organization.” Here are some examples of how -zhǎng, “chief,” “head,” is used:

section
kēzhǎng 科長 section chief
chù division
chùzhǎng 処長 division chief
xuéxiào 學校 school
xiàozhǎng 校長 principal, headmaster

Nín shi něiwèi? Note the use of the polite terms nín and něiwèi. In the English translation, politeness is expressed by the use of the more indirect “Who is this” instead of “Who are you” and also by “please.”

Hǎo jiǔ bú jiàn, “I haven’t seen you for quite a while,” is interchangeable with hǎo jiǔ méi jiàn.

10.1.3.2 Notes on №2
2. A: Wǒ yōu diǎnr shì xiǎng gēn nín dāngmiàn tántan.
我有點兒事想跟您當面談談。
I have something I would like to talk with you about in person.

Gēn: In No. 2 the word gēn is a prepositional verb translated as “with.” The preposition gēn, “with,” differs from the conjunction gēn, “and,” in two important ways: a) where stress may be placed b) where the negative may be placed.

(a) When gēn is used as the conjunction “and,” both items being joined are stressed and keep their tones. When gēn is used as the prepositional verb “with,” a pronoun which follows is unstressed and loses its tone. Notice the contrasting tones on in the following sentences:

  1. When gēn is used as the conjunction “and,” both items being joined are stressed and keep their tones. When gēn is used as the prepositional verb “with,” a pronoun which follows is unstressed and loses its tone. Notice the contrasting tones on in the following sentences:

    我跟他都來了。 Both he and I came.
    Wǒ gēn tǎ dōu lái le.
    我跟他來。 I’ll come with him.
    Wǒ gēn ta lái.

  2. (b) To make negative a sentence containing the conjunction gēn, “and,” the negative is placed with the main verb. In sentences containing the prepositional verb gēn, “with,” the negative precedes the prepositional verb. (You have seen this pattern with other prepositional verbs, for example, zài [see BIO, Unit 2, notes on Nos. 8–11].) Notice the contrasting positions of the negatives in the examples below:

    我跟他都沒有去。 Neither he nor I went.
    Wǒ gēn tā dōu méiyou qù.
    我沒有跟他去。 I didn’t go with him.
    Wǒ méiyou gēn ta qù.

    Dāngmiàn means “face-to-face.” Literally, dāng means “in the presence of,” and miàn means “face.

10.1.3.3 Notes on №3
3. A: Bù zhīdào nín yǒu gōngfu meiyou.
不知道您有工夫沒有。
I don’t know whether you have the time or not.
B: Yǒu gōngfu.
有功夫。
I have the time.

10.1.3.4 Notes on №4
4. A: Shénme shíhou duì nín héshì?
什麽時候對您合適?
What time would suit you?
B: Jīntiān, míngtiān dōu kéyi.
今天,明天都可以。
Either today or tomorrow would be fine.

10.1.3.5 Notes on №5
5. A: Jīntiān xiàwǔ liǎngdiǎn zhōng fāngbian ma?
今天下午兩點鐘方便嗎?
Would two o’clock today be convenient?
B: Sāndiǎn bī liǎngdiǎn fāngbian yìdiǎnr.
三點比兩點方便一點兒。
Three would be more convenient than two.

10.1.3.6 Notes on №6
6. B: Yīnwei wǒ yìhuǐr chūqu, yěxǔ liǎngdiǎn huíbulái.
因爲我一會兒出去,也許兩點回不來。
Since I’m going out in a little while, I might not be able to get back by two.

10.1.3.7 Notes on №7
7. B: Nàme, wǒ sāndiǎn zhōng zài lóuxiàde huìkèshì děng nín.
那麽,我三點鐘在樓下的會客室等您。
Well then, I’ll wait for you in the reception room downstairs at three o’clock.
A: Hǎo, sāndiǎn jiàn.
好,三點見。
Fine. I’ll see you at three.

10.2 Drills

10.3 Criterion test

10.4 Appendices

10.4.1 Appendix

10.4.2 Appendix

10.4.3 Appendix

10.4.4 Appendix

10.4.5 Appendix

11 Unit 2

11.1 Introduction

11.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

11.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

11.1.3 Material you will need

11.2 References

11.2.1 Reference List

11.2.2 Vocabulary

11.2.3 Reference Notes

11.2.3.1 Notes on №

11.2.3.2 Notes on №

11.2.3.3 Notes on №

11.2.3.4 Notes on №

11.2.3.5 Notes on №

11.2.3.6 Notes on №

11.2.3.7 Notes on №

11.2.3.8 Notes on №

11.3 Drills

11.4 Criterion test

11.5 Appendices

11.5.1 Appendix

11.5.2 Appendix

11.5.3 Appendix

11.5.4 Appendix

11.5.5 Appendix

12 Unit 3

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

12.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

12.1.3 Material you will need

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

12.2.2 Vocabulary

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №

12.2.3.2 Notes on №

12.2.3.3 Notes on №

12.2.3.4 Notes on №

12.2.3.5 Notes on №

12.2.3.6 Notes on №

12.2.3.7 Notes on №

12.2.3.8 Notes on №

12.3 Drills

12.4 Criterion test

12.5 Appendices

12.5.1 Appendix

12.5.2 Appendix

12.5.3 Appendix

12.5.4 Appendix

12.5.5 Appendix

13 Unit 4

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

13.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

13.1.3 Material you will need

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

13.2.2 Vocabulary

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №

13.2.3.2 Notes on №

13.2.3.3 Notes on №

13.2.3.4 Notes on №

13.2.3.5 Notes on №

13.2.3.6 Notes on №

13.2.3.7 Notes on №

13.2.3.8 Notes on №

13.3 Drills

13.4 Criterion test

13.5 Appendices

13.5.1 Appendix

13.5.2 Appendix

13.5.3 Appendix

13.5.4 Appendix

13.5.5 Appendix

14 Unit 5

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

14.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

14.1.3 Material you will need

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

14.2.2 Vocabulary

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №

14.2.3.2 Notes on №

14.2.3.3 Notes on №

14.2.3.4 Notes on №

14.2.3.5 Notes on №

14.2.3.6 Notes on №

14.2.3.7 Notes on №

14.2.3.8 Notes on №

14.3 Drills

14.4 Criterion test

14.5 Appendices

14.5.1 Appendix

14.5.2 Appendix

14.5.3 Appendix

14.5.4 Appendix

14.5.5 Appendix

15 Unit 6

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

15.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

15.1.3 Material you will need

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

15.2.2 Vocabulary

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №

15.2.3.2 Notes on №

15.2.3.3 Notes on №

15.2.3.4 Notes on №

15.2.3.5 Notes on №

15.2.3.6 Notes on №

15.2.3.7 Notes on №

15.2.3.8 Notes on №

15.3 Drills

15.4 Criterion test

15.5 Appendices

15.5.1 Appendix

15.5.2 Appendix

15.5.3 Appendix

15.5.4 Appendix

15.5.5 Appendix

16 Unit 7

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

16.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

16.1.3 Material you will need

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

16.2.2 Vocabulary

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №

16.2.3.2 Notes on №

16.2.3.3 Notes on №

16.2.3.4 Notes on №

16.2.3.5 Notes on №

16.2.3.6 Notes on №

16.2.3.7 Notes on №

16.2.3.8 Notes on №

16.3 Drills

16.4 Criterion test

16.5 Appendices

16.5.1 Appendix

16.5.2 Appendix

16.5.3 Appendix

16.5.4 Appendix

16.5.5 Appendix

17 Unit 8

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

17.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

17.1.3 Material you will need

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

17.2.2 Vocabulary

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №

17.2.3.2 Notes on №

17.2.3.3 Notes on №

17.2.3.4 Notes on №

17.2.3.5 Notes on №

17.2.3.6 Notes on №

17.2.3.7 Notes on №

17.2.3.8 Notes on №

17.3 Drills

17.4 Criterion test

17.5 Appendices

17.5.1 Appendix

17.5.2 Appendix

17.5.3 Appendix

17.5.4 Appendix

17.5.5 Appendix

Chapter 7. Module 7: Society

Student Textbook

1 Objectives

2 Tapes for BIO and associated modules

3 Unit 1 Target List

4 Unit 2 Target List

5 Unit 3 Target List

6 Unit 4 Target List

7 Unit 5 Target List

8 Unit 6 Target List

9 Unit 7 Target List

10 Unit 8 Target List

11 Unit 1

11.1 Introduction

11.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

11.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

11.1.3 Material you will need

11.2 References

11.2.1 Reference List

11.2.2 Vocabulary

11.2.3 Reference Notes

11.2.3.1 Notes on №

11.2.3.2 Notes on №

11.2.3.3 Notes on №

11.2.3.4 Notes on №

11.2.3.5 Notes on №

11.2.3.6 Notes on №

11.2.3.7 Notes on №

11.2.3.8 Notes on №

11.3 Drills

11.4 Criterion test

11.5 Appendices

11.5.1 Appendix

11.5.2 Appendix

11.5.3 Appendix

11.5.4 Appendix

11.5.5 Appendix

12 Unit 2

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

12.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

12.1.3 Material you will need

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

12.2.2 Vocabulary

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №

12.2.3.2 Notes on №

12.2.3.3 Notes on №

12.2.3.4 Notes on №

12.2.3.5 Notes on №

12.2.3.6 Notes on №

12.2.3.7 Notes on №

12.2.3.8 Notes on №

12.3 Drills

12.4 Criterion test

12.5 Appendices

12.5.1 Appendix

12.5.2 Appendix

12.5.3 Appendix

12.5.4 Appendix

12.5.5 Appendix

13 Unit 3

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

13.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

13.1.3 Material you will need

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

13.2.2 Vocabulary

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №

13.2.3.2 Notes on №

13.2.3.3 Notes on №

13.2.3.4 Notes on №

13.2.3.5 Notes on №

13.2.3.6 Notes on №

13.2.3.7 Notes on №

13.2.3.8 Notes on №

13.3 Drills

13.4 Criterion test

13.5 Appendices

13.5.1 Appendix

13.5.2 Appendix

13.5.3 Appendix

13.5.4 Appendix

13.5.5 Appendix

14 Unit 4

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

14.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

14.1.3 Material you will need

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

14.2.2 Vocabulary

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №

14.2.3.2 Notes on №

14.2.3.3 Notes on №

14.2.3.4 Notes on №

14.2.3.5 Notes on №

14.2.3.6 Notes on №

14.2.3.7 Notes on №

14.2.3.8 Notes on №

14.3 Drills

14.4 Criterion test

14.5 Appendices

14.5.1 Appendix

14.5.2 Appendix

14.5.3 Appendix

14.5.4 Appendix

14.5.5 Appendix

15 Unit 5

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

15.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

15.1.3 Material you will need

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

15.2.2 Vocabulary

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №

15.2.3.2 Notes on №

15.2.3.3 Notes on №

15.2.3.4 Notes on №

15.2.3.5 Notes on №

15.2.3.6 Notes on №

15.2.3.7 Notes on №

15.2.3.8 Notes on №

15.3 Drills

15.4 Criterion test

15.5 Appendices

15.5.1 Appendix

15.5.2 Appendix

15.5.3 Appendix

15.5.4 Appendix

15.5.5 Appendix

16 Unit 6

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

16.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

16.1.3 Material you will need

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

16.2.2 Vocabulary

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №

16.2.3.2 Notes on №

16.2.3.3 Notes on №

16.2.3.4 Notes on №

16.2.3.5 Notes on №

16.2.3.6 Notes on №

16.2.3.7 Notes on №

16.2.3.8 Notes on №

16.3 Drills

16.4 Criterion test

16.5 Appendices

16.5.1 Appendix

16.5.2 Appendix

16.5.3 Appendix

16.5.4 Appendix

16.5.5 Appendix

17 Unit 7

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

17.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

17.1.3 Material you will need

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

17.2.2 Vocabulary

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №

17.2.3.2 Notes on №

17.2.3.3 Notes on №

17.2.3.4 Notes on №

17.2.3.5 Notes on №

17.2.3.6 Notes on №

17.2.3.7 Notes on №

17.2.3.8 Notes on №

17.3 Drills

17.4 Criterion test

17.5 Appendices

17.5.1 Appendix

17.5.2 Appendix

17.5.3 Appendix

17.5.4 Appendix

17.5.5 Appendix

18 Unit 8

18.1 Introduction

18.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

18.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

18.1.3 Material you will need

18.2 References

18.2.1 Reference List

18.2.2 Vocabulary

18.2.3 Reference Notes

18.2.3.1 Notes on №

18.2.3.2 Notes on №

18.2.3.3 Notes on №

18.2.3.4 Notes on №

18.2.3.5 Notes on №

18.2.3.6 Notes on №

18.2.3.7 Notes on №

18.2.3.8 Notes on №

18.3 Drills

18.4 Criterion test

18.5 Appendices

18.5.1 Appendix

18.5.2 Appendix

18.5.3 Appendix

18.5.4 Appendix

18.5.5 Appendix

Chapter 8. Module 8: Travelling in China

Student Textbook

1 Objectives

2 Tapes for BIO and associated modules

3 Unit 1 Target List

4 Unit 2 Target List

5 Unit 3 Target List

6 Unit 4 Target List

7 Unit 5 Target List

8 Unit 6 Target List

9 Unit 7 Target List

10 Unit 8 Target List

11 Unit 1

11.1 Introduction

11.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

11.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

11.1.3 Material you will need

11.2 References

11.2.1 Reference List

11.2.2 Vocabulary

11.2.3 Reference Notes

11.2.3.1 Notes on №

11.2.3.2 Notes on №

11.2.3.3 Notes on №

11.2.3.4 Notes on №

11.2.3.5 Notes on №

11.2.3.6 Notes on №

11.2.3.7 Notes on №

11.2.3.8 Notes on №

11.3 Drills

11.4 Criterion test

11.5 Appendices

11.5.1 Appendix

11.5.2 Appendix

11.5.3 Appendix

11.5.4 Appendix

11.5.5 Appendix

12 Unit 2

12.1 Introduction

12.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

12.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

12.1.3 Material you will need

12.2 References

12.2.1 Reference List

12.2.2 Vocabulary

12.2.3 Reference Notes

12.2.3.1 Notes on №

12.2.3.2 Notes on №

12.2.3.3 Notes on №

12.2.3.4 Notes on №

12.2.3.5 Notes on №

12.2.3.6 Notes on №

12.2.3.7 Notes on №

12.2.3.8 Notes on №

12.3 Drills

12.4 Criterion test

12.5 Appendices

12.5.1 Appendix

12.5.2 Appendix

12.5.3 Appendix

12.5.4 Appendix

12.5.5 Appendix

13 Unit 3

13.1 Introduction

13.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

13.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

13.1.3 Material you will need

13.2 References

13.2.1 Reference List

13.2.2 Vocabulary

13.2.3 Reference Notes

13.2.3.1 Notes on №

13.2.3.2 Notes on №

13.2.3.3 Notes on №

13.2.3.4 Notes on №

13.2.3.5 Notes on №

13.2.3.6 Notes on №

13.2.3.7 Notes on №

13.2.3.8 Notes on №

13.3 Drills

13.4 Criterion test

13.5 Appendices

13.5.1 Appendix

13.5.2 Appendix

13.5.3 Appendix

13.5.4 Appendix

13.5.5 Appendix

14 Unit 4

14.1 Introduction

14.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

14.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

14.1.3 Material you will need

14.2 References

14.2.1 Reference List

14.2.2 Vocabulary

14.2.3 Reference Notes

14.2.3.1 Notes on №

14.2.3.2 Notes on №

14.2.3.3 Notes on №

14.2.3.4 Notes on №

14.2.3.5 Notes on №

14.2.3.6 Notes on №

14.2.3.7 Notes on №

14.2.3.8 Notes on №

14.3 Drills

14.4 Criterion test

14.5 Appendices

14.5.1 Appendix

14.5.2 Appendix

14.5.3 Appendix

14.5.4 Appendix

14.5.5 Appendix

15 Unit 5

15.1 Introduction

15.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

15.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

15.1.3 Material you will need

15.2 References

15.2.1 Reference List

15.2.2 Vocabulary

15.2.3 Reference Notes

15.2.3.1 Notes on №

15.2.3.2 Notes on №

15.2.3.3 Notes on №

15.2.3.4 Notes on №

15.2.3.5 Notes on №

15.2.3.6 Notes on №

15.2.3.7 Notes on №

15.2.3.8 Notes on №

15.3 Drills

15.4 Criterion test

15.5 Appendices

15.5.1 Appendix

15.5.2 Appendix

15.5.3 Appendix

15.5.4 Appendix

15.5.5 Appendix

16 Unit 6

16.1 Introduction

16.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

16.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

16.1.3 Material you will need

16.2 References

16.2.1 Reference List

16.2.2 Vocabulary

16.2.3 Reference Notes

16.2.3.1 Notes on №

16.2.3.2 Notes on №

16.2.3.3 Notes on №

16.2.3.4 Notes on №

16.2.3.5 Notes on №

16.2.3.6 Notes on №

16.2.3.7 Notes on №

16.2.3.8 Notes on №

16.3 Drills

16.4 Criterion test

16.5 Appendices

16.5.1 Appendix

16.5.2 Appendix

16.5.3 Appendix

16.5.4 Appendix

16.5.5 Appendix

17 Unit 7

17.1 Introduction

17.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

17.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

17.1.3 Material you will need

17.2 References

17.2.1 Reference List

17.2.2 Vocabulary

17.2.3 Reference Notes

17.2.3.1 Notes on №

17.2.3.2 Notes on №

17.2.3.3 Notes on №

17.2.3.4 Notes on №

17.2.3.5 Notes on №

17.2.3.6 Notes on №

17.2.3.7 Notes on №

17.2.3.8 Notes on №

17.3 Drills

17.4 Criterion test

17.5 Appendices

17.5.1 Appendix

17.5.2 Appendix

17.5.3 Appendix

17.5.4 Appendix

17.5.5 Appendix

18 Unit 8

18.1 Introduction

18.1.1 Topics covered in this unit

18.1.2 Prerequisites to the unit

18.1.3 Material you will need

18.2 References

18.2.1 Reference List

18.2.2 Vocabulary

18.2.3 Reference Notes

18.2.3.1 Notes on №

18.2.3.2 Notes on №

18.2.3.3 Notes on №

18.2.3.4 Notes on №

18.2.3.5 Notes on №

18.2.3.6 Notes on №

18.2.3.7 Notes on №

18.2.3.8 Notes on №

18.3 Drills

18.4 Criterion test

18.5 Appendices

18.5.1 Appendix

18.5.2 Appendix

18.5.3 Appendix

18.5.4 Appendix

18.5.5 Appendix